VoiceNote mPower QT User Guide V 7.5 11 Mary Muller Drive P.O. Box 3044, Christchurch, New Zealand. Telephone +64 3 3844555. Fax +64 3 3844933 E-mail: info@humanware.com World Wide Web: http://www.humanware.com P/N NT442 V1.0 070820 Copyright © 2007 HumanWare Limited, Christchurch, New Zealand. All rights reserved No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form whatsoever without the express written permission of HumanWare Limited. Every effort has been made to ensure that the information contained in this user guide is correct at the time of issue. Neither HumanWare Limited nor its agents assume responsibility for errors or omissions in this information. No liability is assumed for damages resulting from the use of this information. This product complies with the requirements of EMC Directive 89/336/EEC. Braille translation copyright © 19752005 Duxbury Systems, Inc. All rights reserved. The patent for the touch cursor technology incorporated in the BrailleNote is owned by ALVA BV. The Text Adventure Games application in KeySoft uses a software module based upon the Jzip interpreter written by John D. Holder and redistributed according to the terms below: Original source code and programs are available from the Interactive Fiction Archive whose main page is http://www.ifarchive.org/ Jzip V2.1 Infocom/Inform Zcode Format Interpreter  Copyright (c) 2000 John D. Holder. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Authorised European Union Representative: HumanWare Russell Smith House 2 Bullmatt Business Centre Northampton Road, Rushden Northamptonshire NN10 6AR United Kingdom phone: +44 (0) 1933 415 800 fax: +44 (0)1933 411 209 email: eu.info@humanware.com web: www.humanware.com Corporate Headquarters HumanWare Limited 11 Mary Muller Drive, P.O. Box 3044 Christchurch, New Zealand Phone: +64 3 384 4555 Fax: +64 3 384 4933 email: info@humanware.com Web: www.humanware.com North America 175 Mason Circle Concord, CA 94520, USA Phone: (800) 722 3393 Fax: (925) 681 4630 email: us.sales@humanware.com 1030 RenéLévesque, Drummondville, Québec, CANADA Phone: 1888723 7273 Fax: (819) 471 4828 email: ca.sales@humanware.com Europe Russell Smith House 2 Bullmatt Business Centre Northampton Road, Rushden, Northamptonshire NN10 6AR United Kingdom Phone: 01933 415800 Fax: 01933 411209 email: eu.sales@humanware.com Bredaseweg 108a, 4914 NS Oosterhout The Netherlands Phone: 31 162 437 910 Fax: 31 162 437 904 Sjouddev. 8, 35246 Växjö Sweden Phone: 46 470 764 490 Fax: 46 470 711 088 Australia Asia Suite 2, 711 Railway Street, P O Box 944, Baulkham Hills NSW 2153, Australia Phone: (02) 9686 2600 Fax: (02) 9686 2855 email: au.sales@humanware.com Susceptibility to Interference. There may be temporary degradation of the image when the BrailleNote mPower QT is subjected to a strong radiofrequency field, electrostatic discharge or transient electrical noise. FCC Warning. This equipment generates and uses radio frequency energy and if not installed and used properly, in accordance with the manufacturer's instruction, may cause interference to radio and television reception. It has been type tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device in accordance with Subpart B of Part 15 of FCC Rules and Regulations, which are designed to provide reasonable protection against such interference in a residential installation. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: 1. Reorient the receiving antenna. 2. Relocate the equipment with respect to the receiver. 3. Move the equipment away from the receiver. 4. Plug the equipment into a different outlet so that the equipment and receiver are on different branch circuits. If necessary, the user should consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for additional suggestions. The user may find the booklet prepared by the Federal Communication Commission helpful: "How to Identify and Resolve RadioTV Interference Problems". This booklet is available from the U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington, DC 20402. Stock No. 004000003454. Shielded cables and certified Class B peripherals must be used on this product. Using unshielded cables or uncertified peripherals may result in this unit not complying with FCC Rules Part 15. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer could void the user's authority to operate this equipment. Notice for Canada. This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian InterferenceCausing Equipment regulations. Modem Information (USA ONLY) This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules. Located on the equipment is a label that contains, among other information, the FCC registration number and ringer equivalence number (REN). If requested, this information must be provided to the telephone company. The REN is used to determine the quantity of devices which may be connected to the telephone line. Excessive REN's on the telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most, but not all areas, the sum of the REN's should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be connected to the line, as determined by the total REN's contact the telephone company to determine the maximum REN for the calling area. This equipment cannot be used on the telephone companyprovided coin service. Connection to Party Line Service is subject to State Tariffs. If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice isn't practical, the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, you will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe it is necessary. The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations, or procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to make the necessary modifications in order to maintain uninterrupted service. If trouble is experienced with this equipment, please contact: HumanWare 175 Mason Circle Concord CA 94520 Phone 8007223393 If the trouble is causing harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may request you to remove the equipment from the network until the problem is resolved. This equipment uses the following USOC jacks: RJ11C It is recommended that the customer install an AC surge arrester in the AC outlet to which this device is connected. This is to avoid damaging the equipment caused by local lightening strikes and other electrical surges. This equipment is HearingAid Compatible (HAC). The telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic device, including fax machines, to send any message unless such message clearly contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message and the telephone number of the sending machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or any other number for which charges exceed local or longdistance transmission charges.) There may be temporary degradation of the image when the BrailleNote mPower QT is subjected to a strong radiofrequency field, electrostatic discharge or transient electrical noise. Contents 1 Getting Started. 1 1.1 Unpacking your BrailleNote. 1 1.2 General Features. 2 1.3 Software Features. 3 1.4 Orientation. 4 1.5 Keyboard. 5 1.6 Power Switch. 6 1.7 Resetting the VoiceNote mPower QT. 6 1.8 Speech. 7 1.9 Earphones. 7 1.10 KeySoft Concepts. 7 1.11 The KeySoft Menus. 9 1.12 A First Experience. 11 1.13 General Functions. 12 1.14 Switching Between Tasks. 15 1.15 Copying and Pasting Text. 16 1.16 Keyboard Assistance. 16 1.17 Saving before Switching off. 17 1.18 Time and Date. 17 1.19 User Guide. 19 1.20 Where to Now? 20 2 VoiceNote mPower QT Hardware. 21 2.1 The Battery. 21 2.2 Long Term Storage. 25 2.3 Connections and sockets. 26 2.4 PC Cards. 29 2.5 Compact FlashCards. 30 2.6 Secure Digital Cards. 31 2.7 USB Peripherals. 32 2.8 Visual Display. 33 2.9 General Care. 36 3 Word Processor. 37 3.1 What is a Word Processor. 37 3.2 Text and Braille. 37 3.3 The KeyWord Menu. 38 3.4 Documents Folders and Drives. 38 3.5 Opening a Document. 40 3.6 Naming a Document. 41 3.7 Creating a Document. 41 3.8 Reading a Document. 42 3.9 Review Commands. 44 3.10 The Cursor 44 3.11 Format Indicators. 45 3.12 Editing a Document. 47 3.13 Breaking your Document into Pages. 50 3.14 Checking the Word Count and File name. 50 3.15 Searching a Document. 50 3.16 Checking the Cursor Position. 52 3.17 Going to a Specified Position. 53 3.18 Marking Places for Quick Reference. 53 3.19 The Spelling Checker. 54 3.20 Opening ASCII and Plain Braille format Documents. 58 3.21 Large Documents. 60 3.22 Switching Between Documents. 60 3.23 Setting the Default Working Language. 61 4 Book Reader. 63 4.1 Reading the Sample Book. 63 4.2 Additional Reading Commands. 63 4.3 Miscellaneous commands. 65 4.4 Review Book Opening Options. 65 4.5 Reading Books Stored on Other Drives. 67 4.6 Exiting KeyBook. 68 4.7 Bookshare. 68 4.8 DAISY Book Reader. 70 5 General Functions. 79 5.1 Date. 80 5.2 Time Options. 80 5.3 Braille Options. 82 5.4 Keyboard Settings. 84 5.5 Review Voice. 85 5.6 Visual Display. 86 5.7 Next Appointment. 87 5.8 Power and Battery Status. 87 5.9 User Guide. 87 5.10 Insertion. 87 5.11 Repeat and Spell. 88 5.12 Hear Punctuation. 88 5.13 Move to Another Task. 89 5.14 Change Speech Volume Rate and Pitch. 90 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. 90 6 Embossing and Printing Documents. 93 6.1 Setting Up the Embosser or Printer. 93 6.2 Printing with Infrared. 93 6.3 Printing with USB. 93 6.4 Printing with Bluetooth. 94 6.5 Embossing or Printing a Document. 94 6.6 Embossing Options. 95 6.7 Embossing a Group of Documents. 95 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. 96 6.9 Printing a Braille Document. 99 6.10 Testing the Embosser. 99 6.11 The Printer SetUp List. 100 6.12 Testing the Printer. 100 7 Advanced Word Processing. 101 7.1 Overview. 101 7.2 Document Types. 102 7.3 Formatting a Text Document. 103 7.4 Formatting a Text Document for Embossing. 111 7.5 Block Commands. 118 7.6 Cursor Movement Modes. 124 7.7 Moving to the Start of the Next Line. 125 7.8 Moving to the Next Tab. 125 7.9 Inserting the Time Date or Calculator Result. 125 7.10 Binding Spaces. 126 7.11 Pasting an Address. 126 7.12 Working with Documents on other Drives. 126 7.13 Saving a Document. 127 7.14 Quitting a Document. 128 7.15 Creating Other Document Types. 128 7.16 Braille Documents. 129 7.17 Formatting a Braille Document. 131 7.18 Extended Characters. 139 8 Scientific Calculator. 145 8.1 Entering KeyPlus. 145 8.2 Entering a Calculation. 145 8.3 Basic Operations. 147 8.4 Statistical Operations. 151 8.5 Memory Operations. 160 8.6 Scientific Operations. 161 8.7 Inserting a Result or a Calculation. 164 9 Planner. 165 9.1 Entering the Planner. 165 9.2 The KeyPlan Menu. 165 9.3 Selecting a Date. 165 9.4 Scheduling Appointments. 168 9.5 Recurring Appointments. 170 9.6 Reviewing the Appointments. 174 9.7 Changing an Existing Appointment. 176 9.8 Selecting Another Date. 178 9.9 Alarms. 178 9.10 Embossing and Printing. 181 10 Address List. 183 10.1 Adding an Address. 184 10.2 Looking Up an Address. 186 10.3 Changing a Field or Adding More Information. 188 10.4 Deleting a Record. 188 10.5 Duplicating a Record. 189 10.6 Inserting an Address into a Document. 189 10.7 Embossing Addresses. 190 10.8 Printing Addresses. 191 10.9 Templates. 191 10.10 Copying Addresses. 193 10.11 Selecting an Address List. 195 10.12 Creating an Address List. 195 10.13 Using KeyList to Manipulate Databases. 197 11 Email. 199 11.1 What Can KeyMail Do. 199 11.2 KeyMail Menu. 200 11.3 Before You Start. 201 11.4 Correcting Input Errors. 202 11.5 Writing an Email Message. 202 11.6 Email Signatures. 205 11.7 Attaching a file to an email. 205 11.8 Read Email. 206 11.9 Connect to Send and Receive Email. 216 11.10 Setup Options. 218 12 Web Browser. 223 12.1 Connecting to the World Wide Web. 223 12.2 Changing to another part of KeySoft. 224 12.3 Logging on. 224 12.4 Navigation. 225 12.5 Moving from Page to Page or Site to Site. 228 12.6 Page Management. 229 12.7 Application Management. 230 12.8 Favorites. 232 12.9 History. 234 12.10 Saving and Refreshing Web Pages. 236 12.11 Tables. 237 13 Connectivity. 239 13.1 Understanding Connectivity Concepts. 240 13.2 Connection Configurations. 240 13.3 The Connectivity Menu. 241 13.4 Using a Wireless Connection. 242 13.5 Wireless Configuration Options. 246 13.6 Dial up and LAN Connections. 246 13.7 Active Connection Details. 250 13.8 Review an existing connection configuration. 250 13.9 Glossary of terms: 251 13.10 Troubleshooting. 252 13.11 Firewalls. 252 13.12 Bluetooth. 252 13.13 Accessing the Network through your VoiceNote mPower QT. 255 13.14 Connecting your BrailleNote to a PC. 258 13.15 KeySync. 263 13.16 File Synchronization. 271 14 File Manager. 273 14.1 Selecting Files Folders and Drives. 274 14.2 Checking the Spelling of Folder or File Names. 274 14.3 The Directory Option. 274 14.4 Folder Manager. 275 14.5 Document and File Types. 277 14.6 Opening Files using File Manager. 278 14.7 Changing the Order of File Lists. 278 14.8 Selecting Multiple Files. 279 14.9 Copying a File. 280 14.10 Erasing a File. 281 14.11 Renaming a File. 281 14.12 Moving a File. 282 14.13 Protecting a File. 282 14.14 Groups of Files and Wild Cards. 283 14.15 What is a Directory. 284 14.16 Creating Renaming and Erasing SubDirectories. 286 14.17 File Translation. 289 14.18 Translation Menu. 289 14.19 Importing Files. 290 15 Utilities Menu. 303 15.1 Backup or Restore Files. 303 15.2 Pronunciation Dictionary. 306 15.3 Date and Time Set. 308 15.4 Application Programs. 309 15.5 Key Management. 310 16 Media Center. 311 16.1 Media Player. 311 16.2 Audio Recorder. 317 16.3 FM Radio. 323 17 Database Manager. 327 17.1 KeyBase Menu. 328 17.2 Exporting data. 335 17.3 Creating a new Database. 336 17.4 Sort Orders. 343 17.5 Record Title. 344 17.6 Associated Database Name. 344 17.7 Database File Management. 346 18 Games. 347 18.1 Starting a Game. 349 18.2 Entering Commands. 350 18.3 Leaving a game. 352 18.4 Saving Games. 352 18.5 Reading Previous Moves. 353 18.6 Status Line. 354 18.7 Single Key Mode. 355 18.8 Downloading and Playing More Games. 356 18.9 Selecting Games for Children. 356 18.10 Freely Available Games. 356 18.11 Commercial Games. 356 18.12 Hints and Walkthroughs. 357 18.13 Internet Resources. 357 18.14 History of Text Adventure Games. 358 19 Command Summary. 359 19.1 General Commands. 359 19.2 Wordprocessor. 367 19.3 Calculator. 374 19.4 Planner. 377 19.5 Address List. 381 19.6 Email. 382 19.7 Database Manager. 384 19.8 Games. 385 19.9 Unicode Characters. 386 19.10 Web Browser. 387 19.11 Stopwatch. 389 19.12 Media Player. 390 20 Index. 425 1 Getting Started. Welcome to the VoiceNote mPower QT, an innovative personal productivity system, from HumanWare. VoiceNote mPower QT incorporates a computer style keyboard, high quality responsive speech, and a suite of powerful applications running under the Windows CE operating system, all packaged into a truly portable system. This user guide tells you all about the VoiceNote mPower QT. Note: For ease of reading, the VoiceNote mPower QT will be referred to as VoiceNote mPower QT throughout the rest of this user guide. 1.1 Unpacking your BrailleNote. Carefully unpack your BrailleNote. Save the box and packing materials for future use. Your BrailleNote package comprises the following items: VoiceNote mPower QT; AC adapter; Slim line carrying case; stereoEarphones; (except in Australia) USB cable; Modem data cable; Serial communications cable; 9 to 25 pin cable adapter; Audio CD containing a "Getting Started Tutorial;" Getting Started Guide in embossed Braille; Command summary in inkprint; User Guide in inkprint; PC software for BrailleNote Family on CDROM. If you live in the UK, Australia or New Zealand, a modem cable adapter is also included. 1.1.1 Optional items include: BrailleNote GPS. Concise Oxford Dictionary and Thesaurus Nemeth Tutorial Braille Manual. Software Maintenance Agreements. 1.2 General Features. The VoiceNote QT is a compact portable Personal Organizer with a computer style keyboard and synthesized speech output. The VoiceNote mPower QT has serial and USB host and client ports, a Bluetooth transceiver, and a highspeed infrared port. It also has 128MB of flash memory that retains information indefinitely, even if the batteries run flat. A Type 2 CompactFlash slot and a Type 2 PC Card slot allow for additional storage and LAN and/or wireless Network options. The Secure Digital (SD) card slot allows for another 2 Gigabyte of storage, and the USB host port can be used to plug in devices such as keyboards, embossers, printers, card readers, external hard drives and USB thumb drives. For information on compatible devices, see our website at www.humanware.com. 1.3 Software Features. A multipurpose program, called KeySoft, running under the Windows CE operating system, is especially designed for people with a visual impairment. KeySoft provides the following functions: A word processor called KeyWord that is powerful yet surprisingly simple to learn. KeyWord lets you work in Braille or text, and format the same document for printing and embossing. KeyWord has most of the features of an office word processor, including unlimited text insertion, search and replace, indents, clipboard operations, spell check and so on. An email program called KeyMail that lets you send and receive electronic mail, using a secure connection if required. You can also send and receive attachments with your email. An internet browser called KeyWeb, that allows you to search and use the world wide web and also read locally stored html documents. A Media player that plays a range of audio format files and allows you to record and play back memos. It also provides you with an FM Radio that can be automatically tuned and have multiple stations preset. A calendar, scheduler and planner called KeyPlan. Your entries may include alarms that sound even if the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. An address list manager called KeyList that sorts your entries and allows flexible searching. Addresses can be copied into letters and email. A synchronization tool called KeySync that works in conjunction with KeyPlan and KeyList to keep their records up to date with MS Outlook on a PC. A 10 digit scientific calculator called KeyPlus. Support is provided for Nemeth, UK and Unified English Braille (UEB) mathematics. A book reader called KeyBook that enables you to read Braille books, or books in any standard text format including Microsoft Word and DAISY format. Books opened in KeyBook are protected from accidental editing. You can access books from Bookshare.org via KeyWeb, and read them using KeyBook. A Keyboard Learn function that helps you to learn the keyboard layout and the available quick key functions. A File Manager that allows files to be copied, renamed, protected, deleted and translated. A program called ActiveSync that allows the VoiceNote mPower QT disk structure to be viewed and managed on a PC running Microsoft Windows. A Database Manager called KeyBase that allows you to store a wide range of information including recipes, bank records, a catalog of CDs in your CD collection and so on. KeyBase comes with 9 different databases. If you cannot find exactly what you need from the list of supplied databases, you can develop new databases and modify the definition of existing databases. A Games application that enables you to play fun text adventure games, also known as Interactive Fiction. These games are played using textbased input and output A Braille Terminal that allows the BrailleNote to act as a Braille display and keyboard for PCs running screen readers such as Window Eyes or JAWS?. A Remote Synthesizer mode that allows the BrailleNote to act as a speech synthesizer for other computers. A Clock, Calendar and Stopwatch. A Network Client option that lets you use a connection between the BrailleNote and a network to access the rest of the network from your BrailleNote. You can switch easily between these KeySoft functions, which are fully integrated so you can transfer information between them. KeySoft has both forward and back Braille translators, so a text document can be imported into the BrailleNote and translated automatically into an uncontracted (grade 1) or contracted (grade 2) Braille document, and vice versa. The BrailleNote can output its display to a separate visual display called KeyView. Using KeyView, a sighted teacher, parent or colleague can view in real time the work being done on the BrailleNote, including the Braille on the Braille display and an immediate translation from Braille to text. KeyView provides a transparent interface between the print and Braille reader. Information can be transferred to and from another computer such as a PC or Apple Macintosh, or specialized equipment such as a selfcontained scanning system. The VoiceNote mPower QT supports the following Braille codes: American English Braille (US), British Braille (UK), Australian Braille, British Braille 2004 (UK 2004), Unified English Braille (UEB), Braille Français Unifié (BFU), Parisian and Canadian French. Computer Braille is also available for direct interaction with print codes. As standard, the following languages are supported: English, French, Spanish, German and Italian. 1.4 Orientation. VoiceNote mPower QT is supplied in a slim line wrap around leather carry case. To open the case, lift the flap on the front edge. Fold back the case to allow operation of the VoiceNote mPower QT. A panel of netting holds the VoiceNote in place, this runs across the top of the front face, just beyond the keyboard. The speaker is positioned beneath this netting. 1.5 Keyboard. The keyboard has a standard typewriter layout for letters and numbers. To position your hands correctly there are small raised dots on each of the "home" keys, F and J. There is also a raised dot on the I key. As discussed later, the Keyboard Learn mode, accessible from the Main Menu, is an invaluable aid towards learning the placement of the various keys. The bottom row of keys, from the left, consists of 11 keys as follows: CONTROL, HELP, MENU, FUNCTION, SPACE BAR, REPEAT, SINGLE QUOTE, DELETE, LEFT ARROW, DOWN ARROW, and RIGHT ARROW. The function key has a raised dot on it. On the second row, SHIFT is at the lefthand end and SLASH is the rightmost key. The last five keys on the second row are: COMMA, PERIOD, SHIFT, UP ARROW, and SLASH. On the third row, the leftmost key is READ and the rightmost key is ENTER. Between L and ENTER are the usual SEMICOLON and APOSTROPHE keys. On the fourth row, TAB is at the lefthand end and the BACKSLASH key is at the righthand end. The fifth or top row consists of ESCAPE, the numbers 1 through 9, then 0 followed by DASH, EQUALS, and BACKSPACE. To help you locate the number keys, the 3, 7, and 0 keys have raised dots on them. In this User Guide, combination key presses are described in the following way. The instruction: Press READ with T, means that you should hold down the READ key, press the T key briefly, then release both keys. It is important that you fully depress the first key, in this case the READ key, before you press the second key, which is in this case the T key. 1.6 Power Switch. From the front edge of your BrailleNote, move your hand along the left side of the case and towards the rear and you will come upon a rocker type power switch surrounded by a raised rectangular frame. To switch the BrailleNote on, press the power switch near the front of the rocker. A power on message is announced, the content of which will depend on where the BrailleNote was when you last switched off. To switch off, press the power switch near the rear of the rocker. Every time you switch the VoiceNote mPower QT on, its operation resumes in exactly the same place as it was when you switched it off. If you are not sure if the VoiceNote mPower QT is on or off, feel the position of the power switch. If you don’t use the VoiceNote mPower QT for approximately 10 minutes it will enter hibernate mode, where the power drawn from the battery is the same as if the unit was switched off. Pressing any key will end the hibernate mode. If you want the Braille display to come up without typing, press READ with SPACE. If your VoiceNote mPower QT announces "Battery is low," or "Battery is critical" or does not come to life, you should plug in the AC adapter. The power socket is located at the rear of the VoiceNote mPower QT on the extreme left. Locate the socket then the small plug on the end of the AC adapter cable. Plug the small AC adapter plug into the socket. Plug the AC adapter into a wall socket. The message "AC adapter on" is announced to confirm battery charging is in progress. If the VoiceNote mPower QT does not start, wait 30 seconds or so and try switching it off then on again. If this does not work then press the Reset button. The VoiceNote mPower QT immediately beeps to confirm that it has been reset. After about 10 seconds, KeySoft announces a sign on message and resumes from the Main Menu. 1.7 Resetting the VoiceNote mPower QT. The Reset button is located just behind the Power switch. The Reset button is recessed to avoid accidental operation, so you may need to use a pointed object to press it. Details of when and how to reset the BrailleNote are mentioned in context throughout this User Guide. Appendix C Troubleshooting deals with this topic in detail. Resets are also described in Reset Topics in the online index. 1.8 Speech. You can listen to the VoiceNote mPower QT using either the builtin loudspeaker at the center back of the VoiceNote mPower QT or headphones. If headphones are plugged in, the loudspeaker is automatically disabled. The headphone socket is on the back of the VoiceNote mPower QT, directly to the right of the central "bump". To increase the volume, press FUNCTION with PERIOD. To decrease the volume, press FUNCTION with COMMA. You can hold down the FUNCTION key and keep tapping the increase or decrease keys to move several steps up or down the volume scale. 1.9 Earphones. To use the earphones, adjust the volume to a comfortable level after fitting the earphones and while the VoiceNote mPower QT is speaking. The VoiceNote mPower QT will also work with a wide range of other popular ear and headphone styles. 1.10 KeySoft Concepts. Learning to use the VoiceNote mPower QT is easy because the User Interface is very consistent. Similar operations in different parts of KeySoft are carried out in similar ways. This section covers the concepts behind the way KeySoft operates. 1.10.1 Help Messages. At any point in KeySoft you can get information about the options that are available. To do this, press HELP. KeySoft help is context sensitive, which means that you are only given help relevant to your current situation. Remember to press HELP for Help when you need it. It does not affect your work in any way, and after you have finished reading the Help message, you are returned to the point at which you selected Help. When the help system is being used to review a list of available commands, pressing ENTER on the announced command will cause that command to be executed. 1.10.2 Prompts. Whenever KeySoft requires input from you, a brief message called a prompt is announced. The prompt indicates what input is required from you. If you are unsure how to respond, press HELP for help. Where possible, KeySoft offers reasonable suggested choices. 1.10.3 Repeating Spoken Prompts. If you miss hearing a prompt when it is spoken the first time, don't worry. You can listen to it again by pressing REPEAT. 1.10.4 Automatic Cutoff of Prompts. KeySoft gives detailed spoken prompts and messages to help you learn the system. To prevent these messages slowing down an experienced user, speech is cut off automatically by the next keystroke. 1.10.5 Menus. KeySoft uses a series of menus to provide a quick and easy way of performing many complex functions. Each menu contains a list of options from which to choose. For example, the Main Menu allows you to select the Word Processor, Planner, Address List, and so on. The selection of items is described in 1.11.1 Reviewing the Main Menu. Many of the more frequently used functions are also available via shortcut key combinations. These are mentioned in context throughout this user guide, as well as being listed in the Command Summary. 1.10.6 Exiting the Current Activity. Another concept used throughout KeySoft is that of exiting what you are doing and taking one step back to the previous option point. You can do this by pressing ESCAPE. 1.10.7 Instant Access. You can switch from one KeySoft task to another with a simple key sequence. For example, you can switch from the Word Processor to the Planner, and then return to the same point in your document. For information on how to do this, refer to 1.14 Switching Between Tasks. 1.11 The KeySoft Menus. 1.11.1 Reviewing the Main Menu. To start with, go to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. KeySoft announces: "Main Menu." To announce the first item of the Main Menu, press SPACE. KeySoft announces: "Word processor." You could select the word processor at this point, but our present object is to review all the items in the Main Menu. So, press SPACE repeatedly, pausing to read and listen to each of the 16 options in the menu, which are: Word Processor; Planner; Address List; Email; Internet; Media Player; Book Reader; Scientific Calculator; Database Manager; Games; File Manager, which allows files to be copied, translated, etc; Utilities, which is a group of general purpose functions; Remote Synthesizer, which makes the VoiceNote mPower QT act as a speech synthesizer for other computers; Keyboard Learn, which helps you to learn the Braille keyboard functions; For Information press READ with I, which provides information about the VoiceNote mPower QT such as the serial number and software version. For the Options Menu, press FUNCTION with O, anywhere, which is a reminder of how to access the Options Menu. The last item is: "End of Menu." Having stepped forward along the menu by pressing SPACE repeatedly, you can step back by pressing BACKSPACE repeatedly. When using speech, if you don't want to hear a complete announcement, you can cut it off and move to the next item by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE. This speech cutoff occurs at all points in KeySoft. 1.11.2 Structure. The entry point to KeySoft is the Main Menu, which contains 16 items. You can announce each of these items in turn, and select one. When you have done this, you are generally presented with another menu. The system may extend to 3 or 4 levels of submenu. This structure is an important aspect of KeySoft. Items are grouped together for easy location, so a huge range of functions can be found from one starting point, the Main Menu. For example, if you start at the Main Menu and choose the Word processor option, you are presented with the KeyWord menu. This contains the following items: Create a document, Open a document, Emboss a document, Print a document, and Setup options. These all relate to wordprocessing. If you choose to Emboss a document, you are presented with a further choice of Embossing, or Setting up the embosser, and so on. 1.11.3 Selecting from the Main Menu. When KeySoft announces the option you want, press the ENTER key. The exceptions are Information and Options Menu, which contain directions on how to access them. Don't worry about getting in over your head, because you can always back out of a selection by pressing ESCAPE for exit on the keyboard. When you have selected an item from the Main Menu, you are generally presented with another menu, from which you can again select an item. To announce a Help message describing your options at any point, press HELP. To return to the previous menu, press ESCAPE. To go directly to the Main Menu, press MENU. 1.11.4 Keyboard shortcuts. As well as moving through the menus an item at a time as described in the previous section, you can take a keyboard shortcut directly to a menu item by typing its first letter. This automatically selects the item that starts with that letter. KeySoft takes you straight to the action selected. For example, if you are at the Main Menu and you want to go to the Word processor, you can press W. KeySoft goes straight to "KeyWord Menu". Press O and the "Open a Document" option is selected and KeySoft goes straight to the "Folder Name" prompt. This is a real time saver. 1.12 A First Experience. Most people hate reading User Guides. They would much rather just have a go, on the presumption that if the product is any good, it should be obvious how it works. If that's you, then this is your section. We'll go through two simple demonstrations: in the first we'll create a basic word processor document, and in the second we'll do an addition with the calculator. You should only need the simple commands that have been introduced so far. If you are not keen on jumping in at the deep end, don't panic. It's not essential to follow these demonstrations, because after this part we'll revert to normal manual mode, and describe in detail all the wonderful things that the VoiceNote mPower QT can do. 1.12.1 General. Most people hate reading User Guides. They would much rather just have a go, on the presumption that if the product is any good, it should be obvious how it works. If that's you, then this is your section. We'll go through two simple demonstrations: in the first we'll create a basic word processor document, and in the second we'll do an addition with the calculator. You should only need the simple commands that have been introduced so far. If you are not keen on jumping in at the deep end, don't panic. It's not essential to follow these demonstrations, because after this part we'll revert to normal manual mode, and describe in detail all the wonderful things that the VoiceNote mPower QT can do. 1.12.2 Writing a Simple Document. The aim of this first exercise is to write a very simple document with the word processor. To reach a common starting point, go to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. Your BrailleNote announces: "Main menu." To get to the word processor, press W. Your BrailleNote announces: "KeyWord menu." To Create a document, press C, for Create, and your BrailleNote announces: "Folder name? General," KeySoft is asking which part of its filing system you want to use, and is offering the "General" folder. This is fine for now, so follow the prompt and press ENTER. KeySoft then announces: "Document to create?" You are being asked to provide a name for the new document, so type a name such as: "test." When you have typed the name, press ENTER. Your BrailleNote announces: "Top of document. Blank." This means that you have created a new document named “Test,” and the cursor is sitting at the top of it. You are now free to type whatever you like. For this demo, just type a simple sentence such as: "This is a test of my new VoiceNote mPower QT." type the first word and press SPACE. Each word is spoken when the space bar is pressed. Complete your sentence. That's all we'll write for now. To finish this little exercise, press ESCAPE. Your VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "KeyWord menu." You are back at the Word processor menu, and your new document has been automatically saved. If you press ESCAPE again you arrive back where you started, at the Main Menu. 1.12.3 Trying Out the Calculator. You might also like to try out the Calculator, which you can do without any extensive knowledge of the VoiceNote mPower QT. From the Main Menu, go to the Scientific Calculator by pressing S. You hear: "KeyPlus. Zero." This means that the Calculator is ready. If someone has previously used the Calculator and it announces another number than zero, you can clear it by pressing CONTROL with I. Let's try calculating 2 + 3. The plus function is obtained by pressing the EQUALS key, you don't need to press SHIFT to obtain the plus function. To calculate the result, press ENTER. Your VoiceNote mPower QT should announce the answer "5". To complete the exercise, press MENU, to return to the Main Menu. 1.13 General Functions. Some useful general functions are available wherever you are in KeySoft. These functions may be accessed from the Options Menu, or often more conveniently via a Quick Command sequence. The general functions allow you to control the configuration of Time, Date, Braille settings and so on. You could be using the Word processor, or using the Calculator, or reading a menu when you request one of these functions. After display of the requested function you are returned to the place from where you initiated the request. The Quick Commands typically use the SPACE, BACKSPACE or ENTER key in combination with another letter. For example, FUNCTION with T announces the current time. Not all items on the Options Menu have an associated Quick Command key combination. The Options Menu can be accessed from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with O. You use the Options Menu in the same way as the Main Menu. For example, you can review the menu list by pressing the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys on the keyboard. The Options Menu contains the following items. Where applicable, the equivalent Quick Command is also given. Date; FUNCTION with D Time Options; For Time press FUNCTION with T For Stopwatch press FUNCTION with W Grade of Braille for Keyboard entry; Braille Options; Keyboard settings; FUNCTION with K Review voice; FUNCTION with R Connectivity; Visual display; Next appointment; FUNCTION with N Power and Battery status; User Guide; READ with HELP Insertion; FUNCTION with I Spell. Repeat and spell; FUNCTION with L Hear punctuation. Repeat with maximum punctuation; FUNCTION with P Move to another task; FUNCTION with S and finally the speech settings, a list of 6 items that tell you how to adjust the volume, speed and pitch of KeySoft's speech, and the 2 media player volume commands complete the Options menu. The "Insertion" item is announced only when it is appropriate to insert such things as the date or time such as in KeyWord. As with all KeySoft menus, to select an item, move through the menu until the required item is displayed, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, from anywhere in the menu, press the initial letter of your choice. This does not apply to the speech settings, which are discussed in 1.13.2 Setting Volume and Pitch. The characteristics of the BrailleNote's voice can be changed anywhere in KeySoft. See. We will now deal with some of the more commonly used items in the Options Menu. All the functions in the Options Menu are detailed in Chapter 5. 1.13.1 Setting the Keyboard Voice. The first of these settings determines how KeySoft speaks what you type. Press FUNCTION with O, then K for Keyboard. KeySoft announces: "Keyboard voice? Words." The options are as follows: To turn off speech altogether, press F followed by ENTER; To spell words as they are typed, press S followed by ENTER; To speak whole words, press W followed by ENTER; To both spell and speak words, press B followed by ENTER; Or just press ENTER to leave the selection unchanged. The suggested setting is "Words." You can request help, using HELP for a reminder of these options. When you have set the Keyboard Voice, you are then asked to set your preferred typing Braille grade for each language on your BrailleNote. When you have set this, KeySoft announces "Do you wish to be advised when Braille input is required?" Finally you are asked whether you wish to use 6 or 8 dot Computer Braille. 1.13.2 Setting Volume and Pitch. The characteristics of VoiceNote mPower QT's voice can be changed anywhere in KeySoft, as follows: To increase the volume, press FUNCTION with PERIOD; (This command changes the overall volume on the BrailleNote, including the volume of the media player.) To decrease the volume, press FUNCTION with COMMA; (This command affects the overall volume, including the volume of the media player.) For faster speech, press FUNCTION with EQUALS; For slower speech, press FUNCTION with HYPHEN; For higher pitch, press SHIFT with FUNCTION with EQUALS; For lower pitch, press SHIFT with FUNCTION with DASH. There are 32 volumes, 16 speeds and 16 pitches, and they change one step at each key press. A reminder of the commands is given in the Options Menu, at the end of the list. 1.13.3 Repeating an Announcement. As we have already mentioned, you can get KeySoft to say a prompt again by pressing REPEAT if you didn't quite catch it. To repeat the prompt with variables such as file names or folder names spelled out, press FUNCTION with L. To reveal the most detail, you can repeat the last prompt with full punctuation and spaces. To do this, press FUNCTION with P (Hear Punctuation). After either command you are returned to your original place in KeySoft. 1.13.4 Power and Battery Status. The VoiceNote mPower QT Power & Battery status can be obtained at any time. Press FUNCTION with O, then P. KeySoft announces the battery charge level as a percentage of fully charged, and whether the AC Adapter is On or Off. For more details, refer to. 1.14 Switching Between Tasks. KeySoft allows you to move directly from one KeySoft task to another without returning to the Main Menu. You can switch between the Word processor, Scientific Calculator, Planner, Address List, EMail, etc. For example, if you are writing a document and you need an address, you can switch directly to the Address List, look up the address, and then return to the Word processor. You are placed back at the same point in your document. The following hot keys are available for switching tasks: To select the Word Processor press FUNCTION with 4; To select the Scientific Calculator press FUNCTION with 5; To select the Database Manager press SHIFT with FUNCTION with D; To select the Games press FUNCTION with G; To select the Planner press FUNCTION with 6; To select the Address List press FUNCTION with 7; To select the Email system press FUNCTION with 8; To select the Book Reader press FUNCTION with 9; To select the Internet browser, press FUNCTION with 0 (zero); To select the Media Player, press FUNCTION with M; To select the FM Radio, press FUNCTION with F. To select the Braille Terminal option, press BACKSPACE with ENTER with T.. There is also a Task menu available. To access this, either: 1. Press FUNCTION with O for the Options menu then M for Move to another task, or 2. Press FUNCTION with S. KeySoft announces: "Task Menu." You can make a selection from the Task Menu in any of the usual ways, for example: 1. Review the menu items using SPACE and select one by pressing ENTER or, 2. Press the initial letter of the task; for example, W for Word Processor. Remember that, if necessary, you can always get back to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. 1.15 Copying and Pasting Text. Are you feeling tired of typing long website addresses, phone numbers that are too hard to remember and complicated addresses? The ability to copy and paste text , is yet another useful feature of KeySoft. You can easily copy and paste a website address from KeyWord or KeyMail when you encounter the address prompt in KeyWeb. You can also copy and paste phone numbers and addresses from KeyMail or KeyList fields. To copy and paste entries within KeyList, KeyMail and KeyWeb, use the following commands: Copy to the clipboard: CONTROL with K Paste text into a field: CONTROL with V 1.16 Keyboard Assistance. There are two ways of getting help with keyboard input. The first is available from the Main Menu, and is called "Keyboard Learn." In Keyboard Learn, KeySoft announces the function of the key that you press, but no further action results. It also announces the function of the key commands that are always available. For example, pressing FUNCTION with T will give the response “announce the time.” Keyboard Learn is invaluable for familiarizing yourself with the keyboard layout and Quick Commands that are available at any point within KeySoft. The second mode works in the Word processor, Web Browser, Calculator, Planner and Book Reader . It is called Announce Key mode, and can be entered by pressing READ with A. The function of any key or key combination is announced. For example, in the Word processor, READ with J announces: "Back one word," without causing any further action. Announce Key mode is helpful for learning the commands available in the selected KeySoft application. You can exit either mode by pressing ESCAPE. 1.17 Saving before Switching off. Before you switch off your VoiceNote mPower QT, it is good practice to return to the Main Menu first. This ensures your current work is saved. If you don't do this, and subsequently the battery becomes discharged, the current version of your work will be lost. That's fairly unlikely, but it's good insurance for the cost of one keystroke. If you have storage cards and/or an external memory drive , you should consider backing up your work regularly. It's a common thing to do with any computer. It minimizes the amount of data you could lose should a computer or software "crash" occur. You can back up all your working files by using the Back up function in the Utilities menu, as described in 15.1.1 Backing Up. 1.18 Time and Date. The Time and Date commands are available from anywhere within KeySoft. To announce the current day and date, press FUNCTION with D. To announce the current time, press FUNCTION with T. If the date or time is incorrect you can set new values, and set how you prefer them to be displayed using the “Date and Time Set” option in the Utilities Menu. If the BrailleNote’s battery goes completely flat, the system will advise that the time and date need to be set. To set the Date and Time, follow this procedure. Remember that online help is available at any point by pressing HELP, and that if you wish to leave a announced value unchanged, just press ENTER. You may exit at any point by pressing ESCAPE. 1. Return to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. 2. Press U to go to the Utilities Menu. 3. Press D to go to the Date and Time set option. 4. Choose your preferred date format. For USA format where the date is in the form month/day/year press S, or for UK format where the date is in the form day/month/year press K. To save your entry, press ENTER. 5. Choose your preferred time format, 12 or 24 hour. For a 12hour clock press A, for a 24hour clock press B then complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 6. Select your Time Zone. To cycle through the list of Time Zones, press CONTROL with SPACE. Alternatively press the initial letter of the Time Zone. Complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 7. Select your Daylight Saving Setting. If you are currently in Daylight Saving Time, press Y. If you are not, press N. Press ENTER. 8. Enter the current time and press ENTER. For instructions on how to enter the time in the format you have selected, press HELP. 9. Enter the current date and press ENTER. For instructions on how to enter the date in the format you have selected, Press HELP. 10. Enter the day of the week that you would like the week to start on. Press S for Sunday, or M for Monday. After setting the time and date you will be returned to the Utilities Menu. Note: If you use ActiveSync, it is possible to have the BrailleNote's time and date automatically set to be the same as the time and date on your PC when you connect. If you choose this option, it is very important that your BrailleNote and PC are set to the same Time Zone. See 13.14 Connecting your BrailleNote to a PC. VoiceNote mPower QT provides many user definable options. As you get to know more about how your VoiceNote mPower QT works, you can change the way it behaves to better suit your personal preferences. Your VoiceNote mPower QT supplier will most probably have set the User settings most appropriate to your needs. The following items will be of principal interest: Speech; volume, rate, and pitch; Time and date correctly set, and in preferred format; Keyboard input voice setting; words, characters, or off; Review or reading voice settings; punctuation settings, numbers or digits; Preferred English Braille Code  US, UK, Australian, Unified English Braille (UEB), UFB, or UK2004; Braille Code settings for additional languages; Braille grade for keyboard input; grade 1, 2 or computer Braille; Calculator Braille Code; Nemeth, UK, UEB, French or German; Computer Braille table  US or UK. Computer Braille 6 dot or 8 dot; Spelling checker dictionary language installed; Address list database installed; Email database installed. Some of these items have already been covered in this chapter, but for convenience, Appendix A of the User Guide provides additional assistance and, if appropriate, a reference to the relevant section in the User Guide. The next section explains how to use the Electronic User Guide to read a particular section of the user guide. After reading this next section, you could use the Electronic User Guide to read Appendix A, User settings for the VoiceNote mPower QT. 1.19 User Guide. This User Guide is built into KeySoft, so that you can look it up any time you want. Using either the Table of Contents or the Index to locate a reference, the User Guide will take you directly to the topic you wish to read. Alternatively, the entire User Guide is available in several PC friendly formats on the CDRom that came with your VoiceNote mPower QT. This gives you the option of working through a chapter trying things out on the VoiceNote mPower QT while reading the user guide on a PC, printing or embossing a copy etc. The rest of this section concentrates on the onboard User Guide, how to access it and how to use it. 1.19.1 Location of User Guide Files. As an alternative to accessing the Electronic User Guide through its Table of Contents or Index, you can also read the User Guide as a number of KeyWord documents. Each chapter and appendix is a separate KeyWord text document. These documents are stored in a folder called "Manual" on your KeySoft System Disk drive. If you wish to read the User Guide like a book rather than look up specific references, simply open the chapter or appendix in the Book Reader like any other book file. 1.19.1.1 User Guide Version Check. There is a simple version check built into the User Guide. Simply access the Index, and select the "Version" entry in the usual way. When you press ENTER it will display "This User Guide is for the VoiceNote mPower QT using version x.x of KeySoft." If the model name or version is not what you expected, contact your distributor. 1.19.1.2 Version. This User Guide is for the VoiceNote mPower QT using version 7.5 of KeySoft. 1.20 Where to Now? By now you should have a good basic knowledge of the VoiceNote mPower QT and KeySoft. The entire User Guide is stored in the VoiceNote mPower QT so you can read each chapter at your leisure. The User Guide can be read using your VoiceNote mPower QT as previously described. A good starting point is to browse through the Table of Contents, as this will provide you with an appreciation of the topics covered in the User Guide. Please read the next chapter, which concerns practical hardware matters like the batteries, port connectors and card slots. To read chapter 2, follow the procedure discussed in the previous section. You will find chapter 2 in the Table of Contents so you can select it from there and start reading. After Chapter 2, most of the remainder of the User Guide is all about KeySoft and you can pick and choose what to read. If you are new to KeySoft, you might want to work through Chapter 3, which introduces the basic Word processor functions. You might then want to read Chapter 5, which deals with the functions available via the Options Menu, or Chapter 7 for advanced word processing features. Chapter 4 covers the book reader, and how to download books from Bookshare.org, if this site is available in your area. And chapter 6 covers how to emboss or print documents. Alternatively, you can read Chapter 8 on the Calculator, Chapter 9 on the Planner, or Chapter 10 on the Address List. If you are interested in using email or accessing the internet, and/or using the other connectivity options the VoiceNote mPower QT offers, read Chapter 13 on Connectivity, then Chapter 11 on Email, or Chapter 12 on the Web Browser, depending on your interest and requirements. Chapter 14 describes use of the File and Folder Manager, and the translation of files from Text to Braille and other formats. Chapter 15 covers the Utilities menu, where topics like backing up, restoring files and software upgrades are discussed. Chapter 16 covers the Media Player and audio recording facilities. It also includes how to access the FM Radio. Chapter 17 covers the Database Manager. If you are keen for a bit of a distraction from your work or want to sharpen your mind, read Chapter 18 to learn how to play games on your VoiceNote mPower QT. Chapter 19 provides a convenient listing of all the keyboard commands for the VoiceNote mPower QT. These are categorized under general commands as well as commands for each of the applications of KeySoft. You might find it tedious to read a User Guide, but we have endeavored to make sure it is full of useful information, and it's surprising what sticks in your memory. When people say, "I didn't know you could do that!" it usually means that they haven’t read the User Guide. And remember; please make frequent use of VoiceNote mPower QT’s superb Help that you can access at any point by pressing HELP. It's a valuable source of information, whatever part of KeySoft you are using. End of Getting Started Chapter. 2 VoiceNote mPower QT Hardware. 2.1 The Battery. The VoiceNote mPower QT can operate from its internal rechargeable battery or from its AC adapter. The length of time you can run the VoiceNote mPower QT from a fully charged battery is typically over 20 hours before it becomes flat. Activities like embossing, emailing and using ports or wireless connectivity increase the drain on the battery. Using the builtin modem also drains the battery more than, say, editing documents. Storage cards and USB devices that draw their power from the VoiceNote mPower QT's battery, also reduce the available battery life. The VoiceNote mPower QT warns you if the battery is getting low. When the battery gauge indicates that the battery is down to 10% full or less the following warning is announced periodically: "Battery is low." If possible, connect the AC adapter to recharge the battery now. You typically have about 2 hours of battery life remaining. If the battery continues to run down and becomes nearly flat, KeySoft announces the following message: "Battery is critical." If this message is announced you should act within the next minute or your VoiceNote mPower QT may switch itself off. The time available to switch off may be as little as 1 minute but it is typically 5 to 10 minutes if you are not using high current accessories. You have two options. You can connect the AC adapter and carry on working indefinitely, or you can save your current work and switch off. To save your work, just return to the Main Menu. If the VoiceNote mPower QT switches itself off, it cannot be switched on again until it is powered from the AC adapter. If the battery becomes flat, the VoiceNote will switch itself off and will not switch on again until you connect the AC adapter. If you connect the AC adapter within an hour or two you will not lose work that was in progress and your VoiceNote will resume where it left off. However, if you leave it longer, any unsaved work may be lost. It is therefore important to heed the battery warnings! Your VoiceNote mPower QT automatically manages its power usage to give you the maximum life from the battery. It will enter into hibernate mode after about 10 minutes of inactivity and stay in that mode until you next press a key. You can help by switching off your VoiceNote mPower QT when you are not going to be using it for a while. Remember that you can switch your VoiceNote mPower QT off and on without affecting your work in any way and your VoiceNote mPower QT resumes from where you were when you switched off. 2.1.1 Charging the battery. To charge the battery, simply plug the AC adapter in and the VoiceNote mPower QT looks after the battery charging itself. There is no chance of overcharging and damaging your batteries, so don't be afraid to leave the AC adapter connected at all times. Once the battery is fully charged, only a very small amount of power is used. Leaving the AC adapter connected ensures that the VoiceNote mPower QT remains fully charged ready for when you next need to use it on battery power. If the battery is flat and the AC adapter is connected, the battery is fast charged in about 5 hours. Charging takes less time if the battery is only partially discharged. You can charge the battery and use the VoiceNote mPower QT simultaneously although the battery may take longer to charge. To ensure that the battery charges correctly, only charge in ambient temperatures between 41 and 95 degrees Fahrenheit, that is, 5 to 35 degrees Celsius. If the ambient temperature is too high, there is a risk that the battery will not charge. We therefore recommend that if the temperature is nearing 95 degrees Fahrenheit, that is, 35 degrees Celsius, leave your VoiceNote mPower QT to charge in a cool place with the carry bag lid open. There is no danger in doing this, and no harm can come to your VoiceNote mPower QT! To connect the AC adapter, locate the power socket on the back of the VoiceNote mPower QT, near the lefthand corner of the case. Insert the plug on the AC adapter cable into the socket, and plug the AC adapter into a wall socket. The VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "AC adapter on." The message is announced even if the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. If this message is not announced after a second or two, check that the AC supply is switched on, and that the plug on the end of the AC adapter cord is inserted securely into the VoiceNote mPower QT's power socket. When the battery is charging, if the AC supply is interrupted, or the AC adapter is disconnected the VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "AC adapter off.” This message, too, is announced even if the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. 2.1.2 Checking Power Status. You can check the stateofcharge of the battery and whether the AC adapter is connected from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with O, then P. First, the battery stateofcharge in percent is announced: “Level c percent,” where c is the battery's stateofcharge. Then the AC adapter status is announced: "Adapter (status)," where "status" is either "on" or "off." After these messages are announced, you are returned to your original place in KeySoft. 2.1.3 Battery Care. Like all rechargeable batteries, as the VoiceNote mPower QT battery ages, its capacity reduces. If your VoiceNote mPower QT is used and charged every day, we expect that the battery will typically last 18 months before its capacity is noticeably lower than it was when new. To have the battery replaced, send the VoiceNote mPower QT back to an authorized Service Center. Do not attempt to replace it yourself. Replacement batteries are expected to typically last 18 months before they too, need replacing. To ensure the battery achieves its maximum life, we recommend that you "condition" the battery every month or so. To condition the battery you don’t have to stop using the VoiceNote, simply fully charge it, disconnect the AC adapter, use it on battery power until "Battery is critical" is announced, and then as soon as you can, reconnect the adapter and fully charge it again. If you haven’t conditioned the battery for a while, the VoiceNote mPower QT will remind you by including the message "Battery conditioning recommended" when you check the Power Status. 2.1.4 The Battery Gauge. VoiceNote mPower QT incorporates a battery gauge that keeps track of the battery’s state of charge. To operate correctly, this gauge must remain calibrated. It is originally calibrated at the factory and for best performance needs to recalibrate periodically as the battery ages. This will happen automatically when you condition the battery as described in 2.1.3 Battery Care. On rare occasions the battery gauge might become too inaccurate for KeySoft to give a percentage state of charge when you check the power status. If this is the case, KeySoft will announce: "AC Adapter (status). The gauge needs recalibrating and is not accurate enough to give a percentage reading", when you request the power status. If the AC Adapter is not plugged in, KeySoft will also announce: "The battery is critical" or "The battery is not critical." You can continue using the VoiceNote mPower QT, but will not be able to find out the percentage power status or receive "Battery low" messages. However, you will still receive "Battery critical" messages if the battery level becomes critical. If KeySoft tells you that the battery gauge needs recalibrating, you can either condition the battery as described in 2.1.3 Battery Care or recalibrate it manually as described in 2.1.5 How to manually recalibrate the Battery. 2.1.5 How to manually recalibrate the Battery. To manually set up the VoiceNote mPower QT to recalibrate its battery, you will need a spot where it can chatter away to itself without disturbing anyone, with a nearby power socket to connect the AC adapter. 1. On the VoiceNote mPower QT, make sure you have no unsaved work. It is very important that you remove any storage cards, or card or USB devices. 2. Go to the Options Menu by pressing FUNCTION with O. 3. Press READ with I. KeySoft will announce "Support Information Mode". 4. Select the "Recalibrate the Battery gauge" option by pressing R. If you haven't already plugged in the AC Adapter, you will be asked to do so. 5. What KeySoft does next depends on how much charge is left in the battery at this time, however it is all automatic. It may not happen initially but when the process gets to the point of discharging the battery, KeySoft will talk repetitiously to help it to do so, thus the need to choose a spot where the noise won't bother you. Once the battery is flat, KeySoft will automatically initiate the recharging cycle. When the whole cycle is complete, KeySoft will announce: "Battery Test Completed." You can check the status of the recalibration process at any time by pressing SPACE. This will give you the times for the various charge and discharge stages depending on which stage it is in. 2.1.6 Checking Battery Information. As well as recalibration, you can also check a range of battery and battery gauge characteristics using the Support Information mode. To enter the Support Information mode from anywhere in KeySoft press FUNCTION with O, followed by READ with I. You can now select the following options and in all cases, you are returned to Support Information Mode after the command has been executed: 1. To find out if the battery gauge has recalibrated and is accurate, press A. If the battery gauge is calibrated, KeySoft will prompt, "Gauge is accurate, Error: plus or minus 2%." If the battery has not been conditioned for a while, KeySoft will prompt, "Battery conditioning recommended, Error: plus or minus x%." See 2.1.3 Battery Care for details on conditioning the battery. If the gauge is inaccurate, KeySoft will prompt, "Gauge is not accurate, Error: plus or minus 100%." The battery gauge needs recalibrating. See 2.1.4 The Battery Gauge for details. 2. To determine when and for how long the battery was last charged, press B. The reported time indicates how long the AC adapter was connected. The report is in the form: Last charge: 234 minutes. Completed: Friday, February 9, at 2:47pm. Started: Friday, February 9, at 10:53am. 3. To determine the charge available from the battery, press C. For example, a typical message is: "Nominal available charge 980." The higher the value the greater the charge. 4. To determine the last measured discharge of the battery and its design capacity, press D. The last measured discharge is the capacity measured the last time the battery gauge was calibrated. For example, a typical discharge message is: "Last measured discharge 1638. Design capacity 1650." The higher the value the greater the capacity available from the battery when it is fully charged. 5. To determine the charging status, press S. For example, if the AC adapter is connected, the VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Fast charging", or "Trickle charging." If not, the VoiceNote mPower QT announces "Discharging." 6. To announce the voltage of the battery, press V. For example: "Battery voltage 7.2 Volts" To return to the place where you selected the Options menu, press ESCAPE. 2.2 Long Term Storage. If you store a fully charged VoiceNote for more than two weeks, the battery will become completely flat. If the battery was less than fully charged prior to storing the VoiceNote, the time for the battery to become fully flat will be shorter. This is because the battery self discharges internally and because the VoiceNote mPower QT draws a very small amount of current, even when it is switched off. When the battery becomes completely flat, the battery gauge may become inaccurate and will need recalibrating as described in 2.1.4 The Battery Gauge. If you intend to leave the VoiceNote switched off for more than a few days, fully charge the battery beforehand, or leave the AC adapter connected, if convenient. If you intend to store a VoiceNote for more than two to three weeks without the AC adapter connected, ensure your work is saved by returning to the Main Menu, and fully charging the battery before putting the VoiceNote into storage. When you take a VoiceNote out of longterm storage, first connect the AC adapter and recharge the battery BEFORE switching the VoiceNote mPower QT on. If it does not resume normally, press the Reset switch with a pointed object. The VoiceNote will beep to confirm that it has been reset. Wait a few seconds while the VoiceNote initializes itself. If the battery has gone quite flat, you will be prompted to reset the time and date and so on. Press ENTER several times if you want to leave that for later or refer to Appendix C, which describes the procedure for initializing the VoiceNote. 2.3 Connections and sockets. Place the VoiceNote mPower QT in front of you with the keyboard oriented as you would use it. The many sockets and connectivity ports are arranged around the sides and back of the VoiceNote mPower QT. Starting from the front of the left side, and working around to the back, you will find: The small record button, the audio output socket for earphones, the audio input socket for a microphone, the power switch and the recessed reset button. Reach beyond the keyboard to the back of your VoiceNote mPower QT and investigate the layout of the back of your VoiceNote mPower QT. From the left there is the small round AC Adapter socket. Keep moving to the right and you will notice that the bottom half of the back is recessed. This is a metal panel that holds most of the ports. They are recessed to protect them from being easily knocked. The first port in this panel is the USB client port above an SD card slot. Moving right from there is the CompactFlash slot, a 9 pin serial port, two horizontal USB host ports, one above the other, and a modem jack. On the far right, back on the casing again, there is an infrared port set between two slightly raised vertical ridges. Down the right side of the unit, you will find the PCMCIA card slot. This has a recessed ejector button on the side furthest from you. Each of these ports is discussed in more detail directly following this section. Please note that if you inadvertently or deliberately remove a card or a plug from the VoiceNote mPower QT while it is active, that is while data is being passed through the connection, it may result in a loss of data, an error message, or even in some cases, corruption of the file or software. 2.3.1 Using the Infrared Port. The infrared port is located at the rear of your VoiceNote mPower QT on the right, directly behind the ENTER key. Run your hand across the back of the VoiceNote mPower QT on the extreme right and you will feel a vertical channel. The infrared port communicates though a window that is located in the channel. The VoiceNote mPower QT's infrared port conforms to the Infrared Data Association specification for infrared communications. This standard is called "IrDA" for short. This type of infrared communication can work up to a high speed. The VoiceNote mPower QT's infrared port can be used for printing or embossing. Using the infrared port, you can print to a printer equipped with an infrared port. You can also print or emboss to a printer or embosser that is connected to an IrDA compatible accessory that facilitates printing. This adapter is normally connected between a PC and a printer without an infrared port. Embossing and printing using the infrared port is described in 6.8.6 Embosser Port. IrDA compatible infrared communications work over a distance of up to about three feet (1 meter) for standard power devices and up to at least eight inches (200 millimeters) for low power devices. The VoiceNote mPower QT is a standard power device. The host's and VoiceNote mPower QT's infrared ports must face each other but they do not have to be lined up exactly because the infrared beam is quite wide. After a little experimentation, you will be able to determine the most convenient arrangement of equipment that works reliably. 2.3.2 Using the Modem. The internal modem can be used for sending and receiving email. A modem port is located on the far right of the recessed rear panel. Your VoiceNote mPower QT is supplied with a modem cable for connecting VoiceNote mPower QT's modem to a phone line. If you live in UK, Australia or New Zealand, an adapter that plugs into a standard "BT" type phone jack is also supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT. The modem cable plugs into the adapter and the adapter plugs into a phone jack. The modem cable has a phone type plug at either end of the cable. Insert one plug into the VoiceNote mPower QT modem port and the other end into a phone jack. To do this, locate the locking clip on one side of the plug. Orient this side to the bottom of the modem port, engage the plug in the socket and push the plug home. A latch holds the plug that should hold when the cable is lightly pulled. To unplug, squeeze the clip in towards the plug and pull the cable. The case bottom is scalloped under the modem port so that you can easily get your fingertip under the clip. When the plug is unclipped it releases freely. Don't forget to disconnect the cable when you are done. As a precaution check for anything connected to your VoiceNote mPower QT before transporting it. 2.3.3 USB Client Port. The USB client port is located above the SD card slot on the left hand end of the back recessed panel. It is a completely different shape to the USB host ports, being small and shaped a little like a miniature 9 pin port set flush into the panel. It is oriented so that the wider side is facing up, just like the 9 pin serial port. The primary purpose of this port is to connect your VoiceNote mPower QT to a PC via ActiveSync. For details on how to do this, refer to 13.14.3 Connecting using USB. 2.3.4 Using the Serial Port. The serial port is on the recessed rear panel of your VoiceNote mPower QT, to the left of the USB host port. It is a nine pin male port with the usual screw holes on each side to secure the plug. The serial port can be used to provide a connection to a visual display, PC or other equipment. You can use the serial port to connect to a terminal, an embosser or printer that has a serial interface, a modem or to other computers to import and export documents and files. You can use the VoiceNote mPower QT as a remote speech synthesizer by connecting the serial port to a suitable driver. You can also run ActiveSync on a PC and access your VoiceNote mPower QT through the serial port like an extension of the PC. Your VoiceNote mPower QT is supplied with a serial cable that has two identical nine pin plugs on each end of the cable. You don't have to identify which is the right end of the cable, either end will do. The connectors can only be plugged in one way. To plug in the connector hold the plug horizontal and push it gently into the socket. If it does not engage turn it through 180 degrees and try again. The cable supplied is called a "null modem cable." This cable works with most equipment except external modems. A different cable is needed to communicate with a modem and equipment that emulates a modem. The 9 pin plugs on each end of the serial cable incorporate two locking screws designed to secure the plug when it is plugged in. Use of these screws is recommended to prevent the plug falling out in use. The screws can be tightened and undone by hand. In the usual way, turning them clockwise does them up and turning them anticlockwise undoes them. Do not over tighten the screws; a light force is sufficient to hold the connector. Don't forget to disconnect the cable when you are done. As a precaution check for anything connected to your VoiceNote mPower QT before transporting it. 2.3.5 USB Host Ports. The two ports to the right of the serial port are USB host ports. They are stacked one on top of the other. USB host ports on the VoiceNote mPower QT allow you to use the VoiceNote mPower QT with a range of USBcompatible devices including: External floppy disk drive, USB memory drive, Some USB printers, and An external memory card reader. The two ports between them have a total power supply of 500 milliAmps, so if using both at once it is important to ensure that the devices plugged in do not require more than this between them. 2.3.6 Audio Sockets. On the left side of the unit, there is a microphone input socket, an audio output socket and a record button. The microphone input socket takes a high impedance electret microphone with a 3.5mm plug. There is also a built in microphone. The audio output socket is stereo and works with most head or earphones with a 3.5mm plug. It will also connect to a set of mini speakers, as used with a PC. Remember that these will also need to be plugged in to a wall socket. 2.4 PC Cards. The VoiceNote mPower QT has a slot for plugin PC cards, also known as PCMCIA cards. These cards are about the size of a credit card, only thicker. The PC card slot can be used for a microdrive or PC storage card, or an approved type of wireless card as discussed in 13.4.1 Creating a new Wireless Configuration. To find out what PC card accessories are available or will become available call your VoiceNote mPower QT distributor. CompactFlash cards can be used in the PC card slot as well as in the dedicated CompactFlash slot in the rear panel, as discussed in the next section. An adapter is available into which you slide the card before inserting it into the slot as described below. Feel along the righthand edge of the VoiceNote mPower QT and you will find a horizontal slot. The card eject button is located in a recess behind the slot. 2.4.1 Inserting and Removing PC Cards. PC or PCMCIA cards can be installed only one way. A polarizing key prevents a card from being fully plugged in if it is the wrong way up. A simple strategy for finding the correct orientation is to just try gently plugging it in. If it engages, gently push it home. If it stops with a "clunk" with the card protruding some 10 mm from the slot, take it out, invert it and try again. You can also identify the correct orientation by touch. The front of the PC card is the short edge on which there are many indentations along its entire length. Hold the front edge away from you. Run your fingers along this edge and just around the corners, where you will find some polarizing ridges. If the card is facing upward, there will be two ridges on the righthand side. The groove between them can be detected with your fingernail. On the left, there will be one ridge. If necessary, turn the card over so that there are two ridges on the right and one on the left. You could label the PC card once you have identified the correct orientation. PC cards should be inserted with the VoiceNote mPower QT switched on. When you do so the VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Card Ready." To remove a PC card, firmly push the PC card eject button. Remember it is located behind the PC card slot. This disengages the card from its connector and pushes the card out about a quarter of an inch. Always use the eject button even if the card has a cable with a grip. You can now pull the PC card completely out of the slot. If the card is removed with the power on, VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Please wait..." and after a few seconds the prompt "Card removed" will confirm that the card is disengaged. 2.4.2 Accessing files on the PC Card. The PC card slot is treated as a drive by KeySoft. To access files on the PC Card, at any file prompt, go to the drive list and press P for PC card. Proceed as normal. 2.5 Compact FlashCards. A CompactFlash card is 3.5cm by 4cm, about the size of a matchbook. It provides considerable extra data storage, and cards come in a large range of capacities running into several gigabytes. The VoiceNote mPower QT has a card slot for CompactFlash cards. This slot is located on the back of the unit. As well as allowing you to use Compact Flash cards for extra data storage, the CompactFlash card slot can be used for data storage using a CF memory card, or as a plug for CompactFlash card type accessories. CompactFlash cards can be used in the PC card slot as well. An adapter is available into which you slide the CompactFlash card before inserting it into the PC card slot as described in 2.4 PC Cards. 2.5.1 Inserting and Removing CompactFlash Cards. The CompactFlash card is wider than it is long, so it is important to orient the card correctly, as attempting to plug the shorter side in may damage the pins in the back of the slot. Also, a polarizing key makes the card more difficult to plug in if it is the wrong way up. A simple strategy for finding the correct orientation is to just try gently plugging it in. If it engages, gently push it home. If it resists being inserted, take it out, invert it and try again. You can also identify most CompactFlash cards' correct orientation by touch. The front of the CompactFlash card is the longer side that has two rows of pin sized indentations. The bottom side of most CompactFlash cards has a slight grip ridge along the opposite edge. You could label the CompactFlash card once you have identified the correct orientation. Compact cards should be inserted with the VoiceNote mPower QT switched on. When you do so the VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Card ready." To remove a CompactFlash card, hold the card firmly and pull it out. This is quite tricky if you have big fingers or no fingernails. Most CompactFlash cards have a grip ridge that makes them easier to grasp. If the card is removed with the power on, VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Please wait..." and after a few seconds the prompt "Card removed" will confirm that the card is disengaged. 2.5.2 Accessing files on the CompactFlash Card. The CompactFlash card slot is treated as a drive by KeySoft. To access files on the CompactFlash Card, at any file prompt, go to the drive list and press C for CompactFlash card. Proceed as normal. 2.6 Secure Digital Cards. On the back of the unit, underneath the USB Client port, there is a card slot for Secure Digital cards, also known as SD cards. These cards are only 32mm x 24mm x 2mm big i.e. less than a quarter of the size of a CompactFlash card, and yet can hold up to 1 Gigabyte of data at time of publishing. This is a very new technology and it won't be long until the capacity will increase. For up to date information on the latest developments, check out our website; www.humanware.com. The VoiceNote mPower QT uses SD cards for memory only. It does not support SD accessories such as wireless or Bluetooth cards. 2.6.1 Inserting and Removing SD Cards. The SD card is about the size of a postage stamp, and only 2mm thick. One corner is cut off at a diagonal, which makes it easy to orient it by touch. The short edge of this cut off corner is the end that is inserted into the SD card slot. You will notice that on one surface of the card, there is a row of ridges along that edge; this side faces down. On each long edge is a notch. If you hold the card as if you were going to insert it, i.e. with the cut off corner and ridged end away from you, along the right side the notch is small, only 2mm long and 1mm deep. However on the left side, the notch is longer and houses a sliding lock mechanism. When the slider is pushed away from you, the card is unlocked and is read/write. When the slider is pushed toward you, the card's memory is read only. SD cards should be inserted with the VoiceNote mPower QT switched on. When you do so the VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Card ready." Push it gently in until you hear it click. To remove an SD card, push it in gently until it clicks then release it. The card will pop out far enough for you to grasp and remove it. If the card is removed with the power on, VoiceNote mPower QT announces: "Please wait..." and after a few seconds the prompt "Card removed" will confirm that the card is disengaged. 2.6.2 Accessing files on the SD Card. The SD card slot is treated as a drive by KeySoft. To access files on the SD Card, at any file prompt, go to the drive list and press S for SD card. Proceed as normal. Likewise if you wish to save a file to the SD card. If you find that you can't save a file to the card, check the sliding lock mechanism on its left edge, as this may be in the "readonly" position, which is closest to the end that goes into the slot first. 2.7 USB Peripherals. As mentioned earlier, there are a range of devices available to work with the VoiceNote mPower QT, that offer a broad range of data storage options, as well as printer access. These are all discussed in turn below. 2.7.1 USB Storage Devices. There are a range of storage devices that work with the VoiceNote mPower QT. Which ones you wish to work with will probably be determined by the other technology you are using and what storage media works best with it. In all cases, when the device is plugged into one of the USB host ports on the back of the VoiceNote mPower QT, it will appear on the drive list as whatever name the device provides. When at a file or folder prompt, simply select that drive. Here is some background information on each type of storage device: External floppy drive: This technology has been around the longest, and offers storage on standard 1.44MB floppy disks. This is a small capacity compared to the other devices, but the universal availability and affordability of floppy disks still makes them a viable storage choice. USB Memory drive: Sometimes known as a USB key, stick or thumb. This is a small device with a USB plug set into one end of it. They vary in shape, size and storage capacity, which can range from 128MB to 1GB. These devices are convenient as they don't have cables, are highly portable, and can be used with a PC without the need for an external card reader, unlike the CompactFlash, PC and SD cards. External card reader: There are card readers available that can be used with the VoiceNote mPower QT as well as a PC. There are card readers for all the types of storage cards, and some take more than one kind. While this may seem a bit redundant when there are three card slots in the VoiceNote mPower QT itself already, it is nevertheless possible. When plugged in, these storage devices show up in the drive list as Hard Drive. 2.8 Visual Display. 2.8.1 KeyView for a PC. KeyView is a visual display application for the PC that enables a sighted teacher, parent or colleague to view in real time the work being done on the BrailleNote. All text that is displayed on the Braille display, or that is spoken, appears on the KeyView screen. If you have a Braille display, a visual representation of the display is also shown on the KeyView screen. KeyView is fully functional with other adaptive PCbased software such as screenreaders and magnifiers. It is colour independent and uses the settings on your PC. Note: KeyView works as a visual display for all versions of KeySoft. 2.8.1.1 KeyView Requirements. You will need: * The KeyView program KeyViewSetup.exe. This file is on the KeySoft version 7.5 (or later) program CD that comes with your BrailleNote, and is also available as a download from www.humanware.com/support/braillenote/software. * A PC running Windows ME, 2000, XP or Vista. * A way of connecting the BrailleNote to the PC. This can be either: * A serial link. For this you need the serial cable supplied with your BrailleNote, and a serial port on your PC. Note: If your PC does not have a serial port, you will need to use a USB to serial adapter. These are inexpensive and can be bought from a local computer store. Check and follow the installation instructions that come with the adapter, and install any software that it needs before installing KeyView, or * Bluetooth. For this your PC must be Bluetooth enabled. Note: KeyView does not support infrared communications. * Adaptive software for your PC, or sighted assistance as you will need to respond to some messages on your PC in order to install KeyView. 2.8.1.2 KeyView Installation. To install KeyView on your PC: 1. Put the KeySoft program CD into your PC, or download the KeyView set up program from the HumanWare website. 2. Doubleclick on the the KeyView setup program. As each window in the installation program is presented to you, select Next to continue. Note that in general, there is no need to change the options that are presented to you. A KeyView icon is placed on your desktop, and HumanWare is added to your Start Menu with the KeyView option listed. 2.8.1.3 Connecting to a PC. Before you can start KeyView, you need to connect your BrailleNote to the PC that is running KeyView. If you are using a serial cable, connect the cable between the back of your BrailleNote and your PC. If you are using Bluetooth, refer to. You need to use an ActiveSync pairing. 2.8.1.4 Using KeyView. To use KeyView: 1. Start KeyView by clicking on the KeyView icon on your desktop, or by opening the Start menu and selecting HumanWare, then KeyView. 2. A window will prompt you to select the serial port that the BrailleNote is attached to. Choose the appropriate serial port number and click OK. 3. Select the Options Menu on your BrailleNote, by pressing FUNCTION with O. 4. From the Options Menu, select "Visual Display" by stepping through the menu until you get to Visual Display and pressing Enter, or by pressing V. 5. If you are using a serial cable to connect your BrailleNote and your PC, press S then ENTER. If you are using Bluetooth, press B then ENTER. 6. If no text appears in KeyView, refer to. 2.8.1.5 KeyView Commands. When using a screen reader or magnifier software, you can move the KeyView cursor in order to review the screen, however this does not affect the KeySoft cursor. See also your screen reader, or magnifier software manuals for further information on using the cursor. You can select text using the standard Windows commands and copy it to the clipboard, and then paste it into other Windows programs. If you want to turn the Braille Display off, open the Options Menu in KeyView and select "Braille Display". Select "Braille Display" again from the Options Menu if you want to turn it back on. If a VoiceNote is attached, this option is greyed out, and no braille display is available on the screen. 2.8.1.6 1. I have followed the instructions, and still can't get KeyView to work. What should I do? If you have a serial connection: * Make sure that you are using the serial cable that was supplied with your BrailleNote. * Check your cable connection and that you have plugged it into the correct serial port on the back of your PC. * Check that you have selected the correct port in KeyView. To check or change the port, exit KeyView and restart it. * Check that no other program is using the serial port that Bluetooth is set to use. If you are using Bluetooth: * check your connection. * check that no other program is using the serial port that Bluetooth is set to use. 2. Can I use any serial cable to connect to the BrailleNote to my PC? No, you MUST use the one supplied with your BrailleNote. HumanWare can supply additional cables if required. Contact your local sales office. 2.9 General Care. Apart from recalibrating the battery gauge and cleaning the case, the VoiceNote mPower QT needs no special maintenance. The internal battery should last typically 18 months before needing replacement and this must be done by an authorized service agent. Keep beverages like tea and coffee away from the VoiceNote mPower QT. Periodically wipe the case down with a warm damp cloth. Don't use any cleaning compounds. End of Hardware Chapter. 3 Word Processor. This chapter introduces the basics of KeyWord, the word processor part of KeySoft, and describes how to create, read and edit a document. Advanced aspects of KeyWord, including creating documents with more complex formats, and quickly making extensive changes to a document, are covered in Chapter 7. In the following discussion, the general terms "announcements," "prompts" and "reading" apply to any of the outputs available in the BrailleNote family of products. If your model is a VoiceNote, they refer to audio output only. For BrailleNote models, they can refer to either the Braille display, the audio output, or both. 3.1 What is a Word Processor. A word processor is like a sophisticated Braille writer or typewriter. The difference is that you do not have to get the document right first time. You can add, delete and change things to your heart's content, and all the time your work is stored in VoiceNote mPower QT's memory. You only need emboss or print your document when you are entirely satisfied with it. There are other advantages too. You can make changes at a later date, and you can keep all the various versions. It's easy to make copies of documents, and filing and retrieving is much simpler than with hard copy. Besides writing documents, KeyWord is useful just for reading documents such as emailed documents that have originated elsewhere. These can be read directly without translating them to Braille. 3.2 Text and Braille. When you start to compose a document, KeyWord assumes that you want to do it in text, so the layout and format are for a print page, suitable for printing directly. This doesn't mean that you are committed to a text document, however. You can send it to an embosser and KeySoft automatically translates it into a suitable format. Alternatively, you have the option of creating a Braille document directly, with a layout and format for a Braille page. A Braille document requires the use of the FDS and JKL keys to input the Braille characters, which is discussed in 7.16.1 Creating a Braille Document. A Braille document may be embossed directly or printed using automatic BrailletoText translation. Unlike some other word processors, KeyWord allows you to work with the layout of a document as it will be printed or embossed. This means that you are working with the actual layout while you are editing, and you do not have to make allowances for any effects of formatting commands. KeyWord allows you to format a document for printing and independently format the same document for embossing. The two sets of formatting controls are independent. Consequently the layout of a document, either text or Braille, can be precisely controlled without making changes between printing and embossing. The document remains unchanged when you send it to a printer or embosser. 3.3 The KeyWord Menu. To select the word processing functions, start from the Main Menu and press SPACE repeatedly until "Word processor" is announced, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, just press W. KeySoft announces: "KeyWord Menu." Press SPACE to announce the first item in the KeyWord Menu, which is: "Create a document." As the prompt suggests, you use this option when you want to create a new document. Press SPACE again, and KeySoft announces the second item, which is: "Open a document." You use the "Open" option to read an existing document, or to make changes to one. Press SPACE again, and KeySoft announces the third item in the KeyWord menu, which is: "Emboss a document." You choose this item once a document had been created and edited, and you are ready to emboss it. Press SPACE again, and KeySoft announces the final item in this menu, which is: "Print a document." You choose this item to print a document on an ink printer. As with the Main Menu, you can review the KeyWord Menu by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE, and you can select an item by pressing ENTER. Alternatively, you can select an item directly from the KeyWord Menu by pressing the initial letter, such as E for Emboss a document. In this chapter we concentrate just on opening and editing a document. Embossing and printing are covered in Chapter 6. 3.4 Documents Folders and Drives. 3.4.1 Documents. Documents are the most common type of file you will use on the VoiceNote mPower QT. You must give each document a unique name enabling KeySoft to distinguish one document from another. For example, when you use KeyWord to write a letter, that letter is stored as a document. Every document name should indicate what type of information it contains. A document name can be up to 250 characters long, including spaces. It cannot contain the following characters: \ / : * ? " < > | 3.4.2 Folders. When you have been using your VoiceNote mPower QT for a while you could very easily accumulate several hundred documents, and it could become tedious to find any particular one. To make life easier, documents can be organized into groups called "Folders." Initially, there are folders named "General," and "My Books," together with a number of others which KeySoft uses. Besides these, you can create as many new folders as you wish. If you have a lot of files to organize and are comfortable with the concept, you might want to create a directory structure of folders, where there is more than one layer of folders. Details about how to do this and all other aspects of folder and file management are covered in Chapter 14. Folders can contain both Braille and text documents. Folder names can be up to 250 characters long, and can consist of any Braille signs except those for the following characters: \ / : * ? " < > | 3.4.3 Drives. Documents can be stored by different pieces of hardware in the VoiceNote mPower QT, called disk drives, or just drives. VoiceNote mPower QT incorporates a type of memory called flash memory. The associated drive is referred to as a Flash Disk. It provides fast, secure storage, retaining its contents even if the battery is flat. It is the memory you normally use to save your documents. You can copy, rename, erase or edit and resave documents to the Flash Disk. Another drive is the KeySoft System Disk. This drive stores information installed in the factory. This includes the main operating software, User Guide, and a sample book. Information installed at the Factory is retained even if the battery goes flat, but user information stored in the KeySoft System Disk will be lost. It is therefore not recommended that you save documents in the KeySoft System Disk, but you can open documents like the sample book and the VoiceNote mPower QT user guide that are stored in it. If you do save documents in the KeySoft System Disk, be aware that they will be lost if the battery goes flat or you do a Reset with JKL keys held down. You can also add external drives to the VoiceNote mPower QT. 3.4.4 Changing the Current Drive. There is a way of selecting a drive in KeySoft generally, which is not restricted to KeyWord. If you are at a prompt for a file name or folder name, and you have not had the opportunity to select a drive, then press BACKSPACE. KeySoft announces: "Drive? (Last drive used)." To step through the list of available drives press SPACE. The list comprises the Flash Disk and KeySoft System Disk, and if in use, the CompactFlash card and/or Storage card and Network. To select a drive, either step through the list of available drives press SPACE then press ENTER, or just type the first letter of the drive name. External drives such as USB memory drives will appear on the drive list without a hot key. To select such a drive, step through the list and select as described previously. 3.5 Opening a Document. Several documents are provided with KeySoft. If you want to read one of them, how do you select it? From the KeyWord menu, select "Open a document." KeyWord announces: "Press ENTER for Folder name? (name)," where the word "name" between the brackets is really the name of the last folder used. To select a document you must first select the appropriate folder. There are three different methods of doing this: 1. To select the offered folder, just press ENTER. This is the folder that was last used. 2. To look through the list of available folders, press SPACE or DOWN ARROW repeatedly. When the name of the folder you require is displayed, select it by pressing ENTER. You can move back along the list, by pressing BACKSPACE or UP ARROW repeatedly. While scanning the list you can quickly relocate to an alphabetical position in the list by pressing a letter. For example, pressing T puts you at the beginning of the list of folders starting with T. If you keep on pressing T, you cycle through all the names starting with that letter. 3. Type the name of the folder you require, and press ENTER. With this method, remember that you have to type the name exactly or it will not work. You can change the current drive by pressing BACKSPACE or CONTROL with D at the "Folder name?" prompt. The Flash Disk is assumed here. If another drive was previously selected, a drive prompt is given as described in above. When you have selected a folder, KeyWord asks: "Document to open? (name)," where the word "name" between the brackets is really the name of the last document you accessed. Just like folder selection, the same three methods are available for selecting a document. Select the offered document by just pressing ENTER, or review the list of documents by pressing SPACE repeatedly and select a document by pressing ENTER, or type the document name and press ENTER. This selection procedure is significant because it is general throughout KeySoft, and is not restricted to just opening a document. Whether you use the SPACE or DOWN ARROW key to scan through a list of folders or documents is a matter of personal preference. Similarly, you may use either the BACKSPACE or UP ARROW key to move back through a list. If you are opening an ASCII text file, or a plain Braille document you will be prompted to review the options associated with the opening and subsequent saving of the document. Section discusses the options given when opening such documents. 3.6 Naming a Document. In the next section we talk about creating a document, but first we discuss names. Each document must have a unique, meaningful name so that it can be stored and later retrieved by specifying its name. You can use whatever name you like, with up to 250 characters and spaces. It cannot contain the following characters: \ / : * ? " < > | If you have several documents on a similar subject, you may find it helpful to put the common part of the name first. For example, you might have: "Club minutes, January," "Club minutes, February," and so on. These document names would be grouped together alphabetically for easy location. If the months are put first, the documents are scattered through the list of documents. Documents can be grouped into folders to make them easier to find. As an example, the documents just mentioned might all be put into a folder called "Club minutes 2001." The rules for naming a folder are the same as for naming a document. Some characters are reserved and you may not use them in a document name. They are: \ / : " < > | * and ? 3.7 Creating a Document. We now create a trial document. From the Main Menu, select the Word Processor option. From the KeyWord menu select "Create a document." KeySoft announces: "Folder name? General." The General folder is fine; so press ENTER to accept KeySoft's suggestion. You are then asked: "Document to create?" Type in the name: "Sample," with or without a capital S as you wish, and press ENTER. KeySoft announces: "Top of Document. Blank." You are now at the top lefthand corner of an empty text document. Without worrying about mistakes, type half a dozen sentences. Each word is spoken only when you have pressed the space bar to complete the word. You can change the Keyboard Voice so that KeySoft speaks each letter as it is pressed, or both words and letters. How to change the Keyboard Voice was discussed in. You may also notice that you can type indefinitely without worrying about the right margin. This is because KeyWord automatically starts a new line if it cannot fit another word onto the current line. This process is known as word wrapping. Start a new paragraph by pressing ENTER to start a new line, and type a few more sentences. When you have finished typing, press ESCAPE. Your document is saved, and you are returned to the KeyWord menu. 3.8 Reading a Document. We now discuss the various commands for reading a document. We recommend you open your "Sample" document, or the "Demonstration Document" that comes with KeySoft, so that you can practice using the reading commands. The "Demonstration Document" is found in the "General" folder. Open the document as explained in 3.5 Opening a Document. . Note: If you are ever unsure which document you are reading, press CONTROL with READ with I, then F for filename. This will display the name of the document. 3.8.1 Listening to a Document. When you are reading sentences or paragraphs, you may be simply listening to the text, or checking it in detail for errors. You can choose to hear the amount of detail you require by setting the punctuation level. You may also choose whether numbers are spoken as words or as digits. You use the keyboard to enter commands when listening to VoiceNote mPower QT's speech. To listen to a document without stopping, press READ with G, for "Go." KeySoft continues reading to the end of the document unless you stop by pressing READ with SPACE. You can start and stop as you wish with these two commands. To return to the top of the document, press READ with T. KeySoft says: "Top of document." and announces the first word of the document. To jump directly to the end of the document, press READ with B. Experiment with the Go, Stop, Beginning and End commands until you are happy that you understand their effects. There are several other important commands for moving around the text. These additional commands are arranged in groups of three on each row of the keyboard centered on the comma, K, I and 8 column of keys. These are all used in conjunction with the READ key. For example, try the commands for reading characters: To move back a character and read it, press READ with M; To read the current character, press READ with comma; To move forward a character and read it, press READ with period. This convention also applies to reading whole words, as follows: To move back a word and read it, press READ with J; To read the current word, press READ with K; To move forward a word and read it, press READ with L. You may be able to guess the next triplet of commands: To move back a sentence and read it, press READ with U; To read the current sentence, press READ with I; To move forward a sentence and read it, press READ with O. A similar convention applies for previous, current, and next paragraphs: To move back a paragraph and read it, press READ with 7; To read the current paragraph, press READ with 8; To move forward a paragraph and read it, press READ with 9. You can follow a sentence or paragraph read command with another sentence or paragraph read command to immediately change the prose being read. Try reading your "Sample" document or the "Demonstration Document" with these commands. You can refresh your memory by pressing HELP, and opening the "Review Commands" list. Alternatively you can enter the Announce Key mode by pressing READ with A and practice the review keystrokes. When using several review commands one after the other, you do not have to wait for speech to finish, nor do you have to release the READ key after each command. Here is an example where we move back several words and then move forward a character at a time. First press, and hold down, the READ key. Now, with the READ key held down, tap J several times, to move back several words. With the READ key still down, tap PERIOD several times to move forward several characters. Finally release the READ key. The CONTROL key operates in the same way when it is used for deleting and formatting text as described later. You will find this feature very convenient to use. 3.8.2 Identifying Indistinctly Spoken Characters. When you read a character by pressing READ with COMMA, it is sometimes difficult to distinguish between letters that sound similar. If you press READ with COMMA, twice, when you are using text or Braille Codes, other than UEB, KeySoft expands the current character into its "military call sign", if the character is alphabetical, for example A  Alpha, B  Bravo, etc. When you are using UEB, the second press of READ with COMMA, speaks the Braille context of the symbol under the cursor. For example, if the cursor is on dot 15 in the sequence 45, 34, 15, the "e acute" will be spoken on the second press. A third press will give the military callsign. 3.8.3 Spelling Out a Word. If you press READ with K twice, KeySoft spells the current word. In a Braille document three presses of READ with K causes KeySoft to spell a translated version of the word. If the word in question contains one or more grade 2 contractions, those contractions are expanded to their equivalent characters and the expanded word is spelt out. For example, the word "time" is spelled as "dot 5 T" on the second press but "t i m e" on the third press. 3.9 Review Commands. The following discussion is applicable when reading a document. 3.9.1 Moving to Either End of a Line. You can position to the start of the current line by pressing READ with H. To move to one position past the last word in the line, press READ with Semicolon. 3.9.2 Selecting ReviewOnly Mode. If you are reading a document that you don't wish to alter, you can avoid having to press READ with all the reading commands. To enter this ReviewOnly Mode, press READ with X. You can then use all the reading commands without needing to press READ. For example, to read the current word, just press K. This mode continues until you press READ with X again or exit the word processor. 3.10 The Cursor The cursor is an important concept because many KeyWord commands use the cursor as a reference to determine where to apply the command. It is also very important to understand exactly where the cursor is in your document so that your changes occur as you intend. Otherwise you may find the changes you make are wrong. The cursor is a pointer to a single character in a document. You can tell which character the cursor is on by pressing READ with COMMA. You can use the read current word, sentence and paragraph commands to determine the context of the cursor. Editing takes effect at the cursor position. If you want to edit the document, you must position the cursor at the point you want the change to start. The cursor indicates the position in the document where the next character will appear when it is pressed. The character is inserted at the cursor position and everything to the right, including the cursor, is shifted one character to the right to make room. Pressing BACKSPACE deletes a character immediately to the left of the cursor and everything to the right of the cursor is moved one character to the left to fill the vacant character space. 3.10.1 Moving the Cursor. VoiceNote mPower QT also allows you to position the cursor using the keyboard. The following discussion describes the cursor movement commands using the keyboard. When you press READ with M or READ with PERIOD, the cursor moves backward or forward by one character on each press. The character that is spoken is the character under the cursor after the move. After reading the current character, word, sentence or paragraph, the cursor position remains unchanged. If you read the previous or next word, the cursor moves to the first character of that word. When you read the previous or next sentence, the cursor moves to the first character of the first word of that sentence, after reading has been completed. Similarly, when you read the previous or next paragraph, the cursor ends up on the first character of that paragraph. You can skip through a document quickly by using the readnextsentence or readnextparagraph commands, READ with O and READ with 9. If you press either of these commands while reading is in progress, KeyWord immediately jumps to the start of the next sentence or paragraph and begins reading from there. Try this by going to the start of your document and skipping through to the end by using READ with O. At any time during reading you can stop the process by pressing READ with SPACE at the same time. The cursor is placed on the first character of the last word that was spoken. Alternatively, you can press ESCAPE. In this case KeySoft stops reading, and returns the cursor to where reading began. There are some more advanced cursor movement commands that provide movement by lines rather than sentences, and vertical movement within a document. These commands are explained in 7.6 Cursor Movement Modes. When a new document is created, the cursor is placed at the top left corner of the blank document. When an existing document is opened, the cursor is placed where it was when the document was last accessed. On entry into the document, KeySoft announces the last few words before the cursor, and the word at the cursor position. 3.11 Format Indicators. To tell you how a document is formatted, KeySoft places special format indicators at particular points in a document. Format indicators are announced according to their names. 3.11.1 Common Indicators. Common format indicators are: LINE BREAK: KeySoft automatically started a new line because there wasn't any more room on the current line. KeySoft automatically word wraps meaning that it starts a new line if it runs out of room on the current line. A line break indicator is inserted into the text showing you where a new line is started. NEW LINE: A new line was started by pressing ENTER. Often a new line indicator marks the beginning of a new paragraph. PAGE BREAK: KeySoft started a new page because the previous page was full in much the same way that word wrap starts a new line when the previous line is full. The page break indicator always appears in conjunction with a line break or new line indicator in a document. The position of a page break varies as you add or delete lines of text. NEW PAGE: The start of a new page is forced by pressing CONTROL with N. If the cursor is positioned over an indicator, the name of the indicator is announced. The positions of block markers, place markers and a range of other formatting markers described in this chapter and in Chapter 7, are also indicated in a document. 3.11.2 Searching for Format Indicators. If you wish to introduce changes to the layout or presentation of a document, you may need to locate format indicators such as layout indicators, font indicators, underline indicators, etc. If you want to change the format of paragraphs, you may need to locate new line indicators. The Find command, READ with F, and the Find and Replace command, CONTROL with F, can be used to locate any of these format indicators. To go to the next occurrence of the selected format indicator, press READ with N. You can use the following command sequences to search for these indicators, and also to insert Format indicators into a document when entered at the "Replace with?" prompt: New Line: CONTROL with ENTER. New Page: CONTROL with N. New Layout: CONTROL with L. Underline On: CONTROL with U N. Underline Off: CONTROL with U F. Font On: CONTROL with F. Font Off: CONTROL with F. Center Line: CONTROL with E. Right Justify: CONTROL with R. Indent: FUNCTION with I. Start Braille or inkprint exclusion: READ with CONTROL with X. End Braille or inkprint exclusion: READ with CONTROL with Y. Translation Options indicator: CONTROL with O. Text or Braille only inclusion: READ with CONTROL with N. Text or Braille layout: READ with CONTROL with L. Style of presentation indicator: CONTROL with Y. Template Menu: CONTROL with A. Change Braille grade: CONTROL with G. 3.12 Editing a Document. We have described how to create a new document and review its contents. This section introduces the basic text editing commands. The most common forms of editing are deleting or inserting characters, words, or sentences. These commands are described here, along with searching, search and replace, defining pages, and moving to particular points in a document. Advanced word processing commands are covered in Chapter 7. 3.12.1 Inserting Text. To insert a character, word, sentence, or any amount of text, you need only to position the cursor at the point where you want to insert the text, and start typing. No special command is required because KeyWord is always in the insert mode. Text is inserted at the cursor position. The character that was at the cursor, and all following characters, move to the right to make room. Experiment with this by inserting some words in your "Sample" document. 3.12.2 Deleting Text. There are seven different delete commands available with KeyWord, allowing for the deleting of sections of text from one character to the whole document. Delete current character  Press CONTROL with COMMA, or DELETE. This deletes the character under the cursor. A short beep is sounded followed by announcement of the new character under the cursor. This command is also available by pressing the DELETE key. The text to the right of the character is all moved one character to the left to fill the gap. The cursor is now placed on the next character and this character is announced. Delete last character  Press BACKSPACE. This deletes the previous character, that is, the last character entered if you are typing. The character deleted is announced followed by a short beep. You can also use the command CONTROL with M. Delete current word  Press CONTROL with K. This deletes the word under the cursor together with any following spaces. A short beep is sounded and the text to the right of the word is all moved to the left to fill the gap. The cursor is now on the first character of the next word and this word is announced. If the cursor is on a space, all spaces up to the beginning of the next word are deleted and the cursor is placed on that word. Delete previous word  Press CONTROL with J. The word before the cursor is deleted, together with any following spaces. Delete to end of sentence  Press CONTROL with I. KeySoft prompts you to make sure that you really mean to delete such a significant amount of text. If you press Y, all text will be deleted from the cursor position to the end of the current sentence. The cursor will be placed on the first character of the next sentence. Delete to end of paragraph  Press CONTROL with 8. KeySoft prompts you to make sure that you really mean to delete such a significant amount of text. If you press Y, all text will be deleted from the cursor position to the end of the current paragraph. The cursor remains in the same position. Delete to end of document  Press CONTROL with D. KeySoft prompts you to make sure that you really mean to delete such a significant amount of text. If you press Y, all text will be deleted from the cursor position to the end of the document. The cursor remains in the same position. There is no specific command to delete all text from a document, but this can easily be done by pressing READ with T to move to the top of the document and then pressing CONTROL with D. Note that the keys used to delete a particular section of text correspond to the commands for reading the same section of text except that the BACKSPACE key is used in place of the SPACE key. In summary, the full set of delete commands is: Delete current character, CONTROL with COMMA, or DELETE; Delete previous character BACKSPACE; Delete current word, CONTROL with K; Delete previous word, CONTROL with J; Delete to end of sentence, CONTROL with I; Delete to end of paragraph, CONTROL with 8; Delete to end of document, CONTROL with D. In case it is not obvious, if you press one wrong key while you are typing, you will want to delete the character to the left of the cursor position, not the blank which is currently under the cursor. For this reason you should use BACKSPACE if you have just made a single typing mistake. Use BACKSPACE also to correct mistakes during entry of file names, search strings, etc. For the same reason, if you realize that the word you have just typed is wrong when KeySoft echoes it, use the deletepreviousword command to remove it. On reading your document again, you may find a word misspelled. When using speech it is often simpler to delete the word and retype it correctly, followed by a single space, rather than delete one or two characters and correct on a letter by letter basis. 3.13 Breaking your Document into Pages. You can force a new pages in your text manually at any point you choose by putting the cursor where you definitely want a new page to start, such as the start of new chapters and pressing CONTROL with N. KeyWord breaks the remaining text into pages automatically, so that the maximum number of lines fit onto each page. When you have finished editing the document, check that it breaks into pages to your satisfaction. You can examine each page break to verify that important text is not split between pages. If you are not satisfied, you can force a new page before a page break by pressing CONTROL with N. To examine each page break, you can move to the start of the next page by using the "Go To" command, READ with R, followed by FUNCTION with DOWN ARROW. You can also move back a page at a time by pressing READ with R, followed by FUNCTION with UP ARROW. The "Go To" command is described further in 3.17 Going to a Specified Position. To cancel a new page, move to the position where the "New Page" indicator is displayed, and use the "deletecurrentcharacter" command to delete it. 3.14 Checking the Word Count and File name. If at any time while in a document, you wish to check the file name or word count, press READ with CONTROL with I. This will give you the Information Menu, with two items, File name and Word Count. Select an option in the usual manner. If you select File name, the name will be announced. If you select Word count, KeySoft will announce "Please wait…" and after a brief pause, the total word count. 3.15 Searching a Document. The Search Command allows you to find a particular string of text within a large document. The term "string" refers to a sequence of characters which may be part of a word, a whole word, or 2 or 3 words. Searches may be either backwards or forwards from the current cursor position. Press READ with F to initiate the search. KeySoft prompts: "Search forward or back?" 3.15.1 Searching Forward. Press F to search forward from the current cursor position. KeySoft announces: "Find?" The last string searched for, if any, is offered as a suggestion. Press ENTER to select the suggested text, or type the text string to be found, and press ENTER. KeySoft starts to search the document. If the text is found, the cursor jumps to the first occurrence of that text. KeySoft says: "Found (word)." where word is the first word of the text string that was entered. If the text string cannot be found, KeySoft announces: "Can't find (string)." If you want to carry on searching forward for the next occurrence of the same text, press READ with N. In a large document the search may take a few seconds. If searching for a particular email, use the binding space command CONTROL with SPACE to put spaces between words. This is not necessary in other contexts. 3.15.2 Searching Back. You can search back from the current cursor position by pressing B, instead of F, at the Search Forward or Back prompt. The rest of the procedure for searching back is the same as that just described for searching forward. 3.15.3 The Search String. The Search string can be up to 50 characters long and it can contain words separated by spaces. Either upper or lower case letters may be used as the search process will locate text regardless of capitalization. It is also possible to search for special indicators such as New Line or New Page markers, printer control markers, underline markers, etc. For information on the way to specify these markers, refer to 3.11.2 Searching for Format Indicators. 3.15.4 Find and Replace. In addition to searching for a particular word or string of characters, you can also replace one string with another. Only whole words are replaced. This is useful, for instance, if you discover you have misspelled a word which is frequently used throughout a lengthy document. The command for "Find and Replace" is CONTROL with F. This command is followed by F for a forward search, or B for a back search. KeySoft prompts: "Find? (Search string)," where "search string" is the text string used last time a search was made. The very first time you use your VoiceNote mPower QT or if you reset it, there is nothing to announce. Type the new word or words to find and press ENTER, edit the previous search string and press ENTER, or just press ENTER to search for the same string again. KeySoft prompts: "Replace with (replacement text)," where "replacement text" is the last entry you made here. Type up to 50 characters of replacement text and then press ENTER, edit the previous replacement text and press ENTER, or just press ENTER to replace the same text as last time. KeySoft then prompts: "Replace all or first?" To avoid the problem of words which happen to be embedded in other words, KeyWord replaces whole words only. If you want to replace all occurrences, forward or back as appropriate, with the new text, press A. To replace just the first occurrence, press F. If the word you are searching for does not occur within the document being searched, KeySoft announces: "Can't find (search string)," where search string is the text string used. It is important to remember whether you are searching forwards or backwards in a document. The "Can't find" message means that a word cannot be found in the direction that is currently being searched. For instance, if you search forward from the middle of a document, you will miss an occurrence in the first half. KeySoft always remembers the most recent search and replacement text, and these become the new suggested strings. Special indicators such as New Line Marker and New Page Marker can be replaced in the same way. 3.16 Checking the Cursor Position. To check where the cursor is currently positioned, press READ with Q. KeySoft responds with the page number, line number and column number of the cursor position. Used in conjunction with the cursor movement commands, this is a useful way of checking your page layout for printing or embossing. For example, you can position the cursor on the first character of a particular line by pressing READ with H, and then check the cursor position to find out which column this line starts on. This enables you to check margin settings. 3.17 Going to a Specified Position. The cursor can be moved to any chosen page, line or column with the "Go To" command. To do this, press READ with R, then enter a page, line and column position in the document, and press ENTER. This command is very flexible, and you can make entries such as the following: C6 moves the cursor to Column 6 on the current line. P3 moves the cursor to Page 3, Line 1, Column 1. P 5 L10 moves the cursor to Page 5, Line 10, Column 1. You can also go to the top of the next or previous page by pressing READ with R, followed by FUNCTION with DOWN or UP ARROW. 3.18 Marking Places for Quick Reference. Up to 26 positions in a document may be marked with Place Markers, enabling instant future reference. Place Markers are identified by letters. Typically, you might put a place marker where you are editing a document. You can then move to another part of the document, and return quickly to the edited text. Place Markers are not retained in nonKeyWord documents when they are saved. A Place Marker is announced as "Place Marker c," where c is a letter which names the Place Marker. It does not affect the document format and is not embossed or printed. 3.18.1 Define a Place Marker. Position the cursor at the point you wish to mark, and press READ with D. KeySoft prompts: "Define Place Marker. Letter?" Press a letter, such as A, to name the Place Marker. KeySoft announces: "Place A." 3.18.2 Jump to a Place Marker. Press READ with P. KeySoft prompts: "Jump to Place Marker. Letter?" Press the letter corresponding to the Place Marker. The cursor is placed just to the right of the Place Marker itself. 3.18.3 Delete a Place Marker. Locate the Place Marker you wish to delete, using the Jump to Place Marker command. This places the cursor just to the right of the Place Marker, so delete the marker by pressing BACKSPACE. 3.19 The Spelling Checker. The Spelling Checker can be used in the Word processor or Planner. It finds typing and spelling mistakes in the current document by looking up each word in a dictionary of 65,000 words. The Spelling Checker can check the whole document or part of a document. Select the Spelling Checker by pressing READ with CONTROL with S. If the Spelling Checker has not been used since KeySoft was installed, you are asked to install the language. There is an American English spelling dictionary and a United Kingdom English spelling dictionary available. Press SPACE until your dictionary of choice is announced, and select it by pressing ENTER. The Spelling Checker menu contains 6 items: Document Check: check the whole document; Lookup Word: lookup any word; Word Check: check the word under the cursor; Paragraph or Section Check: check paragraph or section; Check from Cursor: check from cursor to end of document; Select language. If the Spelling Checker finds a word which is not in its dictionary, it announces the word and then: "Option?" There are 7 possible actions at this point. You may wish to press HELP for assistance. After you have selected your action, checking continues. When the checking has finished, you hear the total number of words checked and the number of unknown words found. The cursor then returns to its original position. The seven options are now discussed. 3.19.1 Review the Word Using Speech. If you want to hear the word again, press READ with K. On the first press the word is spoken. On the second press the word is spelled out. This sequence repeats on subsequent presses. You can also review the word in context at the "Option?" prompt as follows: 1. To read the current sentence, press READ with I. 4. To read the current paragraph, press READ with 8. If Line Reading mode has been selected, these two commands speak the current line or section instead. You can set the Reading Mode at the "Option?" prompt by pressing READ with S. Reading modes are discussed in 7.6 Cursor Movement Modes. 3.19.2 Skip this occurrence of the word. To skip the current occurrence of the word and leave it unchanged, press READ with L. If the word occurs elsewhere, the Spelling Checker queries it again. 3.19.3 Ignore the word. To leave all instances of the word unchanged, press I, for Ignore. Use this option to ignore a name or specialized word which occurs throughout the document, but is not recognized by the spelling checker, and which you do not wish to add to the dictionary. 3.19.4 Add the word to the dictionary. To add the current word to the user dictionary, press A. The word will never again be announced as an unknown word when the Spelling Checker is used. Use this option for names, technical terms, etc which you often use. For more information on the User Dictionary, refer to 3.19.10 The User Dictionary. 3.19.5 Correct the Word. To correct the word being queried, press C, and KeySoft announces: "Enter replacement." Type the replacement word or edit the existing word, and press ENTER. The Spelling Checker looks up your entry in its dictionary before accepting it. If it can't find it, the Spelling Checker asks for confirmation by prompting: "Word not in dictionary. Use?" Press Y to use the new word, or N and then reenter the correction. If you correct a missing space between two words, KeySoft checks each separate word before accepting your correction. In case the word you are correcting occurs more than once in the document, the Spelling Checker also asks: "Correct all or first?" To correct this and all subsequent occurrences of the word in the document, press A, for All. To correct only this first instance, press F, for First. When making corrections, don't worry about capital signs or capital letters because the Spelling Checker leaves them as they are. 3.19.6 Review Suggestions. To obtain a "Suggestions list," press S. This is a list of words which resemble the original, and may be reviewed by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE. The following 3 options are then available: 1. To display the original word, press I. In speech, subsequent presses alternately spell out and speak the word. 2. To replace the misspelled word in your document with the current suggestion, press NEXT or ENTER. You are given the option of replacing all occurrences or just the first one. 3. To spell out the current suggestion using speech, press FUNCTION with O, then S. If you don't like the suggestions, press ESCAPE to go back to the "Option?" prompt. 3.19.7 Look up the Word in the Dictionary. This option allows you to browse the dictionary, word by word, until you have found the correct spelling. You can then replace the misspelled word with the correct one. At the "Option?" prompt, press L, and KeySoft asks: "Word to look up? Press ENTER for (word)," where "word" is the unknown word. You normally press ENTER to select the unknown word. Alternatively, you can enter a possible alternative spelling, or just the first few letters, followed by ENTER. You are then placed at the word in the dictionary which most closely matches the letters you have typed. To browse through the dictionary until you find the word you are looking for, use SPACE or BACKSPACE. There are 4 options here, similar to the Suggestions options. These are: 1. To replace the misspelled word in your document with the current dictionary word, press ENTER. You are asked whether you want to replace the first occurrence or all, in case there are multiple occurrences. 2. To return to the "Word to lookup?" prompt, press ESCAPE. You can then type another alternative spelling, or press ESCAPE again to return to the "Option?" prompt. 3. To announce the original word, press I. In speech, subsequent presses alternately spell and speak the word. 4. To spell the current word in the dictionary, press FUNCTION with O, then S. 3.19.8 Leaving the Spelling Checker. To exit from the Spelling Checker, press ESCAPE. The cursor is placed at the point where the Spelling Checker was interrupted. To restart the spelling check from where you left off, press READ with CONTROL with S, then C. 3.19.9 Browse The Dictionary. You can look up any word, and browse the spelling dictionary, without having first found the word with the Spelling Checker. From anywhere in the document, press READ with CONTROL with S, then L, and KeySoft prompts: "Word to look up?" Type the word, or just the first few letters, and press ENTER. You are placed at the word in the dictionary which most closely matches the letters you have typed, and the word is announced. To browse through the dictionary until you find the word you are looking for, use navigation keys SPACE or BACKSPACE. There are three options available while browsing through the dictionary, as follows: 1. To insert the current dictionary word into your document at the present cursor position, press ENTER. No spaces are included, so you may need to add a space if the word is inserted in a sentence. No capital signs are included so you may need to add these, if necessary. 2. To return to the "Word to lookup?" prompt, press ESCAPE. You can then narrow down the options by typing more starting letters, or enter a different word. To return to the document, press ESCAPE again. 3. To spell the current word in the dictionary, press FUNCTION with O, then S. 3.19.10 The User Dictionary. When you use the "Add to dictionary" option, the new word is stored separately in a KeyWord text document called "User dictionary." The words are arranged one per line. You can review the User Dictionary using KeyWord, and correct or remove words. If you edit the User Dictionary, use only lower case letters and apostrophes. The User Dictionary is saved in the "Dictionaries" folder. 3.20 Opening ASCII and Plain Braille format Documents. Documents in KeyWord's native format, as well as Microsoft Word, RTF, or WordPerfect documents precisely specify their contents and formatting. However, the contents and formatting of documents containing plain ASCII text and the formatting of plain Braille documents are not at all precisely defined, so it is necessary to give you control over how KeyWord interprets them. This is done through a list of options presented when you open such a document. The initial settings for these options are either the ones you established last time you opened the same document, or if you have never opened the document before, settings that KeyWord assumes are most appropriate for the document and therefore usually you will not need to make any changes. So that you can tell whether or not you have opened this document before, the wording of the prompt changes from "Review the options?" to "Review previous options?" accordingly. To continue and open the document without reviewing the options, just press ENTER. To review the options, press Y. The options given when opening a document are as follows: “Is this a Braille or Text document?” If the name extension is .brl or .brf indicating that it will be a Braille file, then this option will have already been set to Braille. When open, these documents default to a reading grade of contracted Braille, regardless of the preferred reading grade set, as most Braille documents are in contracted Braille. If the document is not .brf or .brl but contains Braille, then select "Braille" by pressing B. Otherwise select "Text" by pressing T. Follow either entry with ENTER. “Use Line or Paragraph format when opening the document? currently Paragraph.” When opening a document, it is important that KeyWord knows the difference between the ends of lines within a paragraph and the end of the paragraph itself. Without this knowledge, paragraphs might be run together, or each line within a paragraph may be taken as the end of a paragraph, causing the speech to pause in the wrong places, and stopping the proper reformatting of lines within a paragraph when a change is made. Plain text or plain Braille documents use the same "control characters," for example, "carriage returns" and "line feeds" to show where lines within paragraphs end as they use to show where a paragraph ends. This option allows you to control how KeyWord interprets these control characters to distinguish between ends of lines and end of paragraphs. The option you choose here depends on the way the document you are opening is formatted: The Paragraph format option assumes that a single carriage return and/or line feed character sequence, that is not followed by an indent of more than one space, denotes the end of a line within a paragraph and is therefore removed so that KeyWord can reformat the paragraph within the margins that you have set. A sequence of two or more carriage return and/or line feed characters or a single sequence followed by an indent is interpreted as being the start of a new paragraph and is substituted for KeyWord's New Line markers. This option is the initial setting when you first open a document and is the one that you will need for most prose type documents. The Line format option retains every carriage return and/or line feed sequence as a New Line in KeyWord. Use this setting when opening documents containing lists or documents where each paragraph is formatted as one long line. To retain "Paragraph" format when opening the document, just press ENTER. To select "Line" format, press L followed by ENTER. “Use Line or Paragraph format when saving the document? Currently Paragraph.” In a similar way to the previous option for opening documents, this option controls the use of carriage returns and line feeds when a plain text or plain Braille document is saved. Paragraph option puts carriage return/line feed sequences only where New Line markers occurred while the document was being edited. Line option puts them where either Line Break indicators or New Line markers occur. If you are saving a document for use again in KeySoft or for transferring to another word processor, use Paragraph format. This will ensure that all paragraphs, headings, list, etc. are properly formatted when the document is opened next time. However each paragraph will appear as one long line, so if you are saving the document for use on a system which may not be able to handle this, then save using Line format. To retain "Paragraph" format when saving the document, just press ENTER. To select "Line" format, press L followed by ENTER. You may have worked out that if you open a document using Paragraph format and then save it using Paragraph format, then you must open it next time using Line format. KeyWord changes the setting automatically for you so that if you have saved a document using paragraph format, next time you open it, the opening setting will be Line format. Whether or not KeyWord uses Line Feed control characters in addition to Carriage Return characters is controlled by the "Use of Line Feed characters?" option in the ASCII Translation Options in the Translation Menu. The use of the ASCII End of File character is controlled by the "Use of End of File character" option in the same list. “Extended ASCII character option? Currently Retain.” The standard ASCII character set uses numbers between 0 and 127 to denote each character within the set. It does not make provision for accented characters and other special symbols, so where necessary this is done by extending this set with numbers greater than 127. This option controls how KeyWord interprets these characters. Sometimes extended characters occur not because they are accented characters or special symbols, but because the file has been transmitted through a communications system that has added a "parity bit" which in effect has added an offset to some of the characters. To adjust for this, use the "Convert to standard ASCII" option, by pressing C, followed by ENTER. Sometimes the extended characters are used purely for visual effects such as boxes around paragraphs, etc. In these cases the document will be easier to read if the extended characters are removed altogether, use the "Ignore" option for this. To retain the extended characters when the document is opened, select "Retain." On selection of Retain, another option is presented: "Extended character set? Currently ANSI.” More than one system has been used for extended characters, therefore you must tell KeyWord which one to use for this document. The options are the "ANSI" character set and the "MSDOS" character set. If you don't know which one to use, try one and if the extended characters do not come out correctly, try the other. For the "MSDOS" set press M followed by ENTER. For the "ANSI" set press A followed by ENTER. KeySoft will now announce: "End of list." When you are ready to open the document, press ESCAPE. 3.21 Large Documents. There is no significant limit to the size of a document, but as it gets bigger, some operations take longer to perform. For instance, when you press ESCAPE to exit a document, a delay of several seconds may occur. Moving to the top or bottom of a document may also take a few seconds. In such instances KeySoft announces: "Please wait", or "Repositioning," depending on the situation. Keystrokes are not actioned until such an operation has been completed. If necessary, divide large documents into two or more smaller ones to speed the editing of the text. 3.22 Switching Between Documents. There may be times when you are working with two or more documents. This can happen when you are modifying a document and need to refer often to the original. While you can close one document by pressing ESCAPE, opening the other can involve several keystrokes. There is a quicker way. From the current document, press CONTROL with Z. This closes the current document, and places you at the "Document to open?" prompt. KeySoft then offers the name of the document which was opened before the last one. To open this, press ENTER. This means that you can switch back and forth between your two most recent documents just by pressing CONTROL with Z, followed by ENTER. This scheme also works if you are working with several documents, because the document name that KeySoft offers when you press CONTROL with Z is just the first in a list. If you press READ with 9, KeySoft offers the next most recent document, and you can work down the list towards progressively older documents. You can also work back up the list by pressing READ with 7. When you find the one you want, press ENTER. To provide fast access to recently used documents and folders, READ with 9 is available at most document and folder prompts throughout KeySoft. 3.23 Setting the Default Working Language. You set your default working language in the Utilities Menu. 1. Go to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. 2. Select the Utilities option, by stepping through the Main Menu until you get to Utilities and pressing Enter, or by pressing U anywhere in the Main Menu. 3. From the Utilities Menu, select the Language options list by stepping through the list and pressing Enter, or by pressing L. KeySoft displays: "Working language? Press ENTER for (language name)." 4. Press SPACE with dots 34 to move through the list of languages available. To select a language, press ENTER, or press the initial letter of that language, for example for French, press F and then press ENTER. KeySoft displays: "Default Speech Language? Press ENTER for (language name)." 5. Press SPACE with dots 34 to move through the list of languages available. To select a language, press ENTER, or press the initial letter of that language, for example for English, press E and then press ENTER. KeySoft displays: "Imported Data should be labelled as which Language? Press ENTER for none." You can change the language settings at any time from the Utilities Menu. End of Word Processing Chapter. 4 Book Reader. VoiceNote mPower QT has a book reader called KeyBook. It enables you to read electronic books in the following formats: KeyWord text and Braille, Microsoft Word, ASCII text, RTF, and plain Braille files with a BRF or BRL extension. KeyBook has the same reading commands as KeyWord, but KeyBook does not allow the book contents to be modified. 4.1 Reading the Sample Book. After selecting KeyBook from the Main Menu, KeyBook announces: "Read book in which folder? Press ENTER for My Books." Press ENTER. If this is the very first time a book is read, the book name must be selected from the list of books in the Books folder. Press SPACE repeatedly to announce the list; then press ENTER when "A Christmas Carol" is announced. KeyBook prompts: "Review the options?" Press ENTER to accept the default options, and the book will load. For more information about reviewing the options, see 4.5 Reading Books Stored on Other Drives. Note: If a book has been read before, KeyBook will prompt: "Book name?” Press ENTER for a Christmas Carol." To load the book, press ENTER. Once the book is loaded, the beginning of the text will announce and, if the speech is on, KeyBook announces: "Top of document." You are now ready to start reading. 4.2 Additional Reading Commands. KeyBook's reading commands are the same as KeyWord's, but KeyBook does not allow the book to be edited. This feature prevents intentional or unintentional modification to the text of the book being read. The following commands can be used to listen to the book that has been opened: To go forward reading, press READ with G. Note that while you are continuously reading, you can skip back or forward by sentences or paragraphs without stopping the continuous reading function. This feature is extremely useful if you want to quickly browse forward or back from your current reading position. To stop reading, press READ with SPACE together. The following 6 commands can be used both while KeyBook is continuously reading and when you are reviewing: To move back a sentence, press READ with U; To hear the current sentence, press READ with I; To move forward a sentence, press READ with O; To move back a paragraph, press READ with 7; To hear the current paragraph, press READ with 8; To move forward a paragraph, press READ with 9. The other commands available when reviewing are: To go to the beginning of the book, press READ with T; To go to the end of the book, press READ with B; To find a text string in the book, press READ with F. This command is described in 3.15 Searching a Document. To move back a character, press READ with M; To hear the current character, press READ with COMMA. (Press this command once to hear the character spoken. Press it again, and if the character is a letter, you will hear its "call sign" e.g. Alpha for A, Bravo for B etc.) To move forward a character, press READ with PERIOD; To move back a word, press READ with J; To hear the current word, press READ with K. The first time you press this command, the word is spoken. The second time the word is spelled out; To move forward a word, press READ with L; To enter Announce Key Mode, press READ with A; To query the cursor position, press READ with Q; To go to any page, line, or column, press READ with R. This command is described in 3.17 Going to a Specified Position. Besides accepting the READ with character combinations, KeyBook also accepts the commands without the READ because the meaning is clear. This is the same as KeyWord's "review only" mode that was discussed in 3.9.2 Selecting ReviewOnly Mode. This is quite a long list to remember, but assistance is always available by pressing HELP. 4.3 Miscellaneous commands. KeyBook has a group of block commands. These commands are the same as KeyWord's block commands. To go to the block commands menu, press CONTROL with B. The block commands are described in 7.5 Block Commands. To open another book, press CONTROL with Z. KeyBook prompts: "Book name? Press ENTER for (book title)" where book title is the name of the last book read. You can type the name of the book that you want to load or review the list of books in the current folder by pressing SPACE. You can then select the book you want by pressing ENTER. If you want to change the folder, press BACKSPACE at the "Book name?" prompt. KeySoft announces: "Folder name? (Last used folder)." To step through the list of folders, press SPACE. This procedure was described in more detail in 3.20 Opening ASCII and Plain Braille format Documents. When you have selected a folder, KeyWord asks for the book name as before. To check what document you have selected, press READ with CONTROL with I and KeySoft will announce the document name. 4.4 Review Book Opening Options. Books in KeyWord's native format, as well as Microsoft Word, RTF and WordPerfect format, precisely specify their contents and formatting. However, the contents and formatting of books in ASCII text or plain Braille are not at all precisely defined, so it is necessary to give you control over how KeyBook interprets them. This is done through a list of options presented when you open such a book. The initial settings for these options are either the ones you established last time you opened the same book, or if you have never opened the book before, settings that KeyBook assumes are most appropriate for the book. Because of this, you usually won't need to make any changes. So that you can tell whether you have opened this book before, the wording of the prompt used changes from "Review the options?" to "Review previous options?" accordingly. To continue and open the book without reviewing the options, just press ENTER. To review the options, press Y. The options given when opening a book are as follows: “Is this a Braille or Text document?.” If the file extension is .brl or .brf (plain Braille) then this option will have already been set to Braille. If not, you must respond to the question before moving on. If the book contains grade 1 or grade 2 Braille, then select "Braille" by pressing B. Otherwise select "Text" by pressing T. Follow either entry with ENTER. KeySoft then prompts: "Use Line or Paragraph format when opening the document? currently Paragraph." When opening a book, it is important that KeyBook knows the difference between the ends of lines within a paragraph and the end of the paragraph itself. Without this knowledge, paragraphs might be run together, or each line within a paragraph might be treated as a separate paragraph. This would cause the speech to pause in the wrong places, and make it impossible to skim by paragraph. Plain text and plain Braille books use the same "control characters," for example, "carriage returns" and "line feeds," to show where lines within paragraphs end. This option allows you to control how KeyBook interprets these control characters to distinguish between ends of lines and ends of paragraphs. The option you choose here depends on the way the book you are opening is formatted: The Paragraph format option assumes that a single carriage return or carriage return/line feed pair that is followed by one or no spaces, denotes the end of a line within a paragraph. This end of line marker is removed so that KeyBook can reformat the paragraph within the margins that you have set. A sequence of two or more carriage return and/or line feed characters or a single sequence followed by an indent of two or more spaces is interpreted as the start of a new paragraph. This option is the default setting when you first open a book, and is the one that you will need for most prose books. The Line format option retains every carriage return and/or line feed sequence as a New Line in KeyWord. Use this setting when opening books containing lists, or poetry, or books where each paragraph is formatted as one long line. To retain "Paragraph" format when opening the book, just press ENTER. To select "Line" format, press L followed by ENTER. KeySoft then prompts: "Use Line or Paragraph format when saving the document? Currently Paragraph." Because KeyBook does not allow the text within a book to be modified or added to, just press ENTER to confirm the prompted option. KeySoft then prompts: "Extended ASCII character option? Currently Retain." The most common writing system used by computers is ASCII. In this system, each letter, number, and commonly used punctuation mark is represented by a number between 0 and 127 (Since the system was developed in the U.S., "commonly used" means commonly used in the U.S.) There is no way to represent accented characters and other special symbols, so the system has been extended with numbers greater than 127. The Extended ASCII option controls how KeyBook interprets these characters represented by numbers greater than 127, socalled "extended characters." Sometimes extended characters occur not because they are accented characters or special symbols, but because the file has been transmitted through a communications system that has added a "parity bit" which in effect has added an offset to some of the characters. To adjust for this, use the "Convert to standard ASCII" option, by pressing C, followed by ENTER. Sometimes the extended characters are used purely for visual effects such as boxes around paragraphs, etc. In these cases the book will be easier to read if the extended characters are removed altogether; use the "Ignore" option for this. To retain the extended characters when the book is opened, select "Retain" by pressing R, or press ENTER as this is the default setting. If you select Retain, another option is presented: KeySoft prompts: "Extended character set? Currently ANSI." More than one system has been used for extended characters; therefore you must tell KeyWord which one to use for this book. The options are the "ANSI" character set and the "MSDOS" character set. If you don't know which one to use, try one and if the extended characters do not come out correctly, try the other. For the "MSDOS" set, press M followed by ENTER. For the "ANSI" set, press A followed by ENTER. KeySoft will now prompt: "End of list." When you have made all your selections, press ESCAPE. 4.5 Reading Books Stored on Other Drives. The sample book is stored in the Books folder on the KeySoft System Disk. You should be careful about storing other books in the KeySoft System Disk, because any book other than the sample book will be lost if the battery goes flat, or the VoiceNote mPower QT is reset with JKL keys held down. If you have a backup of the book, or are not concerned about the possibility of losing it, then storing your books on this drive means that you don't use space on the Flash Disk. The Flash Disk is shared by the other programs like KeyWord and KeyMail, and its contents are preserved much like files on a conventional hard drive. There is an empty folder called My Books provided on the Flash Disk. However the Flash Disk has limited storage capacity and you would probably not want to store more than six or seven books in it. Many users who have a large collection of books prefer to keep these on a storage card. 4.5.1 Selecting a Drive. We have previously discussed the selection of files and folders within KeyBook, but we haven't described the selection of a drive. You can change the current drive at any time that you are prompted for a folder name by pressing BACKSPACE. For example when you select KeyBook, it prompts: "Read book in which folder? (Books)." Press BACKSPACE. KeyBook then prompts: "Drive? Press ENTER for (last drive used)." You can select the last drive used by pressing ENTER , or you can review the list of drives by pressing SPACE repeatedly. You can select a drive by pressing ENTER when the required drive is announced, or by typing a letter. There are always at least two drive options available. These are: To select the Flash Disk, press F. To select the KeySoft System Disk, press K. If you have plugged a storage card into the card slot on the back of the unit, select it by pressing S. To select a CF storage card in the CF slot, press C. 4.5.2 Loading a Book from Another Drive. After you have selected a drive, KeySoft prompts: "Read book in which folder? Press ENTER for none." Select the folder in the usual way. When you have selected a folder, KeyBook asks for the book name as before. 4.5.3 Advanced Storage Methods. Another way of storing a large book library is to do so on a PC or laptop. There are several methods available for transferring files to and from a PC, including ActiveSync, using Network client, or a card reader attached to your PC. These are all discussed in the Connectivity chapter of this user guide. You could either transfer the book or books to the "Books" folder on the KeySoft System Disk, create your own folder, or leave them stored on a memory card. 4.6 Exiting KeyBook. Exit KeyBook in the usual way by pressing ESCAPE to take you back to the Main Menu. The book is closed when you exit. To reopen the book from anywhere in the Main Menu, press B, then ENTER twice. You are returned to the place where you were last reading. Remember that you can switch to another task while using KeyBook, as described in 1.14 Switching Between Tasks. For example, to make an entry in the Planner, press FUNCTION with 6. When you have completed your entry, press FUNCTION with 9 to return to KeyBook. The VoiceNote mPower QT may beep once or twice, indicating it is busy preparing to resume from where you were when you switched tasks. 4.7 Bookshare. Bookshare.org is an online service that provides electronic format books that are both in and out of copyright. It is possible to access Bookshare books via KeyWeb on your VoiceNote mPower QT, and read them using KeyBook. Bookshare.org's public domain content is available to anyone, but copyrighted material is available only to members. For information about Bookshare.org, who is eligible to join and how to join, check out www.bookshare.org, or for more specific URLs, please refer to Appendix B. Note that a URL (Uniform Resource Locator) is another name for a website address. HumanWare expects that persons utilizing the Bookshare.org service from their VoiceNote mPower QT will honor the criteria for usage outlined in their membership agreement with Benetech. In this section on how to access Bookshare.org, it is assumed that you have already set up your VoiceNote mPower QT to use KeyWeb, and are a member of Bookshare.org and have created access codes and passwords etc. Be assured that the Bookshare.org site is very user friendly and set up to be easily accessible using a screen reader like KeyWeb. For information on how to use KeyWeb, please refer to Chapter 12. 4.7.1 How Books from Bookshare work. When first downloaded from the site, Bookshare.org books are "packed" into a special compressed format that has a .bks file extension, regardless of what book format you have chosen. Once the book is downloaded, it is then possible to "unpack" it from the .bks file into its normal format such as .brf or .txt. Once this is done, you can then delete the .bks file. To make this clearer, you could think of the .bks file as the bag that Bookshare.org put your book into, and once you have taken it out of its bag, you can throw the bag away. All copyrighted Bookshare.org books are password protected to help prevent them being used or distributed in ways contrary to the terms and conditions of membership. To unpack the book, you need to enter your password. Books that are in the public domain, that is, out of copyright, do not require a password even though the prompt will still come up. In these cases, you can still enter your password, or just press ENTER to pass over the field. 4.7.2 Supported formats. Bookshare.org has books in several electronic formats, some titles in more than one format. The VoiceNote mPower QT supports books in brf, txt and DAISY formats, but not HTML format. If you download a book in an unsupported format, KeyBook will allow you to unpack it, but before the process is complete, it will prompt to say that the format is not available. Books can only be "unpacked" in KeyBook. 4.7.3 Bookshare Favorites. The Bookshare.org home page is already set up as a favorite in KeyWeb. However if you intend to use Bookshare regularly, it might pay to set up the login page as a favorite instead. For information on how to do this, refer to 12.8.1 Adding a Favorite page. 4.7.4 Existing Bookshare books. If you are already a Bookshare.org member and have packed or unpacked books on your PC, you can simply transfer them to your VoiceNote mPower QT via ActiveSync, and open them in KeyBook. The only difference to the procedures below is that when you open KeyBook, you will have to select a folder or drive in the usual way, as it will not default to the correct location. 4.7.5 How to download a book from Bookshare. Follow the steps below to use KeyWeb to download a book from Bookshare.org. 1. Go to KeyWeb on your VoiceNote mPower QT by either pressing I in the Main Menu, or FUNCTION with 0 (zero) anywhere. KeyWeb will prompt you for a URL. 2. Select Bookshare from your favorites. The VoiceNote mPower QT will connect to the web and you will be in the Bookshare homepage. 3. Navigate to the Login page and log in using your member details. You will end up in a personalized welcome page. 4. Locate the book that you wish to read, and download it in a supported format (all books are available as brf; public domain ones are also in txt), and download it to the folder and drive of your choice. For Download instructions refer to 0 Follow these steps to download a file off an internet site. 4.7.6 Unpacking the book for reading. Follow the steps below to unpack your book: 1. Go to KeyBook by pressing FUNCTION with 9. 2. KeyBook will offer you the folder into which you downloaded the book as default. Press ENTER, and it will offer you the book as the default file. If you downloaded several books, it will offer the last one downloaded. To select the book, press ENTER again. 3. KeyBook prompts: "Folder for unpacked Bookshare book? Press ENTER for My Books." Either press ENTER straight away or select another file location. 4. You will be prompted for your Bookshare.org password. Type it in and press ENTER, or if no password is required, simply press ENTER. 5. The book will now unpack. There will be some progress beeps during this time. When complete, KeyBook prompts: "Delete the original packed Bookshare book?." Press Y. Note 1: If the book format is not supported, KeyBook will tell you at this point and return to the main menu. Note2: If there is not enough memory available to unpack the book, KeyBook will prompt – "Could not save unpacked Bookshare book. Disk is full." 6. KeyBook displays the name of the file, including the file extension, for example, "Harry_Po_b_fl.brf". To open it, press ENTER. 7. KeyBook will ask "Review the options?" as it does for every book in a nonnative KeySoft format the first time. As the file will have been set up automatically with the correct settings, press ENTER or N. 8. The book is now ready to read. If you exit the book before completing it, KeyBook will bookmark it for you and the next time you open it, it will open to the same place. Note: If instead of downloading books directly onto your VoiceNote mPower QT from Bookshare, you have transferred them from a PC or they are on a storage card, the same procedure applies. The only difference is that at step 2, you would navigate to the appropriate location, then continue as above. 4.8 DAISY Book Reader. KeyBook can read DAISY books. DAISY is an acronym which stands for "Digital Accessible Information SYstem". DAISY books have several advantages over other talking books: 1. Some books are narrated by an actual human narrator, not just a computer generated voice. 2. Some books contain text which you can read on the Braille display or search. 3. The structure allows quick and easy navigation through the book. For example, moving by chapter or page. Each book includes its own structure thereby making navigation the most suitable for that particular book. The majority of DAISY books that are currently available, contain audio only. However, there are a number of books, for example, books from bookshare.org, which contain text only and others which contain both audio and text. Throughout the description of the DAISY Book Reader, it has been assumed that you are familiar with the existing functionality of KeyBook. 4.8.1 RFB&D AudioPlus DAISY books. KeySoft has fully integrated support for the special AudioPlus formatted books provided by RFB&D to its members in the United States. The BrailleNote now automatically recognises these books and prompts you to enter your personal identification number to access the book. 4.8.2 Searching for a Book. Although DAISY books are made up of many files, KeyBook allows you to search for books by just selecting the book title. As typical for any other type of electronic book, begin the search for a DAISY book by first selecting KeyBook from the Main Menu and then selecting the folder containing the book you want to read. The most recently read book will be offered as the default. If you want to read a different book, press SPACE at this point. A list of all the books in the current folder will then be presented. 4.8.3 Reading Options. 4.8.3.1 Listening to the Book. Once a DAISY book has been loaded, you can listen to the book using the following commands: To start listening: press READ with G. To stop listening: press READ with SPACE. You can change the volume by using the following commands: To increase the volume: press CONTROL with EQUALS. To decrease the volume: press CONTROL with HYPHEN. Note that these volume control commands are relative to the main volume. This means that to turn the volume up further or decrease it, you will need to increase or decrease the main volume using the following commands: To increase the main volume: press FUNCTION with PERIOD. To decrease the main volume: press FUNCTION with COMMA. It is also possible to alter the speed and tone of the narrator using the following commands: To speak slower: press FUNCTION with HYPHEN. To speak faster: press FUNCTION with EQUALS. To increase speech tone: press SHIFT with FUNCTION with EQUALS. To decrease speech tone: press SHIFT with FUNCTION with DASH. 4.8.4 Navigation Options. The structure of a DAISY book is arranged into levels. There are a maximum of six levels of navigation available, although many books contain only 2 or 3. Each level provides an increasingly more precise way to navigate the content within DAISY books. For example, level 1 may be a chapter heading; level 2 sub headings within the chapter and level 3 paragraphs. Using these levels effectively allows you to quickly gain access to any position within the book. As well as the above levels, other options may be available depending on the type of book you are reading. For instance most books also allow you move by phrase or page and audio books also allow you to jump by 1 minute intervals. These levels and other navigation items such as page, phrase and time jump are referred to as DAISY elements. 4.8.4.1 DAISY Navigation. As was mentioned in the overview, you can navigate through the book using the available DAISY elements. You navigate the book by first selecting an element, for example level 1, and then use the forward or back commands to skip to the previous or next level 1 positions. If you wish to move by a different element simply select it and then the forward and back commands will move by the new element. Use the following commands to navigate using the DAISY elements: To move forward by the currently selected element: press RIGHT ARROW. To move back by the currently selected element: press LEFT ARROW. To select the element to be used for navigation, press UP ARROW/DOWN ARROW. Note that the first time you press this command, the current element will be displayed. Press this command repeatedly to cycle through all the available elements for that book until the element you require is displayed. 4.8.4.2 List of Headings. KeyBook can list all the headings in a book in the hierarchy dictated by the book level structure. In most cases this is simply the Table of Contents. To access the List of Headings, press READ with V. Generally, all the headings at Level 1 will be displayed first. If any of these headings contain sub headings, that is, Level 2 headings then the text "has subheadings", will be announced. If you press ENTER at this point, you will be shown the list of Level 2 headings. Once you have found the heading for the section you want to read, press ENTER and you will be taken to that position within the book. Note that the heading you are currently closest to will be displayed when you first enter the List of Headings. 4.8.4.3 Navigating by Text. If the book contains text, the standard KeyBook commands to browse by sentence, paragraph, line, section, word and character can be used. There are two reading modes available for DAISY books, "sentence and paragraph" and "line and section". The current mode determines the functionality of the following commands: To move forward one sentence or line: press READ with O. To move back a sentence or line: press READ with U. To read the current sentence or line: press READ with I. To move forward a paragraph or section: press READ with 9. To move back a paragraph or section: press READ with 7. To read the current paragraph or section: press READ with 8. To move forward a word: press READ with L. To move back a word: press READ with J. To read the current word: press READ with K. To spell the current word: press READ with K twice. To move forward a character: press READ with PERIOD. To move back a character: press READ with M. To read the current character: press READ with COMMA. To change the current reading mode: press READ with S. 4.8.4.4 Finding Text. The standard KeyBook commands to find text can be used in all books containing text. To find text in the book, press READ with F. Press F (for forward) or B (for back), type the text you wish to find, and press ENTER. To find the next occurrence of the text: press READ with N. 4.8.4.5 Jumping to a Page. It is also possible to jump directly to a particular page number. This is only supported if the book is broken into a page structure and fortunately the majority of DAISY books are structured this way. To go to a page, press READ with R. Type P for page, then type the required page number and press ENTER. 4.8.5 Listening Options. As previously mentioned, most currently available DAISY books are audio only. In audio only books, you will hear a narrator (that is, the recorded voice included with the book.) In books containing text only, you will hear the KeySoft text to speech voice. With these types of books, the voice used is predetermined and therefore not controllable. However, some books contain both audio and text and you can choose to listen to either the recorded narrator or to the text to speech voice. You do this by turning the narrator on or off (to toggle the narrator on or off, press READ with SHIFT with V.) If the narrator is on, the recorded voice supplied with the book will do the reading. If you turn the narrator off, the voice that reads the book will be determined by your current KeySoft voice settings. 4.8.6 Placemarkers. As with all other types of books, it is possible to use Place Markers in your DAISY book and these are retained when the book is closed. Place Markers, or bookmarks as are often called, are handy for a number of reasons including keeping track of your progress as you read a book or the location of information you wish to find again. For example, you are reading a book about dog breeds and are particularly interested in any information on Poodles which are mentioned in Chapters 6, 8 and 24 of your DAISY book. Since you are keen to reread these chapters, you will add three Placemarkers to your book. Place Markers are identified by the letters, A to Z. To define a Place Marker, press READ with D, from any position in the book and enter a letter that you wish to associate with that Place Marker, in this case, "P" for Poodles. To jump to any defined Place Marker, press READ with P, followed by the identification letter for that Place Marker. 4.8.7 Text Notes. As well as being able to add Place Markers to a DAISY book, you also have the option of inserting Text Notes. These can be just a few words, a sentence or a whole paragraph long. Text Notes allow you to add notes to a DAISY book as you are reading it. This is a useful feature if you want to make comments at a particular point in the book. To insert a text note, press READ with SHIFT with N. Enter the identification number of the text note that you want to insert and press ENTER. Try to use meaningful numbers if possible, for example text note 1 could refer to chapter 1, text note 12 could represent chapter 12 or chapter 1; sub heading 2. You then need to type the required text and press ENTER. To view a text note, press READ with SHIFT with N. Enter the identification number and press ENTER. The text note will be displayed and you will be taken to the appropriate position within the book. You have the option to edit the text if you wish and it will be saved when you press ENTER. If there is no note for the number you have entered, a new one will be created for the current position within the book. 4.8.8 Clipboard. For DAISY books that contain text, the existing KeySoft clipboard functions are available for you to use when you need to copy information from a DAISY book. See Block Commands 7.5 Block Commands for further details. 4.8.9 Obtaining Book Information. It is possible to obtain information regarding the book you are reading. There are two types of information available; book information and current position information. Book information provides details such as the book title, the number of pages in the book, total time to read the book using the narrator etc. The actual details available may vary from book to book. To obtain book information: press READ with CONTROL with I. Current position information provides details such as the current heading for the section you are in and the page number. Again, the actual information available may be different depending on the book you are reading. To obtain current position information: press READ with Q. 4.8.10 Managing DAISY Books. DAISY books are available from various sources. For example, they are distributed on CD and are able to be downloaded from the Internet. DAISY books are generally too large (some books are 600700MB), to be stored on the Flash Disk of your VoiceNote mPower QT. We therefore recommend that you use large capacity external media, such as a CompactFlash card to store your DAISY books. In managing DAISY books, it is very important that you are aware of the following: 1. A DAISY book is made up of several files, none of which may include the actual title of the book. 2. All files in a single book must be managed as a whole. 3. The File Manager allows you to open, copy and delete DAISY books by their title. 4. You cannot rename or move DAISY books. 5. To have the titles of the DAISY books listed in a list of files, change the file view to 'List of All Books' or 'List of DAISY Books', by repeatedly pressing READ with X until the desired view is displayed. 6. Never rename or delete individual files that make up a book or you risk rendering the book unreadable. Note that some of the files making up a DAISY book can share the same name as files in other books. Therefore, if you decide to copy book files individually, you must ensure that all the files making up a book are stored together in a folder unique to that book. Copying files for a book into a folder that already contains another book, will result in files being overwritten and both books being rendered unreadable. Consequently, is best to use the File Manager to manage your books since it will ensure the above rules are followed. End of Book Reader Chapter. 5 General Functions. This chapter discusses the functions listed on the Options Menu, which was introduced briefly in 1.13 General Functions. A number of these functions are discussed in other sections of this User Guide as appropriate, and the main purpose of this chapter is to summarize all the Option Menu functions in one place. The Options Menu comprises general functions that are available wherever you are in KeySoft. You could be using the Word processor, sending or receiving email, using the Calculator, or reading a menu. After using one of these functions, you are returned to the place you were at previously. To access the Options Menu from anywhere in KeySoft, press FUNCTION with O, and KeySoft will prompt: "Options menu.” You can then review the items by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE. The Options Menu comprises the following items: Date; Time Options; Grade of Braille for Keyboard Entry; Braille options; Keyboard settings; Review voice; Connectivity; Visual display; Next appointment; Power and battery status; User guide; Insertion; Spell. Repeat and spell; Hear punctuation. Repeat with maximum punctuation; Move to another task; Speech settings. To select an item, move through the menu until the required item is displayed, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, from anywhere in the Options menu, press the initial letter of your choice. This does not apply to the speech settings, which are discussed in 1.13.2 Setting Volume and Pitch. Selecting a menu item takes at least two key combinations, for example, FUNCTION with O then D to hear the date. For really fast access, many items are also available through quick commands. These are listed in 1.13 General Functions, as well as being mentioned in each relevant section of this chapter. Some items on the Options Menu will always display the same style of information, for example the time and date functions, while for other options the response will vary depending on where you are in KeySoft when you select the item. An example of this is "Calculator Braille Language," which is only announced when the Calculator is in use. The Connectivity option is discussed in detail in the Connectivity Chapter of this user guide. 5.1 Date. To announce the current day and date, press FUNCTION with O, then D. After the date is announced, return to your original place in KeySoft by pressing ADVANCE. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with D. 5.2 Time Options. There are two time options available – the clock (current time), and the stopwatch. 5.2.1 Current time. To announce the current time, press FUNCTION with T. To access the current time through the time menu, press FUNCTION with O, then T, then C for Clock. After the time is announced you will be returned to your original place in KeySoft. 5.2.2 Stopwatch. The stopwatch operates in a similar way to a mechanical stopwatch. It keeps time down to one hundredth of a second, can be stopped, started or returned to zero, and the time display can be copied to the clipboard for pasting into documents or emails. 5.2.2.1 Stopwatch commands. To access the stopwatch, press FUNCTION with W. Or you can press FUNCTION with O then T, then S for stopwatch. The first time you use it, The stopwatch will be at zero. There are three settings – stop, start and zero. The zero setting resets the time to zero – however we are not referring to it as reset, as "Reset" has a very different meaning on the VoiceNote mPower QT already! To zero the time, press CONTROL with I. To start or stop the stopwatch, press SPACE. This is a toggle command. To stop the stopwatch altogether, first stop it by pressing SPACE then zero it by pressing CONTROL with I. To copy the time to the clipboard, press CONTROL with C. You can do this at any time, even when the stopwatch is running. 5.2.2.2 Running in the Background. Once it has started, the stopwatch will keep running until you press the stop command, or reset the VoiceNote mPower QT. Even if you switch to another task, or switch the VoiceNote mPower QT off, it will still keep running in the background, although it won't announce any times automatically. To check on the elapsing time, simply access the stopwatch by pressing FUNCTION with W. The stopwatch will announce the elapsing time. 5.2.2.3 Stopwatch Announcements. The running stopwatch will announce the time every minute . For example: "7 minutes" or "3 hours, 46 minutes" Any other time, you can hear the elapsing time to the second by pressing REPEAT. For example: "1 hour, 5 minutes, 48 seconds" To hear the same time repeated, press L. When the stopwatch is stopped, you can hear the elapsed time by pressing REPEAT. The VoiceNote mPower QT is primarily designed to handle text information from the computer style keyboard. However, it is possible to open and create Braille documents. In this instance the F, D, and S keys correspond to Braille keys 1, 2 and 3 respectively. Similarly, the J, K, and L keys correspond to Braille keys 4, 5 and 6 respectively. If you are typing a Braille document in Grade 2 and want to enter something which could be ambiguous, you can temporarily select Grade 1 through this item on the Options Menu. After you have entered the word or passage, you can switch back to Grade 2. You might do this for a list of surnames and initials. Another choice when typing Grade 2 is to switch to computer Braille, perhaps for a file name such as "program.exe" which contains a period, or for an email address. If your preferred Braille is Grade 2, KeySoft will occasionally override your preference and force Grade 1. 5.3 Braille Options. To review the Braille Options list anywhere in KeySoft, press FUNCTION with O for the Options Menu, then B. You can move forward or back through the items in the usual way. To leave any option unchanged, just press ENTER. To change any option, enter a setting or value and press ENTER. 5.3.1 Braille Language. For USA Braille, press S. For UK Braille, press K. For Australian Braille, press A. This setting determines the way grade 1 and grade 2 Braille are represented inside the VoiceNote and when it is sent to an embosser. It also controls how it is translated to text and vice versa. Usually this setting will have already been set for you when you receive your VoiceNote. Be careful about changing it because files created in one language will not be read or emboss properly if this setting has subsequently been changed to another language. 5.3.1.1 Preferred Reading Grade. This is the grade used for prompts, help messages, documents, email, etc. The factory default is Grade 2. You set this grade for each language that you use. If you prefer to read in Grade 1, press A. If you prefer to read in Grade 2, press B. If you prefer Computer Braille, press C. 5.3.1.2 Text Document Reading Grade. This option is available within a document, an email, or within the Planner. It allows you to select how text documents are displayed on the Braille display. The default setting is the "Preferred reading grade," which is generally Grade 2. Text documents include VoiceNote mPower QT KeyWord text documents, Microsoft Word, ASCII text and other forms of text documents that you may choose to read or edit. For on the fly translation to your preferred reading grade, press P. For 6 dot computer Braille, press F. For 8 dot computer Braille, press H. To change the text document reading grade using the navigation keys, press ADVANCE with NEXT repeatedly. 5.3.1.3 Braille Code. VoiceNote mPower QT provides a choice of Grade 1/Grade2 English Braille codes. They are: * USA, * UK * Australian * UK 2004 * UEB For USA Braille, press S. For UK Braille, press K. For Australian Braille, press A. For UEB Braille, press E. For UK 2004 Braille, press 4. For the French language, the options are: * French * Canadian This setting determines the way grade 1 and grade 2 Braille are represented inside the VoiceNote mPower QT and when it is embossed. It also controls how Braille is translated to text, and vice versa. Usually this setting will have already been set for you before you receive your VoiceNote mPower QT. 5.3.1.4 Calculator Braille Code. This option is only available within the Calculator. Calculations are displayed on the Braille display in one of the following notations: Nemeth Braille Code for Mathematics, UK Braille Mathematics, UEB, French or German. For Nemeth code, USA, press N. For UK Mathematics Notation, press U. 5.3.1.5 Computer Braille Table. The VoiceNote mPower QT is supplied with two English Computer Braille tables, USA and UK. However, the user may create or install additional Computer Braille tables. For USA computer Braille, press S. For UK computer Braille, press K. To cycle through all the available Computer Braille tables, press CONTROL with SPACE. 5.4 Keyboard Settings. To review the Keyboard settings list anywhere in KeySoft, press FUNCTION with O for the Options Menu, then K. Press ESCAPE to leave the Keyboard settings list and return to your original place in KeySoft. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with K. A detailed explanation of each Keyboard Setting option follows: 5.4.1 Setting the Keyboard Voice. The first of these settings determines how much KeySoft speaks as you type. KeySoft prompts: "Keyboard voice? Currently Words." The options are as follows: To spell words as they are typed, press S followed by ENTER; To speak whole words, press W followed by ENTER; To both spell and speak words, press B followed by ENTER; To cycle through all the items above, press CONTROL with SPACE. Or just press ENTER to leave the selection unchanged. The suggested setting is "Words." If you are learning to type, you may prefer the "Spell" option or the "Both" option. If you can type quickly, you might select the "Words" option. You can press HELP for a reminder of these options. 5.4.2 Preferred Keyboard Braille Grade. The setting determines the grade of Braille in which you prefer to type. To select Grade 1 Braille, press A; Grade 2 Braille, press B; and to input Computer Braille, press C or J. To leave this option unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is Grade 2. If you have a literary Braille selected and the characters that you want are not supported, then you will be advised that you need to use Computer Braille. KeySoft will automatically switch to Computer Braille for you. Computer Braille is not available if you are using UEB. 5.4.3 Advise when a nonpreferred code is required. To be advised when a nonpreferred code is required, press Y. For no warning, press N. To leave this option unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is Yes. Using this setting will cause KeySoft to advise when a Braille code that is different from the preferred code is required. Your preferred code is the one set as the default. 5.5 Review Voice. To examine the Review Voice settings anywhere in KeySoft, press FUNCTION with O for the Options Menu, then R. Press ESCAPE to leave the Review Voice settings and return to your original place in KeySoft. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with R. There are four items associated with the Review Voice settings. These are: The level of punctuation spoken by the Review Voice; The manner in which numbers are announced; The volume of the delete and error alert tones; The volume of the progress tones. When you select the Review Voice, you are presented with the first of the four items, and you must either accept or change the setting before moving on to the next item. 5.5.1 Punctuation level. To select a different level, press a number between 1 and 5. The Factory setting is 2. To leave this option unchanged, just press ENTER. The way the 5 levels treat punctuation and format indicators is described below. 1. All punctuation is ignored except for '\'. 2. This is the factory setting. The following punctuation is pronounced: & / > < * + ^ [ ] | \ = % $ # 3. All punctuation is pronounced except for: , . ? ! ; : space, and single quotes within words. 4. All punctuation is pronounced except for single spaces between words and single quotes within words. All special indicators are announced. Spaces nested between the end of a word and a period, comma, semicolon or colon are also announced. Capital letters are indicated by raising the pitch. If the first letter of a word, or all of the word is in capitals, the pitch is raised for the whole word. If a word contains an unusual mixture of capital and noncapital letters, then the pitch is raised even higher as an alert. 5. All text is spelled. This level is not recommended for reviewing text, but it can be of use for other applications. When computer Braille or text is being read, capital letters are spoken by announcing "CAP" before the letter. If the whole word is in capital letters, the spelling of the word is prefixed with the announcement "CAP ALL". 5.5.2 Number format. For digits, press D. For words, press W. To leave this option unchanged, just press ENTER. The Factory setting is words. For word format, the number 2010 is spoken as “twenty ten,” since it is assumed to be a date. The sequence $20.15 is spoken as "twenty dollars and 15 cents.” If you select the digits option, the number 2010 is spoken digit by digit. The choice is a matter of personal preference and may depend upon the document with which you are working. 5.5.3 Delete Alert Tone Volume. The delete tone sounds when characters are deleted with either the BACKSPACE or any delete option. To change the volume of the tone, press a number between 0 and 6. 0 disables the tone; 6 is loudest. To leave the setting unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is 4. 5.5.4 Error Alert Tone Volume. The error tone sounds when you press an invalid key combination, or make some other error. . To change the volume of the tone, press a number between 0 and 6. O disables the tone; 6 is loudest. To leave the setting unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is 4. 5.5.5 Progress tones. Progress tones are there to let you know a page is loading or a download is progressing normally. To change the volume of the tone, type a number between 0 and 6. Zero disables the tone, 6 is loudest. To leave the setting unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is 4. 5.6 Visual Display. Using and connecting a visual display is described in 2.8 Visual Display. To select visual display, press FUNCTION with O, then V. 5.7 Next Appointment. To find your next appointment, press FUNCTION with O, then N for the "Next appointment" option. The appointment details are announced. When you are finished, press ADVANCE to return to the point at which you selected the Options menu. See also 9.6.2 Checking Your Next Appointment. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with N. 5.8 Power and Battery Status. To determine the power and battery status, press FUNCTION with O, then P. See also. 5.9 User Guide. To access the User Guide, press FUNCTION with O, then U. Accessing the User Guide is fully described in 1.19 User Guide. 5.10 Insertion. The "Insertion" item only appears on the Options menu when you are in a KeySoft function where insertion is possible. For example, if you are in the Main Menu, it will not appear, but it will when in a document in KeyWord. This item takes you to a menu with several options: Time, Date, Calculator Result, Unicode Character, File (only when in KeyMail) The quick command to go directly to the Insertion Menu is FUNCTION with I. 5.10.1 Insert Calculator Result. To insert the calculator result, press FUNCTION with I then C. You are asked if you want to insert the calculator result or the whole calculation. To insert the result, press R. To insert the whole calculation, press C. For example, if the calculation was 3+4=7, pressing R would enter “7” in the document. Pressing C would enter “3+4=7” into the document. 5.10.2 Insert Unicode Character. To insert a Unicode character, press FUNCTION with I then U. After choosing to insert a Unicode character, KeySoft will prompt for the character. Let’s assume you want to enter an "e acute." Type "e acute" at the prompt for the Unicode character. KeySoft will respond with the character "cap e acute," so press SPACE to find the next "e acute" character. When the desired character is announced, press ENTER to insert the character. The Quick Key for inserting a Unicode character is FUNCTION with X. For more information, see also 7.18 Extended Characters. 5.11 Repeat and Spell. To repeat a prompt with the important parts spelled out, press FUNCTION with O, then S for "Spell." You are returned to your original place in KeySoft. This is like repeating an announcement, but with more detail. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with L. This function works on prompts, and file and folder names. 5.12 Hear Punctuation. To reveal the most detail, you can repeat the last prompt with full punctuation and spaces. To do this, press FUNCTION with O, then H for "Hear punctuation." You are returned to your original place in KeySoft. See also 1.13.3 Repeating an Announcement. The quick key for this function is FUNCTION with P. 5.13 Move to Another Task. KeySoft allows you to move directly from one KeySoft task to another without returning to the Main Menu. You can switch between the Word processor, Scientific Calculator, Planner, Address List, EMail, etc. For example, if you are writing a document and you need an address, you can switch directly to the Address List, look up the address, and then return to the Word processor. You are placed back at the same point in your document. The following hot keys are available for switching tasks: To select the Word processor press FUNCTION with 4; To select the Scientific Calculator press FUNCTION with 5; To select the Planner press FUNCTION with 6; To select the Address List press FUNCTION with 7; To select the Email system press FUNCTION with 8; To select the Book Reader press FUNCTION with 9; To select the Internet browser, press FUNCTION with 0 (zero); To select the Media Center, press FUNCTION with M; To select the Remote Sythesizer, press FUNCTION with R; To select the FM Radio, press FUNCTION with F; To select the Database Manager, press SHIFT with FUNCTION with D; To select the Games, press FUNCTION with G. There is also a Task menu available. To access this, either: 1. Press FUNCTION with O for the Options menu then M for Move to another task, or 2. Press FUNCTION with S. KeySoft announces: "Task menu." You can make a selection by either: 1. Review the menu items using SPACE and select one by pressing ENTER. or, 2. Press the initial letter of the task; for example, W for Word Processor. Remember that, if necessary, you can always get back to the Main Menu by pressing MENU. 5.14 Change Speech Volume Rate and Pitch. The Options Menu reminds you how to change the speech volume, rate and pitch. The following commands can be used from anywhere in KeySoft: To speak louder, press FUNCTION with PERIOD; To speak softer, press FUNCTION with COMMA; To speak faster, press FUNCTION with EQUALS; To speak slower, press FUNCTION with HYPHEN; To increase speech pitch, press SHIFT with FUNCTION with EQUALS; To decrease speech pitch, press SHIFT with FUNCTION with DASH. There are 32 volumes, 16 speeds and 16 pitches, and they change one step at each key press. This is the end of the Options Menu. 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. When you type in response to a KeySoft prompt, you can edit your input with KeyWord commands. For example, you may have typed a document name like "Administration costs," and you want to check your spelling before you press ENTER. You can review and edit your input with these standard commands: Read character left, current, or right: READ with M, or Comma, or Period; Read word left, current or right: READ with J, or K, or L; Read whole entry: READ with I; Delete character before cursor: BACKSPACE; Delete character at cursor: CONTROL with COMMA, or DELETE; Delete word at cursor: CONTROL with K; Delete word before cursor: CONTROL with J; Delete to end of entry: CONTROL with I. You can also use these commands to edit the lastused entry that KeySoft offers at various points. For example, you may have two documents named: "Expenses Quarter 1," and "Expenses Quarter 2." Let's assume you had previously been working with "Expenses Quarter 1." When you go to open the second document, KeySoft prompts: "Document to open? Expenses Quarter 1." Instead of typing a whole new name, you could use the review and edit commands to change the "1" into "2". Note that an existing string can be edited only if your first action is a reading or editing command. If you press even one letter, the whole existing string is replaced by your new entry. End of General Functions Chapter. 6 Embossing and Printing Documents. If an embosser or printer is connected to your VoiceNote mPower QT, you can emboss or print documents and email, as well as parts of the planner and address list. The embossing option can be used for either Braille or text documents, the latter being automatically translated before embossing. Similarly, the print option can be used for text or Braille documents. Setup options are provided for both embossers and printers, and the use of test documents is described. The selection and operation of embossers and printers is outside the scope of this user guide. 6.1 Setting Up the Embosser or Printer. You can emboss or print from the VoiceNote mPower QT's serial, USB or infrared ports, or the Bluetooth transceiver. Selecting the appropriate connection for your embosser or printer hardware is described later, in 6.8.6 Embosser Port. 6.2 Printing with Infrared. You can print or emboss using VoiceNote mPower QT's infrared port if you have either an IrDA equipped printer or embosser, or an IrDA compatible accessory such as the JETEYE printer adapter. If a JETEYE printer adapter is used it also needs to be set up. VoiceNote mPower QT's infrared port needs to face the infrared port on the printer or embosser or adapter at a distance of up to three feet (1 meter). The JETEYE printer adapter's port is at the rounded corner of the housing. The infrared ports do not have to be lined up exactly because the infrared beam is quite wide. After a little experimentation, you will be able to determine the most convenient arrangement of equipment that works reliably. 6.3 Printing with USB. USB is now the universal standard for connecting to printers. Simply plug the USB printer into one of your VoiceNote mPower QT's USB host ports, and select USB as your printer port, as explained in 6.8.6 Embosser Port. 6.3.1 Printing to a Parallel Port printer. Although the VoiceNote mPower QT does not have a parallel port, it is still possible to use a printer or embosser that only has a parallel connector. Using an Inside Out Networks  Edgeport /421 multiinterface converter, you can print to a parallel printer or embosser by plugging in the USB cable of the converter to the VoiceNote mPower QT, and the parallel cable of the printer into the converter hub. The Inside Out Networks  Edgeport /421 multiinterface converter requires a special driver to work on the VoiceNote mPower QT, but as this is already in the software, you will not need to reload it. If using this converter with a parallel port printer or embosser, you must select USB as your printer port. 6.4 Printing with Bluetooth. To use a Bluetooth printer with your VoiceNote mPower QT, first you will need to get the bluetooth connection working. 1. Go to the Options Menu by pressing SPACE with O, then C for the Connectivity Menu. 2. Select Bluetooth and press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "Bluetooth on? Currently Yes/No." Press Y. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Search for devices?" Press Y. KeySoft announces, "Searching for Bluetooth devices, please wait..." This may take a few seconds during which you will hear progress beeps. When the search is complete, KeySoft will announce: "List of Bluetooth devices." 4. Select the printer from the list. 5. Now you have an active Bluetooth pairing set up, go to the Embossing Setup list and select Bluetooth as your printing port, as discussed in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. 6.5 Embossing or Printing a Document. The procedures for printing and embossing are exactly the same, except for the prompts that refer to either "print" or "emboss." To avoid repetition, we only discuss embossing. To emboss a document, start at the KeyWord Menu and select "Emboss a Document." KeySoft prompts: "Emboss or Set up embosser?" The Emboss option leads to a series of prompts to select and emboss a document. The Set Up option allows the VoiceNote mPower QT to be matched to the embosser. Details on the set up process are in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. Assuming that the embosser has already been set up, you can proceed to emboss a document. Press E for Emboss, and KeySoft prompts: "Folder name?" If the document you want is not on the current drive, select a new drive, then choose the folder and file names. KeySoft prompts: "Embosser ready? When you reach the "Embosser Ready?" prompt for the first time in a session, it is a good idea to turn the embosser off, then on again. This ensures that its memory is cleared, and avoids spurious characters at the top of the page. To emboss just one copy of the whole document, press Y for Yes. Embossing starts and you are returned to the KeyWord menu. If an embosser connected to the serial port produces random characters or nothing at all, the communications parameters are wrongly set. These can be changed from the Embosser Set Up List. This list is explained in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. 6.6 Embossing Options. If you only want to emboss certain pages, or you want several copies, then reply to the "Embosser Ready?" prompt by pressing N for No. There follows a list of 3 settings that you may want to change: 1. KeySoft prompts: "Start page number?" Enter the page number to start embossing from and press ENTER. The suggested setting is the first page. To check the page number range for the document, press HELP. 2. After this setting, KeySoft prompts: "Finish page number?" Enter the page number to finish embossing at and press ENTER. The suggested setting is the last page. 3. KeySoft prompts: “Number of copies? Press Enter for one" The suggested setting is one. Type the number of copies you require and press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "Embosser Ready?" Press Y and the embosser should start immediately. KeySoft provides a means of pausing or abandoning output from VoiceNote mPower QT to an embosser. However many modern embossers store large amounts of data in their memory. This allows your VoiceNote mPower QT to transfer the data almost instantaneously. Your chances of stopping the transfer of a large amount of information once started are slight. You are left with the only option of turning off the power to the embosser to flush the unwanted data. However if your embosser does not have a large memory, the ability to pause or abandon embossing is still useful. To pause or abandon embossing once started, you must select the "Emboss a Document" option from the KeyWord menu again. KeySoft now prompts: "Embossing (name)," where name is the name of the document being embossed. To emboss another document, press ENTER. To pause embossing, press SPACE. KeySoft announces: "Embossing of (name) Paused." To restart embossing, press SPACE again. To abandon embossing the current document, press CONTROL with I followed by ESCAPE to exit. You are returned to the KeyWord Menu. 6.7 Embossing a Group of Documents. You may wish to emboss or print all documents with a certain group of characters in their names. To accomplish this, wild card characters can be included in a document name. For details of wild card use, refer to 14.14 Groups of Files and Wild Cards. As an example, entering the document name "NOTES," followed by the single character wild card, which is ?, would cause all these documents to be selected: NOTES1; NOTES2; NOTES3. You can also emboss or print all the documents in one folder. To do this, proceed as for a single document, but at the document name prompt, press *, which is the multicharacter wild card. Remember that HELP provides a convenient list of the options available. 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. When you first connect an embosser or printer to the VoiceNote mPower QT, you should review the embosser/printer setup list and change any settings as necessary. You need to know about the paper size, the type of feed, and so on. If you plan to use an embosser with a serial interface, you will also need to know its serial communications parameters before you can complete the setup. Once you have set up KeySoft for the embosser the first time, it is strongly recommended that you emboss a test document as described in 6.10 Testing the Embosser. To check or change the Embosser Setup List, start at the "Emboss or SetUp?" prompt and press S for Set up. KeySoft prompts: "Embosser SetUp List." To move along the list without changing values, press SPACE repeatedly. To move back along the list without changing values, press BACKSPACE repeatedly. You can change settings by entering an appropriate new setting and pressing ENTER. The items in the Embosser Setup List are as follows: These two prompts are for the length and the width of the paper used in the embosser, measured in embossed lines and cells. Typical values are 25 and 40, but if you are not absolutely sure, use the test document described in 6.10 Testing the Embosser to determine what these settings should be. 6.8.1 Use Form Feeds Between Pages. The factory setting for this item is Yes. 6.8.2 Pause After Each Page. For automatic sheet feeding or continuous stationery, leave this item at the factory setting of No. If you have to feed individual sheets into the embosser, you should set it to Yes. When you are actually using the embosser, load a new sheet when prompted to do so, and press ENTER to continue. 6.8.3 Does Your Embosser Emboss Both Sides of the Page. If your embosser embosses both sides of the paper, you should set this item to "Yes". Otherwise, leave it set to the factory setting of "No." If you want to emboss a particular document singlesided, the appropriate setting should be changed in the Document Layout list, not here. This is described in 7.17.9 Layout of a Braille Document. 6.8.4 Page Offset. This defines the position of the left margin of the embossing, in cells from the left edge of the paper. It is like an overall left margin which affects all embossing. The factory setting is zero. Values from 0 to 50 are allowable. 6.8.5 Embosser Braille Table. Following the prompt: "Embosser braille table?", press CONTROL with SPACE to step through the available tables, for example, KeySoft 6dot English Embosser. Press ENTER to make your selection. 6.8.6 Embosser Port. You can select any of the following ports on the back of your VoiceNote mPower QT as the embosser port: USB port; press U then ENTER. KeyWord announces: "USB." Bluetooth port, press B then ENTER. KeyWord announces: "Bluetooth." Note: You can only select Bluetooth as a port when there is an active Bluetooth pairing as discussed in 6.4 Printing with Bluetooth. Serial port; press S then ENTER. KeyWord announces: "Serial cable on COM1." Infrared port, press I then ENTER. KeyWord announces: "Infrared." File, press F then ENTER. KeyWord announces: "File." If you choose the USB port or the infrared port, this is the end of the Embosser Setup List. Exit the list by pressing ESCAPE, confirm any changes you have made, and you are placed back at the "Emboss or SetUp?" prompt. If you have made any changes, you are strongly advised to use the test document to check the embosser setup. If you plan to use an embosser connected to the serial port on the back of the VoiceNote mPower QT, press S at the "Embosser Port?" prompt. There are 4 further items in the Embosser Setup List, relating to the serial connection, as follows. 6.8.7 Baud Rate. You can type a standard baud rate to suit the embosser, or to step through the available rates, press CONTROL with SPACE. 6.8.8 Parity. The options are N, E, or O, for None, Even, or Odd parity respectively. Press ENTER to complete the entry. “Number of Data Bits?” The options are 7 or 8. Press ENTER to complete the entry. 6.8.9 Handshaking. Responses are S for software handshaking, or H for hardware, then press ENTER to complete the entry. This setting determines the way in which the embosser instructs KeySoft to start and stop the flow of data so that it can keep up. Software handshaking is sometimes known as XON/XOFF handshaking. This is the end of the Embosser Setup List for the serial port option. To exit the list, press ESCAPE. You are asked to confirm any changes you have made and you are then returned to the "Emboss or SetUp?" prompt. If you have made any changes, you should use the test document to check the embosser setup. 6.9 Printing a Braille Document. When a Braille translation is involved during printing or embossing, you can decide whether to include page breaks you inserted in the original document into the new one. For example, if the Braille document contains 6 pages each marked by "New Page" markers, these same 6 pages can be printed on the ink printer. This feature may either be on a documentbydocument basis or can be set to apply to all newly created documents. To access this feature on a documentbydocument basis, open the document and go to the Format menu, Ink Print Settings, Translation Options, and move through the list to the "Suppress New Page Markers" item. Set the "Suppress new page markers" to "No" which means that new page markers in a Braille document will cause new pages in the print document. If you want this to be the default setting for all newly created documents, from the Main Menu go to the File Menu, Translate File, Back Translation Options. The "Suppress New Page Markers" option is the sixth item in this list. Set it to "No." if you want a onetoone correspondence between Braille pages marked with a new page marker and the translated print page. 6.10 Testing the Embosser. Once KeySoft has been set up for the embosser, it is strongly recommended that you carry out a test. This can be very instructive because embossers behave in various ways, and may have internal settings which are not obvious. Common problems are incorrect page length or width settings, which result in lines occasionally overflowing onto the next line, or pages with only one or two lines embossed on them. The only foolproof check is a real test. KeySoft is supplied with two test documents for this purpose, and we strongly recommend that you use them when the embosser is first connected, or if changes are made to its setup. To emboss the first test document, start from the Main Menu and press W for the Word processor, then E for Emboss a document, and E for Emboss. Select the General folder, and then the document called "Embosser Test A." Proceed to emboss this single page and examine the result. The first line consists of a repeated sequence of the letters A to J. The number of repeats in the top line, plus the last character, indicates how many cells can be embossed across the page. For example, if there are 3 full repeats, and the last letter is I, you know that 39 cells can be embossed across the width of the page. Sometimes an embosser cannot emboss the far lefthand side of the page, and misses the first one or two cells, so you should also check that the first character of the first line is the letter A. If not, note how many cells are missing and put this number in the Page Offset setting in the Embosser Setup list. Then repeat "Embosser Test A" to find the true embossed width of the page. Now emboss the second document, called "Embosser Test B." This consists of two pages, with a number at the beginning of each line. The lines are numbered sequentially. Check the number on the last line on the first page, which might be 24, for example. This is the number of lines that can be embossed on a page. Return to the Embosser Setup list and set the Paper Length and Paper Width to the values determined in the tests. This completes the Embosser setup. You should not need to change the settings in the Embosser Setup List, or carry out the embosser test again, unless a different type of embosser or paper is used. 6.11 The Printer SetUp List. This list contains similar items to the embosser setup list, with some differences. There is no doublesided option, and there is an additional item called "Printer Type," which determines how the font commands embedded in your text are translated for the printer. The "standard" option is programmed into KeySoft and this is suitable for most printers if you do not require any special fonts. If you require Bold and Italics to be printed you should choose a driver appropriate to your printer. If you want to change the Printer Type, press Y and ENTER, and KeySoft prompts: "Printer name? Press ENTER for (name)" Select a printer name in the same way as choosing a file name, by pressing SPACE repeatedly to review the list of files and selecting one by pressing ENTER. Printer Types for a range of popular printers are included in a folder on the KeySoft System Disk called "Printers." If your printer model is not in the list, it will probably print special fonts correctly if you select "HP DeskJet and LaserJet." 6.12 Testing the Printer. There are two printer test documents that may be used to check the printer setup, in a similar way to the embosser. You may require sighted assistance to check the results of this test. Print the first document, called "Printer Test A." Check the top line, which consists of the repeated sequence of the digits 1 through 9 and zero. Use the number of full repeats and the final digit to determine the number of printable columns across the width of the page. If a number of digits are missing at the start of the line, set the Page Offset to this number and run "Printer Test A" again to determine the printable page width. Print the second test document, called "Printer Test B," and count the number of lines that can be printed on a page. Return to the Printer Setup list, and set the Paper Length and Paper Width to the values determined in the tests. This completes the tests. You should not need to change the settings in the Printer Setup List, or carry out the printer test again, unless a different type of printer or paper is used. End of Embossing and Printing Documents Chapter. 7 Advanced Word Processing. This chapter describes some of the advanced features of KeyWord that allow you to create documents with more complex formats, and quickly make extensive changes to a document. It also discusses the embossing of text documents and handling documents of differing types, such as Braille or Microsoft Word. The content of this chapter is probably one of the more involved in the BrailleNote User Guide, but the elegance of KeyWord is such that often the default format settings more than adequately cover document formatting needs. It is suggested that you read the overview presented in the next section, and confine your initial reading of the remaining sections to areas of specific interest to you. As you become more familiar with KeyWord, revisit specific sections to maximize your understanding and use of the BrailleNote. 7.1 Overview. This chapter starts by defining the difference between "text" and "Braille" documents and how the VoiceNote mPower QT handles them. A text document is prepared for presentation in inkprint format. A Braille document is usually prepared for presentation in embossed or refreshable Braille form. We then look at how the format of a text document, that is an inkprint style document, is controlled. Here we consider Line layout, Page settings, and commands for centering, justifying, underlining, and changing font types. Next we consider the parameters associated with taking a text document, and performing the "onthefly" translation of this document to provide output to a Braille embosser. Following that is a section on Block commands, looking at the capability to quickly manipulate large blocks of text and generate form letters. Next are several sections on ways to make it easier to read a document's content, inserting dates, times and calculator results, binding spaces and pasting details from the Address list. Saving a document to the same or a different disk drive is covered next, along with abandoning the document without saving changes. The procedure to save documents as different document types is also discussed. KeyWord's ability to create and open text documents is looked at next, together with the "onthefly" translation of these documents for Braille embossing. Finally, there is saving and restoring default format settings for a document and Unicode character support for extended characters. 7.2 Document Types. By default, documents created by VoiceNote mPower QT are stored in "KeyWord Text" format, and are referred to as text documents. VoiceNote mPower QT can also create and open documents that have other file types. For example, Braille documents, Microsoft Word, Rich Text Format, ASCII, WordPerfect 5.1 for DOS, and KeySoft Version 2 Braille and text. For the purposes of this chapter, the term text document encompasses all file types except Braille documents. That is, KeyWord Text, Microsoft Word, Rich Text Format, ASCII, WordPerfect 5.1, and KeySoft Version 2 Text documents are all considered to be text documents. Text documents are often created to share information via the inkprint medium, or via a computer screen. As such, the page and line layout of a text document is often related to standard paper sizes handled by inkprint printers. Braille documents, on the other hand, are usually created with the intention of being embossed on Braille paper, or read on an electronic Braille display. One of KeyWord's unique features is the ability to open and create documents of different types. Documents created on the VoiceNote mPower QT are predominantly KeyWord Text documents. These documents can be 'seamlessly' shared with other products in the BrailleNote family, printed on an ink print printer, or output to a Braille embosser. Embossing a KeyWord Text document is as simple as choosing the embosser option rather than the ink printer option. KeyWord can save documents to any of the file types listed earlier. These documents can be reviewed and edited using standard commands. Because KeyWord can open these differing document types, you can directly open a Microsoft Word document, for example, review and edit its contents, and make a print or Braille copy of the document or parts thereof. Braille documents can be opened or created, and reviewed and edited from the VoiceNote mPower QT's computer style keyboard. Eight keys on the home row of the keyboard are used for Braille input, so a Grade 2 or Grade 1 Braille document can be supported. Embossing or printing a Braille document is as simple as choosing either the embosser or printer option from the KeyWord Menu. 7.2.1 Instant Translation. KeyWord, like KeyBook, can translate text into your preferred reading grade instantly, as you read. For example, if your preferred reading grade is grade 2 Braille, KeyWord automatically translates the book into grade 2 as you read. The underlying text is still in its original form, however, and you can examine it in computer Braille, at any time, should you wish. You can choose the Braille grade for viewing text files from the Braille Display options off the Options Menu while in a text file. The factory default is set to “Preferred Reading Grade,” which in turn is set to grade 2. For more information, refer to 7.4.2.4 Braille Grade. 7.3 Formatting a Text Document. The format of a text document, that is an inkprint style document, is determined by the settings in the Layout List, the Page Settings List, and by individual commands for centering, justifying, underlining, and changing font types. The settings associated with taking a text document, and performing the "onthefly" translation of this document to provide output to a Braille embosser, are determined by the items in the Presentation Style List, and the Braille Settings Menu. The preparation of "Template documents" for use with the address list and text files is controlled from the Template Menu. In the following discussion a paragraph is defined as a group of words that end with a new line indicator. 7.3.1 Layout List. The Layout List allows you to review and change options that control the layout or formatting of the text document, such as tabs, indents, page numbering, etc. Pressing CONTROL with L accesses the Layout List for a text document. It is described in 7.3.10 Layout of a Text Document. 7.3.2 Page Settings List. The Page Settings List allows you to review or change the page layout of the text document. Pressing CONTROL with P accesses the Page Settings List for a text document. It is described in 7.3.12 Page Settings for a Text Document. 7.3.3 Center a line. This command centers a line or paragraph. The Center line command is CONTROL with E. It is described in 7.3.13 Center a Line. 7.3.4 Right justify a line. This command aligns a line or paragraph so that each line ends at the right margin. The Right justify line command is CONTROL with R. It is described in 7.3.14 Right Justify a Line. 7.3.5 Underlining. This command underlines text. The Underlining command is CONTROL with U. It is described in 7.3.15 Underlining. 7.3.6 Style of presentation. Styles of presentation are used when a text document is translated and reformatted into a Braille document, for example, before being embossed. They allow you to control the way paragraphs; headings, etc. are formatted in the Braille document independently of the text document's formatting. Pressing CONTROL with Y accesses the Presentation Style List for a text document. The styles are described in 7.4.1 Style of Presentation linked with a Text Document. 7.3.7 Font. This command selects fonts used for text. The Font command is CONTROL with T. It is described in 7.3.16 Font. 7.3.8 Braille Settings. This item allows you to review and change options that affect the way a text document is translated or reformatted as a Braille document. Pressing READ with CONTROL with B accesses the Braille Settings Menu for a text document. It is described in 7.4.2 Braille Settings linked with a Text Document. 7.3.9 Template Menu. This item contains options that are used when preparing a Template Document for use with the Address List. Pressing CONTROL with A accesses the Template Menu for a text document. This is described in 10.9.2 Creating a Template. 7.3.10 Layout of a Text Document. The Layout option presents a list of settings that determine the layout of a text document, such as the left and right margins. You can change a layout setting at any point in a document. The setting takes effect from the last new line indicator and a new layout indicator appears immediately after the new line indicator to indicate that one or more layout settings have changed at that point. Remember that this indicator is never printed; it is there to indicate that the layout changes at this point. It is the effect of the layout change that will be seen when you print the document, not the indicator itself. The New Layout affects only settings that you actually change. Settings that you do not change continue as they were in the previous paragraph. A change to a setting applies from that point until the end of the document, or until the same setting is changed again. Whether or not a setting has been changed in the current paragraph is indicated by the word "changed" or "unchanged" in the prompt for each setting. For example, if you change the Left Margin, it is announced in the form: "Left Margin 12. (changed)" The word "changed" indicates that settings earlier in the document do not affect the left margin of this or subsequent paragraphs. For example, a document has a suggested left margin of 10, and it contains 3 paragraphs. Assume that you change the left margin of the second paragraph to 15, so it is announced as "changed." The left margins for paragraph 1 is 10, and the left margin for paragraphs 2 and 3 is 15. If you now set the left margin of the first paragraph to 12, the left margins are 12, 15, and 15 for paragraphs 1, 2 and 3 respectively. Notice that the margins of the second and third paragraphs have remained at 15. Now if you need to change the right margin for the whole document, move to the top of the document and use the Layout List to make the change. The new right margin applies to the whole document. New Layout does not affect it in the second paragraph because only the Left Margin was changed at that point. To check or change Layout settings, position the cursor anywhere in the paragraph where you require the change and enter the Layout list by pressing CONTROL with L. KeySoft will announce: "Layout List." You can review the settings by pressing SPACE. Make changes by typing a new value when the current one is announced, followed by ENTER. If a setting has been changed in this paragraph, you can clear it so that the setting in the preceding paragraph continues to take effect. To do this, use the Clear Field command, CONTROL with BACKSPACE. The Layout List for a text document consists of the following items: Indent first line; Indent rest of paragraph; Tab stops; Line Spacing; Print page numbers; Justification; Left margin; Right margin; Word wrap. The items in the Layout List are now discussed. 7.3.10.1 Indent First Line and Indent Rest of Paragraph. These settings allow a number of indenting styles to be set up. For example, the first line of each paragraph could start with two spaces, or the whole paragraph could be indented, or a hanging indent could be used where the first line of a paragraph starts at the left margin but subsequent lines are indented. Indent First Line causes just the first line of each paragraph to be indented from the left margin by a chosen number of spaces. Indent Rest of Paragraph causes all lines in a paragraph, except the first, to be indented by a chosen number of spaces. A whole paragraph can be indented by setting Indent First Line and Indent Rest of Paragraph to the same number of spaces. Remember that if these settings are changed, the changes apply for the remainder of the document or until the settings are changed again. To change a setting, type the required number of spaces and press ENTER. The factory settings are zero for both Indent First Line and Indent Rest of Paragraph. The settings for Indent First Line and Indent Rest of Paragraph are entirely independent of the Tab Settings that can also be used to indent a paragraph. 7.3.10.2 Tabs. Tabs provide a way of moving the cursor to predetermined positions on the line, and are used primarily to align columns of text. There are 10 tab stops, numbered 1 to 10. The first is measured in columns from the left margin, and then each subsequent stop is measured from the previous one. Each tab stop has an initial setting of 5 columns, so the actual positions are 6, 11, 16, etc. Suppose you are editing and the cursor is at column 8. Press TAB to insert a Tab indicator, and the cursor will move to the next Tab stop, which is column 11. If you then start typing, the text starts at column 11. If you do the same on subsequent lines, a column of text is formed, starting at column 11. To review the Tab stop settings, enter the Layout List by pressing CONTROL with L. Press SPACE or NEXT repeatedly until "Tab stops" is announced, and press ENTER. You can then review the tab settings by, once again, pressing SPACE repeatedly. To determine which column number a particular Tab falls on, you can press READ with Q, while reviewing the Tab list. When setting up tabs, first determine the number of columns you need and the maximum width each column must be. Now set Tab 1 to the width of the first column, Tab 2 to the width of the second column, and so on. If you later need to adjust the width of a particular column, simply change the setting for that particular tab stop. The width of all other columns remains the same, but if you increase a tab setting, check that you have not pushed a highnumbered tab stop off the page. To change a Tab stop, move to the tab stop number that you want, as if you were reviewing the setting, then type the required value and press ENTER. Make any other changes you require and then press ESCAPE. Indenting Tabs. Any Tab stop can be defined as an "Indenting Tab.” Indenting Tabs allow you to inset either a whole paragraph, or all but the first line of a paragraph. They are most often used when creating numbered lists and outlines, where the first line of each paragraph starts with a number followed by a tab and the rest of the paragraph is indented underneath that tab. The indent created by an Indenting Tab applies only to the paragraph containing the Tab. Forcing a new line by pressing ENTER releases the indent and the text continues back at the left margin. This is the main difference between Indenting Tabs and indents created using the First Line and Rest of Paragraph Indent settings described in 7.3.10.1 Indent First Line and Indent Rest of Paragraph above. To set any particular Tab stop to be an Indenting Tab, type the letter i before the value. For instance, typing: i5, after the value of Tab 1 is spoken, makes Tab 1 an indent 5 cells in from the left margin. With an indent set in this way, you can inset a paragraph by 5 cells by pressing TAB once at the start of the paragraph and the entire paragraph is indented 5 cells. The factory setting for each Tab Stop is Indent 5. 7.3.10.3 Line spacing. This allows single or double line spacing to be selected. To change the setting, press S for single, or D for Double. 7.3.10.4 Print Page Numbers. You can choose to have pages automatically numbered or not as you wish. Press Y or N as required. If you do not want a number on the first page of a document, turn off the page numbering at the start of the first page, and then turn it on at the start of the second page. 7.3.10.5 Justification. This style is used in most printed newspapers and magazines, and spreads the words out so the last character of each line is at the right margin. It gives the text a tidy appearance, with both sides of the text being straight, but spacing between some words is increased. It is a matter of preference which way you set this option. The initial setting is off. To change the setting, press N for "ON" or F for "OFF.” 7.3.10.6 Left Margin. This is the position of the left edge of the printed text, counted in columns or characters from the extreme left printing position. A left margin of 0 means that printing starts as far left as the printer can go, providing there is no additional page offset. The factory default for the left margin setting is 10. 7.3.10.7 Right Margin. This is the position of the right edge of the text, counting back from the last column position on a line. The default setting is 10. 7.3.10.8 Word Wrap. This is the process by which text automatically continues on the next line when there is not enough space for another word on the current line. The initial setting of Word Wrap for a new document is "ON" and, unless you plan to write computer programs using KeyWord, you will probably always leave it switched on. Computer programmers may want to switch it off and use a very large Paper Width setting to avoid carriage returns being inserted automatically in their program lines. If word wrap is switched off, a beep sounds 10 columns before the right margin is reached, and you must decide where to start a new line by pressing ENTER. To change the word wrap setting, press N to switch it "ON" or F to switch it "OFF.” This is the last item in the Layout list. Methods of reverting to initial settings and changing initial values used for new documents are discussed in 7.17.12 Initial Format Settings in a Document. 7.3.11 Layout Indicator. When you change one or more layout settings, a New Layout indicator appears at the start of the paragraph to indicate that the layout has changed at that point. The new layout indicator was introduced in. Remember that a paragraph is a group of words that ends with a new line indicator. You can locate Layout markers with the Find command, READ with F, using the search string CONTROL with L. A Layout indicator can be deleted like any other character. This has the effect of canceling all changes made by the new layout, leaving all layout settings the same as they were in the previous paragraph. 7.3.12 Page Settings for a Text Document. This group of settings applies to the entire current document. The Page Settings List contains 5 items, as follows: First page number; Paper length; Paper width; Top margin; Bottom margin. You can change the Page Settings at any point in the document, and the change applies to that whole document. Enter the Page Settings list by pressing CONTROL with P. KeySoft announces: "Page Settings list.” This is a list of the current settings for that document. You can review the values by pressing SPACE repeatedly. Make changes by typing a new value when the current one is announced, followed by ENTER. To return to the document, press ESCAPE. If you have made changes, KeySoft asks: "Confirm changes?" Press Y to confirm the new settings, or N to abandon the changes. You are then returned to the document. The Page Settings List for a text document consists of the following 5 items: 7.3.12.1 First Page Number. This is the number that appears on the first page of the document, if you choose to have your pages numbered. When you create a new document this is set to 1, but if your document was just one chapter of a larger document, you might want to start numbering at a higher number. Suppose you had typed a large report as two separate documents. The first document might contain pages 1 to 12, and the second, pages 13 onward. The first document would be printed with a "First Page Number" of 1, the second with 13. 7.3.12.2 Paper Length and Width. These settings define the length and width of the paper that is used when this document is printed. Usually you will use your standard printer paper when printing a document and you will have already set the Page Length and Page Width settings in the Printer Setup list to the correct values for this paper, as discussed in Section 6.7. In this case, leave the Paper Length and Width settings in the Page Settings List set to the standard printer settings. If you later change the size of the paper you are using in your printer, you only have to change the settings in the Printer Setup List. However, if you always want to use a special Paper Length or Page Width for a particular document, then change the settings for that document here accordingly. If the Paper Length is set to the standard printer settings when you review the Page Settings list, the following prompt is announced: "Paper length? Currently using the standard printer setting of x.” This indicates that the setting is the same as the value in the Printer Setup list. If you change the setting here in the Page Settings List, the prompt is: "Paper length? Currently l.” where l is the paper length in lines. In this case the printer setting is being overridden for this document. To reset the paper length or width to match the value in the Printer Setup list, use the Clear Field command, CONTROL with BACKSPACE. 7.3.12.3 Top and Bottom Margins. These are the numbers of blank lines left at the top and bottom of the page when printing. The initial values for a new document are both set to 6. These are the last items in the Page Settings list. The method of changing the initial values is discussed in 7.17.12 Initial Format Settings in a Document. 7.3.13 Center a Line. You can position a line of text midway between the left and right margins. To do this, place the cursor anywhere on the line, and press CONTROL with E. KeySoft will announce: "Center line" The line of text is centered horizontally. To maintain the centering effect with long lines, text in excess of 90% of the usable page width overflows onto the next line. Centering applies to the whole of a paragraph. 7.3.14 Right Justify a Line. A line of text can be right justified so that the last character is positioned on the right margin. To do this, place the cursor anywhere on the line, and press CONTROL with R. KeySoft will announce: "Right justify line.” Right justification applies to the whole of a paragraph. A line cannot be both centered and right justified; it can only be one or the other. 7.3.15 Underlining. Underlining can be switched on or off at any point in the text. When switched on, it continues until an "Underline Off" command is encountered. To check or change the underline status at any point, press CONTROL with U. KeySoft prompts: "Underline is off." Press ENTER to leave it off, N to turn it on, or F to turn it off. You can underline as you type, by turning it on, typing the word or passage, and then turning it off. Alternatively, you can place the cursor at appropriate points in existing text and turn underlining on or off. To remove underlining, use the Search command with the search string CONTROL with U, N followed by ENTER to position the cursor at the Underline On indicator. Press CONTROL with COMMA to delete the indicator. Repeat the action using the search string CONTROL with U, F to remove the Underline Off indicator. If underlining is on, KeySoft announces: "Underline on." each time you press ENTER to start a new line, to avoid large sections of text being underlined unintentionally. 7.3.16 Font. Most printers can produce special fonts, such as italics, bold, elongated, compressed, and subscripts, to enhance the appearance of a printed document. KeySoft allows fonts to be changed within a text document. A single letter is used to select each font. For instance, I signifies italics, B for bold, E for elongated. The full listing of fonts for any printer is contained in a document for the selected printer, which can be found in the "Printers" folder, located on the KeySoft System disk. Before using the Font commands you should select the driver appropriate to your printer from the Printer Setup in the KeyWord menu. If the driver is not installed, you will not hear the font type. For example "Font B" would be spoken, rather than "Bold.” To check or change the font at any point, press CONTROL with T. KeySoft prompts: "Font?." Press a letter to select the required font. KeySoft prompts: "Font (p). Currently off." where (p) is the letter designating the chosen font. KeySoft describes the font, if it is implemented by the current printer type, as described in 6.11 The Printer SetUp List. To turn the font on, press N. To turn it off, press F. To leave the font unchanged, press ENTER. More than one font can apply to a passage of text. Font commands are displayed in the text when the cursor passes over them, and can be deleted like any other character. 7.4 Formatting a Text Document for Embossing. When you compose a text document, you normally follow print layout conventions. However, when you come to emboss a text document, or translate it to a Braille document as described in Chapter 14, you generally want to use different layout conventions for the embossed text. For example, new paragraphs can be indicated differently, attributes such as bold can't be used, and even the text itself can be different in places. You could translate the text document into a Braille document, and then use KeyWord to format the Braille document according to Braille conventions, before embossing it. That task would soon become tedious, especially if you then modify the text document and have to repeat the entire process. You would also have a text and a Braille version of the same document, and these could easily get out of step if you make modifications. KeySoft therefore allows you to control the embossed layout from within the text document, so that it can be embossed directly and is formatted in Braille completely independently of its text formatting. Two items: "Style of Presentation.” and "Braille Translation Options" control these embossing options. 7.4.1 Style of Presentation linked with a Text Document. KeySoft allows you to indicate various embossing styles. These do not affect the layout of the text document, but when you emboss it, or translate it to a Braille document, KeySoft uses the indicated styles to translate the layout from the text convention to a Braille convention. For example, in text you might have subheadings in bold print with a blank line before and after it. In Braille, however, you might want a subheading on a new line and indented 4 spaces. There are 6 styles of presentation that cover the presentation styles found in most documents. These are as follows: Paragraph; Heading; Subheading; Outline; Lines; Identical to source. To check or change a style, locate the cursor anywhere in the paragraph and press CONTROL with Y. KeySoft displays the style of the current section of text. If you wish to leave the Style unchanged, press ENTER. Alternatively, you can review the available Styles by pressing SPACE repeatedly and choose a new Style by pressing ENTER, or press the initial letter of your choice. Settings apply from the start of the current paragraph following a New Line indicator, and a change is indicated by a "Style" indicator. Use the styles by marking the beginning of each part of your document according to its style, whether it is a heading, subheading, paragraphs of text, an outline or numbered list, or just single lines of information, such as the address at the top of a letter. When you then emboss or translate the document, the styles are used to reformat each part appropriately. While the names represent typical uses, the format produced by each style can be altered to suit your taste or purpose. This is described in 14.19.9 Reviewing and Setting Back Translation Options and 14.19.10 Reviewing and Setting Forward Translation Options. Setting styles is best done when you are typing the document but the style indicators can be added later. Get into the habit of doing it and you will have perfectly formatted embossed documents. The Styles are now described. 7.4.1.1 Paragraph. A blank line is placed above and below a heading. Each new print line starts a new Braille line. A blank line in a heading causes a blank line in Braille. Two or more blank lines in a heading cause the style to revert to "Paragraph.” A heading is centered in Braille. A print line can produce more than one Braille line, so a centered heading could fill the page width. This would destroy the centering effect, so lines longer than 90% of the page width overflow onto the next line. The heading style continues until another style indicator changes it, or two or more blank lines are encountered. In the latter case the style reverts to "Paragraph.” Once again, this is the suggested formatting convention for headings. It can be changed by altering the Forward Translation Options as described in 14.19.10 Reviewing and Setting Forward Translation Options. 7.4.1.2 Subheading. This style starts in Braille with a new line and an indent of 4 spaces. A subheading may contain more than one line, but a single blank line terminates the style and reverts to "Paragraph" style. 7.4.1.3 Outline. This style is used for simple numbered lists or more complex outlines and produces a first line that starts at the left margin. Blank lines in the text are suppressed in Braille and two or more blank lines cause the style to revert to "Paragraph.” 7.4.1.4 Lines. This style is for a series of separate lines all starting at the left margin. Any overflow onto the following line is indented by 2 spaces. The "Lines" style might be used to format the address at the top of a letter, for example. Another style indicator, or two or more blank lines causes the style to revert to "Paragraph.” 7.4.1.5 Identical to Source. Use this style to preserve the layout of a section in a text document when it is embossed or translated to a Braille document. This style continues in effect until another style is set. 7.4.2 Braille Settings linked with a Text Document. These settings can be used when you are editing a text document to control the format of the document when it is Brailed, or translated to a Braille document. To access the Braille Settings menu when you are editing a text document, press READ with CONTROL with B. You can review the list and select an item in the same way as all KeySoft menus. The Braille Settings menu contains the following 8 items: Layout; Inclusion; Start Braille exclusion; End Braille exclusion; Braille Grade; Page settings; Translation options; Control Translation; These items are discussed now. 7.4.2.1 Braille Layout. The settings for a text document, such as left and right margin, are accessed by selecting the Layout List, with CONTROL with L. In contrast, when you are preparing a text document for embossing or translation, you may need to check or change the settings that are used for embossing. These can be accessed from the Braille Settings menu by selecting Layout. The Braille Layout list contains a similar group of settings to the text list, including indents, left and right margins, tabs, page number enabling, line spacing and word wrap, but the values are for embossing. The initial values for new documents are Left and Right Margins 0 cells, and Tab Stops of 3. Values that you set in the Braille Layout are used when your text document is embossed on a Braille printer, or translated to a Braille document. They do not affect the layout of the text document. 7.4.2.2 Braille only Inclusion. You may want to include text or formatting commands in the embossed version that are not required in the text version. For example, you could add an explanatory note, italicize a word, or force a new page. To do this, select the "Inclusion" option in the Braille Settings Menu. KeySoft prompts: "Brailleonly inclusion?" In response to this prompt, type the text that you want to appear in the Braille version and press ENTER. You can also include the following formatting commands: New line: press CONTROL with ENTER; New page: press CONTROL with N; Tab: press TAB; Center line: press CONTROL with E; Right justify line: press CONTROL with R. You can review the document for inclusion markers, and delete them like any other character. To review or edit the text of an inclusion, position the cursor on the inclusion marker and select the Inclusion option again. 7.4.2.3 Braille Exclusion. Conversely, there may be text or formatting commands in the text document that you may want to exclude from the Braille version. This is done by marking the start and end of the text or formatting commands you want excluded, as follows: With the cursor at the required point, select "Start Braille exclusion" from the Braille Settings menu. KeyWord marks the position with a special "Start Braille exclusion" indicator . Now type the text or formatting commands that you do not want to appear in the Braille version, and select "End Braille exclusion" from the Braille Settings menu. KeyWord marks the position with a special "End Braille exclusion" indicator . Note that you can also add these markers to existing text, if you wish. 7.4.2.4 Braille Grade. When a text document is embossed or translated into a Braille document, your Preferred Reading Grade setting is used. This setting is in the Braille Display Options item on the Options Menu. However, you may need to override this grade for a particular passage, for example, if your document contains an email address, you want computer Braille used for the email address when the document is translated into Braille. To have a word or passage appear in a different grade, select the Braille Grade option, select the required grade, type the relevant passage, and then repeat the procedure to restore the grade. This option can also be used to change the grade into which a passage of existing text is translated. For Grade one, press 1. For Grade two, press 2. For computer Braille, press C. For your preferred reading grade, press P. To leave the option unchanged, just press ENTER. 7.4.2.5 Braille Page Settings. This group of settings applies to the entire current text document if it is embossed, and consists of the same 5 items as the Page Settings for a Text document, namely: First page number; Paper length; Paper width; Top margin; Bottom margin. The suggested values for Paper Length and Width follow the values in the Embosser Setup List, and a prompt indicates if a setting is changed. The Braille Page Settings indicator is positioned at the top of the document. 7.4.2.6 Translation Options. This group of 11 settings affects the way in which a particular presentation style in a text document appears in the corresponding translated or embossed version. They are collectively referred to as the “Braille Translation Options List.” Settings apply from the start of the current paragraph, and can be changed at chosen points throughout the document. The initial values are covered in 14.19.10 Reviewing and Setting Forward Translation Options, as well as other translation settings that are not available while editing. To access the Braille translation options in a text document, press READ with CONTROL with B, then T for Translation options. KeySoft announces: "Braille translation options list.” The settings are as follows: What type of paragraph boundary is used in the source document? Interpret larger boundaries as paragraphs also? New Line translation option? Convert italics font to Braille italics? Suppress multiple spaces? Suppress New Page markers? Ignore Tabs? Include capital signs? Suppress blank lines in Outline style? Revert to paragraph style after how many blank lines? Translation find and replace. The last item allows you to replace a particular formatting sequence with another, as part of the translation process. For example, the text document might use two New Line markers to separate paragraphs, and these could be replaced by 3 spaces in Braille. To achieve this last scenario you would first move onto the “Translation find and replace” option. At the “Find?” prompt, press CONTROL with ENTER twice to look for 2 New Line Markers, followed by ENTER to end the find sequence. You will then be prompted for the “Replacement for 2 new lines?” at which point you can press CONTROL with SPACE 3 times, followed by ENTER. 7.4.2.7 Control Translation. This option provides control over how fractions, Roman numerals, dates, and math appearing in the text document are treated in the corresponding translated or embossed version. To access the Control Translation options in a text document, press READ with CONTROL with B, then C for Control Translation options. KeySoft announces: "Translator Control option.” To step through the available options press CONTROL with SPACE, and press ENTER to select an option. The available options are: Fractions On/Off; Roman Numerals On/Off; Date On/Off; Math On/Off. 7.5 Block Commands. The ability to manipulate blocks of text is an invaluable editing aid because it lets you mark a passage and delete it, move it, or copy it. This saves typing time and avoids the introduction of new typing errors. Blocks can be moved from one location to another within a document, copied repeatedly throughout a document, or transferred from one document to another. A block can be copied from one KeySoft task to another. For example, you can copy text between the Word Processor, Planner, Email, Address List, Database Manager, and Games. A "block" of text means any continuous section of text. A block can be any size from a single character, a few words, a sentence, a couple of paragraphs, all the way up to an entire document. You define a block of text by marking one end and then moving the cursor to the other end of the block. If you want to keep the block marked for future reference you can insert markers at each end of the block. You can then move or copy the marked block in a threestep procedure: 1. Move or copy the block to the clipboard; 2. Move to where you want to insert the block; 3. Paste the clipboard to the required place in the text. The clipboard is simply a temporary storage place for the block of text. It is provided automatically when you use a command that requires the clipboard. The word "paste" comes from the old practice of cutting out a section of printed text from its page and pasting it back in a different place. 7.5.1 Block Commands Menu. This menu provides all the commands needed to mark a block and manipulate it. These Block Commands are accessed through the Block Commands Menu, which you can enter by pressing CONTROL with B. There are 13 items in the menu, in order as follows: Append block to clipboard; Copy block to clipboard; Delete block; Insert file; Move block to clipboard; Paste clipboard; Read block; Store block; Top marker insertion; Bottom marker insertion; Erase file and exit Keyword; Zap, erase the block markers; Grade. Correct Braille grade of block. Items on the menu can be selected in either of the usual ways. 7.5.2 Marking a Block. Before performing any block operation, you must define the block. Marking the top and bottom of the text you wish to manipulate does this, or alternatively you can mark one end of the block of text and move the cursor to the other. Follow these steps to mark a block: 1. Move the cursor onto the first character you want included in the block. 2. Enter the Block Commands Menu by pressing CONTROL with B. 3. Select the "Top marker insertion" option. You are returned to the document and a marker appears in the document to indicate the top of the block. 4. Now move the cursor just past the last character you want included in the block. You are now ready to enter the Block Commands Menu and move, copy, or delete the block of text. Alternatively, you can enter a bottom block marker, so that the chosen block remains defined. 7.5.3 Marking a Block cont. Another way of marking a block is with a Quick Mark command. These commands automatically mark a character, word, sentence, line, paragraph or section. Just position the cursor, select the Block Menu and use the following commands: Mark character under cursor, press READ with COMMA; Mark word under cursor, press READ with K; Mark sentence under cursor, press READ with I; Mark paragraph under cursor, press READ with 8. The selection of sentences and paragraphs can be changed to lines and sections by the Reading Mode, as described in 7.6 Cursor Movement Modes. Although it is called "Top of Block" it does not matter which way around you mark a block of text. Only one block can be marked within a document at a time. To move the block marker, just mark a different position. You can check the position of the block marker by reviewing the text with commands such as reading forward a word using READ with L. You can perform other editing functions without affecting the block marker. It is even saved with a document. 7.5.4 Read Block. You can have KeySoft speak a block of text to check that you have marked it correctly. To read a block, press CONTROL with B, for the Block Menu, then R, for "Read.” KeySoft says, "Block read,” speaks the text in the block and returns you to the Block Menu. Like the other reading commands, you can press READ with SPACE at any time to stop the cursor at that point, or press ESCAPE to abandon the reading and move the cursor to its final position. 7.5.5 Copy Block to Clipboard. This command allows you to copy a block of text to the clipboard. To do this, first mark the block of text you wish to copy. Then enter the Block Commands Menu, select the "Copy block to clipboard" option and the marked block of text is copied into the clipboard replacing any text already in there. The original text and the cursor position remain unchanged. Block commands can take a few seconds if a large block of text is involved. 7.5.6 Append Block to Clipboard. This command is similar to "Copy Block to Clipboard.” The difference is that the marked block of text is added to, or appended to, the current contents of the clipboard instead of replacing it. This allows you to build up a phrase or a list of items in the clipboard. To append a block to the clipboard, first mark a block of text. Then enter the Block Commands Menu, select "Append block to clipboard,” and the marked block of text is copied into the clipboard and placed after any existing contents. The original text, including the block markers and the position of the cursor remains unchanged. 7.5.7 Move Block to Clipboard. This command allows you to remove or cut a block of text from its place in the document, and put it into the clipboard. To do this, first mark the block you wish to move. Then, enter the Block Commands Menu, select "Move block to clipboard" and the marked block of text is removed from the document and placed in the clipboard replacing any text already there. 7.5.8 Paste Clipboard. This command allows you to copy the contents of the clipboard into a document. Before using the "Paste" command, you should have copied or moved the required block of text into the clipboard. To paste the clipboard, position the cursor at the exact spot that the first character of the text in the clipboard should appear. This can be in the original document, or you can exit the original document and select another. Enter the Block Commands Menu, select "Paste block,” and the text in the clipboard is inserted at the cursor position. The cursor is on the first character of the pasted block, and the word under the cursor is spoken. There is no block marker in the pasted text. The original text and the cursor position remain unchanged by the pasting operation. This allows you to paste the same block of text to various places without needing to copy or move the block to the clipboard again. The contents of the clipboard are preserved while you carry out any other functions with the VoiceNote mPower QT. For example, you can copy a passage to the clipboard, select the Planner, then return to the Word Processor and the clipboard contents are unchanged. If necessary, the contents of the clipboard are translated to suit the type of document it is being pasted into. This means that you can directly paste a section of a text document into a Braille document, for example, and the text is translated into Braille of the grade in use at the insertion point. 7.5.9 Delete Block. This function completely removes a marked block from your document. It is useful for deleting large amounts of text. To delete a block, first mark the block of text you wish to delete. Then enter the Block Commands Menu and select "Delete block.” KeySoft prompts: "Delete block. Sure?” To confirm the deletion, press Y, or, if you decide not to delete the block, press N. 7.5.10 Changes to Text Format. When you paste a passage into an existing document, make sure that any spaces at the beginning or end are correct. The most common problems are too few spaces at the beginning, or too many at the end. The marked block can contain formatting indicators like New Page indicators, and these are copied or moved and pasted with the block. The exceptions are indicators such as Line Break and Page Break, which are only relevant to the original document. After doing a Block Move, Copy, Delete, or File Insert, you should check the document layout to ensure that it has not been upset by the block manipulation. 7.5.11 Store Block. This command allows you to store a block of text in another file, instead of in the clipboard. The other file may already exist, or you can create it as part of the Store Block process. To store a block, first mark the block of text you wish to store. Then press CONTROL with B for the Block menu, followed by S, for "Store.” KeySoft prompts for the drive, folder and name of the file to store the block in. Select these in the usual way. If you are storing the block in an existing file, you are offered the options of appending the block to the bottom of the file, or replacing the complete file. You can store a block of text directly to a file of another type if you wish. This might be a text document when you are editing a Braille one, or it could be a Microsoft Word document, for example. To create a file of another type press CONTROL with X repeatedly at the file name prompt until the type of file you are looking for is displayed. To select an existing file, type its name or use the list of files to find it. In the list of files you can change the type of the file displayed by pressing CONTROL with X repeatedly. To change between Braille and computer Braille entry at the file name prompt, press CONTROL with X repeatedly. Braille is suitable for entry of KeyWord document names and computer Braille is suitable for entering the name of any file. If you need information about the selection of a directory or file name, you can find this in 14.16 Creating Renaming and Erasing SubDirectories. When storing to an ASCII file, KeySoft uses the options in the ASCII Translation Set Up List, as described in 14.19.8 Reviewing and Setting ASCII Translation Options. The process of storing a block does not remove that block from the current document. 7.5.12 Insert File. The Insert File command allows you to insert the complete contents of another document into your existing document at the current cursor position. This feature is useful if you wish to send the same letter to a number of different people, as described in the next section. To insert a file, position the cursor at the point where you want the first character of the inserted file to appear, select the Block Menu, and then press I, for "Insert.” KeySoft prompts for the drive, folder and name of the file to insert. Select these in the usual way. As well as inserting KeyWord documents you can insert a file of any type supported by KeySoft, for example, a Microsoft Word document. If you need information about the selection of a directory or file name, you can find this in 14.16 Creating Renaming and Erasing SubDirectories. When inserting an ASCII file, KeySoft uses the options setup in the ASCII Translation Set Up List, as described in 14.19.8 Reviewing and Setting ASCII Translation Options. After the file insert, the cursor is positioned immediately after the inserted text. That is, the file is inserted as though it had just been typed. 7.5.13 Merging Documents. The Insert File feature is useful for merging a form letter into a number of letters, each addressed to a different person or company. In fact, this feature makes the preparation of any document that contains some standardized text and layout much easier. Follow these steps to generate personalized memos: 1. Prepare a document containing the text that is common to all recipients; 2. Open another document for the first memo. Type the first person's name and any personal text; 3. Now insert the common text in the memo by positioning the cursor at the appropriate point and pressing CONTROL with B, then I. Follow the procedure outlined in the previous section to select the document containing the common text. Then save this memo, and open another document for the next memo. 7.5.14 Erase File. This option provides a convenient method of completely removing a file and its contents. If you are unsure as to whether you wish to delete a particular file you can open the file, and after determining it is no longer needed, delete it using the Erase File option on the Block menu. This saves you from having to exit the file and delete it using the File Manager. KeySoft will request confirmation before removing the file. 7.5.15 Zap Block Markers. If required, the Block Markers can be removed after a block function has been completed. To erase, or "zap,” the block markers, enter the Block menu by pressing CONTROL with B, and select the "Zap" option. The cursor position remains unaltered. 7.6 Cursor Movement Modes. KeySoft has a range of specific moving commands designed to make moving around a document quick and accurate. These were listed in 3.8.1 Listening to a Document. When you are reading text organized in sentences and paragraphs, then commands to move the cursor by sentence or paragraph are very useful. For example: READ with O moves the cursor to the beginning of the next sentence; READ with 9 moves the cursor to the beginning of the next paragraph. However when working with poetry or lists, it would be more convenient to move by a line at a time than by sentence. To allow the most efficient cursor movement for the text you are working with, KeySoft provides 3 cursor movement modes; sentence and paragraph, line and sentence, and column. When you change the cursor movement mode, the moving commands themselves don't change, just the way in which they direct the cursor to move around the text. To change the cursor movement mode while in a document, press READ with S repeatedly, until you get to the one you want. These affect the operation of the READ with U, READ with O, READ with 7 and READ with 9 reading commands. They also affect what is spoken by these commands and by the CONTROL with 8 and CONTROL with I commands. The default cursor movement mode is Sentence and Paragraph. When in Line and Sentence Mode: READ with O reads the next line; READ with 7 reads the next section. Likewise, READ with U reads the previous line and READ with 7 reads the previous section. In Line Mode, the word "section" has a specific meaning. The Current Section starts at the last blank line before the cursor, and continues until the first blank line after the cursor. Similarly, the Next Section starts at the first blank line after the cursor, and continues until the following blank line. Line Mode is useful when you are concerned with the layout of the document. Among other purposes, it's a good way of checking for blank lines. The third Reading Mode is called Column Mode, and acts as follows: READ with O moves the cursor down a line but keeping it in the same column. It reads the current word on this line; READ with 9, reads the next section. Column Mode is effective for reviewing text that is laid out in a table. It allows you to move up or down a column in a table, reading entries one at a time. Although we have only given two examples, the current cursor movement mode affects all reading commands that relate to sentences and paragraphs. This is also true for deletion commands. For instance, in Sentence and Paragraph mode, CONTROL with I deletes to the end of the sentence, but in Line Mode it deletes to the end of the line. The cursor movement mode also affects the Quick Mark commands in the Block Menu. 7.7 Moving to the Start of the Next Line. It is possible to move the cursor to the first position on the next line without inserting a New Line in the document. To do this, press: READ with ENTER. KeySoft will move the cursor to the next Tab position and announce the word under the cursor. If speech is on KeySoft says "New Line,” or "Line Break,” followed by the first word on the next line. 7.8 Moving to the Next Tab. It is possible to move the cursor to the next tab position without inserting a tab into the document. To do this, press: READ with APOSTROPHE. Note that this command jumps to the next tab position, regardless of whether there is actually a tab indicator in the text. 7.9 Inserting the Time Date or Calculator Result. You can insert the time, date or calculator result directly into a document instead of typing them. With the cursor in the appropriate place in your current document, press FUNCTION with I. In the Insert Menu select Date, Time, or Calculator result as required. If you select the date, KeySoft prompts: "Insert today's date or printing date?." If you press T, KeySoft inserts today's date. If you press P, KeySoft puts in a special "Insert date" indicator , and the current date is substituted whenever the document is embossed or printed, or when it is used as a template file. If you choose to insert from the Calculator, KeyPlus prompts: "Insert result or whole calculation?." Press R to insert the Result or C to insert the whole calculation. The most recent result from the calculator is inserted into the document, which saves you having to remember and retype it. If you select C, the whole calculation is entered, for example “3 + 7 = 10.” There is one additional item on the "Insertion Menu,” named "Unicode character.” This allows the insertion of extended characters from the Unicode character tables. See also 7.18.1 Inserting Extended Characters. . 7.10 Binding Spaces. A binding space is simply a space that binds the words on either side of it to each other in a way that a normal space cannot. You can use a binding space to keep two words together on the same line, so that they cannot be split apart by the text breaking at the end of the line at a normal space. For example, it would be undesirable for a first initial and a last name, such as T. Brown, to appear on separate lines. The other place where binding spaces are useful is in the search function when searching for an email  you need to use binding spaces instead of normal spaces in a string of words to be searched for. In other contexts of search and/or replace, this is not necessary. Pressing CONTROL with SPACE produces a "binding space.” 7.11 Pasting an Address. A person's name and address, or other details, can be copied from an address list and inserted into your current document. Refer to 10.10.1 Copying to a Text or Braille Document. 7.12 Working with Documents on other Drives. While you will usually work with documents on the Flash Disk, KeyWord allows documents to be created or opened directly from any drive available on the VoiceNote mPower QT. If you want to open or create a document on a different drive, follow these steps: From the KeyWord Menu, select Open a Document or Create a Document. At the "Folder name?” prompt, press BACKSPACE. KeySoft prompts: "Drive? (Flash Disk).” Either type the name of the required drive, press SPACE repeatedly to review the list of available drives and press ENTER to select one, or press the hotkey for the drive you want. KeySoft returns to the "Folder name?" prompt. You can now follow the prompts to select the required folder and document name in the usual manner. When editing a document on a removable disk or storage card, do not remove the disk or card containing the document until after you return to the KeyWord Menu or the Main Menu. If you change to a drive other than the Flash Disk, KeySoft reminds you that you are not using the default drive each time you create or open a file. It does this by prompting for the drive, in addition to the folder and document name prompts. It is not recommended that you create or save important files on the KeySoft System disk, because the contents of this drive will be lost if the VoiceNote mPower QT is reset with JKL keys held down, or if the battery goes completely flat. This drive should only be used for temporary storage. 7.13 Saving a Document. Changes to a document are saved automatically when you finish editing it and return to the KeyWord menu or Main Menu, or when switching to another document with the command CONTROL with Z. However, it is good practice to save a document regularly while you are editing it, especially if you are editing the document for a long period of time. For example, you might delete a significant passage by accident. You can recover by quitting without saving, as described in the next section, and then opening the document again. This puts you back to the last version that you saved. To save the current document, press CONTROL with S. If the document has not been changed since the last time it was saved, KeySoft announces: "Document has not been modified" If this message is announced and you do not wish to continue saving the document, you can return to the Word Processor by pressing ESCAPE. If the document has been changed, no such message is given. KeySoft then prompts: "Document name? (name)" where (name) is the name of the current document. You can either overwrite the original document by pressing ENTER then Y for Yes, or write the changed document to a new name by typing a new document name and pressing ENTER. If you choose the first option, the new one replaces the old document. If you choose the second option, a new copy of the document is created under the new name, and the old document remains unchanged. If you wish to save the document to a different folder, press BACKSPACE at the "Document name" prompt and you will be asked for the Folder name, which can be selected as usual. You can also change the type of document at this point. For example, if you are editing a Braille document you can save a copy as a text document or as a Microsoft Word document and so on. To save a document as another file type, press CONTROL with X at the "Document name?" prompt. Repeat the CONTROL with X command until you hear the file format you wish to save in. If you save the document using a different name or file type, KeySoft gives you the option of opening the saved document or continuing to edit the original document. This is convenient if you want to make copies of the document with different formats without having to reopen the original document. If you have a large number of documents and the Flash Disk is almost full, there may be insufficient space available to save the current document. In this case you will be given the option of saving to the KeySoft System Disk or a storage Card, or deleting documents in the Flash Disk to make room. 7.14 Quitting a Document. Changes to a document are saved when you press CONTROL with S, or automatically as you return to the KeyWord menu or Main Menu, or when switching to another document. Sometimes you may need to quit the Word Processor without saving the changes made since the document was last saved. For example, you may have made some incorrect alterations and want to abandon your changes. To do this, press CONTROL with Q, for Quit. If changes have been made, KeySoft prompts: "Lose changes. Sure?" If you really wish to quit without saving the document, press Y. To cancel the command and return to the Word Processor, press N. 7.15 Creating Other Document Types. To create a different type of document, select "Create a Document" from the KeyWord Menu in the normal manner. When KeySoft prompts "Document to Create?", press Backspace with X (BT) or Ctrl with X (QT) repeatedly until the document type you wish to create is announced. These are: Text (KeyWord format); ASCII Text; Braille (BRF); Microsoft Word; Rich text format (RTF); WordPerfect; KeySoft Version 2 Braille; KeySoft Version 2 text; Computer Braille table; Create a Braille document; For further information on document and file types, refer to 14.17 File Translation You can also change the default document type; this is discussed in 7.2 Document Types. 7.16 Braille Documents. So far, we have assumed that our base document is a text document, formatted for inkprint, having around 85 characters per line and 66 lines on a page, suitable for printing on letter or A4 size paper. The alternative is a Braille document written in grade 1 or grade 2 Braille, and having about 40 characters per line and 25 lines on a page. Text and Braille documents can be stored in the same folder, so you review all document names when you review the contents of a folder. Remember that you can check the type of document by pressing READ with I when its name is announced. 7.16.1 Creating a Braille Document. To create a Braille document, press CONTROL with X repeatedly at the "Document to create?" prompt, until the prompt "Create a Braille document" is announced. Type the document name, and press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "This is a Braille document. Braille entry is required. Top of document. Blank" When you are in a document VoiceNote mPower QT allows you to input Braille characters using the FDS keys to represent dots 1 2 and 3 respectively. Similarly, the JKL keys represent dots 45 and 6. The SEMICOLON key represents the ENTER key and the A key the BACKSPACE. You may also use the standard keyboard ENTER and BACKSPACE keys. While it is unlikely that you would wish to create a long Braille document in this manner, the flexibility of being able to directly create or modify a Braille document can often be useful. 7.16.2 Opening Braille Documents. As previously noted, text and Braille documents can be stored in the same folder, so you review all document names when you review the contents of a folder. You can check the type of document by pressing READ with I when its name is announced. When you open a Braille document with KeyWord, KeySoft prompts: "This is a Braille document. Braille entry is required." You are then placed back in the document at the point where it was last exited. VoiceNote mPower QT's standard review commands may be used with Braille documents. For example: To read the next paragraph: READ with 9 To read the next sentence: READ with O To read the current word: READ with K. In a Grade 2 document, pressing READ with K to read the current word functions as follows: First press: Says the word; Second press: Spells the word in its contracted form; Third press: Spells the full word. Similarly, VoiceNote mPower QT's standard edit commands may be used with Braille documents. For example: To delete to end of paragraph: CONTROL with 8 To delete to end of sentence: CONTROL with I To delete the current word: CONTROL with K You may use Place Markers, perform Block operations, and Spell Check the document. 7.17 Formatting a Braille Document. Formatting of Braille documents is handled in a similar manner to that of formatting text documents. The "Layout List.” "Page Settings List.” "Presentation Style List" and the "Template Menu" are still available but there are some differences because Braille documents are formatted for embossing directly on a Braille printer. The commands used to Center and Right Justify a line are still available. The Underline and Font setting commands are not available, as these attributes are not supported in embossed documents. In the same way as you can include Braille formatting information in a text document that is used when the document is translated or embossed, text formatting information can be included in a Braille document. In a Braille document, the "Braille Settings Menu" presented when working in a text document is replaced with the "Ink Print Settings Menu.” The format of a Braille document, that is a document primarily intended for embossing, is determined by the settings in the Layout List, the Page Settings List, and by individual commands for centering, and justifying text. The settings associated with taking a Braille document, and performing the "onthefly" translation of this document to provide output to a ink printer, are determined by the items in the Presentation Style List, and the Ink Print Settings Menu. The preparation of "Template documents" for use with the address list and Braille files is controlled from the Template Menu. In the following discussion a paragraph is defined as a group of words that ends with a new line indicator. 7.17.1 Layout List. The Layout List allows you to review and change options that control the layout or formatting of the Braille document, such as tabs, indents, page numbering, etc. Pressing CONTROL with L accesses the Layout List for a Braille document. It is described in 7.17.9 Layout of a Braille Document 7.17.2 Page Settings List. The Page Settings List allows you to review or change the page layout of the Braille document. Pressing CONTROL with P accesses the Page Settings List for a Braille document. It contains the same options as the Page Settings for text documents, and is described in 7.3.2 Page Settings List. 7.17.3 Center a line. This command centers a line or paragraph. The Center line command is CONTROL with E. It operates in the same way as the command for centering a line of text described in 7.3.3 Center a line. 7.17.4 Right justify a line. This command aligns a line or paragraph so that each line ends at the right margin. The Right justify line command is CONTROL with R. It operates in the same way as the command for right justifying a line of text described in 7.3.4 Right justify a line. 7.17.5 Style of presentation. Styles of presentation are used when a Braille document is translated and reformatted into a text document, for example, before being printed. They allow you to control the way paragraphs; headings, etc. are formatted in the text document independently of the Braille document's formatting. Pressing CONTROL with Y accesses the Presentation Style List for a Braille document. The styles are described in 7.3.6 Style of presentation. 7.17.6 Ink Print Settings. This item allows you to review and change options that affect the way a Braille document is translated or reformatted as a text document. Pressing READ with CONTROL with B accesses the Ink Print Settings Menu for a Braille document. It is described in 7.17.11 Inkprint Settings linked with a Braille Document. 7.17.7 Translation Options. This group of 9 settings affects the way in which the current Braille document is reformatted when it is translated to a text document . Settings apply from the start of the current paragraph, and can be changed at chosen points throughout the document. The initial values are covered in 14.19.9 Reviewing and Setting Back Translation Options, as well as other translation settings that are not available while editing. To access the print translation options, either select the "Translation options" from the Inkprint Settings Menu, or press BACKSPACE with ENTER with O. The settings are as follows: What type of paragraph boundary is used in the source document? Interpret larger boundaries as paragraphs also? New Line translation option? Convert font indicators to Braille typeforms? Include two spaces between sentences? Suppress New Page markers? Include a blank line between items in outline style? Revert to Paragraph Style After How Many Blank Lines? Translation find and replace. The last item allows you to replace a particular formatting sequence with another, as part of the translation process. For example, the Braille document might use 3 spaces anywhere on a line to indicate the start of a new paragraph, and New Line indicators in the text document could replace these. To set up this sequence, at the “Find?” prompt press the binding space command CONTROL with SPACE, three times, followed by ENTER. This sets up the "Find?" string of 3 spaces, then at the “Replacement for 3 spaces?” prompt type: SPACE with dots 26 followed by ENTER. This sets up the "Replacement?" string of one New Line. 7.17.8 Template Menu. This item contains options that are used when preparing a Template Document for use with the Address List. Pressing CONTROL with A accesses the Template Menu for a Braille document. This is described in 10.9 Templates. 7.17.9 Layout of a Braille Document. Press CONTROL with L to access the layout list for a Braille document. The items in the Layout List for a Braille document have initial values that are appropriate for embossing. The Left and Right Margins are both set to 0, and the Tab Stops are set to 3. The Layout List for a Braille document, together with the factory default settings, is as follows: Indent first line of paragraph. Default setting 0; Indent rest of paragraph. Default setting 0; Tab stops. Default setting 3; Line Spacing. Default setting single; Emboss page numbers. Default setting Yes; Page number position. Default setting Top right; Emboss both sides of the paper. Default setting No; Left margin. Default setting 0; Right margin. Default setting 0; Word wrap. Default setting On. The option to "Emboss both sides of the paper" only appears on the Layout List if the Embosser Setup has been set to indicate that the embosser supports double sided embossing. 7.17.10 Style of Presentation linked with a Braille Document. You can attach a style to a section of a Braille document, and this has an effect only when you print the document on an ink printer, or translate it to a text document. This is the converse of the Styles of Presentation described in 7.4.1 Style of Presentation linked with a Text Document. The same 6 style names are available, but their actions are suited to formatting a text document. To check or change a style, open the Braille document, locate the cursor anywhere in the paragraph you wish to check and press CONTROL with Y. KeySoft displays the style of the current section of text. If you wish to leave the Style unchanged, press ENTER. Alternatively, you can review the available Styles by pressing SPACE repeatedly and choose a new Style by pressing ENTER, or press the initial letter of your choice. Settings apply from the start of the current paragraph following a New Line indicator, and a “Style” indicator indicates a change. The styles are as follows: 7.17.10.1 Paragraph. This is the initial style for a new document style. While paragraphs in Braille might start on a new line indented by two spaces, paragraphs in a text document might have no indentation, and be separated by a blank line. While this is the formatting convention for paragraphs, the Back Translation Options described in 14.19.9.1 Type of paragraph boundary used in the source document, allow you to change it to suit your needs. 7.17.10.2 Heading. Regardless of how a heading is formatted in Braille, in inkprint two blank lines are placed above and below the heading and it is centered and in bold font. If a heading takes up more than one line, each subsequent line is also centered and in bold font. A blank line in Braille produces a blank line in inkprint. The heading style continues until another style indicator changes it, or two or more blank lines are encountered. In the latter case the style reverts to "Paragraph.” Once again, this is the suggested formatting convention for headings. It can be changed by altering the Back Translation Options as described in 14.19.9.8 Heading format. 7.17.10.3 Subheading. In inkprint a blank line is left before and after a subheading. The subheading is bold, and starts at the left margin. Subheadings can take up more than one line, but the first blank line returns the style to "Paragraph.” 7.17.10.4 Outline. This style is used where you have numbered paragraphs or an outline. Usually each item starts on a new line, with subsequent lines belonging to that item being indented. This format is retained in inkprint, but a blank line is left between items whether or not there is a blank line in Braille. Another style indicator or two or more blank lines terminates Outline Style, and in the latter case the style reverts to "Paragraph.” 7.17.10.5 Lines. This style is used to show that the text is a series of separate lines all starting at the left margin. It might be used for the address at the top of a letter, for example. Each New Line in Braille starts a New Line in print. Each blank line in Braille causes a blank line in print. Another style, or two or more blank lines, terminates "Lines" style and in the latter case "Paragraph" style comes into effect. 7.17.10.6 Identical to Source. You can use this style to preserve the formatting of a section in a Braille document when it is printed or translated. This style continues in effect until another style is encountered. 7.17.11 Inkprint Settings linked with a Braille Document. These settings can be used when you are editing a Braille document to control the format of the document when it is printed, or translated to a text document. To access the Inkprint settings menu when you are editing a Braille document, press READ with CONTROL with B. You can review the list and select an item in the same way as all KeySoft menus. The Inkprint settings menu contains the following 6 items: Layout; Inclusion; Start inkprint exclusion; End inkprint exclusion; Translation options; Page settings. These items are discussed now. 7.17.11.1 Inkprint Layout. The settings for a Braille document, such as left and right margin, are accessed from the Layout List, accessed by pressing CONTROL with L. In contrast, when you are preparing a Braille document for printing or translation, you may need to check or change the settings that are used for inkprint. These can be accessed from the Inkprint Settings menu, and then choosing Layout. The Inkprint Layout list contains a similar group of settings to the Braille list, including indents, left and right margins, tabs, page number enabling, line spacing and word wrap, but the values are for inkprint. The initial values for new documents are; Left and Right Margins 10 columns, or one inch, and Tab Stops of Indent 5. An additional setting in the Inkprint Layout list is Justification. This style is used in most printed newspapers and magazines, and spreads the words out so the last character of each line is at the right margin. It gives the text a tidy appearance, with both sides of the text being straight, but spacing between some words is increased. It is a matter of preference which way you set this option. The initial setting is off. To change the setting, press N for "ON" or F for "OFF.” Values that you set in the Inkprint Layout are used when your Braille document is printed on an inkprint printer, or translated to a text document. They do not affect the layout of the Braille document. 7.17.11.2 Inkprint Inclusion. You may want to include text or formatting commands in the inkprint version that are not required in the Braille version. For example, you could add an explanatory note, underline a word, or force a new page. To do this, select the "Inclusion" option in the Inkprint Settings Menu. KeySoft prompts: "Inkprintonly inclusion?" In response to this prompt, type the text that you want to appear in the inkprint version and press ENTER. You can also include the following formatting commands: New line: press CONTROL with ENTER; New page: press CONTROL with N; Tab: press TAB; Center line: press CONTROL with E; Right justify line: press CONTROL with R; Underline: press CONTROL with U; Font: press CONTROL with T. You can review the document for inclusion markers, and delete them like any other character. To review or edit the text of an inclusion, position the cursor on the inclusion marker and select the Inclusion option again. 7.17.11.3 Inkprint Exclusion. Conversely, there may be text or formatting commands in the Braille document, such as the description of a table layout, which you may want to exclude from the inkprint version. This is done by marking the start and end of the text or formatting commands you want excluded, as follows: With the cursor at the required point, select "Start inkprint exclusion" from the Inkprint Settings menu. KeyWord marks the position with a special "Start inkprint exclusion" indicator. Now type the text or formatting commands that you do not want to appear in the inkprint version, and select "End inkprint exclusion" from the Inkprint Settings Menu. KeyWord marks the position with a special "End inkprint exclusion" indicator. Note that you can also add these markers to existing text, if you wish. 7.17.11.4 Translation Options. This group of 9 settings affects the way in which the current Braille document is reformatted when it is translated to a text document or printed on an inkprinter. They are collectively referred to as the “Ink Print Translation Options List.” Settings apply from the start of the current paragraph, and can be changed at chosen points throughout the document. The initial values are covered in 14.17 File Translation, as well as other translation settings that are not available while editing. To access the inkprint translation options, select the "Translation options" from the Inkprint Settings Menu. The settings are as follows: What type of paragraph boundary is used in the source document? Interpret larger boundaries as paragraphs also? New Line translation option? Convert Braille italics to italics font? Include two spaces between sentences? Suppress New Page markers? Include a blank line between items in outline style? Revert to Paragraph Style After How Many Blank Lines? Translation find and replace. The last item allows you to replace a particular formatting sequence with another, as part of the translation process. For example, the Braille document might use 3 spaces anywhere on a line to indicate the start of a new paragraph, and New Line indicators in the text document could replace these. To set up this sequence, at the “Find?” prompt type: CONTROL with SPACE, three times, followed by ENTER. this sets up the "Find?" string of 3 spaces, then at the “Replacement for 3 spaces?” prompt type: CONTROL with ENTER, followed by ENTER. this sets up the "Replacement?" string of one New Line. 7.17.11.5 InkPrint Page Settings. When you translate a Braille document to a text document, or print a Braille document on an inkprinter, a group of page settings is used for the entire printed copy or text document. To access the Inkprint Page Settings, select "Page Settings" from the Inkprint Settings Menu. KeySoft announces: "InkPrint Page settings list." This is a similar group of settings to the Braille list, comprising first page number, paper length, paper width, and top and bottom margins. The initial values for Page Length and Page Width follow the values in the Printer Setup List, and a prompt indicates if a setting is changed. The initial top and bottom margins are 6 lines, or one inch, suitable for inkprint. Values that you set here are used in the printed or translated versions of your Braille documents, but do not affect embossing. 7.17.12 Initial Format Settings in a Document. If you have changed one or more settings in a Layout list, you can reach a point in the document where you want the settings to revert to their initial values. That is, the value they were at the start of the document. To do this, ensure that the cursor is at the appropriate place, and from anywhere in the Layout list, press CONTROL with R, for Revert. This causes all the settings in the Layout list to revert to the values that they had at the start of the document. The initial settings that KeySoft uses when you create a new document have been chosen to suit most situations, but you can set up different initial settings if you wish. For example, you may decide that you want a right margin of 8 columns in all the text documents you create from now on. To do this, open or create a text document, and change the right margin setting in the Layout list. Then, from anywhere in the Layout list, press CONTROL with S. This saves all the current values including the new right margin, as the initial settings that are used when you create a text document. To change the initial Page Settings, alter the required setting and then from anywhere in the Page Settings list, press CONTROL with S. Remember that there are separate initial settings for Braille and text documents, which you can change by opening the appropriate document and carrying out this procedure. 7.18 Extended Characters. The text characters represented on the typical QWERTY keyboard only represent a tiny proportion of the total characters available. These include currency indicators e.g. £ and ¥, accented letters e.g. é and ç, character sets for other languages such as Arabic and Japanese and a whole range of specialist characters for use in sciences, math, phonetics etc. totaling around 35,000. Those characters not represented in your standard character set are referred to as the extended character set. As a way of managing this enormous character set, a standard called Unicode exists. Unicode assigns a unique numeric code to every character. This allows for use in coding and programming, formatting, and an easy way to enter characters once you know the character code. For more information on Unicode Tables, have a look at www.unicode.org. 7.18.1 Inserting Extended Characters. Unicode characters only work in text documents. As the QT default document type is text, this should not be an issue, however if converting to or reading these documents in Braille, bear in mind that the inserted symbols will look unusual. There are three different ways of inserting an extended character, that are suitable for different levels of use: a. Searching and selecting the character from the Unicode tables – For the first or only time you look up a character and if you don't know its code, you will need to do this to search for it. There are two methods of doing this detailed later in this section. b. Typing in the character code – This is quick and easy for characters you use occasionally and can remember the code for. c. Setting up a key combination – assigning a key stroke combination to the character. This is a good way to manage frequently used characters. 7.18.2 Insertion By Name. This search is based on the name of the character, for example "e acute" or "Eurocurrency sign.” Follow these steps to insert an extended character using the name search: 1. When the cursor is at the place where you wish to enter the character, press FUNCTION with X. KeySoft will prompt for the Unicode character. If you have used this function before, it will offer the previously selected character. If you want to select it, press ENTER. If not, continue to Step 2. 2. Type in the name, or part of the name, of the character, then press ENTER. 3. KeySoft will respond with a selection, either the character you want or the first one to fit your search criteria. If it is the one you want, press ENTER. If not, view the next search match by pressing READ with N repeatedly until you do find it and then press ENTER. This will insert the character. 7.18.2.1 An Example: Let's assume you want to enter the word "resume" with the letter "e" showing as "e acute,” but you don't know the character code for "e acute.” Type the letter "r,” then press FUNCTION with X. KeySoft will prompt for the Unicode character. We know that we want to enter an "e acute,” so type in "e acute,” then press ENTER. KeySoft will respond with "Cap e acute,” and using this as your starting point you can search for all members of the "e acute" character family by pressing READ with N. In this instance "e acute" will be the next character prompted. Press ENTER, and the extended character for "e acute" will be entered into your document. Continue typing "sum,” then press FUNCTION with X again to enter the last "e acute.” KeySoft will prompt the previously chosen extended character, which in this instance happens to be "e acute,” so you just have to press ENTER, followed by SPACE to complete the word. 7.18.3 Browsing Unicode Tables. Unicode characters are grouped into tables according to type. For example, there is a Unicode table for Greek characters, for General Punctuation, for Superscripts etc. You have the choice of searching for a table then for a character within it. This is useful if you are not sure which character you want but you are aware of its general type. Follow the steps below to browse for a character using the Unicode tables. 1. When the cursor is at the place where you wish to enter the character, press FUNCTION with X. KeySoft will prompt for a Unicode character. 2. To browse the list of Unicode tables, press SPACE repeatedly, or BACKSPACE to go back, or type the initial letter of a table name to narrow down the selection and browse from there. 3. When you locate the table you wish to browse, select it by pressing ENTER. 4. At this point you can either browse the whole table by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE repeatedly, or type the initial letter of a character name to narrow down the selection and browse from there. Note: While reviewing a table, you can announce the numeric code of the character you are currently viewing by pressing READ with I. If you are already within the Unicode tables and wish to search for a Unicode character by name, press READ with F and you will then return to the "Unicode character?" prompt. To search again for the next matching Unicode character description for within the Unicode tables, press READ with N. If there are no more matches you will remain on the current Unicode character. Once you have completed your search, press ENTER to select the Unicode character. 7.18.4 Inserting Characters Using Unicode Codes. This method is easy if you already know the character code i.e. the numeric code assigned to it. Follow the steps below to search for a character using the Unicode tables. 1. When the cursor is at the place where you wish to enter the character, press FUNCTION with X. KeySoft will prompt for a Unicode character. 2. Type the numeric code, and press ENTER. The character will be inserted into the document. (You can, if you prefer, use the hexadecimal value of the code in the form "0x…."). 7.18.5 Assigning Keys to a Unicode Character. KeySoft allows you to assign a key combination to a Unicode character. This is an excellent idea for characters you use frequently. The assignation function is called a macro, and the following steps outline how to define or change a macro for a Unicode character: 1. Enter the Unicode Tables with FUNCTION with X, and locate the Unicode character you wish to create a macro for using one of the search methods above, only don't press ENTER. 2. When the character is announced, press CONTROL with K. If there is no macro assigned, it will announce, " Character Unassigned" where character is the actual name of the character. If a macro is already assigned, it will announce, " Character is assigned to FUNCTION WITH C with keystroke" where Character is the name of the character, and keystroke is the stroke or strokes assigned to it. For example, "E acute is assigned to FUNCTION WITH C with E and C." (Note that FUNCTION with C appears at the beginning of all macros). 3. Press A. The prompt, "Assign, macro to assign to Character?" will display, where Character is the name of the character. Press the key combination you wish to assign to the character, e.g. E and C for e acute, and press ENTER. 4. The prompt, "Assign Function with C then keystroke to character?" will display, where keystroke is the stroke or strokes assigned to it, and Character is the name of the character. For example, "Assign FUNCTION WITH C with E and C to e acute?" Press Y for Yes or N for No. If you press N, you will be returned to the beginning of this step. If you press Y, you will be returned to the same place in the Unicode tables. From there you can select another character or exit by pressing ESCAPE. Note: A Unicode character can have more than one macro assigned to it. To toggle through all the currently assigned key combinations, press SPACE. 7.18.5.1 Changing a Macro. If the Unicode character has already been assigned you may press U to unassign or remove it altogether, or R to reassign or change the key combination. To use either of these functions, follow steps 1 and 2 above. Then: To Remove or unassign the key combination, press U at this point. The prompt, "Unassign Character from keystrokes, sure?" will display, where Character is the name of the character and keystroke is the stroke or strokes assigned to it. Press Y for Yes or N for No. If you press N, you will be returned to the beginning of this step. If you press Y, you will be returned to the same place in the Unicode tables. From there you can select another character or exit by pressing ESCAPE. To change the key combination, press R at this point. The prompt, "Reassign, Macro to reassign to Character?" will display, where character is the name of the character. Type the new key combination and press ENTER. The prompt, "Reassign Function with C then keystroke to character?" will display, where keystroke is the stroke or strokes assigned to it, and Character is the name of the character. For example, "Reassign FUNCTION WITH C with E and C to e acute?" Press Y for Yes or N for No. If you press N, you will be returned to the beginning of this step. If you press Y, you will be returned to the same place in the Unicode tables. From there you can select another character or exit by pressing ESCAPE. 7.18.6 How to use Unicode Macros. Once you have created a Unicode macro as above, you will then no doubt wish to use it in a document, a file name, address listing etc. To use it, at the point where you wish to insert the Unicode character, press FUNCTION with C and the key combination you assigned to it, followed by ENTER. Continue typing as normal. You may be wondering how this character will display on the Braille display. This is covered in the next section. 7.18.7 Appearance of Unicode Characters in Computer Braille. You may assign a computer Braille dot combination to any extended character so that when the document is translated to computer Braille, that dot combination will be used. Assigning a dot combination follows a similar pattern to assigning a key combination: Search the Unicode tables for the character to which you wish to assign a dot pattern and when you locate it, press CONTROL with D. Press A to assign a computer Braille dot combination. If the Unicode character has already been assigned you may press R to reassign a dot combination, leaving the original dot combination free. Assigned dot combinations can be removed by selecting U. Upon selecting A (assign) or R (reassign) you will be asked to enter the dot combination to assign to the selected Unicode character. Finally, you will be asked to confirm your dot combination selection. To confirm the selection, press Y. Note that multiple Unicode characters can be assigned to one dot combination. This may be useful if, for example, you use e acute, e grave, and e macron, you could assign a dot combination that for you means "e with an accent,” or you might assign the same combination to all vowels that have diereses. You can use this feature any way you see fit. As soon as a "dot pattern" is assigned to a Unicode character, a "Custom" Computer Braille table is automatically added in the "Dictionary" folder. This file is used in place of the previously selected Computer Braille file. 7.18.8 Interpreting Braille Versions of Unicode Characters. If you are reading a text document that has been translated to Grade 2 in Braille, whether you have or haven't assigned a computer Braille dot output combination, you will see the same thing. Using the word cafe as an example: You will observe the letters "caf" on the embossed printout, followed by "dot 4", then the letter "e". The "dot 4" is the Grade 2 indication for an extended character. If you are reading a text document that has been translated to computer Braille, you will see either a blank cell if the character is unassigned, or the dot combination you assigned to the character in computer Braille. On any computer Braille character you can find out the name of the character by pressing the "Read current Character" command READ with COMMA, twice. End of Advanced Word Processing Chapter. 8 Scientific Calculator. The Scientific Calculator, KeyPlus, can be used for straightforward sums such as addition or division, but is also capable of many more complex operations. The result of a calculation is announced, and either the calculation result or the complete calculation can also be inserted into a document. Remember that at any point, you can press the HELP key to obtain information on the options available. 8.1 Entering KeyPlus. You can enter KeyPlus from the Main Menu by pressing S, or from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with 5. Your VoiceNote confirms the calculator status when you last left the calculator. This might be the result of a calculation or part of one you were entering. Continue entering the calculation or, if a result is announced, starting a new calculation clears the calculator. To clear the calculator to zero, press CONTROL with I. 8.2 Entering a Calculation. A calculation is entered in the same order as it would be typed or announced. For example, to add the numbers 3, 4 and 5, then subtract 2, you would press: 3 + 4 + 5  2 Press ENTER, for Equals, and KeySoft announces the answer, which in this case is: 10 To enter numbers into the calculator, you can use the top row of the keyboard for the numbers 1 through 9, and 0. To the right of these are Minus and Plus. (The SHIFT key is not required for the plus function.) The multiplication key, called Star or Asterisk, is on SHIFT with 8. The division key is SLASH, and is the rightmost key on the second row up from the bottom. Alternatively, you may prefer to use a group of keys which form a keypad during calculator use. This keypad, is not marked, but has the same layout as a computer keypad or pocket calculator. The top row is: 7, 8, 9. On the next row: 4, 5, 6, and Minus, are on the U, I, O, and P keys. There is a raised dot on the 5. On the third row: 1, 2, 3, and Plus, are on the J, K, L, and SEMICOLON keys. On the fourth row: 0, Asterisk (for multiplying), and Decimal Point, are on the M, COMMA, and PERIOD keys. Try some simple calculations to get the feel of the calculator. If you type in a long sequence such as: 3 * 2 + 5 * 6 + 9 the answer will not be determined until you have typed in the complete calculation and pressed the ENTER key. Press HELP to obtain a complete list of key combinations for the calculator. You can also check key combinations with the "Announce Key" mode, by pressing READ with A. In this mode, pressing a particular key combination causes the resulting function to be announced. To return to the normal calculator function, press ESCAPE. Remember that the order for entering numbers and operators is just as you would write them. 8.2.1 Reviewing the Calculation. If you are not sure that you have entered a calculation correctly, you can review the calculation before pressing ENTER. There are two review commands available. They are: To review the whole calculation, press READ with I; To review the last number or operator entered, press READ with K. 8.2.2 Editing the Calculation. While entering a calculation you can backspace to delete entries onebyone by pressing BACKSPACE or CONTROL with M, one or more times. If the current calculation started with the result of a previous one, BACKSPACE does not delete that number, because it was calculated rather than typed. Entering a new calculation clears the last result. 8.2.3 Calculation Entry Errors. When you type a calculation, KeyPlus beeps if you make a mistake, such as: 3 + * Press HELP to find the reason. In this case, KeyPlus announces: "Value expected." Other messages indicate different errors. You may want to review the calculation after an incorrect entry, by pressing READ with I to find out where you are. 8.2.4 Setting the Calculation Precision. The maximum number of decimal places announced may be set from 0 to 9. This is done by pressing CONTROL with PERIOD followed by the desired number of digits. This does not affect the internal precision of calculations but only the number of digits announced. For example to set the number of decimal places to 4, first press CONTROL with PERIOD. KeyPlus prompts: "Decimal places currently (current setting)." Press 4 then ENTER. If you are checking the precision, just press ENTER to leave the current setting unchanged. 8.3 Basic Operations. The basic operations provided are: Addition, Subtraction, Multiplication and Division; Negation, Percent, Parenthesis and Fractions. 8.3.1 Addition, Subtraction, Multiplication and Division. These operations have the normal order of precedence. This means that expressions inside brackets are evaluated first, and then division and multiplication are performed, followed by addition and subtraction. 8.3.2 Parentheses. Parentheses, or brackets, are used to change the order in which an equation is evaluated. For example, the equation: 3 + 4 x 5 is evaluated by adding 3 to the product of 4 times 5. The answer is 23. If you want the addition of 3 and 4 to occur first, and the result to be multiplied by 5, insert parentheses around the 3 + 4, as follows: (3 + 4) x 5= 35 Parentheses can be placed wherever a number can occur. You can use up to 6 levels. If you try to open more than 6 levels, or close more than are open, KeyPlus beeps. 8.3.3 Negation. The Negation operator N is used to enter negative numbers. For example to calculate 5 divided by negative 2 you press: 5 / N 2 ENTER Note that the Negation operator is not the same as the subtraction operator, and that they are on different keys on the keyboard. 8.3.4 Percent. The Percent operator is used to calculate percentage markup or markdown. It is a special operator that automatically evaluates the calculation without the need to press ENTER. For example, To calculate a 20% markup on 56 press: 5 6 + 2 0 % which gives the result 67.2. To calculate a 10% markdown on 45 press: 4 5  1 0 % which gives the result 40.5. To calculate what percentage 17 is of 20, press: 17 / 20 % which gives the result 85. That is, 17 is 85% of 20. To calculate 30% of 180 press: 180 * 30% which gives the result 54. 8.3.5 Fractions. This section describes how to calculate fractions in KeySoft 7.5. It covers the entry of simple fractions, improper fractions and mixed numbers. It also describes how to convert fractions. If you want to use addition, subtraction, multiplication and division in an equation that includes fractions, refer to 8.2 Entering a Calculation. Note that the calculator memory can hold either a fraction or a decimal at any one time. 8.3.5.1 Entering Simple and Improper Fractions. This section explains how to enter simple and improper fractions into the Scientific Calculator. A simple fraction is a fraction in which both the numerator and denominator are integers or whole numbers. For example, 1/2 which is spoken in KeyPlus as "1 over 2". An improper or 'top heavy' fraction is one in which the numerator is larger than the denominator. For example, 24/9. To enter a simple or improper fraction, follow the steps below: 1. Enter the numerator (the top number in the fraction). 2. Enter the fraction command that adds a horizontal line between the numerator and denominator. The fraction command is as follows: Press CONTROL with forward slash '/'. You will hear "over" as CONTROL with forward slash '/' is pressed. 3. Enter the denominator (the bottom number in the fraction). 4. If applicable, continue entering the remaining part of the equation. 8.3.5.2 Entering Mixed Numbers. A mixed number is the combination of an integer or whole number, and a fraction. For example, 6 1/2. To enter a mixed number, follow the steps below: 1. Enter the integer or whole number and press SPACE. You will hear "and" as SPACE is pressed. 2. Enter the numerator (the top number in the fraction). 3. Enter the fraction command that adds a horizontal line between the numerator and denominator. The fraction command is as follows: Press CONTROL with forward slash '/'. KeyPlus will display "over" as CONTROL with forward slash '/' is pressed. 4. Add the denominator (the bottom number in the fraction). 8.3.5.3 Converting Fractions. This section covers how to convert a fraction into many different forms and many different forms into a fraction. The conversion hot key is used for all conversions except converting a fraction to its lowest term and to a percentage. To use the conversion hot key, enter it after the result of an equation is displayed. The conversion hot key will therefore operate on the result. You can also enter the conversion hot key immediately after the fraction or decimal has been entered. In this case, the conversion hot key will operate on the fraction or decimal entered. The conversion hot key is READ with forward slash '/'. 8.3.5.4 Converting a decimal to a fraction. Converting a decimal to a fraction is the opposite of converting a fraction to a decimal which you achieve by dividing the numerator by the denominator. For example, the fraction 1/2 is the decimal 0.5 which you calculate by dividing 1 by 2. To convert a fraction to a decimal, press READ with forward slash '/'. KeyPlus prompts: "Fraction option?". To cycle through the list of options, press SPACE. Complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 8.3.5.5 Converting a fraction to a decimal. Every decimal can be written as a fraction. For example, 1 divided by 3 is 1/3. To convert a fraction to a decimal, press READ with forward slash '/' D. KeyPlus prompts: "Fraction option?". To cycle through the list of options, either press D (the hot key) or press SPACE. Complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 8.3.5.6 Converting a fraction to its lowest terms. A fraction is in lowest terms or lowest prime denominator, when the greatest common factor of its numerator and denominator is 1. The result of an equation involving a fraction is always displayed in its lowest terms form. For example, 1/4 + 1/4 = 1/2. If you are not converting the fraction to its lowest terms, the answer to the equation would be 2/4. To directly convert a fraction to its lowest terms, Type the fraction and press ENTER. 8.3.5.7 Converting a mixed number to an improper fraction. To convert a mixed number to an improper fraction, press READ with forward slash '/' I. KeyPlus prompts: "Fraction option?". To cycle through the list of options, either press I (the hot key) or press SPACE. Complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 8.3.5.8 Converting an improper fraction to a mixed number. To convert an improper fraction to a mixed number, press READ with forward slash '/' M. KeyPlus prompts: "Fraction option?". To cycle through the list of options, either press M (the hot key) or press SPACE. Complete your entry by pressing ENTER. 8.3.5.9 Converting an equivalent fraction to the displayed fraction. Equivalent fractions are fractions that have the same value. You can determine if fractions are equivalent by multiplying the numerator and denominator by the same number. The number that you multiply should be such that the numerators will be equal after the multiplication. For example, if you compare 1/2 and 2/4, you would multiply by 2/2 which would result in 2/4 so they are equivalent. To convert an equivalent fraction to the displayed fraction, press READ with forward slash '/' E. 8.3.5.10 Converting a fraction to a percentage. Percentages refer to fractions of a whole. To convert a fraction to a percentage, press the percent sign '%'. 8.3.5.11 Taking the reciprocal of a fraction. The reciprocal of a fraction is taken by switching its numerator and denominator. For example the reciprocal of 3/4 is 4/3. Notice that when you multiply a fraction and its reciprocal, the product is always 1. To take the reciprocal of a fraction, press READ with forward slash '/' R. 8.4 Statistical Operations. Statistical operations in KeyPlus, allow you to enter a set of numbers, and KeyPlus then calculates their mean (average), median, mode, standard deviation, minimum, maximum, etc. You can review the statistical results, insert them into documents, or use them in calculations, etc. You can also review the data in the order you entered it, in numeric order or as a frequency table. The data set can be edited to correct mistakes and can be saved in a file for later use, to share, or export for use in a database or spreadsheet. You can paste in a set of numbers copied from a document, as well as being able to import data from databases and spreadsheets. There are two menus for Calculator Statistics  the Data Set Menu and the Statistical Functions Menu/Statistical Functions Review List. The Data Set Menu is where data sets are reviewed, saved, loaded and cleared. It also provides you with the option to turn Data Entry on or off and to paste data from the clipboard into the data set. The Statistical Functions Menu/Statistical Functions Review List is for performing numerous statistical operations, such as finding the mean and the sum of values. The Data Set Menu is accessible from anywhere in KeyPlus. To go to the Data Set Menu, press CONTROL with S. The Statistical Functions Menu/Statistical Functions Review List is also accessible from anywhere in KeyPlus. To go to the Statistical Functions Menu/Statistical Functions Review List, press READ with S. 8.4.1 Entering Data. To perform statistical operations, KeyPlus needs a set of numbers to operate upon. To avoid confusing these numbers with other numbers in KeyPlus, these numbers will be referred to as "values", and the set of values KeyPlus operates on is called "the data set." The number of times a value occurs is called the "frequency" of the value. When you put a value and a frequency together, you get a data item. Note that the maximum number of data items allowed in a data set is 5000. Once you have entered a set of values, they remain in KeyPlus until you either purposefully clear the data set, or load another data set in its place. In order to add each individual value one at a time, you will need to turn Data Entry on. Data Entry is turned on using the first item in the Data Set Menu. To enter the Data Set Menu, press CONTROL with S. Move to the first menu item by pressing SPACE and KeyPlus will announce: "Data entry is off. Turn it on." To turn it on, press ENTER. KeyPlus will announce: "Data entry on, N is 0." "N is 0" means there are currently no values in the data set. You are now back in KeyPlus with the Data Entry on. When you press ENTER after typing a number or performing a calculation, the number or result of the calculation will be added to the data set. Alternatively, you can toggle data entry on/off using the hotkey, READ with D. While Data Entry is on, “N is …” is always announcedafter the calculator result. This tells you the total number of values in the data set and reminds you that Data Entry is on. If at anytime you want to check that the Data Entry Mode is on or off, press SHIFT with I. KeyPlus will announce: "data entry is on, N is (xx)" or "data entry is off." Once you have finished entering values or if you need to use the calculator for another purpose, turn Data Entry off again. To do this, enter the Data Set Menu and move onto the first item. You will notice that it is now "Data entry is on. Turn it off." To turn it off, press ENTER and you will be returned to the Scientific Calculator. There are 4 ways to type individual values into the data set: 1. Entering a single number: You can type numbers, for example, type 73 and press ENTER. KeyPlus announces: "seven three equals seventy three", and then pauses before "N is 1", followed by "73 N is 1" is announced. This shows that the number 73 has been added to the data set and it now contains one value. 2. Entering the result of a calculation: You can enter the result of a calculation directly into the data set. For example, type 3 * 6 and press ENTER. KeyPlus announces: "three times six equals eighteen", and then pauses before "N is 2", followed by "18 N is 2" is announced. This shows that the number 18 has been added to the data set, which now contains 2 values. 3. Entering a number and how often it occurs: If you know a particular number occurs more than once, you do not have to enter it multiple times because you can tell KeyPlus in one entry what the number is and how often it occurs. The number of times a number occurs is called the frequency of the number. To enter a number and its frequency, type the number, the frequency command, and then the number of times it occurs. For example, to input "5", ten times, type "5", the frequency command, "10" and press ENTER. KeyPlus announces: "five frequency ten", and then pauses before "N is 12", followed by "5; 10 N is 12" is announced. This shows that the number 5 has been added ten times to the data set, which now contains 12 values. A value followed by its frequency is called a data item. The frequency command is apostrophe. 4. Pasting numbers from the clipboard: You can paste either a single number from the clipboard or a set of numbers. A single number can be pasted into the calculator using the standard paste command, CONTROL with V. If any invalid characters are included, KeyPlus will announce: "Value is out of range." Invalid data items include alphanumerical words, such as ninetyone; spaces; and mathematical operations. To paste in a set of numbers use the "Paste clipboard into data set" option in the Data Set Menu. The numbers must be separated by commas. For example, if you are reading a worksheet or text book that instructs you to "Calculate the mean of the following numbers: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5", copy just the numbers, commas, and spaces, to the clipboard, switch to the calculator, enter the Data Set Menu, and select the "paste clipboard into data set" option. If any invalid characters are included, KeyPlus will announce: "Discarded invalid data items. N is xx." 8.4.2 Importing Data. You can import data from a file that has been saved in Comma Separated Values (CSV) format. Most spreadsheets and databases have this as an option when saving or exporting data. Note that in this file, the data items must be listed so that the value comes before the frequency. For example: 73,2 58,2 38,1 The data is presented in a list with one value and in its associated frequency per line. Also, the numbers are written in digits rather than words. Note that you do not need to include the frequency on each or any line. For example, your list could include: 73,2 58 38,1 or 73 58 38 When importing data, any lines containing invalid data are ignored and importing continues. If any invalid data items are included, KeyPlus will announce: "Discarded invalid data items, N is xx." Otherwise, KeyPlus will announce: "N is xx." To start the process of importing data, you will need to access the Data Set Menu. To do this, press CONTROL with S and select the "Load another Data Set" option. If the data set has been modified prior to being loaded, KeyPlus will announce: "Existing data set has been modified. Save?." If you would like to save the modifications, press Y. You will be prompted to select the file in which to save the data set and the data set will be saved. KeyPlus will then prompt: "Name of data set to load?". Type a file name or select the file containing the data set and press ENTER. KeyPlus will prompt: "Replace existing data set or append new data to existing data set?". If you select "replace", the existing data set will be cleared before the selected data set is loaded. If you select "append", the loaded data will be added to the existing data set. All the existing data items in the current data set will now be added or replaced and KeyPlus will prompt: "N is xx" and at the same time, a series of progress beeps may be heard if there is a reasonable amount of data items to add or replace. Note that the "xx" in "N is xx", represents the new sample size, which will either be the size of the imported data set, or the total of the previous sample size combined with the sample size of the imported data, depending on whether you choose the "Replace" or "Append" option. 8.4.3 Leaving the result of a calculation out of the data set. As described above, when Data Entry is on the result of a calculation is added to the data set when you press ENTER. There is a way to perform calculations while Data Entry is on, without entering the result into the data set. To find the result of a calculation without entering it into the data set, press dots 123456 (Nemeth), dots 2356 (UK Braille and UEB) instead of ENTER. If you then want to add the result to the data set, press ENTER. 8.4.4 Clearing the Data Set. The purpose of clearing the data set is to allow you to begin with a new set of data items. To clear the data set, go to the Data Set Menu by pressing CONTROL with S and select the "Clear Data Set" option. If the data set has been modified prior to being cleared, KeyPlus will announce: "Existing data set has been modified. Save?." If you would like to save the modifications, press Y. You will then be prompted with: "Name of data set to save?." Type an appropriate name for the data set and press ENTER. KeyPlus will announce: "Clear Data Set. Sure?." To clear all the existing data items in the data set, press Y. If you have performed any statistical calculations, these will also be cleared at this point. 8.4.5 Statistical Functions. KeyPlus uses the data you enter to calculate the values for the following statistical functions. Also listed is the hot key that you use for each function in the Statistical Functions Review List and the Statistical Functions Menu. 1. Sample size (N); hotkey N. 2. Arithmetic mean; hotkey M. 3. Median; hotkey D. 4. Mode; hotkey O. 5. Minimum; hotkey I. 6. Maximum; hotkey X. 7. Sample Standard deviation; hotkey S. 8. Population Standard deviation; hotkey P. 9. Sum of values; hotkey V. 10. Sum of the square of the values; hotkey Q. For definitions of the above statistical functions, refer to 8.4.10 Definitions of Statistical Terms. 8.4.5.1 Reviewing the Statistical Functions. At any time while you are entering data or once you have finished, you can review the results of the statistical functions by pressing READ with S. What happens next depends on whether or not Data Entry is on. When Data Entry is on, the Statistical Functions Review List is announced and you can review the statistical results an item at a time by pressing SPACE repeatedly, or jump directly to a particular result by pressing its hot key. When Data Entry is off, the Statistical Functions Menu is announced. This allows you to review the statistical results by pressing SPACE repeatedly, as well as to select any result for use in a calculation. To select any result for use in a calculation, either press ENTER when the result is announced or enter the menu and press the hot key. For example, to calculate the mean plus 2 times the standard deviation follow these steps: 1. In the calculator ensure Data Entry is off and the calculator is cleared. 2. To enter the mean, select the Statistical Functions Menu by pressing READ with S. You can then either move along to “Mean” and press ENTER or just press the hot key for mean, which is M. You will be returned to the calculator with the mean inserted into your calculation. 3. Enter “plus 2 times” and insert the standard deviation by selecting the “Sample standard deviation” from the Statistical Functions Menu again. You will once again be returned to the calculator and the sample standard deviation will now be inserted into your calculation. 4. Finally press ENTER to obtain the result. To use a statistical result in another KeySoft application, use the clipboard. Simply review the result in the Statistical Functions Review List or the Statistical Functions Menu and copy the value to the clipboard by pressing CONTROL with C. Insert the result and paste the clipboard into the Word Processor, via the Block Commands Menu. Otherwise, move to the application in which you want to insert the result and paste the clipboard by pressing CONTROL with V. 8.4.6 Reviewing the Data Set. It is often easy to accidentally enter the wrong items or add data that is already in the data set. Also, you will often want to review your data using a method that differs from how the data was entered. KeyPlus offers three different ways to review your data: 1. The order you entered the data. 2. The frequency order. 3. The numeric order. KeyPlus has a Data Set Review Mode in which you can review the data, and if Data Entry is on, make changes. To enter the Data Set Review Mode, go to the Data Set Menu by pressing CONTROL with S and select Review Data Set. KeyPlus announces: “Data Set Review Mode. Entry Order” followed by the last data entry. To exit Data Set Review Mode and return to your calculation, press ESCAPE. You can review your data using the following commands: To go to the previous data item, press READ with U. To go to the next data item, press READ with O. To go to the first data item in the data set, press SPACE with dots 123 (BT), or READ with ; (QT). To go to the last data item in the data set, press READ with B. To find to a specific number in the data set, press READ with F, followed by the number and press ENTER. To find the next occurrence of the same number in the data set, press READ with N. To change the order in which the data items are presented, press READ with V. KeyPlus will prompt: "View data in which order? Currently Entry Order." Select the order you require. There are 3 options: 1. Entry Order (hotkey E)  lists the data items in the order that data was entered. 2. Frequency Order (hotkey F)  lists the data items by frequency, in descending order. This lets you review your data set in a frequency table format. For details on how to generate a frequency table, refer to 8.4.9 Generating a Frequency Table. 3. Numerical Order (hotkey N)  lists the data items by numerical values, in ascending order. If you change the order in which your data items are presented, KeyPlus will prompt: "Sorting data set items, please wait…Data set sorted."  8.4.7 Editing the Data Set. While reviewing your data, you may discover an incorrect entry that you want to edit or delete. To edit or delete data, Data Entry must be on and you must be in entry view. To edit the current data item, use KeySoft’s editing commands to make the cursor appear. Move the cursor, insert or delete, as required. When you have completed the edit, press ENTER. The item in the data set is now changed. To delete the current data item, press CONTROL with I. KeyPlus will provide a confirmation prompt and if you confirm the deletion, will delete the current number and the frequency it occurs from the data set. It will then announce the next data item. For example, if the current item is “5 frequency 4”, "Delete 5 frequency 4. Sure?", will be announced. If you press Y, the data item will be removed, and the unit will announce the next data item in the list. 8.4.8 Saving the Data Set. Saving data sets to files means that you can have multiple data sets and whichever one you require when you need it. You can also share data sets with other VoiceNote users and transfer them to PC or other systems to use from within spreadsheets or databases. You can insert them into documents as frequency tables, and so on. To save the data set, go to the Data Set Menu by pressing CONTROL with S and select "Save Data Set". If you have not previously saved a data set, KeyPlus will prompt: "Destination folder name? Press ENTER for Calculator Data Sets." Calculator Data Sets is offered as a handy place to keep your data. It is first created when you save a data set for the first time. Select this folder or another in the usual way. To change the drive on which this data set will be saved, press BACKSPACE. KeyPlus then prompts: "Name of data set to save?." If the data set was previously saved, KeyPlus will provide you with the most recently used data set name. Select the name offered by pressing ENTER or type an appropriate name for the data set and press ENTER. Note that a series of progress beeps may be heard if there is a large number of data items to save. The data set will be saved and you will be returned to the calculator. Data sets are saved in Comma Separated Values (CSV) format files. The first line of the file contains the words "Value" and "Frequency" separated by a comma and each subsequent line contains a value and a frequency separated by a comma. When you save a data set, the order of the data in the CSV file is the same as the order you currently have set for Review Mode. 8.4.9 Generating a Frequency Table. A frequency table can be automatically made up from the data set. To review your data set in a frequency table format, enter the Review Mode by selecting "Review Data Set" from the Data Set Menu. KeyPlus announces: “Data Set Review Mode. Entry Order” followed by the last data entry. You now need to change the view to Frequency Order. To change the order in which the data items are presented, press READ with V. KeyPlus will prompt: "View data in which order? Currently Entry Order." Type F or "frequency" to select the Frequency Order. The data items are now ordered by frequency, in descending order. You can then save the data items using the save option (as described in 8.4.8 Saving the Data Set). Once saved, go to the document and use Block Insert (that, is the "Insert a File" option in the Block Commands Menu) to insert the CSV file into your document or to the clipboard. You can now reformat the data, as required. 8.4.10 Definitions of Statistical Terms. As you probably know, Statistics is a mathematical science pertaining to collection, analysis, interpretation and presentation of data. Below are the terms that you will need to be familiar with in order to effectively use the statistics function of KeySoft. VALUE: A value is a number that is a measurable amount or quantity. In statistics, a set of values is what makes up a data set. FREQUENCY: The frequency is the number of times a value occurs and is represented by the letter N. DATA ITEM: A data item is made up of a "value" and a "frequency". DATA SET as represented by the symbols left set or opening curly brace, a group of numbers with commas in between them and right set or closing curly brace to close the set, that is {,,,}: The section of a population which is observed. For example, the number of goals scored in a hockey tournament is represented by the following data set: {0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 2, 2, 2, 2, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 4, 4, 4, 5, 5, 5} We can represent the above data set as follows: Number of goals = 0; Frequency = 4 Number of goals = 1; Frequency = 3 Number of goals = 2; Frequency = 4 Number of goals = 3; Frequency = 5 Number of goals = 4; Frequency = 3 Number of goals =5; Frequency = 3 It is often faster to enter a data set into the calculator by entering the value and frequency together. For example, rather than typing the value of 0 four times, we can type the value of 0 followed by a frequency separator, followed by the frequency. Once the above data is entered into the calculator, we can access the statistical functions menu to find out the average score, the most common score, how many games were played, etc. MAXIMUM: The maximum is the highest value in the data set. MEAN as represented by the Greek letter symbol, mu, italicized x with a bar above it, m or mean values: For a data set, the mean is the same as the average. It is the sum of all the values divided by the number of values. For example, the mean or average of 2, 3, 3, 5, 7 and 10, is 30 divided by 6, which is equal to 5. MEDIAN: A median in statistics, is the middle number in a group of numbers. At most, half the numbers in the group have values that are greater than the median, and half have values less than the median. For example, the median of 2, 3, 3, 5, 7 and 10, is equal to 4. MODE: The mode is the value that has the largest frequency. For example, the mode of 2, 3, 3, 5, 7, and 10, is 3. Note that there may be more than one mode in the data set or no mode at all if every number occurs to the same frequency. Where there is more than one mode, use the Frequency Order in review mode to view them. SAMPLE SIZE as represented by the letter N: The sample size is the total number of values in the data set. POPULATION STANDARD DEVIATION as represented by sigma, sigma with subscript n, or italicized x with sigma and subscript n: The population standard deviation is a measurement of the variability of data in a population. Population in statistics, refers to a set of potential measurements or values, including not only cases actually observed but those that are potentially observable. SAMPLE STANDARD DEVIATION as represented by italicized s, sigma with subscript n minus 1, or italicized x with sigma and subscript n minus 1: The sample standard deviation is a measurement of the variability of data in a sample. A sample differs from a population in that it is the part of a statistical population which is actually observed. Note that this type of standard deviation is the most commonly requested when the standard deviation is required in an equation. SUM OF VALUES as represented by capital sigma italicized, italicized x followed by subscript n: The sum of values is the total you get when all the individual values in the data set are added together. SUM OF THE SQUARE OF VALUES as represented by capital sigma italicized with italicized x followed by superscript two and subscript n: The sum of the square of values is the result you get when each individual value is squared (that is, multiplied by itself) and all the squares are added together. 8.5 Memory Operations. There are 10 separate memories for storing conversion factors, partial results, etc. They are numbered 0 to 9. The commands for memory number 1, for example, are as follows: Clear memory 1: C 1; Store number in memory 1: S 1; Add to memory 1: A 1; Recall contents of memory 1: R 1; Announce contents of memory, but do not use in calculation: SHIFT with R 1. 8.5.1 Clear Memory: C. This operation clears the particular memory immediately. For example to clear memory 5, press C, then 5. KeyPlus announces "Clear memory." "Clear which memory?" "5." 8.5.2 Store Memory: S. This completes the current calculation and stores the result in a memory. For example to calculate the result of 3 + 5 and store in Memory 4, press: 3 + 5S 4. When you press S, "Store memory" is announced. The resulting value of 8 is stored in memory number 4. 8.5.3 Add to Memory: A. This completes the current calculation and adds the result to the existing contents of a memory. For example after the previous example Memory 4 contains 8. Now to calculate 9 divided by 5, and to add the result to Memory 4, press: 9 / 5 A 4. When you press A, "Accumulate memory" is announced. The calculation is evaluated, resulting in 1.8. This is then added to Memory 4, to give a value in Memory 4 of 9.8. 8.5.4 Recall Memory: R. This is used to recall the value in a memory and insert it into the calculation. For example to divide the contents of memory 4 by 4 and store the result in Memory 1, press: R 4 / 4 S 1. This calculates 9.8 / 4 = 2.45 which is stored in Memory 1. 8.5.5 Announce Memory: SHIFT with R. This is used to announce the value in a memory at any time without affecting the current calculation. For example, if you press: SHIFT with R followed by 4. KeyPlus replies "Display Memory," "Display which memory?" "4. memory 4, nine point eight." but this does not affect any calculation in progress, which can continue. 8.6 Scientific Operations. Trigonometric, logarithmic and exponential functions are available, as well as squares, square roots, powers and roots. 8.6.1 Trigonometric Functions. The trigonometric functions can be calculated in either degrees or radians. To select degrees press D, to select radians press SHIFT with D. A setting stays in effect until it is superseded by another. The trigonometric functions provided are: Sine press CONTROL with T, S; Arc Sine press READ with T, S; Cosine press CONTROL with T, C; Arc Cosine press READ with T, C; Tangent press CONTROL with T, T; Arc Tangent press READ with T, T; PI press Y. Use the Announce Key mode to familiarize yourself with the location of the trigonometric keys. To calculate the sine of 30 degrees, press: D CONTROL with S 30 followed by ENTER. The result "0.5" is announced. If the calculator is already set to degrees, it is not necessary to precede the calculation with D. Note that the function applies only to the number immediately following. If you wanted to find the sine of the sum of two 15 degree angles, for example, you must put brackets around the addition as follows: D CONTROL with S (15+15) ENTER. The result "0.5" is announced. To calculate the Arc Tangent of 2, press: READ with T 2 followed by ENTER. The result "63.43495" is announced. To calculate the cosine of Pi radians divided by 3, press: SHIFT with D CONTROL with C ( Y / 3 ) followed by ENTER. The result "0.5" is announced. Pressing SHIFT with D selects radians mode. The parentheses causes KeyPlus to calculate PI / 3 before taking the cosine. 8.6.2 Square Roots and Squares. The square and square root keys are SHIFT with Q and Q respectively. To calculate the square root of the sum of 3 squared plus 4 squared, press: Q ( 3 SHIFT with Q + 4 SHIFT with Q ) followed by ENTER. The result "5" is announced. The square root operator precedes its number, while the squared operator occurs after its number, following the written convention. 8.6.3 Decimal Exponent. Very large or very small numbers are often expressed in scientific notation as a power of 10. For example, the number 4000 is equal to 4 x 1000, which may be written as 4 x 10 to the power of 3. This number could be entered into a calculation by pressing: 4 ^ 3, that is, 4 followed by SHIFT 6, followed by 3. Similarly, the number 0.05 could be entered by pressing 5 ^ N2, that is, 5 followed by SHIFT 6, followed by N, followed by 2. 8.6.4 Powers and Roots. These functions are assigned as follows: x to the power of y: Press X; x to the power of 1/y: Press SHIFT with X. For example, to calculate 3 to the power of 4, press: 3 X 4 followed by ENTER. The result "81" is announced. Parentheses can be used where y is a compound expression. For example, to calculate 2 to the power of 6 + 8, press: 2 X (6 + 8) followed by ENTER. The result "16,384" is announced. To calculate the cube root of 27, press: 2 7 SHIFT with X 3 followed by ENTER. The result "3" is announced. 8.6.5 Logarithmic Functions. The following logarithmic functions are provided: Log base e: press E; e to the power of: press SHIFT with E; Log base 10: press T; 10 to the power of: press SHIFT with T. For example, to calculate the log base e of 10 and save the result in Memory 2, press: E 1 0 S 2 followed by ENTER. The result "2.302585" is announced. Now calculate e to the power of 2.302585. Press: SHIFT with E R 2 followed by ENTER. The result "10" is announced. Similarly, to calculate log base 10 of 2 and store the result in memory 3, press: T 2 S 3 followed by ENTER. The result "0.30103" is announced. Now calculate 10 to the power of 0.30103. Press: SHIFT with T R 3 followed by ENTER. The result "2" is announced. 8.7 Inserting a Result or a Calculation. Suppose that you are writing a letter, and you want to do a calculation and include the result in the letter. How would you do that? You could do the calculation before starting the letter. Alternatively, you could begin the letter and then switch from the Word Processor to the calculator by pressing FUNCTION with 5, do the sum and then switch back to the letter by pressing FUNCTION with 4. When you get to the point in the letter where you want to include the result of your calculation, press FUNCTION with I for the Insert Menu, then I for Insert field, and C to insert from the Calculator. KeyPlus prompts: "Insert result or whole calculation?" Press R to insert the Result or C to insert the whole calculation. The most recent result from the calculator are inserted into the document, which saves you having to remember and retype it. End of Scientific Calculator Chapter. 9 Planner. KeyPlan is a pageperday planner, which allows you to make notes and reminders for each day of the year. You can also enter appointments for particular times, reschedule them, and include an audible alarm with any appointment. Appointments can be single events or recurring right out until the year 9999. And all of this information can be shared with Microsoft Outlook's calendar via a synchronization function we call KeySync, which is discussed in detail in 13.15 KeySync. The commands you use with the planner are similar to those used in KeyWord. Planner pages are formatted as Braille documents, and you can use grade 1, grade 2, or Computer Braille as you wish. 9.1 Entering the Planner. To enter the Planner, select it from the Main Menu by pressing P. This will take you to the KeyPlan Menu. Or you can open the Planner directly from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with 6. 9.2 The KeyPlan Menu. When you select the Planner from the Main Menu, your VoiceNote mPower QT announces "KeyPlan Menu." Open planner; Setup options. If you want to make entries in the planner or review its contents, choose "Open planner." This option is described first. If you enter the Planner by pressing FUNCTION with 6, you will go directly to the "Open Planner" option. 9.3 Selecting a Date. When you select the "Open" option, KeyPlan announces: "Day? Press ENTER for (today's date)." Before pressing ENTER, you can choose a different date by either typing it in as described in the next section, or by moving around the calendar, as follows: By day back or forward, use LEFT or RIGHT ARROW; By week, use UP or DOWN ARROW; By month, use PAGE UP or PAGE DOWN; By year, use TAB or SHIFT with TAB. When the required date is announced, press ENTER to select it. 9.3.1 Entering the Date. Instead of moving around the calendar to find the required date, you can type a date as: You can use a 3letter abbreviation for the month, such as: 25 dec 06, or dec 25 06 Or you can type the month name in full: 25 december 06 or december 25 06 You can also use numbers separated by a slash or a space in the form: 25 12 06, or 12 25 06, and 25/12/06 or 12/25/06 depending on the KeySoft date format you have set. If you omit the year, then the current year is assumed. When you have selected or typed the date, press ENTER and you are placed in the required planner page. If you have selected today's date, the cursor is placed at the beginning of the next appointment for today, if one exists. This allows you to check your next appointment very quickly. For other dates, the cursor will be at the top of the page, ahead of any existing entries. 9.3.1.1 Going to Today's date. There is a quick way of going directly to today's date from anywhere in the planner. Whatever day you are currently on, if in the Planner itself, return to the calendar by pressing ESCAPE. At the prompt "KeyPlan Calendar. Date? Press ENTER for (date)", type "today" and press ENTER. This will take you directly to today's planner page. 9.3.2 Page Layout. The planner is laid out as a pageperday desk planner. Each day starts on a new page. The date appears on the first line. On the next line are any general notes or reminders that can use as many lines as required. These are called "allday events" and are not associated with any particular time. The scheduled appointments then follow. Each of these starts on a new line, and begins with a time. The appointment details follow on the same line. Here is an example: "Friday January 27 2006 All day: Mike's Birthday. All day: Sarah in interviews all day Don't forget to clear her voicemail. 10:0011:00 am Team meeting 12:301:15 pm Lunch with Bob 7:3011:00 pm Movies Return of the King Reading 2, meeting in foyer." When an appointment is scheduled or rescheduled, it is placed on the correct page, and is sorted into time order with other entries. 9.3.3 Making Notes on a Particular Day. Notes are recorded as allday events and KeyPlan precedes them with the words "allday:". They are not associated with any particular time during that day. To make notes on any page of the planner, first select the date. The cursor is placed ahead of any text that may already be on the page. If the page is blank, then just start typing. If there is already text on the page, check that the cursor is in the right place before typing. As soon as you start typing, KeyPlan will automatically schedule an allday event for you. You can move the cursor to a different point in the text by using the cursor movement commands. These are similar to KeyWord commands. When you have finished typing an entry, you do not need to press ENTER unless you require a new line. If you have selected today's date, the cursor is placed on a scheduled appointment, if one exists. You can use the cursor movement commands to move the cursor, or you can go to the top of the page by pressing READ with T. 9.3.4 Scheduling an AllDay Event. You can set up an allday event with the properties of an appointment, such as recurrence, or being marked as busy or out of office. Please note that the default setting for AllDay appointments is set to "free" as it is in MS Outlook. This is because typically people use this function for events such as traveling, birthdays or other anniversaries, and reminders rather than actual appointments where they will be busy. Remember that AllDay means midnight to midnight, not just 8am to 5pm. This means that the AllDay event or appointment alarm will go off at midnight! To prevent this from happening, either set a warning time so that the alarm goes off the day before, or schedule a reminder appointment instead. If you have already set up the allday event, put the cursor into the text. Select Review or Modify this appointment by pressing CONTROL with R. This will give you all of the scheduling options. If you are setting the appointment up from scratch, when scheduling the appointment, specify an appointment time of L for allday. From there continue as normal. Full directions on scheduling an appointment are in the next section of this User Guide. 9.4 Scheduling Appointments. An appointment is made up of a group of settings that the user defines. These include date, start time, end time, title, location etc. The process of scheduling an appointment is basically going through the list of these settings and defining each setting. You don't have to go through all the settings to make an appointment, in fact they are ordered so that you cover the mandatory settings first and can exit and save by pressing ESCAPE at any point after you have set the date, time, and title. Like all lists in KeySoft, you can move back and forward by pressing BACKSPACE and SPACE. However, if you follow the procedure below, you will see that KeyPlan steps you through the settings logically and easily. If you wish to change any setting you have made before exiting and saving, use the back and forward commands to return to the setting and make the change. KeyPlan assumes you wish to schedule the appointment on the date of the planner page you are currently in, and so jumps directly to the time setting. To schedule an appointment in KeyPlan, follow this procedure: 1. From any planner page, select Schedule an appointment by pressing CONTROL with ENTER. 2. KeyPlan prompts: "Appointment time?." The way you enter appointment times should agree with the setting of 12 or 24 hour format, which is announced when you press HELP. You can enter a time without using number signs, in the form: hh:mm where "hh" is hours and "mm" is minutes, separated by a colon. You can abbreviate an entry with fewer digits or no colon if it is unambiguous. In 12 hour format, follow the minutes by a space and then a or p, to denote a.m. and p.m. Note that if you use an abbreviated form for an a.m. time, for example 7a for 7:00 am, type a letter sign before the a or it will be read as a 1. And if you forget to type a or p, KeySoft will prompt you to do so. For an allday event, type L instead of a time. Before you enter a time, you can change the day or date of your appointment by pressing BACKSPACE. KeySoft prompts: "Appointment Day? Press ENTER for (current day and date)." A calendar is being presented. If the offered date is correct, just press ENTER. Otherwise, move around the calendar to the required date, or type it, and then press ENTER. 3. KeySoft prompts: "End time or length? Press ENTER for (time) 30 minutes." where (time) is the time 30 minutes after the appointment time. The default length is 30 minutes, but you can change this. You can type a number by itself for minutes, or follow the number with h for a number of hours, d for days or w for weeks. For h and d, put a letter sign or space between the number – this is not necessary for m and w. To enter a finishing time, type the time in the same format as the appointment time. Press ENTER to go to the next field. Note: If you want to set a different end date, you can either press BACKSPACE as soon as you hear the End Time or length prompt, or set the end time and then press BACKSPACE twice. 4. KeySoft prompts: "Appointment title?." Type the reason for this appointment and press ENTER. If necessary, you can add more notes about this appointment after you have finished scheduling it. 5. KeySoft then prompts: "Location?." This is not a mandatory field. Either type the location and press ENTER, or simply press ENTER. 6. KeySoft prompts: "Recurrence? Press ENTER for once." For a one off appointment, press ENTER. For more information on recurring appointments, refer to 9.5 Recurring Appointments. 7. KeySoft prompts: "Set an alarm on this appointment? Press ENTER for N." If you do not, press N. If you want to set an alarm, press Y, and KeySoft prompts: "Warning time? Press ENTER for n (time)," where "n" is the suggested interval of time (for example 30 minutes) and (time) is the actual time at which it would ring (for example 7:30pm). To change the setting, type either a time in the usual format, or a number of minutes, or a number followed by h for hours, d for days or w for weeks. For h and d, put a letter sign or space before the letter – this is not necessary for m and w. Press ENTER. 8. KeySoft then prompts: "Show time as? Press ENTER for busy." The options are free = f, tentative = t, busy = b and out of office = o. These settings let you know the level of availability you will have with this appointment. If you select "free", you will be able to schedule an overlapping appointment without any reminders from KeySoft. For the other options, KeySoft will remind you at the time setting and at the point of saving the appointment, but it won't prevent you from scheduling it. 9. KeySoft then prompts: "Mark as Private? Press ENTER for No". To mark as Private, press Y. 10. KeySoft prompts: "End of List". At this point, to schedule the appointment, press ESCAPE. KeySoft prompts: "Schedule this appointment?" Press Y or N. KeySoft announces: "Appointment scheduled." The time is inserted in the planner page, on a new line, followed by the title and location. The appointment is sorted into the correct time order for the current date, and the cursor is placed just after the new entry. 9.4.1 Making Notes on an Appointment. You can make notes on any appointment at any time by placing the cursor in the time and title line and pressing ENTER. From there, simply type your notes. If you have only just scheduled the appointment, the cursor will already be in the time and title line. When the notes are complete, you will exit when you press ESCAPE, which will take you to the top of the day, or perform any other command such as Scheduling another appointment, using any "go to" or "move" commands etc. 9.4.2 Making another entry. To make another entry, press CONTROL with ENTER again. The new entry is sorted into order with existing entries. You can set as many appointments as you wish. 9.5 Recurring Appointments. A recurring appointment is one that is repeated in a regular pattern of times determined by the user. You can schedule your appointment according to dates, or patterns of days, weeks, months or years – for example an event may be on the 25th of every month, or on the third Thursday of every month, or every 25th of March, or every day at 9am, etc. There is a pattern of recurrence to cover just about every type of recurring event you could think of. For the sake of clarity, we will refer to any use of calendar days as dates – for example the 6th or the 23rd, and we will use the word "pattern" to describe other intervals such as the third Friday in the month, or the last Thursday in November. 9.5.1 Recurring patterns. Apart from "once" which of course is not recurring at all, the options for a recurring event are: Daily, Weekly, Monthly or Yearly. Each of these is described and relevant instructions given below. 9.5.1.1 Daily. Daily means any pattern based on a number of days. This could be every day, or every second day, every 5 days etc. At the prompt “Days between occurrences? Press ENTER for 1 day(s)", The default setting is 1 day. To change this, type the number of days of your choice. For example, for every second day, type 2. 9.5.1.2 Weekly. Weekly means any recurring event that happens weekly, or in a weekly pattern. For example, every Monday, every week day, or every second week on a Thursday. At the prompt “Recur on which days? Press ENTER for x y z" where x y z are any days you require, type any of the following, with a space between if more than one (and in any order): Sunday = Su; Monday = Mo; Tuesday = Tu; Wednesday = We; Thursday = Th; Friday = Fr; Saturday = Sa; every day = v; weekdays = d (Monday through Friday) and weekend days = e (Saturday and Sunday). For example, if your appointment is every Monday, Tuesday and Thursday, you would type "Mo Tu Th". If it were every Saturday and Sunday, type "e" for weekend days. Note: you can type initial letters only for Monday, Wednesday or Friday as they are the only day names starting with M, W or F. You can also type more or all of the name of a day, for example, Thurs or Thursday. At the prompt “Weeks between occurrences? Press ENTER for n” type the number of weeks if different from the default n. For example if it occurs weekly, type 1, if fortnightly, type 2 etc. 9.5.1.3 Monthly. Monthly recurrence includes dates, or patterns of days or weeks scheduled on a monthly basis. For example, every 20th of the month, or every third Thursday, or the second week, or even the last weekend day, are all monthly events. 1. When you select Monthly, KeyPlan prompts: "Recur on day x of the month?" where x is the date you originally selected. To choose this option press Y for Yes then go to step 4, otherwise press N and go to step 2. 2. KeyPlan prompts: “Week of recurrence? Press ENTER for x”. where x is the correct week for the original date selected. The options are: first, second, third, fourth, last. Either press ENTER, or cycle through the options using CONTROL with SPACE, or press the hotkey for your choice. These are: first = 1; second = 2; third = 3; fourth = 4; last = l. No number sign required. Press ENTER. 3. KeyPlan prompts: “Day of recurrence? Press ENTER for x” where x is the day of the week of the original date selected. Options are the days of the week, weekday, weekend day, or day (refer to note above). To make a selection, cycle through by pressing CONTROL with SPACE then ENTER. 4. KeySoft then prompts “Months between occurrences? Press ENTER for n” where n is 1 by default. Either press ENTER or type the new number and then press ENTER. 9.5.1.4 Yearly When setting a yearly recurring event, you have a choice of a date, or a month based pattern. You already selected a date when setting up the appointment initially, for example every 8 February. KeyPlan prompts: "Recur on February 8 each year? Press ENTER for Yes." For Yes, press ENTER as stated. If you want to schedule a pattern, press N for No. KeyPlan assumes you have scheduled the correct month in the beginning. KeyPlan prompts: “Week of recurrence? Press ENTER for x.” The options are: first, second, third, fourth, last. Either press ENTER, or cycle through the options using CONTROL with SPACE, or press the hotkey for your choice. These are: first = 1; second = 2; third = 3; fourth = 4; last = l. No number sign required. Press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: “Day of recurrence? Press ENTER for x.” where x is the day of the selected appointment date. Options are the days of the week, weekday, weekend day, or day. To make a selection, cycle through by pressing CONTROL with SPACE then ENTER. 9.5.2 Number of Recurrences. Having set up the pattern, KeyPlan now wishes to know how many times the event will recur. You have four choices: “End of recurrence? Press ENTER for none”, "None" – With this option, the event will recur right out until the end of 9999. “# occurrences” – with this option, type the number of times the event recurs in digits, the maximum being 999. “date” –With this option, type in the date when you wish the last recurring event to occur, or to occur before, in usual date format. If the date you select does not fall in the recurring pattern, the last appointment will be the one immediately before it. For example, if your appointment is always on the second Tuesday of the month, but you specify 31 December 2006 as the end date, the last recurrence will be the second Tuesday of December 2005, which is the 12th. "length" – You can specify the length of time by a number of days or weeks. To do this, type the number and then D or M, for example 6 weeks is 6w and 15 days is 15d. Or, you can press the relevant hotkey as many times as the number. The hotkeys are: Days = RIGHT ARROW; Weeks = DOWN ARROW; Months = PAGE DOWN; Years = SHIFT with TAB. For example, for six months, press PAGE DOWN six times. Press ENTER. At this point you will be back into the normal Scheduling appointment procedure. 9.5.3 Recurring Appointments scheduled in Outlook. If you are using KeySync to synchronize your calendar with MS Outlook's, you will find that recurring appointments that "come across" from Outlook will take exactly the same form as above, and you can modify and change them as you wish in KeyPlan. 9.5.4 Moving between Recurring Appointments. It is very likely that you will want to move through the occurrences of a recurring appointment, and there are commands to do this that work when the cursor is in the time and title line of an instance of the appointment. To move to the next occurrence of the appointment, press SHIFT with READ with O. To move to the previous occurrence, press SHIFT with READ with U. 9.5.5 Notes on Recurring Appointments. These notes explain how recurring appointments behave differently to ordinary appointments in the following circumstances: 9.5.5.1 Alarm Warning Time. In a recurring appointment, the alarm warning time must be shorter than the interval between occurrence. For example – recurring appointment is 5pm daily, a warning time of 25 hours would have the alarm sound before the previous occurrence of the recurring appointment. 9.5.5.2 Modifications and Exceptions. If you modify just one instance of a recurring appointment in any way at all, it creates an exception. If later you then modify the date, start or end time, and/or recurrence interval of all recurrences of that same appointment, the exception will be overwritten by a normal instance. 9.5.5.3 Privacy Setting. When reviewing or modifying just one instance of a recurring appointment, the privacy setting is not offered for modification. This is because Outlook doesn't allow exceptions to this setting. However when reviewing or modifying all occurrences, then you can change it. 9.6 Reviewing the Appointments. 9.6.1 The Review Commands. Most KeySoft review commands are available in the planner, but two groups of commands are unique: To read all planner entries for the: Previous day: READ with 7; Current day: ; Next day: READ with 9. To read the planner entries within a particular day: Previous entry: READ with U; Current entry: READ with I; Next entry: READ with O. These actions will read one complete appointment, or allday event. The previous and next commands will move the cursor to the beginning of the new appointment or line. Repeated use of the previous or next commands will move the cursor through the planner. A beep will indicate that there are no more entries to read in the calendar. Note: The calendar goes out to the year 9999, so it might pay to put an end time on recurring appointments if you ever want to hear that beep! Note however that if the cursor is in the notes of an appointment, these commands will take you to the next, previous or current sentence or line, as they do in KeyWord. To move the cursor to the top or the bottom of the current day, press READ with T, or READ with B. Likewise, when in the notes of an appointment, these commands will take you to the top or bottom of the notes. To speak continuously, press READ with G. To stop the VoiceNote mPower QT speaking at any time, press READ with SPACE. To confirm the date of the current planner page, and how many days away from today's date, press READ with Q. Press this command again to get the interval of time stated in weeks and days. Note: These two commands can be used to check how much time there is to go in the year or how much time has passed, simply by using the 1st January or the 31st December of the current year as the reference dates. 9.6.2 Checking Your Next Appointment. You can check the details of your next appointment from any point in KeySoft, without losing your place in your current activity. To do this, press FUNCTION with N. This command recognizes appointments showing their time as busy, out of office or tentative, but not those marked as free. KeyPlan will tell you whether you have any, any more, no, or no more appointments for the day, if you are in a current appointment time, when the next appointment is and on what date and time, and when the next alarm is scheduled for if it is not associated with the next appointment. When you are finished you are returned to the same place in your original activity. The other way of checking just your current or next appointment for the current day is to enter the planner and select today's date in the calendar. This places you at the current or next appointment of the day, if there is one. 9.6.3 Overlapping Appointments. Overlapping appointments occur when two appointments are scheduled with an overlapping start or end time. KeyPlan only recognizes appointments as overlapping if neither are set to show their time as free. As mentioned before, KeyPlan will warn you that you are about to schedule an overlapping appointment but won't stop you from doing so. And of course the synchronization process may also cause overlapping appointments. This is discussed fully in 13.15.5.1 Overlapping Appointments. While in the planner, you can find the next or previous occurrence of an overlapping appointment. The commands are: Go to next overlapping appointment: CONTROL with READ with O. Go to previous overlapping appointment: READ with CONTROL with U. When you go to the overlapping appointment, KeyPlan will announce its date, time, title and location. To hear the appointment with which it is overlapping, press CONTROL with READ with O again. The same command will take you to the earlier of the next pair of overlapping appointments. To resolve an overlapping appointment situation, simply modify one or both appointments in the usual way, as described in 9.7.3 Modifying an Appointment. 9.6.4 Calendar or Appointment Information. There are two quick ways to get information about either a day in the calendar or a specific appointment. These are by using the information command READ with I, and READ with Q. When the cursor is in the date line of a calendar page, you can access the following information: Press READ with I for the number of appointments and number of allday events, when the first appointment starts and the last appointment finishes. Press READ with Q for the date and how many days away from the current date. Press the command again for the interval of time stated in weeks and days. When the cursor is in an appointment, you can access the following information: Press READ with I for a summary of recurrences and alarm status. Press READ with Q for the date and time of the appointment and how many days away from the current date. Press the command again for the interval of time stated in weeks and days. 9.6.5 Finding an Appointment. You may need to find an appointment whose date you have forgotten. If you remember a word, name or phrase in the text, then you can use the Find command, READ with F, to find it. If the text is found, you can read the details by pressing READ with I, and you can query the date by pressing READ with Q. The text can appear more than once in the planner, so you may not find the required appointment on the first try. To continue the search, press READ with N. 9.7 Changing an Existing Appointment. After you have created an appointment or allday event, you can edit the text of its notes, review or modify its time, date or other properties, or cancel it altogether. These functions are all outlined in this section. 9.7.1 Editing an Appointment. After you have made an entry in the planner, you can edit, delete, move or change the layout of its text. Most of the KeySoft editing commands are available in KeyPlan. These can be used to make changes to the text of an appointment, but not to change the time and date of an appointment itself. In the case of recurring appointments, changes made this way will only affect the appointment you are in; to change all recurrences you need to use the "Review or Modify Appointment" option. As with the review commands, there are some minor differences to the edit commands. For example, CONTROL with I, which in the Word Processor is "delete to end of sentence," or "delete to end of line," depending on the Reading Mode, cancels the appointment if the cursor is in the subject line, or deletes to the end of the line or sentence if the cursor is in a note. 9.7.2 Cutting, Pasting and Deleting using block commands. The marking, cutting and pasting operations that are available elsewhere in KeySoft also work in KeyPlan. Because the Planner is not just a document, however, these operations behave a little differently. You can copy, cut and paste the title or notes from one appointment to another, but you can't use this method to move an appointment in total. However you can copy a whole appointment and paste it into an email or word document. You can also mark an entire appointment or block of appointments and delete it using the CONTROL with B then D Delete block command. It is wise to note, however, that if you use this function to delete a recurring appointment, it will only delete that one instance of the appointment. Doing this will use more storage space than leaving the recurring appointment in the planner. You can mark a block and change its language (for multilingual users) and/or Braille grade as elsewhere in KeySoft, but only one appointment at a time. The Block Commands are detailed in 7.5.1 Block Commands Menu and. 9.7.3 Modifying an Appointment. This option allows you to reschedule the date or time, change the recurring pattern, alarm status, location etc of any appointment. Position the cursor anywhere in the appointment you wish to modify, and press CONTROL with R. If the appointment is a recurring one, you will now be asked if you wish to modify just this one, or all instances. For just this one, press J, for all instances, press A. You will be presented with the same prompts and steps as for creating an appointment, the difference being that you will be offered the current appointment's options as defaults at each prompt. Simply change the ones you wish to change and pass over the others by pressing ENTER. To cancel an appointment, position the cursor in the appointment you wish to cancel, enter the Appointment menu by pressing CONTROL with I. KeySoft prompts: "Cancel this appointment (title). Sure?" To cancel, press Y, to abort, press N. If the appointment is part of a recurring pattern, KeySoft will then prompt: "Cancel all occurrences or just this one?" For all, press A, for just the currently selected instance, press J. 9.8 Selecting Another Date. There are two ways to select another date. Assuming you are already in the planner, you can return to the Calendar Day selection prompt by pressing ESCAPE, and then select or Braille the required date, or you can move forwards or backwards to a different date by using the "Go to" command, READ with R. When you press READ with R KeySoft prompts: "Go where?." Press F for forwards, or B for back. Follow this with D, W, M or Y, to move a day, week, month or year, and then press ENTER. You can also put a number and space before the D, W, M or Y (that is, Day, Week, Month or Year). For example, to move forward 3 days, use the following: READ with R, f, 3, SPACE, D, ENTER. To find where the cursor is currently located, press READ with Q. Today's date and day of the week can be checked from any point in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with D. You also have the option of typing a number after the D, W, M or Y. If you do not specify forward or back, information will be taken as an absolute value, for example W 10 will take you to week 10 of the current year. If you want to go to week 10 of another year in the future you would type the year before the week. For instance, Y2008 W10. 9.9 Alarms. 9.9.1 Setting an Alarm. When you schedule an appointment, setting an alarm is one of the steps you go through. You can set an alarm on an appointment that is already set up through modifying an appointment. 9.9.2 When Alarms Sound. An alarm rings at its programmed time, even if the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. The speaker and the headphones sound the alarm. Unlike speech, the speaker sounds the alarm even if the headphones are plugged in. If not acknowledged, the alarm continues ringing for a length of time called the "Alarm ringing time." It is then silent until: the "Alarm repeat time" has elapsed, OR; a key is pressed, OR; the machine is switched on; In which case it sounds again. See 9.9.4 Alarm Set Up The maximum number of times an alarm can cycle is set to 10. This is to prevent an alarm causing unnecessary battery drain. 9.9.3 Acknowledging an Alarm. If the VoiceNote mPower QT was on standby when the alarm sounds, it turns itself on and brings up the alarm options menu: To cancel the alarm: press C; To read and hear appointment details without canceling: press R; To postpone the alarm for 10 minutes: press SPACE. If the VoiceNote mPower QT is on when the alarm sounds, first acknowledge it by pressing READ with SPACE together. You are then automatically placed in the Alarm options menu. There are four items that you can select by pressing their initial letter. They are: Cancel the alarm; Read and hear the appointment details without canceling; Postpone the alarm. A number of minutes will be offered; to change it, type a new number of minutes (number sign not required). Go to the corresponding appointment in the planner. The alarm is cancelled, and the cursor is placed at the start of the appointment so that you can read its details. 9.9.4 Alarm Set Up. The ringing and repeat times have the same values for all alarms. To review or change the values, first move to the KeyPlan menu. In the KeyPlan Menu select "Setup options" and KeySoft enters the "KeyPlan setup list." The first item on the list is alarm volume. KeyPlan announces: "Alarm volume? 24." To change the alarm volume, type a new value between 5 and 32 where 5 is quietest and 32 is loudest, and press ENTER. To test the volume, go back to the alarm volume item and press CONTROL with T. The next item on the list is the alarm ringing time. KeyPlan announces: "Alarm ringing time? 30 seconds." This is the length of time an alarm sounds before it turns itself off. To change the value, type the required duration in seconds and press ENTER. The value can be between 5 and 600. A number sign is optional. The second item in the list is: "Alarm repeat period? 5 minutes." This is the period of time for which an unacknowledged alarm will be silent before it sounds again. To change the value, type the required duration in minutes and press ENTER. The value can be between 1 and 60. 9.10 Embossing and Printing. Any part of the planner can be embossed or printed. This section refers to embossing, but the procedure for printing is the same. To emboss part of the planner, first move to the KeyPlan menu, and then select: "Emboss planner." KeyPlan prompts: "Emboss or Setup Embosser?." The Emboss option leads to a series of prompts to select the dates to emboss. The Set Up option allows the VoiceNote mPower QT to be setup to match your embosser. This is the same as the Set Up option presented when embossing a document and is described in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. If you have already setup your VoiceNote mPower QT for embossing documents, you do not need to set it up again. Assuming that the embosser has already been set up, you may proceed to emboss part of the planner. Press E for Emboss, and KeySoft prompts: "Emboss from which date? Press ENTER for (date)," You can accept the date suggested, or type a different date, or choose the starting date from the calendar that is being presented. The next prompt is: "Emboss up to and including which date?." Select a finishing date, or if you prefer, a length of time from the start date. When "Embosser ready?" is announced, press Y and embossing begins. The default number of print or emboss copies is one. If you want more than one copy, press N, and you are prompted for the number of copies. Enter a number, press ENTER, and you are placed at the "Embosser ready?" prompt again. Press Y and the embosser should start immediately. Only dates with planner entries and the final date in the specified range will be embossed or printed, and each embossed or print page will show as many days as will fit. End of Planner Chapter. 10 Address List. KeyList is an address list manager. It allows you to enter addresses, phone numbers and other data against a person's name. You can review and edit the information, sort it, and copy it to KeyWord or KeyPlan. It is also possible to synchronize your Address List with an MS Outlook Contacts list – see 13.15 KeySync. To enter the Address List from the Main Menu, use the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys to review the items in the menu, until "Address List" is announced, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, you can select the Address List from the Main Menu by pressing A. You can switch directly to the Address List from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with 7. If you leave the Address List by switching directly to another application, such as the Word Processor, then pressing FUNCTION with 7 will return you to the same point in the Address List. VoiceNote mPower QT announces "KeyList Menu". This menu comprises 6 options as follows: Add address. Look up address. Copy addresses. Emboss addresses. Print addresses. Select KeyList file. The following chapter describes these options. If you are using KeyList for the first time, the address list is empty until you have added some addresses. 10.1 Adding an Address. This option allows you to enter contact details; last name, first name, and a list of other information. Each item of information, such as a phone number, is called a "field". Up to 25 fields can be associated with a last name to form a contact "record". At the KeyList menu, select "Add address." KeyList announces: "Entry list for Address List." Move to the first item in the list by pressing SPACE, and KeyList prompts you for a Last name. Type a last name and press ENTER. You are then prompted for text to enter into the following fields. For any field other than the last name field, you can enter text or skip the field by pressing SPACE. The complete list of fields for an address record is as follows: Last Name First name Middle Name Title Home Phone Business Phone Cell Phone Home Email Business Email Home Fax Business Fax Street Address Street Address Line 2 Street Address Line 3 City State or County Zip or Postcode Home Country Business Title Company Name Department Business Street Address Business Street Address Line 2 Business Street Address Line 3 Business City Business State or County Business Zip or Postcode Business Country Web Page Notes For each field, type the information and press ENTER. You are then asked for the next field. When you come to the Notes field, press ENTER to select it. You can then write, edit or read the notes, and return to the list by pressing ESCAPE. Remember that names and addresses may be printed at some stage, so it is good practice to capitalize proper names as appropriate. KeySoft will put one in if you don't. All fields except Last name are optional, so if you wish to skip a field, just press SPACE to move to the next one. You can review the list by pressing BACKSPACE to move back, and SPACE to move forward. When you are satisfied, add the new record by pressing CONTROL with ENTER. KeyList announces, "Record added", and you are returned to the KeyList menu. If you wish to add another record, press A and repeat the previous procedure. 10.2 Looking Up an Address. 10.2.1 Searching by Surname. At the KeyList menu, select "Lookup Address". KeyList announces: "Selection list for Address List". Move to the first item in the list by pressing SPACE, and KeyList prompts: "Last name?" You are being asked for data which is used to find matching records. We deal with a simple case, and return to more complex searches later. For example, you may want to review the records of all people called "Smith". In this case, type "smith" at the last name prompt, and press ENTER. The first name and last name of the first person in the address list called "Smith" is announced. You can move through the list of "Smiths" by pressing RIGHT ARROW. Each press announces his or her first name, followed by the last name, in this case "Smith". Only records which match the selection list are displayed. A beep indicates when there are no more matching last names. To review the other fields in a particular record, press SPACE repeatedly. Only fields containing an entry are announced. The format of each item comprises the name of the field, such as "Company name", followed by the entry, such as "Yoyodyne Inc." The movement commands are as follows: To move to the previous record: LEFT ARROW. To move to the next record: RIGHT ARROW. To move to the previous field: BACKSPACE or UP ARROW. To move to the next field: SPACE or DOWN ARROW . To jump to any field: Press the first letter of the field name. For example, H for Home phone number, Home email address or Home fax number. When reviewing using speech you can use the following commands: To hear the current record: READ with 8. To read the next record: READ with 9. To read the previous record: READ with 7. To hear the next field: READ with O. To hear the current field: READ with I. To hear the previous field: READ with U. To hear the next word: READ with L. To hear the current word: READ with K (Press twice to spell current word.) To hear the previous word: READ with J. When you have finished listening to a selection, you can return to the selection list by pressing ESCAPE. You are asked for another Last name. If you have finished searching, you can return to the KeyList menu by pressing ESCAPE again. 10.2.2 Record Matching. The information which you enter into the Lookup Selection List is used to find matching records. You may include as much or as little data in the List as you wish. For example, when looking up a telephone number, you might specify just the person's last name. To start the search, press ENTER and the first person with that last name is announced. If necessary, move through the other entries for that last name by pressing RIGHT ARROW, until you locate the one with the required first name. Then press either H or B to move to the home phone number field or business phone number field. You need only type the first few characters in a field rather than the whole field. For example, if you just type S in the Surname field, you are able to access the records of all people whose surnames begin with S. You can search for all people who work for a particular company. At the lookup selection list, don't specify a surname, but press SPACE repeatedly until the prompt: "Company name?" is announced and then type the company name and press ENTER. You can then use RIGHT ARROW to move through all the people who work for that company. 10.2.3 Wildcard search. You can also search for a name fragment within a field, using the multicharacter wild card for the unknown first part. For example, you may remember a company as: "Something and Fox, Incorporated". If you press *, followed by "fox" in the company name field, you should have a very short list of records to review. When setting up the Lookup Selection List, you can move forward and backward through the entries without changing their values. Press SPACE or BACKSPACE to do this. To change an entry, just type the required setting. When the Selection List is to your satisfaction, start the lookup by pressing ENTER and the first match is announced. For example, you may wish to announce all entries in your address list with a last name of Smith that live in the city of Seattle. To do this type “Smith” in the last name field, then press SPACE until the City field is announced. Type “Seattle”, and press ENTER. All records matching your search criteria will be presented. 10.2.4 Clearing a Field. Any fields used in a Lookup will be offered as a suggestion for the next search, unless you exit to the KeyList Menu between searches. You may want to blank out a previouslyused field so it is not used in the next search. To do this, move to the required field using FUNCTION with O and press the Clear Field command, CONTROL with BACKSPACE. 10.3 Changing a Field or Adding More Information. First we will look at changing an existing field, as would be the case, for example, if you wished to change a person's phone number. From the "Lookup address" option, select the person's record you wish to modify, then move to the field to be changed. Press CONTROL with K or CONTROL with I, and you are asked for a new entry for this field. There are three options here: 1. Type a new entry and press ENTER. 5. Edit the old field which is offered as the suggestion, as described in 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. . 6. Clear the field by pressing CONTROL with BACKSPACE, followed by ENTER. This puts you in an entry list so you can modify or add to any other field as well. You have the same three options for all the fields and you can change any other field in the record. The second scenario is where you wish to add an additional field to an existing record. From the "Lookup address" option, select the person's record you wish to add to, then press CONTROL with K. KeySoft will prompt: "Last name? Currently (name)" Press ENTER to accept the name, then use SPACE to move through the list of fields until you hear the field you wish to add. Type in the required information and press ENTER. When you are satisfied press CONTROL with ENTER and the modified record will be stored. 10.4 Deleting a Record. To delete a record, comprising a last name and all its associated fields, use the "Lookup" option. Move to any field in the record and press CONTROL with 8. You are prompted to make sure, so press Y, and the record is deleted from the address list. 10.5 Duplicating a Record. You may want to create a new record which is similar to an existing one. There is often less to type if you duplicate an existing record, and then make the required changes. You might do this, for example, if two people work for the same company and many of their details are the same. There is a useful function called "Retrieve last record", which can help here. Assume that you have just added a new record for someone who works for a particular company, and you want to add another similar record for someone else. Select the Add Address option and when you get as far as the Last name prompt, select the Block Commands Menu by pressing CONTROL with B. Note that this is a different menu to the Block Commands menu in KeyWord. Press SPACE and KeyList announces: "Retrieve last record". KeyList is offering to retrieve the last record you added, so press ENTER. KeyList prompts, "Last name? Currently Smith". You now have two identical records, so you should change the fields that are to be different, such as Last name, First Name, and Title. When you have made the changes, add the new record by pressing CONTROL with ENTER. If you need to add other similar records, continue using the retrieve last record command as necessary. If you want to duplicate an old record, just look it up first, since the retrieve last record command retrieves the last record which was looked up, added or copied. 10.6 Inserting an Address into a Document. You may wish to insert a name and address, from KeyList into a letter you are typing with KeyWord. This can be done in two steps as follows: 1. Copy the address to the clipboard. 7. Paste the clipboard into the document. These steps are now described. Select KeyList and from the KeyList menu, press L for Lookup, and locate the person's address. At any field in this record, select the Block Commands Menu by pressing CONTROL with B. There is only one item in this menu, and if you press SPACE the following message is announced, "Copy record to clip board". This is the action you require, so press ENTER. KeyList then prompts, "Template name?" for the name of the template that determines which fields in the record should be copied, and in which order. You can create your own templates as described later. For the moment, select an existing one by pressing SPACE repeatedly until "Letterhead template" is announced and press ENTER. The record which you just looked up is copied to the clipboard. KeyList displays, "Record copied to clipboard", and you are returned to your place in the record. The fields which have been copied to the clipboard are formatted in a letterhead style. Now use KeyWord to create the letter which requires an address. Place the cursor where you want the address to be inserted and paste the clipboard by pressing CONTROL with B, then P. If you review this document, you will find the selected person's name and address in a letterhead layout. 10.7 Embossing Addresses. You may want to emboss a name and address or phone number, or a selection of them. From the KeyList menu select "Emboss addresses." KeySoft prompts: "Emboss or Set up embosser?." If you haven't previously set up the embosser, press S. The set up procedure is covered in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. To proceed with embossing, press E, and KeySoft prompts: "Template name".? 10.7.1 Templates for Embossing. An address record is a series of fields, whereas an embossed page must have a specific format. So, to emboss address records, you must specify which fields you want to emboss, and how they should be arranged. This is defined by a template, which is a KeyWord document laid out with the required field names in the required arrangement. A template may also contain text and formatting information. There are two main template categories, namely Braille templates and text templates. To emboss addresses from the address list, you would use a Braille template. Conversely to print addresses from the address list, you would use a Text template. The convention used for naming templates, places the word "Braille" in front of the Braille templates. KeySoft is provided with several readymade Braille and Text templates for copying, embossing or printing. There is a "Letterhead template", which produces a letter heading in the form: Line 1: (first name)space(last name). Line 2: (street address). Line 3: (street address, line 2). Line 4: (city)comma(state)(zip or postal code). Another readymade template is called, "Phone List template", and produces a single line for each record in the form: (last name)space(first name) Tab: (street address)space(street address, line 2) Tab: (city) Tab: (business phone number). A new line is then created. Select a template for your purpose. If there is no template which suits what you want to do, you can modify or create a template as described in 10.9 Templates. 10.7.2 Selecting Addresses to Emboss. After you have selected the template, KeyList announces, "Selection list for Address List". If you want to emboss every record, press ENTER. However, you can select just those addresses you want to emboss. For example, you might type "Yoyodyne Inc." in the "Company name" field. When you have set up the required search field, or fields, start the lookup by pressing ENTER. KeyList announces the number of selected records, and prompts, "Emboss all selected records?" To do this, press Y. All the selected addresses are embossed, and you are returned to the KeyList menu. Alternatively, you have a further opportunity to choose from the selected addresses. To do this, press N, and you are presented with the first matching record. If you wish to emboss this record, press ENTER and this record is embossed. If you do not want to emboss this record, scan the list, and press ENTER for each record that you do wish to include. 10.8 Printing Addresses. The procedure for printing an address list, or a selection of it, is very similar to embossing. From the KeyList menu, select "Print addresses". KeySoft prompts: "Print or Set up printer?" If you haven't already set up the printer, press S. The set up procedure is covered in 6.11 The Printer SetUp List. To proceed with printing, press P, and follow the prompts to select a template and choose which address records to print. 10.9 Templates. Templates are used for copying, embossing and printing. You can use the templates as they are supplied, or you can modify them, or create new ones. The procedure for creating a new template is described. 10.9.1 Braille and Text Templates. It is important to note that a template can be either a Braille or a text document, and the right one must be used for the purpose. If you want to emboss a Braille document, or insert into a Braille document, then a Braille template is required. Conversely, if you want to print, or insert into a text document, then a text template is needed. 10.9.2 Creating a Template. Suppose that you wish to copy records from an address list into some business letters. You might want a template which puts your own address at the head of the letter, followed by the date, and then the recipient's name and address. We will assume that the letters will be Braille documents, which could be printed later. In this case you will need a Braille template. From the KeyWord menu, press C to create a new document. At the "Folder name?" prompt, select "KeyList", which is the folder where templates are kept. At the prompt: "Document to create?" type a suitable name such as: "Business template". Unless you specify otherwise a Braille template is created. If you had wanted a text template, press CONTROL with X at the prompt for "Document to create?" until "Create a text document" is announced. Now compose this document in the way you want the record to be formatted. The layout is for a business letter, so first type your own address, followed by a blank line. Next, insert the date by pressing FUNCTION with O, followed by I, then D. KeySoft prompts, "Insert today's date or printing date?" Select the Printing Date option by pressing P. This causes the date to be updated each time you use the template to emboss or print Address List records. The Today's Date option inserts today's actual date, that is the date you created the template document. The text you have typed so far will be reproduced each time you use this template. Now we want to copy a recipient's first name from the address list. Place the cursor where you want the name to go, and select the list of available field names as follows: Select the Template menu by pressing CONTROL with A, and then select the Insert Field option. KeySoft prompts, "Insert field from which database?" Select "KeyList's Address list" by pressing A. You are then presented with the "Field selection list." This is a list of all the field names in an address list. Press SPACE or BACKSPACE repeatedly to review this list and find the field you want, which in this case is: "First name." Press ENTER to select it. You are returned to the document, a "First name field" marker is inserted, and the cursor is placed just after it. Now when a record is copied into a document using this template, a person's First Name appears in the marked position. To put a space after the first name, press SPACE. To include the last name next, follow the same procedure which you used to select the first name, but select the "Last name" field instead. This places a "Last name field" marker after the space. Start a new line by pressing ENTER, and continue to compose the recipient's address, using field names from the list. A template may include whatever punctuation, formatting commands or text that you wish, and these are included with the fields that are specified by the template. Other layout rules to remember are: 1. When using a template, KeyList filters out lines which only contain blank fields. For example, the original record may have a blank "Country" field. If your template contains a "Country" field name on a line by itself, a blank line will not be generated. 2. If you want a blank line to be generated when it contains only blank fields, start the line in the template with a marker to indicate "Force Inclusion of Line", by pressing CONTROL with A, then F. 3. Part of a line in a template can be marked with suppression markers. If the field or fields between the markers are blank, everything between the markers is suppressed when the template is used. To insert these markers, press CONTROL with A, for the Template menu, and choose Start or End Conditional Suppression. For an example of the use of suppression markers, see the "Letterhead Template" in the KeyList folder. 4. To put a comment line in a template, start the line with a comment marker. To do this, press CONTROL with A for the Template menu, and choose: "Mark comment line". The contents of the comment line are not included when the template is used. 5. Records can be printed to fill the page, in a layout suitable for a phone list. Alternatively, they can be printed one per page, to suit envelopes and form letters. In the latter case, a "New Page" marker is required at the end of the template. When you have finished the template, you can review it as you would review any other KeyWord document. Markers are spoken with character or word review commands. In the template, fields appears to have a particular length, but the actual field lengths are substituted when you use the template. For example, the "First name" field appears to be 13 characters long in the template, but only 4 characters result if the address list field contains the name "John". If you create a new template or modify an existing one, you should check the resulting layout to ensure that it is what you intended. You can do this by copying a record into the clipboard, using the new template, and pasting the clipboard into a blank document. You can then review the layout. 10.10 Copying Addresses. KeyList allows you to copy a subset of the address list, such as all people who work for Fox Corporation, into a chosen file. At the KeyList menu select "Copy addresses". KeyList announces: "Copy addresses to a document or an address list?" You have the option of copying the addresses to a KeyWord document, or to another address list file used by KeyList or KeyMail. 10.10.1 Copying to a Text or Braille Document. To copy to a document, press D, and you hear prompts for a destination folder name and document name. Select an existing Braille or text document, or create a new one. When you have entered the destination document name, you are prompted, "Template name?" This determines the fields to be copied and their format on the page. The offered template is either a Braille or a text document, to match the type of destination document you have chosen. To accept the suggested template, press ENTER, or press SPACE repeatedly to review the list of available templates, and choose one by pressing ENTER. You are then placed in the KeyList Lookup function, at the prompt: "Selection list for Address Notebook". If you want to copy every record, press ENTER. However, you also have the opportunity to select just those addresses you want to copy, if they have something in common. For example, in the "Organization" field you might type "Fox Corporation." When you have set up the required search field or fields, start the lookup by pressing ENTER. KeyList announces the number of selected records, and prompts, "Copy all selected records?" To do this, press Y. All the selected records are copied to the destination document, and you are returned to the KeyList menu. Alternatively, you have a further opportunity to choose from the selected addresses. To do this, press N, and you are presented with the first matching record. If you press ENTER this record is added to the document. If you do not want to include this record, use READ with 9 to scan the list, and press ENTER for each record you wish to include. 10.10.2 Copying to an Address List File. You can also copy addresses to another address list file, rather than to a document as just described. At the KeyList menu select "Copy addresses". Your VoiceNote mPower QT prompts: "Copy addresses to a document or an address list?" To copy to an address list file, press A, and your VoiceNote mPower QT prompts for a destination folder name and file name. Select an existing address list. If you need to select a different drive or folder, press BACKSPACE. There are now two possibilities; either the source and the destination files have the same number of fields and the same field names, or there are differences. The first case applies when you are copying records to a file with an identical structure to the source file. KeySoft advises, "All fields match. Review field mapping list?" You would normally press N here, and you are placed at the Selection List, from where you may select the required records, as described in the previous section about copying to a document. Alternatively, if the source and destination structures are different, KeySoft tells you how many field names match, and queries, "Review field mapping list?" If you press N at this point, KeySoft copies only those fields which have matching field names in the destination file. However, if you want to specify how each field in the source file is mapped to the destination file, press Y. KeySoft presents a "Field Mapping List" containing pairs of field names. The first of each pair is a field name from the source file, and the second is a matching field name in the destination file, if a match exists. To change a mapping, review the field mapping list by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE repeatedly and select a source field name by pressing ENTER. You are presented with a field selection list containing all the field names in a destination record. Review this list and pick the corresponding field name by pressing ENTER. You can then continue to review the field mapping list, making changes as required. To prevent a field being copied, use the Clear Field command, CONTROL with BACKSPACE, when the field name is announced. When the field mapping list is to your satisfaction, press ESCAPE and you can proceed to select the required records to copy, as described previously. 10.11 Selecting an Address List. KeySoft is installed with a blank address file called: "Address List". Its name is announced when you select, "Add address", or "Lookup address". However there is no reason why you can't have multiple address lists, instead of one, and use them for other purposes than storing addresses. You should read the following section on Creating an Address List before proceeding. To select a different address list, or to verify which address list is currently selected, select the "Select KeyList file" option in the KeyList Menu. You are prompted for a folder and file name. Select the folder and file in any of the usual ways. The selected file remains current until deliberately changed. If the file selected is not of the Address List type then you are prompted to verify the selection when you enter KeyList. 10.12 Creating an Address List. Each address list has an associated KeyList definition file that defines the fields that are contained in an address record. The definition file for the standard "Address List" may be found in the KeyList folder and is named "Address List.klt". When you first enter details into the Address List, an associated database volume is created within the "Keylist.cdb" file that is stored in the KeyList folder on the Flash Disk. The entries you place in the Address List are stored within this database file. We recommend caution in working with database definition files. If you think that you have the necessary skills and wish to experiment with creating your own variant of the "Address List", we suggest that you first make a copy of the existing Address List definitions file and that you modify this copied file. In this way you will always have the original Address List definition file intact. From the File Manager, copy the file named "Address List" from the KeyList folder on the Flash Disk to the General folder on the Flash Disk. Use Keyword to open the Address List file you have copied into the General Folder. We suggest you set KeyWord to line reading mode, by pressing READ with S until "line reading mode" is announced. We'll now consider the task of modifying this file so that the associated database is named "Phone List", and the definition file only contains fields for "Last Name", "First name", and "Phone". Now, let's take a closer look at the original address list definitions file that we have just opened. You will find that the file contains some 33 lines of information. The syntax of each line determines its function. The first line of the file contains the word "database", followed by the words "Address List". We want to create a definition file called "Phone List", so replace "Address List" with "Phone List", leaving the word "database" at the start of the line. The second line contains the number "24". Leave this unchanged. The next 27 lines define each field as it appears in the Address List. Each line starts with a unique number, but the order in which the fields appear in the database is determined by their relative line position, not the number used to identify the line. Delete the lines starting with "16420" and "16419". These lines represent the fields "Middle Name" and "Title" in the original definition file. Position the cursor at the start of the line numbered "14856" and place a "Top of Block" marker. Next position the cursor to the start of the line numbered "24594", enter the Block Menu and select "Delete Block". You should now be left with a file that contains 9 lines. Modify the line starting with "14857" so that the text between the quotes is "Phone" rather than the original "Home phone number". It is important that the word "Phone" is placed inside quotation marks. The final form of your modified file should be: database Phone List 24 14865, name, autocap, "Last name" 14854, name autocap, "First name" 14857, phone, autonum, "Phone" 24594, concat, "14865, 14854" 24595, concat, "14854, 14865" announcement order 14854, 14865 sort order 24594, 24595 Once you are happy with the contents of the modified file, exit the file, and from the File Command Menu, rename it to "Phone List". Ignore the message that there is no database associated with the file. Copy the "Phone List" definition file back into the KeyList folder. All you have to do now is go to the Address List menu and select the "Phone List" file as your address file. You can then add entries to your new phone list. When you first try to add an entry to the phone list, you will be asked to confirm the creation of the associated database within the "Keylist.cdb" file. 10.13 Using KeyList to Manipulate Databases. KeyList is not restricted to looking up or adding to an address list. It can also be used to manipulate any of the databases in the KeyList folder. To do this, select the folder and name of the required database using the "Select KeyList file" option in the KeyList menu as described in 10.11 Selecting an Address List. You can now use KeyList to Lookup or Add to the selected database in the usual way, as if it were an address list. When you have finished reviewing or updating a database, remember to reselect the Address List in the KeyList folder for future use. Refer to the Database Manager chapter for information on setting up a database and how to free database space. End of Address List Chapter. 11 Email. This chapter introduces KeyMail, the VoiceNote mPower QT's userfriendly email package that lets you send, receive and manage your email. If you are new to the world of electronic telecommunications you may wonder what email is. That is, apart from being short for electronic mail. Essentially email is just the electronic equivalent of paper mail, but it is faster and cheaper than ordinary mail. It takes minutes or hours rather than days to reach its destination even when the destination is on the other side of the world. In order to send and receive email, computers need to have a set of rules, or protocol, which determines how the information is sent. VoiceNote mPower QT's email program, KeyMail, uses the popular POP (Post Office Protocol) email format. This protocol has become the "industry standard" which ensures easy connection to the majority of Internet Service Providers. We commence this chapter by describing, in general terms, what KeyMail can do. We then take an overview of the KeyMail package, and follow this with getting started with KeyMail from a first time perspective. Following this is a fuller description of KeyMail and its component parts. 11.1 What Can KeyMail Do. The KeyMail email program enables you to access mainstream email services and communicate with email users worldwide. KeyMail provides you with the following capabilities: KeyMail enables you to communicate with people using many different popular email programs like Microsoft Outlook or Outlook Express, Eudora, and Lotus cc:Mail. KeyMail guides you through the steps of addressing and composing an email message, connecting to an email service provider, sending email and receiving email. KeyMail helps you organize your email messages so you can find them easily using electronic folders, and it enables you to set up your preferred email options. KeyMail handles attachments to email. It understands Microsoft Word document formats so you can read Word documents attached to your email. You can also attach files of any format to your outgoing email. KeyMail eliminates the routine task of appending your name and email address, and facilitates responding to an email message. Replying to a message automatically creates a new message with the address and subject line filled in, and the message area contains the text of the original message. With a range of connectivity configurations available and the KeyMail software, VoiceNote mPower QT provides everything you need to join the connected world of email. 11.2 KeyMail Menu. You can access KeyMail by typing E from the Main Menu, or by pressing FUNCTION with 8. This takes you to the KeyMail Menu, which contains 4 items. These are: Write an email; Read email; Connect to send and receive email; Set up options. 11.2.1 Write Email. Choose "Write an email" when you wish to send a new message to one or more people. You can enter their email addresses manually, or more conveniently, choose them from your KeyList address list. KeyMail steps you painlessly through the various options that include the following items: main recipient or recipients; carbon copy recipient or recipients; blind carbon copy recipient or recipients; subject; and, whether you wish to send any file attachments. You can then create, review, spell check, and edit the text of your email message using the same friendly commands used in KeyWord. At this point you may choose to send your email, with or without saving a copy, or save it as a Draft, so that you can return to it at a later time. You may also emboss or print a copy of your email. 11.2.2 Reading Email. To read email stored on your system, choose "Read Email.” You can check for new messages before you start, or read messages stored from previous sessions. KeyMail uses a series of folders to organize your mail, and you can add folders of your own to streamline the filing of your mail. KeyMail guides you through selecting the desired folder, and provides tools for replying to and forwarding email, with and without the original text and/or attachments included. Emails can be marked for further action, such as moving or copying to another folder, or sending to the Trash folder. 11.2.3 Checking for Email. To check for new email, choose "Connect to send and receive email.” KeyMail prompts you through the necessary steps, and provides feedback about the status of the connection and mail download. If you have any unsent mail, it is also sent at this time. 11.2.4 Setup Options. The purpose of the "Set up options" is to define the details of your email accounts. You can set up as many accounts as you wish. Using the Receive options you can choose not to delete messages from your service provider after they have been downloaded, leaving them available to be downloaded to another computer. A size limit can also be set on emails to be downloaded, and if exceeded, an alert will be given. The Address list set up allows you to define which address list to use, if you have more than one, and to tell it your own name and email address so these can be included in email you send. Each of the Set up Options is detailed in 11.10 Setup Options. Setting up access to the internet itself is handled separately. For more information, refer to 13.3 The Connectivity Menu. 11.2.5 Disconnecting. When KeyMail connects in order to send or receive email, at the end of the process it will prompt: "Remain connected?" At this point you can press Y to stay connected to the internet, or N to disconnect. The reason you have this choice is because you may wish to do other email activities, or switch to KeyWeb, during the same session. When you choose to remain connected, KeySoft returns to the Main Menu. When you disconnect, KeySoft returns to the KeyMail Menu. 11.3 Before You Start. Before you can send and receive email, you need to set up an email account with an Internet Service Provider, or ISP for short. If you already have an email account, you can configure KeyMail to work with it in most cases. For those unfamiliar with Internet Service Providers, your ISP can be thought of as providing a similar service to telephone banking, only instead of shuffling money, your ISP handles your email. First you have to choose a Service Provider (ISP) and establish with them what your email address and log on password will be, and the address of their send and receive mail boxes. A typical example of these various items may be: User Name: Murray_Thorn; Password: Cheeky; Pop Server address: pop.clear.net.nz; SMTP Server address: smtp.clear.net.nz. In some cases you may require other information such as a DNS address. Either ask your Service Provider for details on setting up a Windows CE machine, or contact your VoiceNote mPower QT dealer. If using a dialup connection, you will also require a telephone number from them. Some Service Providers also require a User Name and Password for the initial connection, as well as those required to access your actual EMail account. Some people have email accounts with separate providers, but may only access them using one ISP connection to the Internet. Others may have several accounts and several different ways to get connected. Others will have just one email account through one ISP. This chapter covers the setting up of an email account and the handling of email. For information on how to set up the connection to the internet, refer to the Connectivity Chapter. 11.4 Correcting Input Errors. Unless you are extremely accurate, it is highly likely that you will input an incorrect keystroke or two while you are filling in the various details. KeySoft has a number of editing and review commands that make it easy to correct such problems. Get into the habit of frequently using KeySoft Help, HELP. It often provides a valuable source of information relevant to what you are trying to do. If you notice a mistake while typing in, use BACKSPACE to take out the last character. To review an email address, you can announce it by pressing READ with K. Pressing this combination again causes the address to be spelt. You can move forwards and back through an entry using READ with M or READ with PERIOD. 11.5 Writing an Email Message. KeyMail provides most of the important functions of the popular email programs available today. If you have used any of these programs you have a head start because you already understand what you are doing. KeyMail guides you through the process of addressing, writing an email message and attaching files to email. There is some essential detail that you must provide, like who you want to send the email to, but there is also much detail that is optional. The following discussion guides you through all of the available options. When addressing email using KeyMail you may select addresses from an address list. KeyMail provides a way of setting up your own personal address details that are used specifically by KeyMail. This information is needed so that KeyMail can add your details to your outgoing email. Then your email correspondents have a return address for their reply. Remember that if you need help with your available options at any point, press HELP. 1. From anywhere in KeySoft, press FUNCTION with 8, or go to the Main Menu and press E. From the KeyMail menu, select "Write an Email." 6. KeySoft prompts: "Send to?." Type in the address and press ENTER. Or, if the address you want to use is in your address book, press the first few letters, or the whole name, of the person you want to send the email to and press ENTER. KeySoft looks for entries in the address list with matching first names. If it finds a match, it announces the first name and surname of the matching record. KeySoft continues at Step 3. If two or more records are found, it reports "X records selected" where X is the number of records, and queries "Send to all selected addresses?." If yes, press Y. KeySoft continues at Step 4. If you don't want to send to all of them, press N. KeySoft confirms "No" and displays the first name and surname of the first matching record. To send to this person, press ENTER. To skip this person and go to the next, press READ with 9, and so on until KeySoft announces your choice, then press ENTER. KeySoft will confirm your selection with the message: "Address added." If KeySoft fails to find a match, it reports "Cannot find name in the address list," where “name” is the name you typed. You can edit the name and try again. A person may have more than one email address, in which case you get to choose which address to use. Other options available when entering an email address are: Type in the email address, rather than the person’s name. Look up the person in the address list by pressing CONTROL with L. This takes you to the selection list for the Address List. 7. KeySoft now prompts, "Also send to?.” The same options as are discussed in step 2 are available. To skip adding another address here, press ENTER. 8. A prompt: "Copy to?" is announced. Type a name as discussed in step 2 or press ENTER to skip. 9. A prompt: "Blind copy to?" is announced. Again you can type a name as discussed in step 2 or press ENTER to skip. You may be wondering what blind copy is? It is a copy of an email that is sent without being marked with all "send to" and "copy to" addresses. Consequently the recipient does not know that anyone else has been sent a copy. 10. KeySoft prompts: Subject?." Type a word or phrase that encapsulates the topic of your email and press ENTER. You can quickly move to the Subject field from any of the previous field by pressing READ with 9. This saves you having to "pass through" all the intervening fields if you do not wish to enter any addresses. 11. KeySoft then queries "Attach a file to this email?." If no press ENTER or press N and KeySoft continues at the next step. If yes please refer to section 11.7 Attaching a file to an email. 12. The prompts "Email message,” "Top of document" and "Blank" are presented. You are placed at the top of a new document in KeyWord where you can type, review and edit your email message. When you are happy with it, press ESCAPE to exit KeyWord. 13. Now the prompt "Ready to send this email?" is announced. If not press N and you will be returned to the "send to" prompt. You may review the details you previously entered by pressing SPACE. If you are ready to send the email, press Y. KeySoft now prompts "Save a copy?." Press N to send the email without retaining a copy. Press Y to send the email and to save a copy of the email message. KeySoft queries which folder to use. Select the folder from existing ones or create a new folder in the usual way. KeySoft returns to the KeyMail menu. There are 4 other options available at the "Ready to send this email?" prompt: To save the email as a Draft, press D. This saves the email in the "Draft" folder, where it can be retrieved at a later time. To Print, press P. To Emboss, press E. To abandon this email without sending, press ESCAPE. KeySoft saves your outgoing email in a special folder, called the "Outbox.” When you exit the KeyMail menu, KeySoft will prompt if there are any unsent messages in the Outbox, and ask if you want to send them. Pressing N leaves the email in the Outbox to be sent at some other time. If you press Y KeySoft will prompt for an email account and connection configuration, and send the email. KeySoft does not check for newly received email at this time. If you know that you have email to send and also wish to check for new received email, choose the "Connect to send and receive email" option on the KeyMail menu. Note: If you receive a message that has multiple recipients and you only want to reply to one of them, follow these steps: 1. Select the email you wish to reply to (but leave it closed). 2. Move to the address of the person you want to sent a reply to and press CONTROL with C. 3. KeyMail will announce: "copied to clipboard". 4. To add the address into the To: field of a new message, press CONTROL with V. 5. Fill in the Subject field and write your message. 11.6 Email Signatures. You have the option of automatically adding your own customized signature to an email. Your signature can include any information, such as your name, initials, contact details, or even a meaningful quotation! The email signature that is added to the end of a new message comes from a document that you create and name, 'signature'. Likewise, an email signature that appears at the end of an email message that you reply to or forward, originates from a document that you create and name, 'reply signature'. The contents of the 'signature' and 'reply signature' documents, can be exactly the same or be different in whatever way you like, depending on your requirements. For instance, in new emails, you may want to include your full contact details whereas in emails that you reply to or forward you might need to include just your name and work phone number. Follow these steps to create email signatures: 1. Go into the Word Processor and select the KeyMail folder from the Flash Disk. 2. Create the 'signature' and 'reply signature' documents. 3. Type your signature and be sure to format it the way you want it to appear in your email message. Once you begin to write, reply or forward an email, you will notice that your new signature has been automatically added to the end of the email. This signature can be personalized for the individual email by simply editing it at this point. 11.7 Attaching a file to an email. To attach a file to an email, follow these steps. 1. When KeySoft queries "Attach a file to this email?" press Y. KeySoft announces "Folder name? General." Select a drive, folder, and file in the usual way. 2. You are now asked "File to attach?" Press SPACE to access the file list. KeySoft prompts "List of all files in (folder name) folder." Review the list and select the file you want. 3. KeySoft now queries whether you want to attach the file in its current format. For example, KeySoft might query "Attach this KeyWord document in a different file type?" If you press Y for Yes, KeySoft queries, "Attach as which file type? Microsoft Word file?” Press ENTER to accept this option. To choose a different file type, press CONTROL with SPACE. The available file types are: Microsoft Word, ASCII text, Plain Braille file, Rich Text Format (RTF), WordPerfect 5.1, and same file type as the source. 4. KeySoft now prompts, "Attach another file?” You can now attach another file by typing Y for yes. KeySoft continues at the beginning of this step. 5. When you have finished attaching files, press N. Continue with the email writing procedure. Note: When sending a document as an attachment, it pays to consider the reading equipment available to the recipient. For example, a plain Braille file is no use to someone without a Braille reading device. Remember also that you can attach files off the Network, even those whose file type is incompatible with the VoiceNote mPower QT. 11.8 Read Email. The "Read EMail" option on the KeyMail menu is likely to be the most frequently used feature of the VoiceNote mPower QT's email system. Using this option you can download new email, read email stored in the KeyMail filing system, including those sent by yourself, organize your email into folders, and send unwanted email to the trash folder. KeyMail guides you through processes such as reading or detaching email file attachments and moving or copying email to other folders. It provides options for replying to, and forwarding email. KeyMail allows you to perform these options one at a time, or you can mark individual email for later action. Next we discuss the philosophy behind KeyMail's "Read Email" design, then we take a detailed look at each of the available features. 11.8.1 Email Folders. KeyMail organizes your messages by sorting them into folders. These folders are located within the KeyMail system, and are not part of the normal folder structure of KeySoft. Initially, KeyMail provides 8 internal folders. These are My Email, Inbox, Outbox, Sent, Received, All, Draft and Trash. It is highly recommended that you create at least 2 folders of your own. Your folders could simply be called “Mail In” and “Mail out.” Incoming mail is automatically placed in the Inbox. When you have read an email, KeyMail will prompt you to move the email to another folder. This folder must be one that you have created, or the "Trash" or "My Email" folder, and could for example be your “Mail In” folder. Items moved from the Inbox also appear in the Received folder. A link to this email also appears in the All folder. It is important to understand that if an email stays in the Inbox, it does not appear in either the Received or All folders. The Outbox stores your outgoing email messages until they have been sent. At the point where you are about to send your email message, KeyMail asks if you wish to save a copy. If you answer yes, you are prompted for the folder into which to save the email. Again, this must be a folder you have created, and could be your “Mail out” or "My Email" folder. Email saved in a folder prior to sending will also appear in the Sent folder. A link to this email is also placed in the All folder. It is important to realize that sent emails only appear in the Sent and All folders if you have saved them to one of your folders. The Drafts folder is used to hold messages that have been started, but are not ready to be sent, and the Trash folder stores any emails deleted from the system. New mail is automatically placed in the Inbox and is stored in the order it is received. If you choose to read the Inbox, KeyMail asks whether you wish to check for new mail before placing you in the Inbox at the last item received. KeyMail encourages you to organize your email as you read. Once a message has been read from the Inbox, you are prompted to move the message from the Inbox to another folder. In this way you keep the number of items in your Inbox to a manageable number, and you are able to organize your email under useful categories. Email within a folder can be marked, either on an individual basis, or alternatively all items can be marked. This handy feature allows you to move, copy, delete, print or emboss marked emails as a group without having to repeat the procedure for each email. Reading or detaching file attachments received with email is easy with KeyMail. Document attachments can be read without detaching, or they may be detached and saved in the normal KeySoft folders so that they can be accessed from KeyWord. The “Email Action Menu" can be invoked from within any KeyMail folder, or while reading an email, and provides tools for replying to email, forwarding an email to another person or group of people, moving, copying, deleting, printing and embossing email. 11.8.2 Receiving incoming Email. The following steps are required to read your incoming email. 1. Select KeyMail by pressing FUNCTION with 8. 2. KeySoft announces "KeyMail Menu.” Select "Read Email" from the KeyMail menu. 3. KeySoft prompts "Connect using which configuration? Press ENTER for (name).” where (name) is the name of a connection configuration you have set up in the Connectivity menu. To use the offered configuration, just press ENTER. If the correct configuration was not prompted, press SPACE repeatedly to find the required configuration. When you have found it, press ENTER. 4. KeySoft prompts: "Use which email account? Press ENTER for (account)" To select the offered email account, press ENTER, otherwise press SPACE repeatedly to find the required account. When you have found it, press ENTER. Note: If you typically use the same email account and the same connection configuration every time, you can simply cut these two prompts short by pressing ENTER, because the offered option is always the last option used. 5. If using a dialup modem to access your email, read this. If not, skip to the next step. KeySoft announces the message “dialing,” and you should hear the dialing process followed by whistling noises as your modem connects with the modem at your Service Provider. Before the sequence of messages listed in the next step, you will first hear these: Dialing; Connected; Logging On; Logon Successful; Connected; ...and at the end of the sequence below, you will get this message: Remain connected to the modem? (Press Y or N) 6. KeySoft reports the progress of the mail checking sequence by displaying the appropriate message as each significant stage of the operation is completed. The typical sequence of messages, assuming you have one new message to receive and no outgoing email to send, is: There is 1 email on Server; Checking for new messages; There is 1 new email; Receiving 1; There is no email to send. 11.8.3 Reading New EMail. When new email appears in the Inbox, you will be presented with the first new email to read: 1. To review the fields associated with the Email press SPACE to advance through the fields, or BACKSPACE to move back through the fields. Each email entry in a folder consists of a number of fields, depending on whether the email has any attachments, and how many there are. The first field presented is the Subject, followed by the sender. Next the date and time the message was received is given, followed by a field for each attachment, if they are present. Finally, a list of whom the email was to be copied to, followed by the date and time the message was sent in the time zone it was sent from. File attachments are discussed in 11.8.5 Received Attachments. 2. To read the email, press ENTER at any field other than an attachment field. 3. KeySoft prompts ”Top of Document,” and you are placed at the top of the email message. Use the normal KeyWord commands to read and review the message. When you have finished reading, press ESCAPE to exit the document. 4. KeySoft prompts "Move this email to which folder?." To hear the existing options, press SPACE. These are Trash and My Email. You can create a new folder by typing its name and pressing Y at the prompt. KeySoft will advise that one email has been moved. If you want to leave the email in the Inbox press ESCAPE. You are then returned to the Inbox, where you can review and read your next email. The following section provides instructions on how to move around the email within the "Inbox,” or any folder. discusses Folder Management, folders you have created, and how you may either rename or delete them from the KeyMail folder system. 11.8.4 Reviewing Email. When you enter any folder, the focus is on the last item entered in that folder. You can move up and down the items in a folder, and read the key fields associated with each item. If desired, you can also read the email message, and if present, any attachment. KeyMail provides the following commands to review email within a folder: To read the selected email, press ENTER. To exit the email message, press ESCAPE. To move to the next field, press SPACE. To move back to the previous field, press BACKSPACE. To move to the next email, press READ with 9. To move back to the previous email, press READ with 7. To move this email to the trash folder, press CONTROL with 8. To mark an email for further action, press CONTROL with SPACE. To search for a subject, name or contents, press READ with F, then S, or N or C; remember that you can add spaces to a search string by using the binding space command. To select the Email Action Menu, press CONTROL with ENTER. To move forward or back a day, press CONTROL with PERIOD or with M. To move forward or back a week, press CONTROL with L or with J. To move forward or back a month, press CONTROL with O or with U. To move forward or back a year, press CONTROL with 9 or with 7. To move to the first email in a folder, press READ with T. To move to the last email in a folder, press READ with B. To determine the number of emails in the folder press READ with I. 11.8.5 Received Attachments. If the email being reviewed has one or more attachments, these appear as fields in the email entry. Move forward or back through the fields with the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys. KeySoft announces "Attachment 1 name,” "Attachment 2 name,” and so on, depending on the number of attachments. Press ENTER on the desired Attachment, and KeySoft asks you to confirm whether you wish to detach or read the file. To read the attachment, press R. To detach, press D. Choosing Read, places you at the top of the attached document. KeySoft's normal review commands may then be used to read the file. Press ESCAPE to exit the attachment, and you are returned to the folder from which you opened the attachment. Choosing the “Detach” option, causes KeySoft to prompt the attachment file type, and ask whether you wish to detach the file as a KeyWord document. For example, if the attachment were a Microsoft Word document, KeySoft would prompt: "Attachment is a Microsoft Word file. Detach as a KeyWord document?" To have the file converted to a KeyWord Text Document, press Y. To leave the attachment as a Microsoft Word file, press N. To have the file converted to a KeyWord Braille Document, press B. KeySoft will then prompt: "Delete this attachment from the email?" Now that you have saved a copy of the attachment, you can save storage space by deleting the attachment from the email. To delete the attachment from the email, press Y, to leave the attachment unchanged, press N. 11.8.6 Folder Management. Email folders are different to the other kinds on the Flash Disk. They are held in a database, called Email folders.cdb, found in the KeyList folder of the Flash Disk. You cannot access this database any other way than KeyMail, but we hope that by understanding this, it will make the folder management process easier to understand. It also explains why, in order to make more room for emails, the option is called "Free Database Space". For more information on this option, please refer to 11.10.3 Free Database Space. Organizing your email requires that you give some thought to what folders you need to efficiently categorize your email. New folders can easily be created at any prompt to name a folder, by simply typing in a new folder name. If the folder doesn't already exist you will be prompted to confirm the creation of a new folder. The following options are available at the “Folder Name" prompt: To select the suggested folder press ENTER. To move forward or back through the list of existing folders, press SPACE, or BACKSPACE. In the "list of folders,” the following commands are available: To delete a folder, press CONTROL with 8; To rename a folder, press CONTROL with R; To determine the number of emails in the folder, press READ with I; To jump to folders starting with a particular letter, press that letter. 11.8.7 Marking Email. Email within a folder may be marked for future action. The marking can either be applied to all email in the folder, or on an individual basis. Email marking is extremely useful when you are organizing your email, as it allows you to perform common actions on a number of files. For example, if you decide, while reading your new emails, that a number of them can be deleted, these emails may be marked. Before exiting the folder you can move all the marked emails to the Trash folder by pressing CONTROL with 8. To mark individual emails, press CONTROL with SPACE. To mark all files in the folder, press CONTROL with ENTER to open the “Email Action Menu,” and choose the mark all files option. Email marking only applies while you are in the folder. When you exit the folder the marking is turned off. 11.8.8 Email Action Menu. non PK The Email Action Menu is available when you are reviewing email within a folder, and is entered by pressing CONTROL with ENTER. The options available from the menu depend on the folder you are reviewing. Invoking the Email Action Menu within the Inbox presents the following options: Reply: Used to send an answer to the person who sent you the message. Choosing this option presents further choices, and after you have chosen the appropriate action, KeyMail creates a new message with the address and subject line filled in. The additional options available after choosing Reply are: Reply to sender only: If you receive a message that has been sent to a group of people you can send a reply to all members of the group as well as the sender, or just to the sender of the message. Answering Y to this option restricts your reply to the sender. Move email to another folder: Choose this option to move the selected email to the folder of your choice. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Copy email to another folder: Choose this option to copy the selected email to the folder of your choice. This leaves the original in the current folder. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Delete email from this folder: Choose this option to delete the selected email from the current folder. The deleted email is moved to the Trash folder. Mark all email: This is a useful feature if you want to perform an action on all email within the current folder. For example you may wish to copy the contents of the folder to another folder. If you wanted to do this, first "Mark all email,” then choose the "Copy email to another folder option" from the Email Action Menu. Invoking the Email Action Menu within, for example, the Sent folder, causes the “Reply" and “Delete email from this folder" options to be suppressed. A new item, "Move to Trash" will appear on the menu in addition to the other standard items. Include copy of original email: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email text in the message area. Include original email attachments: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email attachments with the reply. Forward: Used to send an email message you have received to another person or group. Choosing this option presents further choices and input fields to be entered. After you have done the appropriate action, KeyMail creates a new message with the subject line filled in, and the message area will contain the forwarded email. You can then enter your message ahead of the forwarded email. The additional option available after choosing Forward is: Include the original emails attachments: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email attachments with the forwarded message. You are then presented with the standard prompts for writing an email, such as: Send to? Also Send to?, Copy to?, and so on. From this point, proceed on as if you were preparing and sending a standard email message. Move email to another folder: Choose this option to move the selected email to the folder of your choice. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Copy email to another folder: Choose this option to copy the selected email to the folder of your choice. This leaves the original in the current folder. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Delete email from this folder: Choose this option to delete the selected email from the current folder. The deleted email is moved to the Trash folder. Mark all email: This is a useful feature if you want to perform an action on all email within the current folder. For example you may wish to copy the contents of the folder to another folder. If you wanted to do this, first "Mark all email,” then choose the "Copy email to another folder option" from the Email Action Menu. Invoking the Email Action Menu within, for example, the Sent folder, causes the “Reply" and “Delete email from this folder" options to be suppressed. A new item, "Move to Trash" will appear on the menu in addition to the other standard items. Print email: Choose this option to print an ink copy of the selected email. Emboss email: Choose this option to emboss a copy of the selected email on a Braille printer. 11.8.9 Include copy of original email. Include copy of original email: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email text in the message area. Include original email attachments: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email attachments with the reply. Forward: Used to send an email message you have received to another person or group. Choosing this option presents further choices and input fields to be entered. After you have done the appropriate action, KeyMail creates a new message with the subject line filled in, and the message area will contain the forwarded email. You can then enter your message ahead of the forwarded email. The additional option available after choosing Forward is: Include the original emails attachments: Answering Y to this prompt causes KeySoft to include a copy of the original email attachments with the forwarded message. You are then presented with the standard prompts for writing an email, such as: Send to? Also Send to?, Copy to?, and so on. From this point, proceed on as if you were preparing and sending a standard email message. Move email to another folder: Choose this option to move the selected email to the folder of your choice. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Copy email to another folder: Choose this option to copy the selected email to the folder of your choice. This leaves the original in the current folder. Either select the folder by pressing SPACE, then ENTER, or type in the name of the folder. If the folder does not already exist you are asked to confirm the creation of a new folder. Delete email from this folder: Choose this option to delete the selected email from the current folder. The deleted email is moved to the Trash folder. Print email: Choose this option to print an ink copy of the selected email. Emboss email: Choose this option to emboss a copy of the selected email on a Braille printer. Mark all email: This is a useful feature if you want to perform an action on all email within the current folder. For example you may wish to copy the contents of the folder to another folder. If you wanted to do this, first "Mark all email,” then choose the "Copy email to another folder option" from the Email Action Menu. Invoking the Email Action Menu within, for example, the Sent folder, causes the “Reply" and “Delete email from this folder" options to be suppressed. A new item, "Move to Trash" will appear on the menu in addition to the other standard items. 11.8.10 Trash Folder. The Trash folder is used as a temporary storage folder for emails deleted from any of the KeyMail folders. When you exit KeyMail and return to the Main Menu, KeySoft advises if there are any email in the Trash folder and asks if you want to empty the trash. Typing N at the prompt to "empty trash?" returns you to the Main Menu, and leaves the items in the "Trash" folder. To empty the trash, press Y. To Review the Trash Folder, press R. Pressing Y permanently deletes all email from the Trash folder. Typing R allows you to review the items. The following options are then available: To review each email by moving through the fields, press SPACE to move to the next field. To move back to the previous field, press BACKSPACE. To move to the next email, press READ with 9. To move back to the previous email, press READ with 7. To delete the email being reviewed, press CONTROL with 8. To restore emails in the Trash folder to their original folders, press CONTROL with ENTER to enter the 'Trash Folder Menu.” From this menu you may choose the option to "Restore this email to original folder.” The other option in this menu is "Empty the Trash Folder.” 11.9 Connect to Send and Receive Email. Connect to Send and Receive Email checks for new email, and sends any emails in the "Outbox.” You are prompted through the steps required, and feedback is provided as to the status of the connection and mail download. If you have any unsent mail, this is also sent at this time. 1. From the KeyMail menu select "Connect to send and receive email.” 2. KeySoft prompts "Connect using which configuration? Press ENTER for (name).” where (name) is the name of a connection configuration you have set up in the Connectivity menu. To use the offered configuration, just press ENTER. If the correct configuration was not prompted, press SPACE repeatedly to find the required configuration. When you have found it, press ENTER. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Use which email account? Press ENTER for (account)" To select the offered email account, press ENTER, otherwise press SPACE repeatedly to find the required account. When you have found it, press ENTER. Note: If you typically use the same email account and the same connection configuration every time, you can simply cut these two prompts short by pressing ENTER, because the offered option is always the last option used. 4. If using a dialup modem to access your email, read this. If not, skip to the next step. KeySoft announces the message “dialing,” and you should hear the dialing process followed by whistling noises as your modem connects with the modem at your Service Provider. Before the sequence of messages listed in the next step, you will first hear these: Dialing; Connected; Logging On; Logon Successful; Connected; ...and at the end of the sequence below, you will get this message: Remain connected to the modem? (Press Y or N) 5. KeySoft reports the progress of the mail checking sequence by displaying the appropriate message as each significant stage of the operation is completed. The typical sequence of messages, assuming you have one new message to receive and no outgoing email to send, is: There is 1 email on Server; Checking for new messages; There is 1 new email; Receiving 1; There is no email to send. For details on the options available while downloading email, during the download options, refer to the following section. During the sending and receiving process VoiceNote mPower QT beeps once every few seconds indicating it is busy. When using a dialup connection, at completion of sending your messages, KeySoft announces "Remain connected to modem?" To disconnect and return to the KeyMail Menu, press N. To remain connected and return to the Main Menu, press Y. If you wish to terminate the email session at any time, press ESCAPE. If using a dialup connection, KeySoft will prompt, "Abandon email session after current operation or hangup immediately?". To allow KeySoft to compete its current operation before hanging up, press N for no. To hang up immediately, press I for immediately. 11.9.1 Download status. You can press ENTER at any time during the download process to hear the status of the download. During this process the VoiceNote mPower QT beeps once every few seconds indicating it is busy. Download status announces the percentage complete, the size of the email currently being downloaded and the percentage complete of the total emails waiting to be downloaded. It is useful to check the status during downloads of long messages, as it provides an indication that the download is progressing satisfactorily. The maximum size for any email to download, without prompting for User intervention, is initially set to 50K or approximately 50,000 characters. Any email bigger than this setting causes KeySoft to prompt: "This email is larger than the maximum size allowed. Option?" The following options are available at this point: Continue to download: press ENTER; Skip this email: press S; Delete this email from server: press D; Hear information about the email: press I; This announces the sender and the subject. Download only the first 10 lines, but leave all on the server: press T; Download 10 lines and delete from server: press A. Change the size limit: press L. 11.10 Setup Options. Selecting Setup Options from the KeyMail menu presents the KeyMail Setup Menu which provides 3 options; "Directory of Email Accounts,” "Receive Options,” and "Free Database Space" "Directory of Email Accounts" allows you to define account details for email using a particular Service Provider, and provides options for both adding a new account and looking up and modifying an existing account. For details refer to 11.10.1 Directory of Email Accounts. "Receive Options" allows you to choose whether or not your email is deleted from your mail box at the Service Provider after you have downloaded it to the VoiceNote mPower QT. It also allows you to set the size limit for automatic download. Refer to 11.10.2 Receive Options. "Free Database Space" allows you to reclaim space in the email database that had been taken up by unwanted emails. Refer to 11.10.3 Free Database Space. 11.10.1 Directory of Email Accounts. To select "Directory of EMail Accounts,” first select KeyMail from the Main Menu, then select Setup Options. You are presented with the KeyMail Setup Menu and "Directory of Email Accounts" is the first item on this menu. There are two options on this menu; "Add an Email Account,” and "Look up an Email Account.” "Add an Email Account" is used to set up the details of a new email account. "Look up an Email Account" allows you to review the details for an existing email account, and modify individual fields as appropriate. Information relating to a particular email account is stored in a record, and each record has a number of fields that contain the details for that record. KeySoft provides commands for moving between records and reviewing the fields within them. To move to the next record, press READ with 9. To move back to the previous record, press READ with 7. Within a record you can use the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys to move forward or back through the list of fields. The next two sections provide detailed information on "Adding an Email Account" and "Looking up an Email Account.” 11.10.1.1 Add an Email Account. To send and receive email you need access to an email Service Provider. When you open an account with a Service Provider you need to obtain details of the service such as the POP server and SMTP addresses, and these details must be loaded into KeyMail before you can use that email account. Note: Details of the actual internet connection are listed separately. This is because it is not uncommon for users to access the internet in multiple ways, via a different setup to the default one, and this arrangement saves double entering account details or connection configurations. To add an email account, follow these steps: 1. Select Email from the Main Menu, or press FUNCTION with 8, anywhere. 2. KeySoft announces "KeyMail Menu.” Select Set Up Options from the KeyMail menu. KeySoft announces "KeyMail Set Up Menu." Select Directory of Email accounts. 3. KeySoft announces "Directory of Email Accounts.” Select Add an account. KeySoft announces "Entry List for Directory of Email accounts.” 4. KeySoft now steps you through a list of details of the service so that you can enter details for each item. KeySoft queries “Account Name?” Enter the name you wish this account to be called and press ENTER. Typically you would use the name of your provider, for example, "Earthlink.” 5. KeySoft prompts "User Name?” Enter the user name, for example Murray_Thorn. Typically this is the part of your email address that precedes the @ sign. 6. KeySoft prompts “Password?" For greater security, you can leave this blank and you will be prompted for the password each time you connect. Alternatively, type your password. The password is announced as you enter it. You can review it before pressing ENTER. After pressing ENTER it displays as 5 asterisks. Remember that passwords are often case sensitive, so it is important that you enter the password exactly as you have chosen or been given. 7. You are then prompted for "Your Name?" and reminded that computer Braille is required. This is the name that will appear in the From: field when the recipient reads email from you. 8. KeySoft prompts "Your Email address?." Type your full email address for this provider, for example: Murray_Thorn@earthlink.net. 9. KeySoft now queries "POP Server?." Enter the POP server address. For example a POP server address might be "pop.humanware.com.” The POP server address defines the path via which you receive mail from your email account provider. 10. KeySoft queries "Use a secure connection for POP server?" If your POP server requires a secure connection (SSL), press Y. If a secure connection is not required, press N. The default is No. 11. Next KeySoft queries "SMTP Server?." Enter the SMTP server address. For example a SMTP server address might be "smtp.humanware.com.” The SMTP server address defines the path via which you send mail to your email account provider. 12. KeySoft then queries "Use a secure connection for SMTP server?" If your SMTP server requires a secure connection (SSL), press Y. If a secure connection is not required, press N. The default is No. 13. Finally, KeySoft announces, "SMTP authentication required?" Increasingly, email providers expect users to verify their user name and address on the SMTP server before allowing them to proceed. The VoiceNote mPower QT is set up to automatically provide your username and password if you have turned this feature on. The default is No. Press Y to turn on. 14. You can review your list of entries with the BACKSPACE and SPACE keys. When you are happy with the entries, press ESCAPE to exit the list and KeySoft prompts "Add this record?." Press Y to save this record in the list of email accounts. KeySoft confirms your choice with the message "Yes,” "Record added" and returns to the Directory of Email Accounts Menu. If you have more than one email account that you wish to access on the VoiceNote mPower QT, simply add another record in the same way. Each account will have its own POP and SMTP server addresses, which you can get from the email account provider. 11.10.1.2 Look up an Email Account. To check or modify details of a particular account, select "Look up an Email Account". To do this, follow these steps: 1. Select Email from the Main Menu, or press FUNCTION with 8, anywhere. 2. KeySoft announces "KeyMail Menu.” Select Set Up Options from the KeyMail menu. KeySoft announces "KeyMail Set Up Menu." Select Directory of Email accounts. 3. KeySoft announces "Directory of Email Accounts.” Select Look Up an account. KeySoft queries "Account to Look Up?" 4. To lookup all account records, press ENTER. To move to the next account record, press READ with 9, and to move to the previous account record, press READ with 7. Alternatively type part or the entire email account name, then press ENTER. If your entry matches more than one account name, KeySoft announces the number of matches and places you at the first matching account name. To move to the next match, press READ with 9, or to move back, READ with 7. Make a selection by pressing ENTER. 5. KeySoft steps you through the fields of the nominated account so that you can check the details of each item. If you want to change a field, press CONTROL with K anywhere in the list. This takes you into an entry mode where all fields are presented and you can enter or change any field. Press ENTER when you have finished modifying a field and the next field will be presented. ESCAPE takes you back to the review option. To make a duplicate copy of an email account record, you can use the same technique as discussed in 10.5 Duplicating a Record, for duplicating address list records. This provides a quick and convenient way of duplicating a record, and then modifying a field. The account record list comprises the following items: Account Name; User Name; Password; Your Name; Email address; POP Server; POP Server secure connection (SSL). Yes or No; SMTP Server; POP Server secure connection (SSL). Yes or No; SMTP Authentication Required? 6. When you are happy with the entries, press ESCAPE to exit the record, and if you changed any details KeySoft prompts "Add this record?" Press Y to save this record in the list of services or N if you do not want to save your changes. If you want to delete an account record, select the account you wish to remove, and press BACKSPACE with dots 2356. 11.10.2 Receive Options. Receive Options allows you to choose whether you want to delete email from the email service after uploading it to your VoiceNote mPower QT, and to put a size limit on incoming emails. To select Receive Options, first select KeyMail from the Main Menu, and then select Setup Options. You are presented with the KeyMail Setup Menu and Receive Options is the second item on this menu. Selecting Receive Options places you in the Email Receive Options Setup List, which contains two items. 1. "Delete email from service after receiving? currently Yes or No" For the usual option of having each email deleted from your service account after it has been successfully received, press Y. To leave it on the service so that, for example, you can also download it to your PC, press N. This feature can be useful if you wish to keep a complete record of your received email on your PC, and are using your VoiceNote mPower QT to download your messages while you are traveling. 2. "Size limit for automatic download of email? Currently 50K" If an email is larger than this setting, KeySoft will prompt you with a number of options before downloading it. These options were discussed in 11.9.1 Download status. To change the value, enter the maximum size in kilobytes and press ENTER. For example, to set the limit at 60 kilobytes, enter 60, followed by ENTER. The default setting is 50K, or approximately 50,000 characters. To exit the Receive Options list, press ESCAPE and you are returned to the KeyMail Setup Menu. 11.10.3 Free Database Space. Email folders are held in a database. One of the peculiarities of databases is that when you delete items from them, they don't automatically shrink back down again. Because of this, simply deleting your unwanted emails does not free up more space. The "Free database space" software shrinks the database back to the smallest size capable of storing the emails remaining in the database. To use this utility, simply go to the email setup menu, and select the item "Free database space". After running, the utility will report how much space has been freed. End of Email Chapter. 12 Web Browser. KeyWeb has all the same basic features as Internet Explorer. You can browse the web, use a search engine, download files or read a page online and work through forms. KeyWeb can also be used to open and read locally stored html files, such as a saved web page. This chapter is designed to demonstrate the features and commands of KeyWeb, and the ways it makes the Internet accessible for users of the BrailleNote family of products. To learn more about how the Internet works, we suggest that you investigate the various tutorials available that are designed to aid persons who are blind or visually impaired in learning to use the Internet and all its accompanying features. KeyWeb has all the same basic features as Internet Explorer. You can browse the web, use a search engine, download files or read a page online and work through forms. KeyWeb can also be used to open and read locally stored html files, such as a saved web page. This chapter is designed to demonstrate the features and commands of KeyWeb, and the ways it makes the Internet accessible for users of the BrailleNote family of products. To learn more about how the Internet works, we suggest that you investigate the various tutorials available that are designed to aid persons who are blind or visually impaired in learning to use the Internet and all its accompanying features. 12.1 Connecting to the World Wide Web. As with KeyMail, in order to use KeyWeb, you will need to set up at least one connection configuration. The connection configuration makes it possible to connect to an Internet service provider and therefore to the world wide web. There are many different setups you can use to do this, and the ones that you choose will depend on what technology you have available and where you want to be when you browse the web. Here are some examples of available connection configurations: Using the internal modem in your VoiceNote mPower QT, plug into a dialup connection. Connect to a LAN network using an ethernet card Using a WiFi (wireless) card in your VoiceNote mPower QT, access any available WiFi network, at home, school, work, or even out shopping. 12.2 Changing to another part of KeySoft. As is standard in KeySoft, you can jump in and out of KeyWeb to go to other applications such as KeyMail, KeyWord etc. The hot key combination for changing to KeyWeb is FUNCTION with 0 (zero). For more information on the Task list, see 1.14 Switching Between Tasks. If you are using a phone line connection and jump to another task, KeyWeb will ask if you wish to stay connected. If you jump into KeyMail while still connected, you can then use the same connection to check your email. Likewise if you wish to return to KeyWeb from KeyMail, you can continue to use the same connection. If you jump to another task, perhaps to paste new contact information into the Address list, you will also stay connected, and you can return to KeyWeb when you have finished, using FUNCTION with 0 (zero). You will be returned to the same page you left. When using a USB, wireless, network or Bluetooth connection, you will automatically stay connected until you choose to disconnect. 12.2.1 Disconnecting from outside KeyWeb. While using a dialup connection, if you have left KeyWeb while still connected to the Internet, and you decide that you don’t wish to return to either KeyWeb or KeyMail, you can disconnect from right where you are. Simply press FUNCTION with O to access the Options Menu, select Connectivity Menu, and from this menu, select Disconnect. This option only announces in the Connectivity Menu when you are connected to the Internet, and using a dialup connection. 12.3 Logging on. A URL (Uniform Resource Locator) is the location address of a web page; for example, www.humanware.com, or Flash Disk\My Favorites\hw. The first prompt announced when you select KeyWeb from the Main Menu is a request for a URL. At this point you have several options. You can either: Select the home page, which is the URL offered; Type a URL; Copy and paste a URL from another location, such as from KeyWord or KeyMail (For more information refer to 1.15 Copying and Pasting Text); Select a URL from your favorites (For more information refer to 12.8.3 Selecting a Favorite); Select a URL from the history list (For more information refer to 12.9.1 History Records); Select an HTML file from a folder (For more information refer to 12.7 Application Management); Having made a selection, press ENTER. KeySoft prompts for a connection configuration. If you only have one set up, this one will be offered. If you have several configurations, it will offer the last one used. To change service provider, press SPACE at the prompt and select another one in the usual way. During the page loading process, you may hear a series of beeps unless you have turned them off; these are progress tones, designed to let you know something is happening while the page is loading. You can also find out what percentage of the page has loaded by pressing HELP. When the page has completed loading, KeyWeb will announce the words in the top line of the page. Note that you can hear the contents of a URL by pressing READ with COMMA then repeat the command. 12.3.1 Progress tones. Progress tones are there to let you know a page is loading or a download is progressing normally. You can control their volume or turn them off altogether. To do this, go to the Options Menu, Review Voice by pressing FUNCTION with O then R. Press SPACE repeatedly to reach the Progress Tone Volume option. Type a number between 0 and 6. Zero disables the tone, 6 is loudest. To leave the setting unchanged, just press ENTER. The factory setting is 4. 12.4 Navigation. 12.4.1 Moving around a Page. Apart from the "move by" commands outlined below, KeyWeb uses the same commands as the Book Reader for moving through a page. These commands are in the Command Summary and are also covered in 4.2 Additional Reading Commands. There are different ways you can review or move across a web page: You can read it, using the standard KeySoft Read commands. You can skip across it from hyperlink to hyperlink, referred to in KeyWeb as simply “links;” You can move through it reviewing another page element such as input controls, headings or frames. Or you can combine these in any way that works for you. In this chapter, we refer to links, frames, headings and input controls collectively as “page elements.” 12.4.1.1 Moving by text. This function allows you to move from section to section of nonlinked text. You can set a minimum number of characters for KeyWeb to search for. For example, if the minimum size is 50, KeyWeb will find the next section of text that is 50 or more characters long, and skip to the beginning of it ready for you to read. The larger the minimum number, the larger the section KeyWeb will skip to. This is useful when reviewing news or magazine sites, research sites, or anywhere where you just want to get to the information. The key commands are: Move to next section of text: FUNCTION with ENTER, Move to previous section of text: SHIFT with FUNCTION with ENTER. Note: These commands are similar to move by paragraph but use ENTER instead of SPACE. To set the minimum size of the section of text, there is an option in the display settings. To get to this setting, press CONTROL with 2 then D for Display Settings, then select "Text section size?" Enter the number and press ENTER. The factory setting is 50. 12.4.2 Links. Links will take you to another place, either in the same page or website, or somewhere else entirely. They also can lead to downloads, documents, etc. Moving from link to link is a very useful way to review or use many types of sites. Great for reviewing search results on a search engine, a menu page or frame, the home page of a large site, etc. If you have speech on or have set speech on request, you will notice that links are identified by a small beep just before the name of the link. 12.4.2.1 Moving by Link. Moving by Link is always available to you in KeyWeb; so you can use it in conjunction with moving by another type of page element. To move from link to link, use BACKSPACE to move backwards and SPACE to move forwards. Alternatively, press the initial letter of the link. Note that each time you press a particular letter, you are moved to the next link on the page that starts with that letter. For example, if you repeatedly press the letter "n" you will be moved sequentially through all the links starting with "n" in the order that they occur on the page. When punctuation level 1 is set, no beep will be heard. However, when punctuation level 2 is set, you will hear several beeps. For punctuation levels 3 to 5, KeySoft will announce "link start" and "link end". 12.4.2.2 Selecting a Link. You can follow the link you are on by pressing ENTER . It is also possible to place the cursor on a character within a link as opposed to following it, perhaps to copy and paste the link into a document or email. When you are on the link, press and hold down the PREVIOUS navigation key, then press and release the touch cursor. 12.4.3 Other Page Elements. The other three types of page elements you can use to move around the page are Input control, Heading or Frame. You can toggle through these types of page elements using the commands listed below. The default setting is input control. Because these page elements share a separate set of movement commands to links, you can use whichever one you have selected in conjunction with links. You can select links in the same manner as well; the command is included in the list below. What follows is a brief description of each page element and how it is used. Input control: Input controls are fields where you can type in text, or some other form of entry is required. They include text form fields, check boxes, radio buttons, buttons, and selection lists. Almost all forms are made up of a combination of these types of fields. Handling forms is discussed in 12.6.1 Handling Forms. Heading: Headings usually cover the topics on a page and are a good way of finding out what the page is about. Frame: Many web pages are divided into frames. They are basically windows within the page, usually dividing the page into subjects or groups of links etc. This is a high level search and a good way of skipping around a page quickly to get a sense of what it is about. 12.4.4 Commands for Moving by Element. These are the commands used to move around the page by element: Move to next element: TAB; Move to previous element: SHIFT with TAB; Current element: READ with X; Change move type: READ with C; Link: L; Input Control: I; Heading: H; Frame: F. Once you are on an element, you can read from that point. For example, having moved by frame to Frame 2, you can then press READ with G for a speech readout of the contents of that frame. If ever in doubt, press HELP. 12.5 Moving from Page to Page or Site to Site. For pages and sites previously visited in the same session, you can use the forward and back commands RIGHT ARROW and LEFT ARROW to move between them. If you wish to move on to a new site at any point, simply press CONTROL with O. KeyWeb will prompt: “Address? Press ENTER for (current URL).” At this point you have five options (these are the same as when first logging on): 1. To select the current URL, press ENTER. 2. Type in a new URL or favorite name and press ENTER. 3. Go to list of favorites by pressing SPACE. 4. Go to a saved web page by either typing the \pathname with a back slash in front of it, or pressing SPACE and then CONTROL with T to go into directory mode, and locate it that way. Even if you make a selection that is not online, your Internet connection will stay connected. 5. Go to your history by pressing READ with CONTROL with H. For more information on History, refer to 12.9 History. 12.6 Page Management. 12.6.1 Handling Forms. To fill out forms you need to be in "move by input control" mode, as forms are made up of input controls such as form fields, combo or list boxes, check boxes, buttons, and radio buttons. When on an input control, it is not always clear what needs to be input. There are two ways to deal with this: 1. Set the “Automatically read input control prompts” to on. This mode will announce most of the prompts, or labels, that explain the purpose of the input control. NOTE: Some prompts may be coded in such a way that they cannot be read at all. 2. The alternative way is for when you are working with the “Automatically read input control prompts” mode set to "off." Simply press REPEAT to read the prompt. 12.6.1.1 Filling in text fields. To fill in a text field, type the information in computer Braille, e.g. user name, search criteria etc. Any existing text can be deleted by pressing CONTROL with I. You can edit or delete what you have written in the usual way. Once you are happy with your input, press ENTER, and your text will be submitted. Note that you have to press ENTER before your input will be accepted. If you change your mind and don’t wish to submit the contents of the field after all, you can either delete it all by pressing CONTROL with I, or if there is a reset button, move to it using TAB and press ENTER there. If the form has more than one text field, you may need to move between them using TAB instead. 12.6.1.2 Selecting from selection lists. In KeyWeb, selection list is the term used for combo boxes and list boxes. These are the input fields that allow you to make a selection from a list, and sometimes to type in your own entry if none of the list items is appropriate. Once you are in the selection list field, you can select an item by pressing SPACE and BACKSPACE to go down and up the list. Alternatively, in some selection lists you can type the initial letter and press it repeatedly until you find your preferred selection. This is useful in lists of countries or states, for example, where you know the item you are looking for. Having selected an item, simply use SHIFT with TAB or TAB to move on, and your selection will be entered. 12.6.1.3 Selecting Check boxes and buttons. To Tab to a button, check a box or select a radio button, press ENTER. KeyWeb will announce "click" or "check" or "pressed" respectively. 12.7 Application Management. Most application management happens from the Internet Options menu. This is accessible when you are in KeyWeb, either on a web page or a locally stored document, by pressing CONTROL with 2. These are the available options: Open HTML file; Set current page as home page; Go to home page. Internet file management: Clear cookies; Delete temporary files; Erase browser history; File download options. Display settings: Hide images without descriptions; Automatically read input control prompts; Text section size; Default language for web pages. Print current web page; Error status. Here is each of these options in more detail: 12.7.1 Open HTML files. For opening a locally stored document, such as a saved web page. 12.7.2 Set Current Page to Home Page. Your home page is the one that is always presented at the URL prompt. When you first enter KeyWeb, the home page is set to www.humanware.com\keyweb. To change this to a home page of your choice, go to that page in the usual manner, and then select this option off the menu. 12.7.3 Go to home page. No matter where you are on the internet, when you select this option you will go straight to your home page. 12.7.4 Internet File Management. The three items on this submenu all involve managing cached files i.e. files that save themselves to your VoiceNote mPower QT: 12.7.4.1 Clear Cookies. Cookies are small files that are uploaded to your computer or VoiceNote mPower QT by web pages. They serve a wide range of functions, but they can build up and from time to time, it pays to delete them all. Select this option to do so. 12.7.4.2 Delete temporary files. Same as with cookies, web pages upload various files to your VoiceNote mPower QT and they build up over time. Select this option to delete them all. 12.7.4.3 Erase browser history. This clears all of the URL's and files that are listed in KeyWeb's history. Very useful for teachers and students or other people who share equipment, or simply if you end up with a lot of URL's you will never look at again. 12.7.4.4 File download options. From the File Download Options List you have the choice of turning "Stream Audio Links" on (the default) or off. To allow for the streaming of audio links, ensure that "Stream Audio Links" is on. If you want to download an mP3 file, you need to turn "Stream Audio Links" off. 12.7.5 Display Settings. These settings determine the extra information that will announce as you read a web page. 12.7.5.1 Hide images without descriptions Y/N. Visual images may have a label called an alt tag, which describes in words what the image portrays e.g. Child playing with Dog, back view of VoiceNote mPower QT, etc. Images without these alt tags are not a lot of use and in this option you can choose Y to ignore them altogether. The default setting is N. The exception is when an image is used as a link, in which case it will be treated as a link and not an image, regardless of how this setting is set. 12.7.5.2 Automatically read input control prompts Y/N. When this is set to Y for yes, KeyWeb announces the label associated with each of the input controls as it reads them, such as text boxes, radio buttons, check boxes, tables, etc. To turn this feature off, press N. 12.7.5.3 Default language for web pages. If a page is written in a foreign language such as French or German, it may have a hidden HTML code that indicates this. If this is the case, and you have that language on your VoiceNote mPower QT, KeyWeb will automatically read the page in that language. If the page does not have a code marker, you can listen to it and read it using the English setting, or change it to another language in the usual way, again assuming you have that language on your VoiceNote mPower QT. 12.7.5.4 Text Section Size. This was described in 12.4.1.1 Moving by text. Type a minimum number of characters for the "Move by Text Size" function. Factory setting is 50. 12.7.6 Print current web page. To print the current web page, you use the same process that you would for printing a document. If your printer is ready, print the current web page straight away. Otherwise, you will be required to setup the current printer before printing. Refer to Chapter 6 on Embossing and Printing Documents, for further information. 12.7.7 Error status. Occasionally you will find that a web page is not working correctly. If this is the case, KeyWeb will inform you of any Java script errors in the current web page. 12.8 Favorites. You can type in the name of a favorite and, assuming that the favorite exists, that page will be loaded. Pressing SPACE when at the address prompt takes you to a folder / file prompt layer where you can choose an existing favorite to load. 12.8.1 Adding a Favorite page. To add a favorite webpage to your favorites folder, you have to be on the page, online. Go to the Favorites Menu by pressing CONTROL with 1, and press SPACE until you get to “Add current page to Favorites” Press ENTER. KeyWeb will ask you to confirm the name and offers the title of the page. At this point you can rename your favorite by typing in the name of your choice before pressing ENTER. When you next review your Favorites list, the page will announce as the name you chose. 12.8.2 Create favorite from current link. It is possible to create a favorite from a link on a website, such as an audio streaming link. This option will only show up in the Favorites Menu when the cursor is on a link. Go to the Favorites Menu by pressing CONTROL with 1, and press SPACE until you get to “Create Favorite from current link” Press ENTER. KeyWeb will ask you to confirm the name. At this point you can name your favorite by typing in the name of your choice before pressing ENTER. When you next review your Favorites list, the link will announce as the name you chose. 12.8.3 Selecting a Favorite. The simple way to do this is to press the SPACE bar at the URL prompt. This will take you to the List of Favorites in your Favorites folder. Note that there are three home pages that have already been set up as favorites in your Favorites folder. These are: bookshare.org  an online service that provides electronic format books. ifarchive.org  an Interactive Fiction Archive that provides helpful links to download and learn how to play games. list.humanware.com  the location from which you can subscribe or unsubscribe to and modify the settings of various HumanWare lists. You can either review the favorites by pressing SPACE repeatedly and pressing ENTER to select one, or simply type the initial letter of the name and press ENTER when it is announced. To select a favorite from another folder other than your Favorites folder, press the BACKSPACE bar at the URL prompt. KeyWeb will prompt: "Folder name? Press ENTER for My Favorites". Press SPACE and KeyWord will announce: "List of folders on Flash Disk". To review the list of folders on the Flash Disk, press SPACE repeatedly and press ENTER to select one, or simply type the initial letter of the name and press ENTER when it is announced. 12.8.4 Organizing Favorites. You can organize your Favorites in exactly the same way as you would normally organize files and subdirectories in KeySoft, as discussed in Chapter 14. Move, change, rename or delete favorites just as you would any other files. The difference is that instead of KeyWord file format files being the default file type, it is HTML. This means that while in My Favorites, KeyWeb will only announce URL's unless you use the READ with X command, in which case you can then also choose between txt and html file types. 12.9 History. History is a record of all the web addresses or local file paths (referred to as URLs) you have accessed using the browser, with an upper limit of 300. To access the history, press READ with CONTROL with H. To go to the history list, press RIGHT ARROW. To navigate to a page listed in the history, select it from the history list using SPACE and BACKSPACE, then press ENTER. Alternatively, use the READ with F find command to locate the history item in the list then press ENTER. 12.9.1 History Records. Each history record consists of the following information: Date when last visited – self explanatory; URL – the whole address path for the page e.g. http://www.humanware.com/index.cfm/8,html; Title – the title given to a particular page; Domain – the base web address for a page, e.g. www.humanware.com. 12.9.2 Sorting history records. You can change the way in which a history is presented by sorting by day or by domain. A search by day will sort all the fields in a record by date and time order, then by domain. A search by domain will sort all fields by domain, then date and time. To toggle the sort mode press CONTROL with S. The factory setting is by day, and if you change it, the system will always default to the setting you last made, whichever it is. 12.9.3 Reviewing history. Having established a sorting order for the history records, you may then want to review them. You can do this in two ways – by record or by field. Reviewing by record will take you from record to record in the order defined by the sort. Use RIGHT ARROW to review forwards and LEFT ARROW to review back. Review fields within a record by using SPACE for forwards and BACKSPACE for back. Other commands for reviewing history records are: Next History record: RIGHT ARROW. Previous History record: LEFT ARROW. Forward one Day: READ with PERIOD. Back one Day: READ with M. Forward one week: CONTROL with L. Back one week: CONTROL with J. Previous Domain name: CONTROL with O. Next Domain name: CONTROL with U. Newest History record: READ with T. Oldest History record: READ with B. Sort by domain/day: CONTROL with S. Note: history is presented alphabetically for day or domain. 12.9.4 Pop Up Dialog Boxes. KeyWeb is ‘sitting’ on Internet Explorer, and from time to time, Internet Explorer will open a dialog box. You will know this because KeyWeb will announce its title and the fact that it is a dialog box. Wherever possible, the same navigation keystrokes are used as for the rest of KeyWeb. The difference is that at every text input field, you need to press ENTER to submit your input. You then move to the next one using SPACE. The final entry will almost always be a button control with a label such as YES, NO, OK, or CANCEL. Move to the appropriate button and press ENTER to activate it. Where you end up from there will depend on what the dialog box was for. 12.10 Saving and Refreshing Web Pages. Downloading files to the VoiceNote mPower QT is easy. You can use this feature to download: Software upgrades directly onto your VoiceNote mPower QT; Books; Bank Statements; MP3 files; …and other files that you may wish to use on your VoiceNote mPower QT, assuming they are compatible. You can also download files for moving to a PC later. However, please heed the following warning before making any downloads. WARNING: Only HumanWare's proprietary software can run on the VoiceNote mPower QT. KeyWeb does not limit the type of file you can download, but we strongly advise you not to try and run executables on your VoiceNote mPower QT, including those designed to run on Windows CE. Doing this could cause irreparable damage to your VoiceNote mPower QT and to KeySoft, and you do so at your own risk. Follow these steps to download a file off an internet site. 1. When you are on the download link or button, press ENTER. KeySoft will prompt: "Download file into which folder?" 2. Select a folder in the usual way, either on the VoiceNote mPower QT itself or on an external drive or storage card. 3. KeySoft will prompt: "Download file name? Press ENTER for (file name)" where the file name is the current name of the file to download. Press ENTER, or to change the name of the file at this point, type a new name (without a file extension, which is automatically added) and press ENTER. When the download is complete, you will be returned to a blank page. You can then use the go back or forward commands to return to the web page you were previously in, or press CONTROL with O to choose another page. Note: Please remember that the entire available memory of the FlashDisk is 14MB at most. If you attempt to download a file that is too big for the VoiceNote mPower QT to receive, you can abort the download by pressing ESCAPE during the download process. To find out the status of a download at any time, press HELP. And remember, you can download large files to a storage card instead of the Flash Disk. General Caution: While copying or moving any files onto your FlashDisk from any location, never perform a reset. This can cause your Flashdisk to disappear and can cause corruption. 12.11 Tables. Tables are a common occurrence on web pages, and are used for everything from setting out items for sale to laying out records in online banking. KeyWeb has a Table Mode just for navigating tables. To get into Table mode, you need to be in a table. Press READ with S. While in table mode, you can find out what cell you are in. Press READ with Q and KeyWeb will announce your row and column coordinates. The cursor moves through a table by row or by column. On the display there will be one space between each column, and two spaces between each row. While in Table mode the following navigation commands apply. Move forward one cell along a row: READ with O. To hear the current cell in a row: READ with 8. Move back one cell along a row: READ with U. Move down one cell in a column: READ with 9. To hear the current cell in a column:READ with I. Move down one cell in a column: READ with 7. End of Web Browser Chapter. 13 Connectivity. This chapter looks at all the different ways the VoiceNote mPower QT can connect to other forms of technology. From cables to cableless, there is bound to be a connection configuration that will suit your requirements. These connection configurations allow you to access: The World Wide Web; Email; Local Area Network; Your PC via ActiveSync. Bluetooth makes it possible to access the web and your email anywhere, any time, by pairing with a bluetooth cell phone. You can also pair with a bluetooth qwerty keyboard. With wireless networking you can also access the web and your email anywhere where there is an available wireless network. Use it to view the network on your VoiceNote mPower QT and even manage network files LAN networking makes the same things possible, using a cable to connect to the network. USB client allows you to connect to your PC with ActiveSync and access your email or the web via your PC's internet connection, be it dial up or networked. USB host allows you to use a USB printer of embosser, keyboard or any of a range of USB client devices. Serial connection allows you to dialup the internet via a modem, or view your VoiceNote mPower QT on your PC using ActiveSync. Infrared port provides a fast and easy connection to a compatible PC or printer. This chapter assumes that you have a basic understanding of networking and already have a network available. Not all the options discussed require a network however, so don't be put off if this is not something you wish to get into! The heart of setting up connectivity on your VoiceNote mPower QT is the Connectivity Menu. This is available from the Options Menu. 13.1 Understanding Connectivity Concepts. The world of connectivity is a world of communication between, or among, devices of all kinds. Just as in the world of human beings, where there are those who speak our language and those who don't, not all devices can talk to all other devices, they have to share a method of communication. And again, just as sometimes people don't like what each other are saying, or don't agree, or misunderstand; in the world of connectivity, even when devices share the same methods of connecting, they don't always manage to connect the first time. Why is this? Firstly, because electronic and computerized devices are "dumb". They only know what they know, and if a device offers another device a setting even slightly different to what it is expecting, it will ignore it. And while there are industry standards, with so many different companies manufacturing devices that are trying to talk to each other, there is bound to be the odd miscommunication, where theory collides with practice. Then there is the business of which device initiates the connection. With cableless connectivity options such as wireless networking, this gets even more interesting again. When you use cables, you actually plug the cable in between two devices, so there is no ambiguity as to which devices are supposed to be communicating. However, cableless devices have to broadcast their availability to all other devices within range, and then there is a stage of identifying which device goes with which, not to mention security levels etc., before anything else can happen. In the face of all these possibilities, initiating a connection can take some patience, some tweaking, but most of all, following the instructions. The VoiceNote mPower QT has been designed to make this as straightforward as possible. There is just one important rule to remember  that the VoiceNote mPower QT initiates all connections. A special case among tens of millions of PC's, laptops and PDA's, it knows best what it needs from other devices, and is set up to initiate connections. 13.2 Connection Configurations. A connection configuration is a record of the settings required in order to be able to use a particular type of connectivity, such as wireless networking or a phoneline, with a particular device. Because each type of connectivity is different, their configuration needs to be different. You may also find that you will need to set up different configurations for the same kind of connectivity, such as a network configuration for work, and one for home. The same connection configuration can be available for a range of uses, such as email, browsing the web, and local network access. In this section we discuss the devices available to connect your VoiceNote mPower QT with other devices. 13.3 The Connectivity Menu. The connectivity menu is the heart of the connectivity options available on the VoiceNote mPower QT. The Connectivity Menu is off the Options Menu. It has the following items: Create a New Dialup or LAN connection: Select this option to set up a new dial up, or LAN connection i.e. using an ethernet card. Refer to 13.6.1 Creating a New Dialup or LAN connection. Disconnect Dialup connection: Only announces when the VoiceNote mPower QT is online using a dialup connection. Refer to 13.6.4 Disconnect Dialup connection. Active Connection Details (Name): This option gives you information on any connection that is currently active. Refer to 13.7 Active Connection Details. Bluetooth: Select this option to turn Bluetooth on or off. Refer to 13.12 Bluetooth. . Wireless Ethernet: Select this option to turn WiFi on or off. Refer to 13.4 Using a Wireless Connection. Review an existing connection configuration: This option allows you to make changes to a configuration. Refer to 13.8 Review an existing connection configuration. Setup Options: When you select this option, KeySoft prompts: Computer name? Currently VoiceNote. You can change the name of the VoiceNote to something unique. This is the name that a network will use to identify your VoiceNote mPower QT as a networked device. This is particularly important if any other network users are using a VoiceNote mPower QT. 13.4 Using a Wireless Connection. Wireless networking is just a different form of computer networking that doesn't require cables. It is also sometimes referred to as WiFi or 802.11, but they are all the same thing. To use the VoiceNote mPower QT with a wireless network, you will need a wireless network card. This is a card that fits into either the PCMCIA or CompactFlash card slots on the VoiceNote mPower QT. HumanWare supports a range of WiFi cards  for a list of these please refer to the readme, to the FAQ page of our website, or contact us. You will also need access to a wireless network. This may be in your home, workplace or school, or in an airport, café or library. There are two ways in which to access a wireless network  through setting up a connection configuration, and through scanning for and picking up a wireless network. Which method you use will depend on the circumstances. Although there has been much talk over the past few years about wireless security, or lack of it, most workplaces or institutions will have proper security measures in place on their wireless networks. These comprise a range of settings, passwords and codes that are only made available to legitimate users. In the case of public wireless networks such as in libraries and airports, the network itself will provide most of the settings automatically because they are set up to let you log in, not to prevent you. However, before trying to connect your VoiceNote mPower QT to any nonpublic wireless network, be aware that you will need to have some advance information about the wireless network, usually via the network administrator. To find out how to: Create a new wireless networking configuration, refer to 13.4.1 Creating a new Wireless Configuration. Scan for a new wireless network and logging on, refer to 13.4.2 Scanning for a Wireless Network. Connect to wireless network after it is set up, refer to 13.4.3 Reconnecting to a Wireless Network. Organize the wireless network configurations already set up, refer to 13.5 Wireless Configuration Options. 13.4.1 Creating a new Wireless Configuration. When you have a wireless connection available to you on a regular basis, you should set up a dedicated configuration for it. It may be, for example, on your college campus or in your workplace. All wireless networks have an SSID (Service Set Identifier). The SSID is just the name given to the network. For added security, networks not intended for access by the general public may hide their SSID, so it can not be displayed when you scan for visible networks. In this case, the network administrator needs to tell you what the SSID for the network is, and any other applicable settings such as WEP. To create a connection configuration for a wireless connection, go to the Wireless Network option of the connectivity Menu. Ensure the wireless network card is inserted into the VoiceNote mPower QT's card slot, as without it this procedure is not possible: 1. Insert your wireless card into the appropriate card slot of the VoiceNote mPower QT. 2. From the Options menu, select Connectivity by pressing C, then Wireless Ethernet, by pressing W. 3. KeySoft prompts, "Wireless on? Currently No." Press Y for Yes. 4. You are at the Wireless Ethernet Menu. Select "Configure a New Wireless Connection" and press ENTER. KeySoft presents you with the Entry List for Connection configuration. You can move down the list by pressing SPACE. 5. The first item is Name. Enter any name you like, something that is meaningful to you, and press ENTER. 6. KeySoft prompts, "SSID?" This is the name of the network as determined by the network administrator. Type in the SSID and press ENTER. 7. Next are "Use Infrastructure Mode?" and "Use Shared Authentication?", which both require a Y or N value. The values you need to assign will be given to you by the network administrator. 8. Next is "Use WEP?" If you answer Y, the next item you see on the list is a WEPKey entry field. Type in the WEPkey and press ENTER. Note that the WEPkey will be in hexadecimal format and either 10 characters long for a 64 encryption or 26 characters long for a 128 encryption. 9. Next is 802.1x Authentication. This will be either 0 for no authentication, 1 for TLS, or 2 for MD5  Challenge. Type in the appropriate value and press ENTER. 10. The rest of the fields are standard network settings and again, the values will come from the network administrator. The fields are: "Obtain an IP Address Automatically?", "IP Address", "Subnet Mask", "Default Gateway", "Primary DNS", "Secondary DNS", "Primary WINS", and "Secondary WINS." Any fields that don't need changing, just pass over them by pressing SPACE. 11. KeySoft prompts, "Use a proxy server for this connection?" If N for No, you will go to the end of the list. If Y for Yes, you will need to fill in two more fields  "proxy server name" and "proxy server port." 12. To save and close the record, press ESCAPE. KeySoft prompts, "Add this Record?" Press Y for Yes or N for No. This configuration is now available for use as described in 13.4.3 Reconnecting to a Wireless Network. To make changes to, or to delete a wireless configuration, use the “Review an existing connection configuration” function as described in 13.8 Review an existing connection configuration. 13.4.2 Scanning for a Wireless Network. An alternative way to log into a wireless network is to scan for it. Wireless networks that have the public display of their SSID disabled will be invisible to a scan, so scanning is not an appropriate way to try to log into those networks. However wireless networks with low, or no security, such as are found in libraries, airports and cafés etc., are set up through scanning. This is because when selected the first time, they then typically transfer most of the settings required in a connection configuration automatically to your VoiceNote mPower QT. This connection configuration is then available to use to log on automatically in the future. 1. To scan for a new wireless network, from the Wireless Ethernet menu, select Scan for Wireless Networks and press ENTER. 2. KeySoft prompts, "List of available connections." The connections listed will depend on how many wireless networks are displaying themselves in your vicinity. To review the list, press SPACE. Each network will announce its name, for example: 1. SSID: Vodaphone; 2. SSID: Tsunami; 3. SSID: Air America 3. Make a selection by pressing ENTER. 4. KeySoft prompts, "Entry List for Connection Configurations." Press SPACE. The first field is the connection configuration name. Give it a name and press ENTER. In most cases, the rest of the fields will be correctly configured by the connection itself, however this will vary depending on how the wireless network is set up. In some cases, the venue will provide you with a code to enter, in others the whole configuration is provided. Once completed, exit the configuration using ESCAPE and press Y when asked if you wish to save it. 5. KeySoft announces the name of the network, e.g. "1. SSID: Vodaphone, Active" You are now on the Wireless network. The next time you scan for this network, it will show up with its configuration listed just before its name. For example, if the connection configuration is called VP, you would hear or read, "VP SSID: Vodaphone. Active." Just press ENTER on this option and you will be connected. 13.4.3 Reconnecting to a Wireless Network. This option makes it really easy to connect to a wireless network that you use repeatedly. If you only use one wireless network, this option automatically reconnects to it. If you use more than one, a list of configurations is formed. As the VoiceNote mPower QT can only pick up a wireless network that is in the vicinity, this option will always pick up the one that you want. In the unusual situation that you have two wireless networks with configurations in the same vicinity or two configurations for the same wireless network, so that there is a chance it may pick up the wrong one, you can change the order of the list so that the preferred configuration will get picked up first. To reconnect to a wireless network; from the Connectivity Menu, select “Reconnect using existing Configurations” and press ENTER. KeySoft will announce, "Please Wait, connecting to (config)" there will be progress beeps as it locates the network, then "Please Wait, connected to (config)." You are now connected to the wireless network. Of course in order to reconnect, you will need to have your wireless card inserted. 13.4.3.1 Changing preferred order. Wireless network connection configurations will order themselves with the first created at the top. As discussed in the previous section, if this doesn't work for you, you can change the order of the list. To change the order of the list, follow these steps: 1. From the Wireless Ethernet Menu, select Order Connection Preferences. 2. KeySoft prompts: "List of configurations in preferred order." To review the list, press SPACE. The list will be something like: 1. work; 2. home; 3. home2 3. When you are on the item you wish to move, press CONTROL with ENTER. This will take you to the Preference Order Action Menu. The options are: Top: Move to the top of the list, Up: Move up one position in the list, Down: Move down one position in the list, and Bottom: Move to the bottom of the list. 4. Select a move from the list and the order will change accordingly. For example: I want to move "home2" above "home", as it is the one I use most often. I go to "3. home2" and press CONTROL with ENTER. I press SPACE twice to get to "Up: Move up one position in the list," and press ENTER. KeySoft announces, "2. home2," confirming that "home2" has moved to position 2. I press ESCAPE. 13.5 Wireless Configuration Options. The Wireless configuration options allow you to set some parameters on how wireless operates on the VoiceNote mPower QT. To review the list items, press SPACE to go down the list, or BACKSPACE to go up. To get to the “Wireless Ethernet Options List,” select it from the Wireless Ethernet Menu. The three options and their purposes are: 1. “Notify when new networks are available (currently yes/no)” When this option is set to yes, a message announces when the device is not yet connected to a wireless network and a network is sensed by the wireless card. 2. “Automatically Connect to Non preferred Networks (currently yes/no)”. This option allows the wireless card to try to establish a connection to a network that is not part of the existing configurations database. 3. “Types of Networks to Access (Currently Access Points only )”. When trying to connect, this option filters out the wireless devices using a different Infrastructure. The default is Access points only with P as its hotkey. This setting detects only network access points. For AdHoc only, press H. This filters out access points and detects only peer to peer devices. For all types of network, press A, this allows any type of network to be accessed. 13.6 Dial up and LAN Connections. These two kinds of connection are quite different in the way they operate, but have some things in common in how you set them up. This is because both are used to access the internet, and both require cables. Even if you are using a LAN network connection to access a network, instead of just using the internet, the setting up of the network connection configuration is the same. This section explains how to set up a dial up or LAN connection, and how to use it once you have done so. 13.6.1 Creating a New Dialup or LAN connection. Use this option to set up a Dial up or LAN connection, as the name suggests. You can also enter a wireless configuration this way but it is preferable to do so via the "Wireless" Menu item. Before following this procedure, please refer to either 13.6.3 Using a Dialup Connection. or 13.6.2 Using a LAN connection, whichever applies to what you want to do. They provide essential information about devices and settings that are needed to complete the procedure. 1. Configurations are kept in a database, and the first time you go to enter a configuration, you will be prompted to create a database in which to do it. KeySoft prompts: "The database for connection configurations does not exist. Create a database called connection configurations?." Press Y for yes and this happens automatically. After the first time you won't hear this prompt again. 2. KeySoft prompts: "Entry list for connection configurations." To go to the first field, press SPACE. 3. "Connection configuration name?" Enter a name for the record that is meaningful to you, then press ENTER. 4. "Device to use? (name)." Dialup only  if using networking, select the device to use (such as, ethernet if you are accessing a network via the ethernet card) and then go to step 9. If you are not using Dialup, this is where you specify the device through which you are making the connection, such as a type of modem. Select the device you want by pressing ENTER. To cycle through the list, press CONTROL with SPACE and make a selection by pressing ENTER. 5. "Phone Number?." For dialup connections only. If using in a work environment, remember to add any dialout prefix to the number. 6. "Service User name?." This is the user name you use to get onto the internet via your ISP. Type it here. Likewise the "Service Password?." 7. For the rest of the prompts, leave them set to their default unless otherwise stated in 13.6.3 Using a Dialup Connection. or 13.6.2 Using a LAN connection. 8. For dialup connections only: When you are happy with all the settings, add this configuration by either pressing CONTROL with ENTER, or ESCAPE then Y at the "Save this record?" prompt. The rest of this procedure applies to networking configurations only. 9. The rest of the fields relate to networking using a LAN. As discussed in 13.6.2 Using a LAN connection, you may not need to fill in all, or even any of them, depending on the way in which the network is set up. "IP Address"  This identifies the VoiceNote mPower QT as a part of the network. "Subnet Mask"  The part of the IP address that is common to all of the IP addresses in the domain. "Default Gateway"  Default connection to the Internet through another piece of hardware or software that provides address translation and/or security. "Primary DNS"  Domain Name Server  translates network names into IP addresses. "Secondary DNS"  The system will look to this setting if the primary DNS setting cannot be located. "Primary WINS"  A WINS setting has a similar purpose to DNS, and it is highly unlikely a network will have both WINS and DNS. The system administrator will advise you which to use. "Secondary WINS"  The system will look to this setting if the primary WINS setting cannot be located. Proxy Settings: "Use a proxy server for this connection?" Y/N 'proxy server name" "proxy server port" End Of List 13.6.2 Using a LAN connection. LAN is an acronym for Local Area Network. We use the term in this user guide to refer to networking via an ethernet card and cable as opposed to wireless networking, which uses a wireless network card that doesn't need cables. Wireless networking is discussed separately in 13.4 Using a Wireless Connection. To establish a LAN connection for your VoiceNote mPower QT, you will need an Ethernet Card (type Socket Low Power Ethernet (LPE) EA2902139, CF+ R/LP  E)  which has a ruggedized, i.e. connected, cable. You will also need access to a working ethernet computer network, via a network capable PC, server, hub/switch/router or DSL modem. When configuring the connection, use these specific settings: At the "Device to Use?" prompt, select Ethernet Network. At the "Obtain an IP address automatically?" setting, ensure it is set to yes, unless the network uses static IP addresses as in scenarios a and b below, where it is necessary to enter the IP address manually. When set to Yes, this setting allows the network to fill in the rest of the fields automatically except the proxy server fields. The scenarios below cover most of the common network configurations found at work, school or at home. In a work or school scenario, you may need to involve the network administrator in this task. a. Home Network: If you have one PC and only intend to connect to the VoiceNote mPower QT, such as in a home user situation (i.e. No DHCP server, no WINS, maybe gateway), set an IP address in the same range as the PC's IP address. For example, if the PC's is 10.0.0.1, make the VoiceNote mPower QT's 10.0.0.2. If the PC acts as a gateway, add a gateway address. If you use a router, the address is likely to start with 192.168.0.n where n is a number that uniquely identifies your VoiceNote mPower QT. Note: If another computer is subsequently attached to the network, it MAY take the IP address that the VoiceNote mPower QT has. If this happens, one of the addresses will need to be changed, and setup run again. b. Local Network with static IP addresses: If the network uses static IP addresses i.e. not automatically assigned, set an IP address on the VoiceNote mPower QT in the range of acceptable addresses. Add a gateway address if available. c. Local Network with DHCP: This kind of network automatically assigns IP addresses. When creating the new dialup or LAN connection, set the "Obtain an IP address automatically?" setting to Yes. It will pick up the DNS or WINS from the DHCP. 13.6.3 Using a Dialup Connection. To use a dialup connection, you will need a modem. The VoiceNote mPower QT has its own internal 56k modem. If for some reason you wish to use an external modem, this is also possible. Both are discussed in this section. 13.6.3.1 Using the Internal Modem. The VoiceNote mPower QT has an internal 56k modem. The modem port used for connecting this modem to a dialup connection is located on the right of the rear panel. Your VoiceNote mPower QT is supplied with a modem cable for use with this port. If you live in UK, Australia or New Zealand, an adapter that plugs into a standard "BT" type phone jack is also supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT. The modem cable plugs into the adapter and the adapter plugs into a phone jack. The modem cable has a phone type plug at either end of the cable. Insert one plug into the VoiceNote mPower QT's modem port and the other end into a phone jackpoint. To do this, locate the locking clip on one side of the plug. Orient this side to the bottom of the modem port, engage the plug in the socket and push the plug home. The plug should hold when the cable is lightly pulled. To unplug, squeeze the clip in towards the plug and pull the cable. The case bottom is scalloped under the modem port so that you can easily get your fingertip under the clip. When the plug is unclipped it releases freely. 13.6.3.2 Using an external modem. While it is possible to use an external modem with the VoiceNote mPower QT, there is little advantage in terms of speed of connection. However the following two scenarios are possible: 1. Using an external modem connected via serial port: If you are using this combination, connect the modem to the VoiceNote mPower QT using the serial to serial cable. Ensure the modem is on and plugged into a phone line. The device name to choose when configuring the connection is Hayes Compatible Modem on COM1. 2. Using a card modem in the CF card slot: Insert the modem card before setting up a configuration for it, and it will appear on the device list as the name given to it by the manufacturer. 13.6.4 Disconnect Dialup connection. This option only announces when you are online with a dialup connection. It allows you to hang up without having to be in either KeyMail or KeyWeb at the time. To disconnect from the dialup connection, select this option off the Connectivity Menu and press Y for Yes. To exit without disconnecting, press N for No. 13.7 Active Connection Details. This option off the Connectivity menu lists out information on a currently active wireless or LAN connection. The items listed are: Name: Status: connected to (name of network) Signal strength: (if connected via wireless) IP Address: DNS address: Test current connection. This last option is a "ping" function. This allows you to check if there is a connection path between the VoiceNote mPower QT and a particular site. Although KeySoft prompts you for the IP address, you can also enter a URL such as www.humanware.com. 13.8 Review an existing connection configuration. This option allows you to access connection configurations that you have already created, and view and/or edit the information in them. This applies to all configurations including wireless ones. From the Connectivity Menu, select "Review an existing connection configuration". Using SPACE, then RIGHT ARROW to move from one to the next, find the configuration record that you wish to review. At this point you can review the different fields in the record by pressing SPACE and BACKSPACE. If you wish to make a change to any field, follow these steps: 2. Move to the field to be changed. Press CONTROL with K, and you are asked for a new entry for this field. There are three options here: a) Type a new entry and press ENTER. b) Edit the old field which is offered as the suggestion, as described in 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. . c) Clear the field by pressing CONTROL with BACKSPACE, followed by ENTER. 3. This puts you in an entry list so you can modify or add to any other field as well. You have the same three options for all the fields, and you can change any other field in the record. If you want to fill in a field that is blank, simply navigate to it and type in the new entry. 13.8.1 Duplicating a Connection Configuration. Being able to duplicate a connection configuration is highly useful when you wish to make slight variations to the configuration, such as adding a dial out prefix to a phone number for use at work. It is better, and far simpler, to create two configurations than to keep changing the setting in the one configuration. By duplicating the entire configuration and renaming it, all you then have to do is adjust the settings that need it, and you have a second configuration. To create a duplicate configuration, follow these steps: 1. From the Connectivity Menu, select "Review an existing connection configuration". Using SPACE, then RIGHT ARROW to move from one to the next, find the configuration you wish to duplicate, go to name field by pressing SPACE, then exit with ESCAPE. 2. Select the "Create a new Dialup or LAN Connection" option and when you get as far as the "Connection configuration name?" prompt, select the Block Commands Menu by pressing CONTROL with B. Note that this is a different menu to the Block Commands menu in KeyWord. 3. Press SPACE and KeyList announces: "Retrieve last record?". This is the configuration you accessed in step 1, so press ENTER. 4. KeyList prompts, "Connection configuration name? Currently (name)". You now have two identical configurations. Change the name, and any other fields necessary, then press ESCAPE. 5. When prompted to save the record, press Y for Yes. 13.9 Glossary of terms: These are terms that are used with LAN and wireless networking. DHCP: Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. WINS: Windows Internet Naming Service  Microsoft specific Name. Number protocol: similar to DNS, but for NetBIOS. Gateway: Connection to the Internet through another piece of hardware or software that provides address translation and/or security. IP Address: Identifier on a Network. DNS: Domain Name Server, translates network names into IP addresses. WEP: Wired Equivalent Privacy, encryption protocol on wireless networks providing a security level similar to a wired connection. Both 64bit (the standard WEP) and 128bit encryption strength are available. It is however recommended that you use 128bit encryption as it offers the highest level of security. Note that WPA encryption is not currently supported. 802.1x: Authentication protocol in use on wireless networks. Subnet mask: A mask used to determine what subnet an IP address belongs to. LAN: Local Area Network. Access Point: Device connected to a network that allows other wireless devices to enter this network. Infrastructure: Type of wireless connection (using an access point or in Ad Hoc mode). Ad Hoc: Wireless direct (Peer to peer) connection between devices. 13.10 Troubleshooting. 1. "Card not recognized" message on inserting Ethernet card into the VoiceNote mPower QT: Have you inserted the card up the right way? Is the card one that is supported? Check out the readme, or our website FAQ,. 2. VoiceNote mPower QT doesn't acknowledge your wireless card: Have you inserted the card up the right way? Is the card one that is supported? Check out the readme, or our website FAQ. Did you reset after inserting the card? This is important as it enables the VoiceNote mPower QT to recognize the presence of the wireless card. 3. Connection to ActiveSync over Ethernet fails, however, Internet connection (mail, browser etc) via DSL or Cable Modem works: Is there a firewall program (such as Zone Labs ZoneAlarm, or Norton Personal Firewall) on the PC? If so, have the appropriate ports been opened? Has "Allow network (Ethernet) and Remote Access Service (RAS) server connection with this desktop computer." been checked in the ActiveSync Connection Settings dialog? If you have any troubles with ActiveSync once you have set it up, try deleting the partnership and creating a new one. This allows you to reset all the settings in ActiveSync. Alternatively, try a reset on the VoiceNote mPower QT with no keys held down. 13.11 Firewalls. If there is a firewall in use on your network, disable any firewall blocking for the IP address of the VoiceNote mPower QT. This may require setting a static IP address for the VoiceNote mPower QT, depending on the firewall in use on the network. 13.12 Bluetooth. Bluetooth allows devices to connect to one another without the need for cables. A Bluetooth device contains a radio transceiver that takes the information normally carried by a cable, and transmits it at a special frequency to a Bluetooth transceiver in the receiving device, which will then pass the information to that device. When two Bluetooth enabled devices link up like this, it is called "pairing." Every Bluetooth device has one or more services that it offers. These are functions that it has available to share with another Bluetooth device. In Bluetoothspeak, offering a service is called exposing a service. For example, a keyboard can only expose keyboard as a service, as it can only do one thing. A PC however, may expose a range of services, such as "modem", "network", or "headset". This is complicated slightly by the fact that devices expose all of the services they can potentially support, whether or not the device transmitting a request to pair can actually use those services. Bluetooth is a relatively new technology and has some interesting idiosyncrasies such as the one just mentioned. However with patience it usually all works in the end! Most Bluetooth device pairings involve an authentication code. This code is sometimes known by other names, but it's the same thing. When initially setting up the pairing, you enter the same code into each device, and in subsequent pairings, this is used by the devices to recognize one another. Not all pairings require a code, even if they ask for one, so a certain amount of experimentation might be worthwhile. 13.12.1 VoiceNote mPower QT Supported Services. The VoiceNote mPower QT can pair with a Bluetooth keyboard, the modem functionality of a Bluetooth cell phone, and the ActiveSync and modem services exposed by a Bluetooth enabled PC. We do advise that you get recommendations of makes and models of these devices that work with the VoiceNote mPower QT successfully, or test this yourself before purchasing any Bluetooth device. To use any of these services, you first need to establish a pairing between the VoiceNote mPower QT and the other device. This is akin to plugging the two devices into one another before being able to actually do anything. This is discussed in the following section 13.12.2 Pairing with another Bluetooth device. 13.12.2 Pairing with another Bluetooth device. The procedure for pairing the VoiceNote mPower QT with another device is fairly consistent regardless of what the device is. Using ActiveSync involves a few more steps so it is documented separately in context in 13.14.4 Connecting using Bluetooth. 1. Go to the Options Menu by pressing SPACE with O, then C for the Connectivity Menu. 2. Select Bluetooth and press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "Bluetooth on? Currently Yes/No." Press Y. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Search for devices?" Press Y. KeySoft announces, "Searching for Bluetooth devices, please wait..." This may take a few seconds during which you will hear progress beeps. 4. When the search is complete, KeySoft will announce: "List of Bluetooth devices." 5. Review the list with SPACE and select the device with which you want to pair by pressing ENTER when it is announced. Single service devices such as a keyboard, will offer pairing when selected and you can start using them straight away, although in many cases you will be asked to type in an authentication code. This code is the same on both sides, and you will need to enter it on each side. The VoiceNote mPower QT will cue you through this process. Pairing with a PC to use ActiveSync is slightly different so refer to 13.14.4 Connecting using Bluetooth. Once you have established a pairing, the VoiceNote mPower QT keeps a record of it and the authentication code, so it is easy to reconnect next time. Specific details on how to pair with a Bluetooth keyboard follow. Specific details on pairing with a Bluetooth Printer are covered in 6.4 Printing with Bluetooth. 13.12.2.1 Connecting to a Bluetooth keyboard. Follow these steps to connect to a Bluetooth keyboard. 1. Press the "connect" button on the Bluetooth keyboard. This is usually found on the underside of the keyboard. 2. Start a search for Bluetooth devices using the VoiceNote mPower QT as described in steps 1 to 4 of the previous section. 3. Once searching is complete and the keyboard is on the device list, pair & activate the keyboard. 4. At the "Authentication code?" prompt, type any code and press ENTER. 5. Then type the same code on the Bluetooth keyboard and press ENTER. You should now be connected. 13.12.3 Setting up Bluetooth on your PC. If your PC is not already Bluetooth enabled, you can turn your PC into a Bluetooth device by purchasing a Bluetooth USB dongle or a Bluetooth CF card from an electronics retailer. These plug into the USB port or card reader on your PC and come with the necessary software on CD. As with any new soft or hardware, first ensure that your PC meets the system requirements. The PC may offer services including ActiveSync (if ActiveSync is installed) and a modem, if it has one. 13.13 Accessing the Network through your VoiceNote mPower QT. As well as accessing the internet, you can also use a connection between the VoiceNote mPower QT and a network to access the rest of the network on your VoiceNote mPower QT. This means that you can browse to folders and files on the network, allowing you to open compatible files and/or attach any kind of file to your emails. Open an MS Word file from a network folder, make changes and close it again. Email an Excel spreadsheet using your VoiceNote mPower QT or, if you receive one, move it onto the network where you can open it from a PC. Transfer files quickly and easily onto the network. This is possible when a LAN or wireless connection is set up without ActiveSync (which has the opposite effect of allowing you to browse the VoiceNote mPower QT file structure on your PC). If you don't already have a connection configuration set up for using with LAN or wireless networking, follow the connection set up instructions in 13.6.1 Creating a New Dialup or LAN connection or 13.4.1 Creating a new Wireless Configuration. The network appears as Network on the Drive list when there is a Network available. 13.13.1 Network terminology. There are several key terms and concepts that are important to understand in order to access a network confidently. Network Client: A network client is a device that requests and receives data over the network. When connected to a network, the VoiceNote mPower QT is a client device. Domain: A domain is a group of computers and devices on a network that are administered as a unit. A network may have only one domain, or multiple domains, depending on the way it has been designed. The domain is the highest point available when searching and you need to know the name of the domain in order to do so. Please note that if a network is a workgroup and doesn't have a domain, you won't be able to search by domain. Server: A server is basically a computer on which the network, or part of the network, resides. There may be one or several servers in a domain. If you wish to access a specific server on the network, you will need to know its name. Otherwise you can search the domain and locate it that way. Network Folders: We are using this term to cover all of the shared folders and directories or resources on a network. Resources that are not available for use with the VoiceNote mPower QT, such as printers, will not show up at all. Network Place: The VoiceNote mPower QT allows you to map any frequently used network folders to a list of network places, making it quick and easy to access them. The list of Network Places is the first thing to appear once you select Network Drive. For more information, refer to 13.13.4 Network Places. 13.13.2 How to access Network for the first time. This topic explains how to set up access to a network's servers and folders via your VoiceNote mPower QT. The first time you access the network, there are no defaults set up as it is previously unchartered territory. However on subsequent uses, you will find that most of the prompts will offer your previous choice as a default, for example, "Network server? Press enter for server1." There are other short cuts for future use that are discussed as they come up. Before starting this procedure, you will need to know the exact name and spelling of either the domain, if there is one, or the server or servers that you wish to access. You will also need to have a wireless or LAN card plugged in and in the case of a wireless card, be connected. In both cases, you will need of course to have a connection configuration set up to access this particular network using either method. Lastly you will need to know your username and password for logging onto the network, if the network requires this. From anywhere in KeySoft where you are prompted to select a Drive from the Drive list (for example, File Manager, Directory): 1. Select Network from the Drive list by pressing N. 2. KeySoft prompts, "Network Place?." Ignore this prompt for now and press SPACE twice. 3. KeySoft prompts, "Browse entire Network." Press ENTER. 4. At this point you have two choices; Network Server, or press SPACE to choose Domain to Search?. The one you choose will depend on what information you have available. If you know the name and exact spelling of the server you wish to access on the network, type it at the Network Server prompt and press ENTER. If you know the name and exact spelling of the domain and wish to search for a network folder that way, type it in at the Domain to Search? prompt and press ENTER. 5. Regardless of which option you chose, if you have to log into this network, at this point you will be prompted for your network server user name. If your Braille code does not support the characters required, you will be advised to use Computer Braille. 6. Press ESCAPE. This extracts you from the login fields. the VoiceNote mPower QT will ask you to verify your choice to save username and password with a Y or N. 7. KeySoft prompts: "Update the default login information?." This prompt relates to whether you wish to save your login details on the VoiceNote mPower QT. If you type Y for yes, you will hear a warning about the risks of saving it. However if you do save it, you won't need to log in manually again. If you type N for no, you won't run the risk of someone using your VoiceNote mPower QT to gain access to the network with your login, but you will have to reenter your username and password every time. 8. If you chose the Network Server name, skip this step. If you chose the domain search, at this point you will be presented with all of the servers on the network. You can review them all by pressing SPACE, or press the initial letter of the server you are looking for, repeatedly if necessary, until you find it. Press ENTER. 9. KeySoft prompts: "Network Folder?." Either type the exact name, review all the folders by pressing SPACE, or press the initial letter of the folder you are looking for until you find it. Press ENTER. 10. KeySoft prompts: "Network Place name for this folder? Press ENTER for (folder name)." Type another name or press ENTER. Network Places are explained in 13.13.4 Network Places. 11. From here on, it is the same as reviewing the folder structure in the VoiceNote mPower QT. Note: If you turn off the VoiceNote mPower QT, the VoiceNote mPower QT will ask you to enter your network server user name and password as soon as you select Network from the Drive List. 13.13.3 How to access the Network after the first time. Once you have been onto the network at least once and set up a network place or places, accessing the network becomes a lot more straightforward. The procedure is almost the same as the first time, but now you have some shortcuts in the Network Places list, possibly a saved login, and default options at each prompt to make the process quicker. 1. Select Network from the Drive list by pressing N. 2. KeySoft prompts, "Network Place? Press ENTER for (name)" where (name) is the last network place visited. Either press ENTER, or go to the list of network places by pressing SPACE, select one, and press ENTER. 3. If you saved your username and password, or do not have one, from here on, it is the same as reviewing the folder structure in the VoiceNote mPower QT. If you didn't save your username and password, you will be prompted here to enter them. 4. Press ESCAPE. This extracts you from the login fields. 5. From here on, it is the same as reviewing the folder structure in the VoiceNote mPower QT. Note: After a reset of the VoiceNote mPower QT, there will be no defaults set up as they are all wiped. If you do a reset while holding down JKL keys, all your settings will be lost and you will need to start again as described in 13.13.2 How to access Network for the first time. 13.13.4 Network Places. The VoiceNote mPower QT maps network folders to a list of network places, making it quick and easy to access them. The list of Network Places is the first thing to appear once you select Network Drive, so you can go directly to them instead of having to search down through the domain or review all the servers to find the shared folder that you want. Every time you open a new network folder, KeySoft will ask you to map it to a network place. You can give the network place any name you like, but as it is the convention, KeySoft offers the folder's name as the default. You can accept it by pressing ENTER, or type an alternative name then press ENTER. Because you may not want to keep a network place for the future, you can delete it. To do this, select the network place from the list of network places, but do not press ENTER. Instead, to delete, press CONTROL with I. KeySoft will ask you to confirm this by typing Y for yes, or N for No. You can also rename a network place by pressing CONTROL with R. It is not possible to map the same network folder to two different network places, nor is it possible to have two network places with the same name. 13.14 Connecting your BrailleNote to a PC. To connect your BrailleNote to a PC, you need to install a Microsoft? program onto your PC and connect the BrailleNote and PC with a USB cable or Bluetooth. To use Bluetooth, you need to set up your PC with a Bluetooth accessory such as a dongle or card. See 13.14.4 Connecting using Bluetooth. If you are using Windows XP or earlier, you install ActiveSync. If you are using Windows Vista, you need the Windows Mobile Device Center (WMDC). These programs can be downloaded from www.microsoft.com. ActiveSynch is also available on the CD that is supplied with your BrailleNote When you have one of these programs installed, and your BrailleNote and PC are connected, you can use your PC to: * View the BrailleNote file structure. * Manage the files and folders on your BrailleNote, including copying, moving and deleting them. * Synchronise files and time settings between your PC and your BrailleNote. * Redirect internet acesss via your PC's internet connection. If you are using WMDC, you can access your files on the BrailleNote, edit and save them, without having to first copy them to your PC. 13.14.1 USB, Bluetooth, Ethernet, Infrared and Serial Connection Types. The VoiceNote mPower QT may be connected to the PC via either the serial port, infrared port, Bluetooth, USB, or via Ethernet connection, wireless or LAN. Assuming you have access to a suitable PC, you have everything you need to set up the cable connections required for Serial or USB. PC's that are not Bluetooth, infrared and/or network enabled require extra PC hardware and associated software drivers before these can be used. Here are some things you should know about each connection type: Serial Port: This is the slowest connection type but it has the advantage of not requiring any extra equipment, and is simple to set up and use. Only works with ActiveSync. Refer to. Infrared Port: Faster than a serial connection, but requires a PC that is infrared capable. For how to set up an Infrared connection, refer to 2.3.1 Using the Infrared Port. For how to set up an ActiveSync connection, refer to. LAN connection: Fastest of all the connections, you have the option of accessing the internet as well as the usual ActiveSync activities. Requires an ethernet card and some configuring at the PC end. For information on setting up LAN, refer to 13.6 Dial up and LAN Connections. For ActiveSync connection set up, refer to. Wireless Ethernet connection: As fast as LAN, with the same capabilities, this type requires that there is a wireless network available to you. VoiceNote mPower QT requires a wireless network card. For more information on setting up a wireless connection, refer to 13.4 Using a Wireless Connection. ActiveSync connection set up is very much the same as the LAN connection explained in. Please note that while you can access the internet using LAN and Wireless with ActiveSync, you can also do so without ActiveSync. Bluetooth: This wireless connection type is faster than serial. To use Bluetooth, you need to set up your PC with a Bluetooth accessory such as a dongle or card. Only works with ActiveSync. For more information on Bluetooth, refer to 13.12 Bluetooth. . For how to set up an ActiveSync connection, refer to 13.14.4 Connecting using Bluetooth. USB: This connection is faster than serial and as long as your PC has a USB port, it will work fine. You can use this connection type to use ActiveSync in the usual ways, but also to gain internet access on your VoiceNote mPower QT via the PC, whether this be network access or dialup. This is discussed further in 13.14.3 Connecting using USB. USB can be used anytime by simply connecting the USB cable once your PC is running ActiveSync. You can also select the "Connect to ActiveSync" option from the Utilities Menu. Note that this method is more commonly used for connecting to Serial, Infrared and Bluetooth. If you activate ActiveSync via "Connect to ActiveSync", the VoiceNote mPower QT will attempt to connect using the connection method that has been stored in the "Connect to ActiveSync" option. Also, the setting for this connection is only accessible when selecting "Connect to ActiveSync" from the Utilities Menu, not from a USB Port connection. 13.14.2 Installing the Synchronisation Software on your PC. Before you can use ActiveSync or WMDC with the VoiceNote mPower QT, you need to install the software on your PC. You can download the software from the Microsoft? website or, if you are using ActivSync, you can install is from the CDROM supplied with the VoiceNote mPower QT. If you are downloading the program from the Microsoft? website, www.microsoft.com, search for the software using the keywords "Activesync" or "WMDC", and then follow the instructions on your screen. If you are downloading from the BrailleNote CD, follow the instructions below. 1. Insert the CDROM into your PC CDROM drive. After a few seconds, a menu is displayed. Select "Install ActiveSync". 2. Give the installation file a few seconds to automatically extract and copy files. When this is complete, the first window of a SetUp wizard is displayed. In the SetUp wizard window, Tab to the Next button. 3. Follow the wizard until the SetUp is complete. 13.14.3 Connecting using USB. USB is a good connection type to start off with, as it is simple and allows you to set up a partnership for future LAN or wireless connections. To make a connection between your VoiceNote mPower QT and a PC, follow these steps: 1. Plug the smaller end of the USB cable into your VoiceNote mPower QT, and the larger end into a USB port on your PC. 2. On the VoiceNote mPower QT, ensure the ActiveSync connection type is set to USB. To do this, go to the Main Menu, then Utilities Menu, then Miscellaneous Options, press SPACE, and then U for USB. Exit by pressing ESCAPE. 3. Return to the Utilities Menu by pressing ESCAPE. Press C or SPACE once to get to "Connect to ActiveSync via USB". Do not press ENTER yet. 4. On the PC, make sure the connection type is also set to USB. To do this, in the ActiveSync window on your PC, from the File Menu, select Connection Settings. Check the option Allow USB connection... and Tab to OK and press ENTER. If it is your first ever connection on the PC, the Get Connected Wizard may pop up instead, in which case just carry on to step 5. 5. Now on your VoiceNote mPower QT, press ENTER. Note: If the connection does not happen within 10 seconds, reset the VoiceNote mPower QT until you hear a beep, and the connection should come up straight away. To use this connection to access the Internet, there are a few more simple steps: 1. Enter the Options Menu by pressing FUNCTION with O. Press C for Connectivity then SPACE to get to "Create a New Dialup or LAN Connection." Press ENTER. 2. KeySoft prompts: "Connection configuration name?." Type a name that is meaningful to you and press ENTER. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Device to use?." Cycle through the options to Ethernet Network Connection and press ENTER. 4. Press ESCAPE and at the prompt, "Save this configuration?" press Y for Yes. This configuration is the one you will need to access the internet. Now return to the main menu and select Internet. When asked which configuration to use, select the one you have just set up. 13.14.4 Connecting using Bluetooth. The user interface for the PC Bluetooth service may vary from the one described here. Nevertheless, the COM port information will still be available somewhere. Before setting up a pairing between the VoiceNote mPower QT and your PC's Bluetooth function, ensure that both ActiveSync, or WMDC for Windows Vista and Bluetooth are set up on your PC. See 13.14.2 Installing the Synchronisation Software on your PC. To set up Bluetooth on your PC: 1. Install the Bluetooth driver. Follow the instructions supplied with your Bluetooth dongle or card. 2. Open the Bluetooth Devices Control Panel. 3. Click on the Options tab and select Turn discovery on and Allow Bluetooth devices to connect to this computer. 4. On the COM Ports tab, click Add. 5. Select Incoming (device initiates the connection) and click OK. 6. Note the number of the COM port that was added. 7. Close the Bluetooth Devices Control Panel by clicking OK. 8. On your PC, open your synchronisation program, either ActiveSynch or WMDC. 9. From the File menu, select Connection Settings. 10. Select "Allow connections" 11. Select the COM port assigned to Bluetooth. 12. Click OK. Now you need to connect the BrailleNote. To do this: 1. Go to the Utilities Menu on your BrailleNote and press M for Miscellaneous Options. 2. Go to ActiveSync Connection by pressing SPACE. 3. Select Bluetooth by pressing B then ENTER. Bluetooth is now the connection type of choice. Now you need to set up Bluetooth on the VoiceNote mPower QT. 4. Go to the Options Menu by pressing SPACE with O, then C for the Connectivity Menu. 5. Select Bluetooth and press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "Bluetooth on? Currently Yes/No." Press Y. 6. KeySoft prompts: "Search for devices?" Press Y. KeySoft announces, "Searching for Bluetooth devices, please wait..." This may take a few seconds during which you will hear progress beeps. 7. When the search is complete, KeySoft will announce: "List of Bluetooth devices." 8. Your PC will appear on the list by the name you gave it during Bluetooth set up. Select it by pressing ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "List of services for (device name)?" Review the list, and select "ActiveSync". 9. KeySoft prompts: "Pair with (device name) and activate ActiveSync?" Press Y. 10. On your VoiceNote mPower QT, KeySoft will prompt: "Authentication code?" Type a password that you can remember, in letters or numbers. 11. On your PC, there will be a dialog box requesting an authentication code. Type the same password here and click OK. You are now connected to ActiveSync via Bluetooth. 13.14.5 Connecting via ActiveSync. 1. Connect the VoiceNote mPower QT to your PC with your chosen connection type. 2. On the VoiceNote mPower QT, go to the "Utilities Menu," and press C to select "Connect to ActiveSync" option. 3. The ActiveSync window on the PC should indicate that the PC is "Connecting" to the VoiceNote mPower QT. This process normally takes about 5 to 10 seconds. When connected, the "New Partnership" dialogue box may appear. If you followed the steps in the last section, a partnership was established, so this dialog shouldn't appear. Select Yes or No and Tab to OK and press ENTER. 13.14.6 Synchronizing Time in ActiveSync. Synchronizing the time on your VoiceNote mPower QT each time you use ActiveSync is a simple matter of ticking a checkbox. Firstly, ensure that your VoiceNote mPower QT is set to the correct international timezone. This is described in 1.18 Time and Date. Your VoiceNote mPower QT will synchronize to the time zone specified so if it is incorrect, the time will always be out. Whether you not connected via ActiveSync, open the ActiveSync window on your desktop. From the Tools Menu, Tab to Options and press ENTER. On the Sync Options tab that shows, you will find a check box labeled "Synchronize mobile device clock upon connecting". Check this box, and to save the change, Tab to OK and press ENTER. 13.14.7 File Conversion and ActiveSync. One of the options available in ActiveSync is the automatic conversion of MS Word files to MS Pocket Word format when transferring them to the VoiceNote mPower QT from your PC, and convert them back when transferring in the other direction. As this is automatic i.e. you do not get the option of choosing when you would like to do this and when not, we recommend that you ensure it is turned off. However at times, converting to MS Pocket Word format may be useful, and if so it is useful to know how to switch this function on. From the Tools menu in the ActiveSync window of your desktop, select Options. There are three tabs, select the Rules tab. There is a button marked Conversion Settings. Tab to this and press ENTER. On this tab is a check box labeled "Convert files when synchronized, copied, or deleted." When checked, ActiveSync will always convert transferred MS Word or MS Pocket Word files; when unchecked it never will. 13.15 KeySync. 13.15.1 What is Synchronization. Synchronization is the act of keeping two things the same. In the world of planners and address lists and files, it specifically means being able to keep the entries, or records on the VoiceNote mPower QT the same as those on a PC, or vice versa. When you synchronize, the information goes back and forth between the two systems in such a way that both sides end up the same, with a little help from you occasionally. So, if you enter a friend's name or an appointment on the VoiceNote mPower QT, you can ensure that by synchronizing, they will end up recorded in MS Outlook as well. If you don't want your entries and records to be the same, then sychronizing is not for you. There is one kind of VoiceNote mPower QT to PC synchronization that uses ActiveSync without KeySync, and that is file synchronization. This is discussed in detail in 13.16 File Synchronization. 13.15.2 Getting the best out of Synchronization. Like so many tools, the efficiency of synchronization is as much in the way you use it as in the design. Synchronization is designed to keep both copies of a record the same. While it is possible to temporarily override the process on a record by record basis, the ultimate objective of synchronizing is to allow you to keep accurate, matched records, and if that is not what you want to do, perhaps synchronizing is not the way to go. Synchronizing works best when you do it often, rather than leave the records to build up. If you do it often, there won't be so many opportunities for conflicts and duplicates, and so it will work quickly without you having to make lots of judgment calls. The first time you synchronize records, any records that are unique to either KeySoft or Outlook will copy themselves to the other system. Duplicate records will need user intervention, and the length of time this takes will be determined by how many you have. However, it will never be such a large job again, especially if, as we mentioned before, you synchronize regularly. 13.15.2.1 Getting the best out of Synchronisation. The first time you synchronize records, any records that are unique to either KeySoft or Outlook will copy themselves to the other system. Records that already occur on both your BrailleNote and your PC will need user intervention, and the length of time this takes will be determined by how many you have. If you have a sizeable number of records on either your PC or BrailleNote or both, the first synchronization could be quite a mission! Synchronizing works best when you do it often, rather than leave the changes to build up. 13.15.3 Installing KeySync on your PC. The software required to set up KeySync on your PC is available on the program CD that came with your VoiceNote mPower QT, and on the HumanWare web site at www.humanware.com/support/braillenote/software. 1. Either: * Put the CD into the CD drive of your PC, and select "Install KeySync PC Software" from the menu that is displayed, or * Download Keysync from the HumanWare web site and run the program called setup.exe. 2. The KeySync Setup window appears. Read the information on it, then Tab to Next and press ENTER. 3. The Destination Folder window appears. In this window there is a file path field, in which the file path C:\Program Files\HumanWare\KeySync is specified. Tab to Next and press ENTER. Note: if reinstalling KeySync, at this point you will get a dialog box saying "You've specified a folder that already exists…" Tab to Yes and press ENTER. 4. Your PC is now ready to install KeySync. In the window that appears, Tab to Next and press ENTER. 5. After a short period of installing activity, a dialog box displays asking if you want to run KeySync at every start up. Tab to Yes and press ENTER. 6. When the Installation Complete window displays, tab to the Finish button and press ENTER. KeySync puts an icon in your system tray, but otherwise as KeySync is driven from your VoiceNote mPower QT, there is very little you need to do with it on the PC. Important Note: If for some reason you wish to reinstall the KeySync PC Software, do not remove the original version of the software, just install over it. This is because the removal process also deletes the previous synchronisation information. 13.15.3.1 Setting up for Synchronizing. Having installed KeySync on the PC, you can now set up the BrailleNote. This involves options for what is to be synchronized, and what to do if information relating to something has been changed in both KeySoft and the PC. KeySync works by finding new records on the BrailleNote and the PC with the same name and title, but different details, as well as records which have had different changes made to both the KeySoft and the Outlook copies since the last synchronisation. This section covers the options you have for dealing with new and differing records. For address records, the First and Last names of the contact are used as an identifier. For appointments, the date, time and title are used as an identifier. In the procedure below, these identifiers are represented by the word (identifier) in brackets. Follow the steps below to set up the synchronization options.. 1. From the Main Menu on your BrailleNote, choose Utilities Menu, then Synchronization. 2. KeySoft prompts: "KeySync Menu". There are two menu items. Select the second item, "Options for synchronization".  3. KeySoft prompts: "KeySync Options List". Press SPACE. 4. KeySoft prompts: "Action if something has changed on both the PC and in KeySoft?" * If you want to make a judgement call on an individual basis, press A ("Ask the user to choose"), and press ENTER. * If you trust the BrailleNote records over Outlook, press K ("Choose KeySoft's copy"). press ENTER. * If you trust the Outlook records over the ones on the BrailleNote, press P ("Choose the PC's copy"). press ENTER. * If you want to leave both options unchanged, and unsynchronized at this stage, press L ("Leave both unchanged"). press ENTER. 5. KeySoft prompts: "Synchronize contacts? Currently (y/n)". Type Y for Yes or N for No and then press ENTER. 6. KeySoft prompts: "Synchronize Planner? Currently (y/n)" Type Y for Yes, or N for No and then press ENTER. If you answered yes, KeySoft prompts: "Synchronize All appointments? Currently (y/n)" This option allows you to specify a period of weeks, past or future, that you wish to synchronize. If you want all past and future appointments synchronized, type Y for Yes and go to step 9. If you wish to specify a period of time, type N for No and then press ENTER. 7. KeySoft prompts: "Past weeks of appointments to sync? Currently All." The values you can enter are, L for All, or a number between 0999, which specifies the number of weeks. If you don't want to synchronize any past weeks, type 0. No number signs required. Type a value and press ENTER. 8. KeySoft prompts: "Future weeks of appointments to sync? Currently All." The same values are valid as for the past. Type a value and press ENTER. Note: In the case of both past and future time frames, all the instances of any new recurring appointments starting in the time frame will synchronize through, even if they extend beyond the time frame specified. 9. You are now set up to synchronize as much or as little as you wish to. The values that you have selected become the defaults until you change them again. To get back to the KeySync menu, press ESCAPE. 13.15.3.2 Synchronising 1. Connect to ActiveSync. 2. From the Main Menu, select the Utilities Menu, then Synchronization, then "Synchronize Now". The first time you synchronize, a dialog box will pop up on the PC, asking if you wish to synchronize with this particular BrailleNote BT, with an accompanying announcement from the BrailleNote BT saying "Please confirm on the PC that it is OK to sync data." To answer yes, press Enter on your PC. If you are not using Office XP or 2000 with the security pack installed, go to step 3. * If you are using MS Office XP or 2000 with the security pack installed or running Vista, a second dialog box may display on your PC. It is a feature that is meant to stop viruses from polling your Outlook records, and warns that a program is trying to get into your contacts list. If you are not using a screen reader, it may seem like the process has hung, but it is a simple routine on the PC to get around the dialog box: * Tab to the check box labeled "Allow access". * Press the space bar to check the box, then Tab to go to a combo box that has a range of times up to ten minutes. * Use the arrow keys to select a time from the dropdown list. * Tab to the Yes button and press Enter. You can then proceed. Unless you have hundreds of contacts to synchronize, ten minutes should be enough time. If it is not, the dialog box will reappear allowing you to specify another ten minutes in the same way. 3. KeySync displays: "Connecting…Syncing contacts/planner, please wait…". Some beeps may follow. Then there are three prompts, either one, some, all or none of which may come up, in the following order: * “The details for (identifier) have changed on both sides. Option?." To use the KeySoft details, press K. To use the PC details, press P. To leave the decision until next time you synchronise, press L. To always use the KeySoft details, press S.  To always use the PC details, press C. * "(Identifier) has been deleted from (the PC/KeySoft) only. Option?" where PC/KeySoft is either one or the other. Select one of the following options: To delete this record from the PC and KeySoft, press D. To restore the record to the PC/KeySoft, press R. To leave the decision until next time you synchronize, press L. To always restore records to the PC/KeySoft, press A. To always delete records from KeySoft/the PC, press E. * "New records for (identifier) have been found on both KeySoft and the PC. Option?." Select one of the following options: If these are different people, then to create separate records for both, press D. If these are the same person, then to use the KeySoft details, press K, or to use the PC details, press P. To leave the decision until next time you synchronise, press L. To always use the KeySoft details, press S. To always use the PC details, press C. 4. KeySync has now presented all the relevant prompts and you have chosen options for them. KeySync will now display: "Syncing (contacts/planner), please wait" then proceed to synchronize. During this process, KeySync will let you know what is going on with a series of "Percentage complete" prompts. When it is complete, KeySync will display some or all of this prompt: "Finished syncing (contacts/planner). x PC items updated. x KeySoft items updated. x KeySoft items deleted." 5. If you are synchronizing both contacts and planner applications, at this point KeySync will return to step 2 and go through the process again for the other application. Note: Once the synchronization begins, do not interrupt it. For details on Synchronizing your Address List and Planner, see 13.15.4 Error! Reference source not found. and 13.15.5 Error! Reference source not found.. 6. When all the syncing is complete, KeySync will display: "Syncing complete. KeySync menu." 4. 13.15.4 Synchronizing the Address List. KeySync works by pairing Outlook and KeyList records with each other and making them the same. It initially identifies pairs of records by looking for identical first and last name fields on each side, and creates copies of single records to make them into a pair. After that, any changes to the pairs are updated when you synchronize. KeySync works with the whole KeyList address database on the VoiceNote mPower QT, and on Outlook the main Contacts folder, not including any subfolders or renamed contacts folders or any group or distribution lists set up on Outlook. KeySync carries out the following functions: When you add a new address record to either KeyList or Outlook, KeySync will add the record to the other system. When you delete an address record in either KeyList or Outlook, KeySync will ask whether you want to delete it from the other system, or restore it. Note: When you delete both copies of a record, they are gone for good. When you make a change to an existing address record in either KeyList or Outlook, KeySync will update the other system with the changes. If when you make different changes to the same record on both sides, KeySync will ask you which one you want to use. Here are some examples: 1. Initially, your friend Andie is in your VoiceNote mPower QT as Andie Brown, but in Outlook as Andrea Brown. Both records are synchronized across as the names are not identical, and you can delete whichever one you don't wish to keep. 2. You update Kyle Jones' email address on the VoiceNote mPower QT but not on your PC. When you run KeySync, it automatically updates Outlook with the new email address. 3. You update a customer's mobile phone number on Outlook, but when you try to ring her while out of the office, you find it is incorrect. You get the correct number and enter it into KeyList as you have your VoiceNote mPower QT with you. When you run KeySync, it will detect that there has been a change on both sides and as you have set KeySync to always ask you about these, you tell it to use the KeySoft copy. 4. On Outlook, you delete the contact record for a supplier that you no longer use. When you synchronize, KeySync asks if you wish to delete it off KeyList, or restore it to Outlook. You select the delete option and wipe it completely. 13.15.4.1 Fields. Because there are a lot more fields in an Outlook Contacts record than in a KeyList address record, and they have different names, only the fields that are in both systems are synchronized. The pairs in order of KeyList then Outlook are: Last Name Name, Last First name Name, First Middle Name Name, Middle Title Name, Title Home Phone Home, Phone Business Phone Business, Phone Cell Phone Home, Mobile Home Email Email Address Business Email Email Address 2 Home Fax Home Fax Business Fax Business Fax Street Address Home Address Street Address Line 2 Home Address Street Address Line 3 Home Address City Home Address City State or County Home Address State Zip or Postcode Home Address Zip Home Country Home Country Business Title Job Title Company Name Company Department Department Business Street Address Business Address Business Street Address Line 2 Business Address Business Street Address Line 3 Business Address Business City Business Address City Business State or County Business Address State Business Zip or Postcode Business Address Zip Business Country Business Country Web Page Web Page Notes Notes 13.15.4.2 Unused Fields in Outlook. The fields in an Outlook record that are not synchronized by KeySync are not generally affected by the synchronizing process. However, if you delete a previously synchronized record off KeySoft, and during synchronization choose to delete the Outlook record as well, the entire Outlook record will be deleted, including the unused fields. 13.15.4.3 Note on Area Codes. It is a characteristic of Outlook that if you do not put an area code onto a phone number, it fills in the default country and area code for you, regardless of whether it is correct or not, and while you can change them, you cannot delete these codes entirely, so you have to have these codes even if the number is local. The phone number fields in KeyList do not do this, however; they simply take whatever numeric combination you type into them. This means that if a number in a KeyList record without a country and area code synchronizes to Outlook, Outlook will add the default one at the Outlook end. And the next time you synchronize, those codes will synchronize back to KeyList. However if you type a country and area code in KeyList, using a space between each code, Outlook will recognize these and sort them into the appropriate fields. For example, the number +1 415 8206820 in KeyList will synchronize accurately into Outlook. 13.15.4.4 Notes on Refreshing Outlook. If you happen to be displaying an individual contact record when you synchronize, the display does not automatically refresh itself with the new information. It will however refresh once you close it. 13.15.5 Synchronizing the Planner. 13.15.5.1 Overlapping Appointments. Overlapping appointments happen when two appointments are scheduled in all or partly the same timeframe, for example one for 10am – 11am and one for 10.30am – 12noon on the same day. Both MS Outlook and KeyPlan will allow you to schedule these appointments, although you will get a notification message from either system. However in this section we are just going to look at the VoiceNote mPower QT end of the process and overlapping appointments that occur when synchronizing with Outlook. When synchronizing, there is a greater chance of getting unwanted overlapping appointments caused by scheduling on both systems. If you are synchronizing regularly, however, your current schedule will be fairly up to date in both systems, so overlapping appointments will be fairly uncommon. But just in case, KeySync will notify you of any overlaps caused as a result of the synchronization process, when the syncing is finished. The overlapping appointment prompt will only be displayed if overlapping appointments occur in the next year. After all records have been synchronized, if there are any new overlapping appointments, KeySync will announce: "There are overlapping appointments. Review them now?" To ignore them, press N and you will be returned to the KeySync Menu. If you wish to review them straight away, press Y. KeySoft returns you to the planner, to the first overlapping appointment resulting from the synchronization. Once in the Planner, you can review any or all overlapping appointments using the two commands: Go to next overlapping appointment: CONTROL with READ with O, and Go to previous overlapping appointment: READ with CONTROL with U. 13.16 File Synchronization. It is also possible to synchronize files between the VoiceNote mPower QT and a PC. This means you can, effectively, keep copies of files on both your VoiceNote mPower QT and PC at the same time, with a choice of having them updated automatically in either direction, or only when you choose to update them. For example, if you have a report that you may wish to work on while traveling to work, then on your PC, then on your way home, simply put it into the Synchronized Files folder on either your VoiceNote mPower QT or PC, and when you ActiveSync, both versions will synchronize to the latest version. File synchronization is not a KeySync function, but works with ActiveSync alone. So, even if you don't want to synchronize your planner or address list, you can still take advantage of this tool, and you don't need to install the KeySync PC software. Also unlike KeySync synchronization, you can synchronize files with more than one PC. 13.16.1 How to Set Up File Synchronization. Follow these steps to set up file synchronization between your VoiceNote mPower QT and your PC. 1. Connect to ActiveSync and say "Yes" to a partnership. Note: If you already have a partnership set up, in the ActiveSync window on your desktop, go to Tools then Options, and skip to step 3. 2. If you are presented with the "Select number of Partnerships" screen and only want to sync with this computer, check the box for "Yes, I want to synchronize with only this computer". If you synchronize with more than one PC, however, it is fine to check the other box. 3. The Select Synchronization Settings window will display. Ensure that the Files option is checked, no others. Note: KeySync will still function if Files is checked. 4. A dialog box will appear telling you that a synchronized files folder will be set up on your desktop. Tab to the OK button and press ENTER. 5. You are back in the Select Synchronization Settings window. Tab to OK and press ENTER and a window called Set Up Complete appears. Tab to the Finish button and press ENTER. 6. ActiveSync will set up a folder in My Documents called "VoiceNote mPower QT Synchronized Files", for storing synchronized files. Likewise, it creates a folder called "Synchronized Files” on the KeySoft System Disk of your VoiceNote mPower QT. It is only the files you put into either of these folders that will be synchronized. 7. At this stage you can select how you want the synchronization to operate. From the Tools menu, select Options, then the Sync Mode tab. You have three choices; they are: Continuous, only at connection, and manually. Select the one that you prefer. Stay in this window for the next step. 8. Lastly, as described in 13.14.7 File Conversion and ActiveSync, you may want to turn off the Convert File Format function. This converts MS Word files to MS Pocket Word and back during the synchronization process. Your File Synchronization is now set up. 13.16.2 Tips on File Synchronization. 1. The Synchronization folder on your VoiceNote mPower QT will set itself up on the KeySoft System disk. Because of this, during a JKL keys reset, any files in this folder will get erased. While the copies on the PC will still be available, if you synchronize again, these too will be deleted. So, if you wish to restore the PC copies to your VoiceNote mPower QT, before connecting to the PC with ActiveSync, move the files out of the Synchronization folder on your PC and into another folder, connect, and then move them back. They will then be restored to the VoiceNote mPower QT synchronization folder. However none of this can restore any changes made to the VoiceNote mPower QT copy of the files since the past synchronization. 2. While the instructions for file synchronization say to turn off the converter function, if the file on your PC is a Microsoft 2000 or later document, you may wish to leave the converter function turned on, and convert the file to Pocket Word. Alternatively, save the Word document as a rich text format file before transferring to the synchronize folder. End of Connectivity Chapter. 14 File Manager. A file is the name given to any organized information stored in an electronic form. File types stored by the VoiceNote mPower QT are word processor documents, email attachments, address lists, dictionaries, and so on. The File Manager provides tools for manipulating and organizing files using folders and a directory structure. To select the File Manager, go to the Main Menu and press F. KeySoft announces: "File Manager menu." As always you can review the options in the menu by pressing the ADVANCE and BACK navigation keys or SPACE and BACKSPACE, followed by NEXT or ENTER to select an item, or just press an initial letter. The File Manager comprises the following items: 1. Directory: To check all the files in a folder; 2. Copy File: To copy a file or group of files; 3. Erase File: To erase any file; 4. Rename File: To change the name of a file; 5. Move File: To move a file from one location to another; 6. Protection: To protect or unprotect any file. Once a file is protected, it cannot be accidentally erased or altered without first unprotecting it; 7. Translate File: Firstly, to translate a Braille file to a text file, or vice versa. The discussion about file translation starts at 14.17 File Translation. Secondly, to import a file that is in some other format  ASCII or Microsoft Word for example, into the VoiceNote mPower QT and convert it to a Keyword format. The file may be on a disk or storage card or brought in through the serial port. Thirdly, to export a document from VoiceNote mPower QT's KeySoft format into some other format; for example, ASCII or Microsoft Word format. The file may be written to a disk or storage card or sent out through the serial port; 8. Folder Manager: To create, rename or erase a folder or subdirectory. General Caution: While in the process of copying or moving any files onto your Flash Disk from any location, never perform a reset. This can cause your Flash Disk to disappear and can cause corruption. 14.1 Selecting Files Folders and Drives. Documents, folders and drives were discussed in 3.4 Documents Folders and Drives. Remember documents are just particular types of files and they are handled in the same way as far as the File Manager is concerned. When you choose an option from the File Manager menu, such as Copy File, you are first asked to select the drive. The selection of a drive was discussed in 4.5.1 Selecting a Drive. . The selection of a folder and file follows the same procedure as discussed in 3.5 Opening a Document. . There is another way of selecting a drive in KeySoft generally, which is not restricted to the File Manager. If you are at a prompt for a file name or folder name, and you have not had the opportunity to select a drive, then press BACKSPACE. KeySoft prompts: "Drive? (Last drive used)." You can choose a drive, and then follow the prompts to select a folder and file. 14.2 Checking the Spelling of Folder or File Names. Folder or file names are easy to check. When KeySoft announces the name of a file or folder, you can repeat the name by pressing REPEAT. Any punctuation and spaces within the name are not usually spoken. If you wish to hear the file or folder name spoken with punctuation and spaces included, press FUNCTION with O, then H. To check the exact spelling of a file or folder name, press FUNCTION with O, then S. 14.3 The Directory Option. To obtain information about a file, folder or drive, use the Directory option. From the File Manager menu, press D for Directory and KeySoft announces: "Drive? (Last drive used)," You can select the drive and then the folder as usual. KeySoft then announces a list of files in the selected folder. Review the list in the usual way. Let us say that you are reviewing the files in a folder, and the file name "Frank" is announced. If you press READ with I, KeySoft provides information about the file. That might typically be as follows: "Braille document. Size: 945. Last modified: Saturday 24 May 2004, at 8:21 PM. Unprotected." At the point where KeySoft announces "List of folders" on a particular drive, you can request information about the selected drive by pressing READ with I. This might typically be as follows: "Disk name: (name). (number) characters free. Disk size: (number) characters." Similarly, you can obtain details as to when a folder was created by stepping through the list of folders presented after the "List of folders" prompt is announced until your desired folder is presented, and then pressing READ with I. For details on how to view subdirectories, see 14.16 Creating Renaming and Erasing SubDirectories. 14.4 Folder Manager. The Folder Manager allows you to create, copy, rename or delete folders and subdirectories. From the File Manager menu press F, for Folder Manager. You can review the options in the usual way. You can also select an option in the usual way by pressing NEXT or just press the initial letter of the option name. 14.4.1 Creating a New Folder. From the Folder Manager menu, press N, for New Folder. KeySoft prompts: "Create folder on which drive? Press ENTER for Flash Disk." Select the required drive, and KeySoft prompts: "New folder name?." Type the new name, of up to 250 characters and press ENTER. A new, empty folder is created, and you are returned to the Folder Manager menu. Note that this is not the only place you can create a folder. You can create a folder at most "folder name" prompts just by typing a new name. For instructions on how to create a subdirectory, see 14.16.2 Creating a SubDirectory. 14.4.2 Copying Folders. The option of copying folders has been added to the Folder Manager. To access Copy Folder, go to the File Manager Menu and open the Folder Manager by pressing F. Copy Folder is listed in the Folder Manager Menu, after New Folder (previously known as Create Folder). Once you hear "Copy Folder", press ENTER and KeySoft will prompt: "Copy folder on which drive? Press ENTER for Flash Disk." If you want to copy the folder onto your Flash Disk press ENTER and KeySoft will prompt: "Folder to copy?." In addition to copying folders, it is also possible to rename and erase them. You cannot however protect and unprotect folders, nor can you move them. 14.4.3 Renaming a Folder. 1. From the Folder Manager menu, press R, for Rename. KeySoft prompts: "Rename folder on which drive? (Suggested drive)." 2. Select the drive, and then the folder you wish to rename. KeySoft prompts: "New name for (original name)?." 3. Type in the new name and press ENTER, or use the prompt editing commands as discussed in 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. to modify the original name, and press ENTER. The name is changed and you are returned to the Folder Manager menu. Alternatively, while in a folder list at any folder prompt, press CONTROL with R. Follow steps 2 and 3 above, and you will be returned to where you were in KeySoft. For instructions on how to rename a subdirectory, see 14.16.3 Renaming a SubDirectory. 14.4.4 Erasing a Folder. You can erase a folder and its contents, including unprotected, protected or hidden files and subdirectories, in one operation. Therefore it is important to check before erasure that there is nothing in the folder that you wish to keep before proceeding. 1. From the Main Menu, press F for File Manager and then F for Folder Manager. 2. Press E for Erase a folder, then select a drive. 3. At the “Folder to Erase?” prompt, press SPACE and locate the folder you wish to erase. 4. When you have found it, press RIGHT ARROW. KeySoft will prompt: “Folder to erase? Press ENTER for folder name” where folder name is the selected folder. Press ENTER. 5. KeySoft prompts: "Erase folder and all contained files and folders. Sure?" Press Y and the erasure begins. 6. If any files are protected, KeySoft prompts: "file name is protected. Erase anyway?". Press Y, or A for All, if you suspect there may be others that you also wish to erase. If you wish to save the protected file, press N and the erasure of the other files will continue, however the actual folder will not be erased. 7. KeySoft announces the number of files and subfolders erased, then returns to the Folder Manager menu. Note that you can also erase a folder by pressing CONTROL with I. 14.5 Document and File Types. When giving information about a file, KeySoft announces the file type in addition to the size and date, etc. The file type indicates what type of information the file contains and whether it is a Braille document, a Microsoft Word document, an address list and so on. It determines how the information contained in a file is to be interpreted by KeySoft. KeyWord, for example, recognizes certain file types and interprets these file types to extract meaningful information. In the VoiceNote mPower QT file system, files can contain information that be interpreted in all manner of different ways. In KeySoft, files which contain text or Braille are called documents. The following document or file types are supported by KeySoft: Braille Document: A document type where the contents are interpreted as Braille characters and symbols; Microsoft Word: The Microsoft Word, word processor document format; Rich text format: A standard word processor format that converts formatting to instructions that other programs, including compatible Microsoft programs, can read and interpret; Word Perfect 5.1: A file type used by the Word Perfect 5.1 DOS word processor; KeySoft version 2 Braille: This is the Braille document format of version two of KeySoft, the version used by the Braille Companion; KeySoft version 2 text: This is the text document format of version two of KeySoft, the version used by the DOS versions of KeySoft Companion, the KeyNote Companion and the Braille Companion; ASCII text. An ASCII text document contains only ASCII characters. It allows only very simple formatting using, for example tab characters; UNICODE text. A standard character encoding format that supports international languages; Plain Braille. A standard form of Braille. When reviewing a folder in the File Manager, KeySoft's default setting only announces files that are likely to contain text. This prevents system files from "cluttering" the list of files and limits the accidental deletion of system files. KeySoft also provides the option to view all files in the folder. To select this option press READ with X when the prompt "List of files in (folder name)" is announced. There are two additional file views available. These are: "List of all, including hidden, files” and "List of KeySoft files." Each time you repeat the READ with X key sequence a different type of file view is presented. 14.6 Opening Files using File Manager. The Directory option in the File Manager allows you to open files using the Media Player, KeyWord, KeyWeb and KeyBook. A file name will be announced after ENTER is pressed, and File Manager will open the file in the correct application if the file type is recognized. File Manager recognizes the file type from the extension, for example, if it is Greensleeves.mp3, File Manager knows to open the file in the Media Player. The file types, .wav, .wma, and .m3u (a play list file that can only be played on the mPower), will also be opened in the Media Player. The file types that can be opened in KeyWord include .brf, .txt, .rtf, .doc, KeyWord text and Braille files. For KeyWeb, the files .html/.htm and url (shortcut) are recognized by the File Manager. 14.7 Changing the Order of File Lists. In a list of files, you can change the order in which files are listed. Files can be ordered by name, date, type or size. For example, let us consider the file, Board of Trustees Report.doc which was last modified on Friday 5 May 2006 and is 27 KB. The order can be changed so that this file is listed before Salary Review.doc which was last modified on Friday 28 April 2006 and is 12 KB. Note that you cannot change the order of folders or directories. As you can see, file lists are arranged in alphabetical order when ordered by name, so that the names of files appear from "A" at the top of the list to "Z" at the bottom of the list. Likewise, by changing the date order, the dates that the files were last modified are listed from the most recently modified to the least recently modified. You can order by type, for example, you can order all the .doc files before all the .txt files in your list. The file size can also be organized from largest to smallest. Ordering files by size is particularly useful when you realize that you are running out of storage space and need to find and delete the largest file in your list of files. To toggle between ordering the file lists by name, date, type or size of a file, press READ with V. 14.8 Selecting Multiple Files. You can mark any number of individual files to select multiple files. When you mark a file, you are selecting it to either copy, move, erase and protect/unprotect. You could also select multiple files, for example, when printing, importing or for playing on the media player. You can either mark an individual file or all the files in a list of files. To toggle between marking and unmarking an individual file, press SPACE with M. If you later discover that you have marked the wrong file or group of files or decide against making a change to a file or group of files, repeat the command, press SPACE with M to remove each mark. To mark all files in a list of files, press CONTROL with READ with F. This is also a toggle command; in other words it will alternate between marking all files and unmarking all files. Note that marks are kept after you open a file in the Directory option. However, marks will be lost if you exit a list of files or if you change the view in a list of file, by pressing READ with X. As well as marking files, you can also mark folders. Once marked, folders can be copied or deleted. Once you have marked the appropriate file or group of files you can: * Perform the copy, move, erase and protect/unprotect operations. * Play a group of marked media files in the media player. * Rename individual files. To do this, press BACKSPACE with R. Note that you cannot mark and then rename multiple files. To copy a marked file or a group of files, press BACKSPACE with Y. For instance, you may wish to make a copy of a file so that you can move it to another location. To move a marked file or a group of files, press CONTROL with READ with M. You can easily move a file to a different location, for instance from the General folder to the KeyBase folder. Note that a marked file or group of files will no longer be marked once moved to another folder. If you move a protected file, you will be asked to confirm the move. Also, when you copy or move a protected file, it will remain protected. To erase a marked file or a group of files, press BACKSPACE with C. When you decide that you no longer need a file or want to get rid of one in order to free up more storage space, you can erase it. To protect a marked file or a group of files, press BACKSPACE with P, then P. You can add security by choosing to protect a file. This is good if you need to prevent others from making changes to a file. This effectively makes the file ReadOnly, which means that others can open the file and read it, but cannot make any changes to it. To unprotect a marked file or a group of files, press BACKSPACE with P, then U. If the protected file is to be reviewed and you want the reviewer to make changes to the file, you can unprotect it. To play a group of marked media files in the media play, press ENTER. The files will be sent for feedback in the media player. Note: If you want to do more than just listen to audio files, for example you want to skip through a track, or pause a track, then you need to switch to Media Player. To switch to media player, press FUNCTION with M. Refer to 16 Media Center. 14.9 Copying a File. This option allows any file to be copied to another folder or drive. You can also copy within a folder. A file is often copied so it can be used as the basis for a similar document or as a template. You might also copy an important file to another disk for security. Copying is a process of duplication, it does not remove the original file. If you wish to do this, refer to 14.10 Erasing a File. During the process, prompts use the terms "Source" and "Destination", which refer to the original file and its copy, respectively. To copy a file, start from the File Manager menu and press C. KeySoft prompts: "Source drive? (suggested drive).” Follow the procedure as previously described; select the required drive, and answer the subsequent prompts for folder and file name. The file is initially assumed to be a KeySoft type meaning that it may only be in Braille. To type the name of any file, press READ with X. The first time you press READ with X, KeySoft announces the current entry type. The second and subsequent times, KeySoft changes the entry type. In the list of files, READ with X can be used to narrow or widen the list of options as described in 14.5 Document and File Types. After a source file name has been selected, KeySoft prompts: "Destination drive? (suggested drive)." The choices of destination drive and folder are made in exactly the same way as in choosing the Source File name. The destination file name is the same as the source file name except if a file is copied within the same folder. Then the words "Copy of" are put in front of the file name to differentiate it from the original file. You can, of course, rename file as described in 14.11 Renaming a File. When a selection has been made, copying commences and after a few seconds you are returned to the File Manager menu. If the chosen Destination File name already exists in the destination folder, KeySoft prompts: "(File name) already exists. Replace?." KeySoft is asking if you want to replace the existing file. Remember that it cannot be recovered later if you change your mind. If you do want to replace it, press Y. Pressing N returns you to the File Manager menu without the file being copied. 14.10 Erasing a File. To conserve disk space, or to make file management easier, you may wish to erase files you no longer need. The Erase File option accomplishes this. From the File Manager menu, press E to select the Erase File option. KeySoft prompts: "Erase file from Drive? (suggested drive)." Choose a disk, folder name, and file name in the same way you would choose a file to copy, as described in the previous section. When a file has been chosen for erasing, KeySoft prompts: "Erase (file name). Sure?." This is your last chance to abandon this destructive process. Press Y to erase the file, or N to abandon the operation. NOTE: Protected files cannot be erased until they are first "unprotected," as described in 14.13 Protecting a File. 14.11 Renaming a File. The names of files often have to be changed as their contents alter with editing, or to avoid confusion with other files. This can be done using the Rename File option. 1. From the File Manager menu, press R, for Rename. KeySoft prompts: "Rename File on which Drive? (suggested drive)." 2. Select the drive, and follow the prompts for folder and file. Once a file has been selected, KeySoft prompts: "New name for (file name)?." 3. Type the new file name or edit the existing file name and press ENTER. Editing the existing file name is the same as editing at a prompt as discussed in 5.15 Editing at a Prompt. . Providing the file is not protected, the name is changed, and you are returned to the File Manager menu. Alternatively, while in a file list at any file prompt, press CONTROL with R. Follow steps 2 and 3 above, and you will be returned to where you were in KeySoft. 14.12 Moving a File. With this option you can move a file (protected or unprotected) from one folder/directory/drive to another in one action. This is different to the Copy file option in that it does not leave a copy of the file in the source folder. Otherwise it is almost the same procedure. To select the Move File option, start from the File Manager menu and press M. KeySoft will announce: “Source Drive? Press ENTER for (suggested drive).” Locate and select the file you wish to move in the usual way. When you select the file, KeySoft will announce: “Destination Drive? Press ENTER for (suggested drive).” Locate the destination folder or directory. When you select it, KeySoft will announce: “One file moved. File Manager menu.” As the prompt says, you are back in the File Manager menu. You can also move a file by selecting it in the usual way and pressing CONTROL with READ with M. 14.13 Protecting a File. Files can be protected against accidental erasure. Once a file is protected, it cannot generally be changed, erased, or copied over with a new file without first removing the protection. You do not need to remove the protection first if you specifically erase a protected file either individually or as part of a group of files or a folder. Although KeySoft does not require you to remove the protection, it will provide the following prompt regardless: "xyz is protected. Erase anyway?." For more information on erasing folders, refer to 14.4.4 Erasing a Folder. To select the Protect File option, start from the File Manager menu and press P. KeySoft prompts: "Protect File on which Drive? (suggested drive)" Select the file to protect in the same way as choosing a file to copy, erase or rename. Once a file has been selected, KeySoft prompts: "(File name) is unprotected," or protected, as appropriate. Press P to protect, or U to unprotect, and you are returned to the File Manager menu. 14.14 Groups of Files and Wild Cards. Often you may want to copy a group of related files, such as all letters to a particular company. You could do this one file at a time, but it is slow if there are more than 2 or 3 files. To speed things up, KeySoft allows the use of two "wild card" characters to specify a group of files with related names. Any single character can specified by ?. For example, the file name: NOTES, followed by ?, would select all the following files: NOTES1; NOTES2; NOTES3. You can use the single character wild card more than once. For example, the file name: NOTES, followed by ?, twice, would select NOTES13 and NOTES24, but would ignore NOTES7. The second wild card is *. This is the multicharacter wild card, used to represent any group of characters. For example, the file name: SCIENCE, followed by * would select all the following files: SCIENCE NOTES – JAN; SCIENCE; SCIENCE3. To Copy, Erase, or Protect a group of related files, include the appropriate wild card characters in the file name that you enter at a "File name?" or "Document name" prompt. Use Help, HELP to remind you of the commands. To select every file in a folder, use just the multicharacter wild card, *, as the file name. You might do this to copy the entire contents of one folder to another folder. If you save the copies in the same directory, KeySoft prefixes "Copy of" to the file name of each copy. When using wildcards KeySoft gives the opportunity to confirm each file individually or to let KeySoft operate on all files without interruption. KeySoft prompts: "Confirm each file?." You can select Y to confirm each file individually, or N to for KeySoft to perform the operation without interruption. If you select "confirm each file", KeySoft requests confirmation for each file before completing the operation and moving onto the next file. For example, when using wildcards to erase files, KeySoft prompts: "(Number)files were selected. Confirm each file?" where number is the number of files. If you press Y, KeySoft prompts for each file: "OK to erase (file name)" where file name is a matching file name. Y confirms the action for this file, N cancels the action for this file and A confirms the action for this and all the other matching files. 14.15 What is a Directory. The idea of folders was introduced very early on in this User Guide because this provides a convenient way to organize documents. When used in one layer only, we call them folders. However when folders are organized in a tree structure with any number of levels, we refer to them as directories. The distinction is not in what they are but in how they are used. It might help to think in terms of being in “folder mode” i.e. one layer, or “directory mode” i.e. several layers. Folder mode is the standard folder management mode in which the VoiceNote mPower QT operates. The reason for having two modes is to make management simpler. If you never intend to use the directory structure, folder mode saves having to type slashes at prompts. If you do have a directory tree of several layers, folder mode will give you the topmost layer of directories only. You can then swap to directory structure to work in the subdirectories of the selected directory. The directory structure is particularly relevant when importing or exporting files. For instance, you might want to import a file from a storage card. The card might be organized as a directory tree with several subdirectories. If you find yourself comparing this with how MS Windows Explorer works, it pays to be aware that you cannot view the subdirectories and files in a directory in the same list. For example, if you are listing the subdirectories in a directory, no files will be listed. If you list the files in the directory, no subdirectories will be listed. When in directory mode, a folder becomes a directory and this is indicated by a slash character “/ ”, appearing before the folder name. This initial slash represents the "root" directory, which contains all the other directories on this drive. The root is called the "parent" of the directories “beneath” it. A typical directory name starts with the slash, followed by a directory name followed by one or more subdirectory names separated by "/." For example, a directory name on a PC card might be: "/storage card/my documents/correspondence." Or a directory on the Flash Disk might be /Flash Disk/general/letters. What does this mean? The name can be broken down into the following parts: The first slash which is the root. "Flash Disk" is a subdirectory of the root directory. In this case it is the Flash Disk drive. The next "slash" is just a separator. "General" is the name of a subdirectory of the "Flash Disk" directory. Its parent is "Flash Disk." The next "slash" is another separator. "letters" is the name of a subdirectory of the "general" directory. Its parent is "general." This naming convention allows us to find a document or file in any directory structure. 14.15.1 Switching to a Directory Structure. You can choose to use directories at any prompt for a folder name, not just in the File Manager. For example, from the File Manager Menu select Copy File and then select a drive such as the Flash Disk. KeySoft prompts: "Source folder name? (Last used folder)." If you now press CONTROL with T, KeySoft replies, for example: "Source directory name? /(Last used folder)" where "/(Last used folder)", is the last used directory. You can select directories in exactly the same way when using the File Manager, Directory option. 14.15.2 Accessing Files in Another Directory. Following on from the previous section, there are two basic ways to choose a different directory at this point. You could type the full name, including slashes, etc., but this can be rather prone to errors, especially if you are not sure of the arrangement of the directories. Alternatively, you can browse the directory structure to find what you want. This is rather like using KeySoft's menus. You can move "down" by selecting a subdirectory from a list, or move "up" by selecting the parent. You can review any list of available directories in several ways: To navigate down a list, press DOWN ARROW, SPACE. To navigate up the list again, press UP ARROW, or BACKSPACE. To go back up a level in the directory structure, press LEFT ARROW. To make a selection, press ENTER. If you know that you are not in a low enough level directory to find the folder you want, you can bypass the "Directory name? Press ENTER for /name" prompts at each level by pressing RIGHT ARROW instead of ENTER. Let's see how this works. For the purposes of this example, we will assume that we are currently in the "/General" directory on the Flash Disk and we wish to go to the "/KeyMail/Attachments" directory. You could be at any "Folder name?" prompt on KeySoft, although the exact prompts will vary. The example is taken from the Open a Document function in KeyWord. At the prompt, press CONTROL with T. 1. At the "Directory name? Press ENTER for /General" prompt, navigate up to the parent directory by pressing LEFT ARROW. KeySoft announces: "Directory name? Press ENTER for /". This is a list of subdirectories of the Flash Disk. 2. Navigate down through the list until "KeyMail" is announced. Either press RIGHT ARROW, or do the following: 1. Press ENTER to select KeyMail, and KeySoft announces: "Directory name? Press ENTER for /KeyMail". 2. Press SPACE repeatedly to see the subdirectories within the KeyMail directory. Regardless of which method you chose, KeySoft now announces "Subdirectories of Flash Disk/KeyMail." 3. Using one of the methods descried in Step 2, navigate to the "Attachments" directory. 4. Press ENTER. You have reached your goal. See what happens when you review this directory. There are no more subdirectories. Navigate back up to the "attachments" subdirectory. You can press ENTER, putting you at the familiar "Document/File to Open?" prompt. You might now review this directory for files. Directories are one of the most demanding concepts to master. Finding files in a complex directory structure can be difficult. Remember to change to directories when prompted for a folder name. Remember also that you can move back and forward through directories and up and down lists of available directories using the commands covered in this section. And of course, if in doubt, you can press HELP at any time. 14.15.3 Relationship Between Folders and Directories. All folders are directories in the root directory of a drive, with the exception of the folder called "None," which is the root directory itself. Subdirectories below this level are not accessible in folder mode. 14.16 Creating Renaming and Erasing SubDirectories. It is possible to browse, create, rename and erase any subdirectories using a variation on the same processes for browsing, creating, renaming and erasing folders. This is because, as discussed before, they are basically one and the same, only used in a different way. It is important to know how to do this if you find that you cannot erase a seemingly empty folder, as it almost definitely contains subdirectories that are not visible in that folder. Three procedures are listed below in a step by step format. You may notice that the prompts refer to both folders and directories, but it still works! Please note also that if you wish to create a subdirectory that is deeper than root level, for example /general/recipes/brownies, this whole “branch” will be announced at prompts that include "/folder name." 14.16.1 Browsing a SubDirectory. When opening a document in the File Manager, you may need to browse through a list of folders and filenames to find the one you want. To browse a subdirectory, follow these steps: 1. From the Main Menu, press F for File Manager and then D for Directory. 2. Change from folder to directory by pressing CONTROL with T. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Directory name?." Either press SPACE and search through the list of folders until you find the one you want, or if you have many folders to search through, type the path instead. You will now be able to view the first level of folders. 4.  Move down the list of folders an press ENTER once you find the subfolder you want. KeySoft will now prompt: "Directory name? Press ENTER for /downloads." Now either press ENTER to select the downloads or return to the list of downloads and select My Subdirectory at the next level down. 5. KeySoft will announce the subdirectory in /downloads, for example, "test". Press ENTER to select "test" and KeySoft will prompt: "Directory name? Press ENTER for /downloads/test." If you press ENTER at this point and "test" is the last subdirectory in the list, KeySoft will prompt: "List of files in (directory name)?." The only problem with browsing a subdirectory using the method described above, is that once you access a subdirectory, you're stuck there until you back out. To browse the directory tree without getting stuck in a subdirectory, press RIGHT ARROW or LEFT ARROW. If you are in a subdirectory and want to move up a level, press RIGHT ARROW and KeySoft will move up a level. For example, from /downloads/test to /downloads. To move up yet another level, press RIGHT ARROW again. To browse subdirectories from within a directory, press RIGHT ARROW. 14.16.2 Creating a SubDirectory. 1. From the Main Menu, press F for File Manager and then F for Folder Manager. 2. Press C for Create a folder, then select a drive. 3. At the “New Folder name?” prompt, press CONTROL with T. The New Folder prompt will repeat. 4. Press SPACE and either search through the subdirectories (folders) until you find the one in which you want to set up the subdirectory. KeySoft will prompt “New Folder name? Press ENTER for /folder name” where folder name is the name of the currently selected directory. 5. Type the name you wish to give the subdirectory without a / before it, and press ENTER. KeySoft will prompt “Directory does not exist. Create new directory?.” 6. Press Y for Yes. KeySoft announces: “Folder created. Folder Manager menu.” You are back in the folder manager menu. 14.16.3 Renaming a SubDirectory. 1. From the Main Menu, press F for File Manager and then F for Folder Manager. 2. Press R for Rename a folder, then select a drive. 3. At the “Folder to Rename?” prompt, press CONTROL with T. The Rename Folder prompt will repeat. 4. Press SPACE and search through the subdirectories (folders) until you find the one that contains the subdirectory you wish to rename; and select it by pressing ENTER. KeySoft will prompt “Folder to Rename? Press ENTER for /folder name” where folder name is the name of the currently selected directory. Press SPACE to move through the list of subdirectories until you find the one you want then press ENTER. If there are any more layers of subdirectories, repeat this procedure until you reach the one you wish to rename. 5. KeySoft will prompt, "New name for /directory name?" where the name is the directory you wish to rename. Press ENTER. 6. KeySoft will prompt “New Name for /directory name?” where directory name is actually the parent directory of the one you have selected. Type the new subdirectory name and it will update that, not the parent directory. 7. Press ENTER to complete the renaming. KeySoft will return you to the Folder Manager menu. 14.16.4 Erasing a SubDirectory. Just as with erasing folders, you can erase a subdirectory and its contents, including unprotected, protected or hidden files and subdirectories, in one operation. Therefore it is important to check before erasure that there is nothing in the folder that you wish to keep before proceeding. 1. From the Main Menu, press F for File Manager and then F for Folder Manager. 2. Press E for Erase a folder, then select a drive. 3. At the “Folder to Erase?” prompt, press CONTROL with T. KeySoft will prompt “Directory to Erase?” 4. Press SPACE and locate the directory containing the subdirectory you wish to erase. 5. When you have found it, press RIGHT ARROW. KeySoft will prompt: “Directory to erase? Press ENTER for /directory name” where directory name is the selected directory. Repeat this if necessary 6. Press SPACE until you reach the subdirectory you wish to delete and press ENTER. KeySoft will prompt, "Directory to erase? Press ENTER for /directory name" where directory name is the selected subdirectory. Press ENTER. 7. If any files are protected, KeySoft prompts: "file name is protected. Erase anyway?". Press Y, or A for All, if you suspect there may be others that you also wish to erase. If you wish to save the protected file, press N and the erasure of the other files will continue, however the actual subdirectory will not be erased. Note that you can also erase a subdirectory by pressing CONTROL with I. 14.17 File Translation. As well as creating and reading your own documents and books, you may want to exchange information with other people, especially via email. KeyWord can directly open a file of any of the supported types listed in 14.5 Document and File Types. KeyWord can also save a file as any of the supported types. The supported types include Microsoft Word format; the de facto standard for Word Processor document exchange. The following sections of this chapter are needed only when you specifically want to convert a file without going into KeyWord. The Translate File option of the File Manager Menu allows you to take a file in ASCII, or Microsoft Word, or WordPerfect 5.1 and others and translate it so that it can be read or edited on your VoiceNote mPower QT. This process of converting a file into KeyWord format is called "importing." Braille files created by another Braille system can also be imported into KeySoft. The Translate File option also works in the other direction as well. You can take a KeySoft document and translate it to the format used by Microsoft Word, or WordPerfect 5.1, or to ASCII format and other formats. This is called "exporting." KeySoft documents can also be exported as Braille files for use by other Braille systems. The Translate File option also translates KeySoft Braille documents into text documents, and vice versa. Apart from an ASCII setup list, which specifies how documents are translated between KeySoft format and ASCII format, there are also setup lists for Braille to text, and text to Braille translation. These provide a lot of layout flexibility in the translated document if required, but you may not need to change any settings because the default settings have been chosen for typical usage. 14.18 Translation Menu. To use the Translation Menu, start from the Main Menu, select the File Manager, and then the "Translate file" option. The Translation Menu consists of the following items: Import file; Export document; Translate between Braille and text; ASCII translation options; Back translation options, Braille to text; Forward translation options, text to Braille. Note that the ASCII translation options apply in the case of ASCII imports and exports including those to or from the serial port. The serial port options are included in the ASCII translation options. The Translation Menu items are now discussed. 14.19 Importing Files. To import a file, follow these steps. 1. From the Translation Menu, press I, for import a file. KeySoft prompts: "Import from which device? Press ENTER for file." 2. The options are: 1. If the file is stored on a CompactFlash, SD or PC card, press F to import from a File. 2. If you want to import from a host using the serial cable provided with your VoiceNote mPower QT press S for Serial port. 14.19.1 Importing from a File. After selecting "File" as the device to import from, KeySoft prompts: "Import file from which drive? (Suggested drive)." Select the drive. KeySoft then prompts: "Directory name? (Suggested directory)." The slash character is used to separate the different parts of the directory path name. For a description of directory path name, refer to 14.15.2 Accessing Files in Another Directory. You can accept the suggested directory, or type a new directory path name, or edit the old name. Alternatively you can press SPACE to review a list of subdirectories of the suggested directory. Next select the desired file to import when KeySoft prompts: "File to import?." Remember that you can press SPACE to list all files in the selected directory. If the file is of a type unknown to KeySoft, possibly a plain text file, you are asked, "Is this a Braille or text file?." If you know that the file is a Braille file, press B. If it is an ASCII text, press T and KeySoft then asks if you want to translate the file into text. Press Y if yes or N if you want to leave the file in its existing format. When you have selected the file KeySoft prompts: "Destination folder name? (Suggested folder)." Select a folder. KeySoft announces: "Text (or Braille) document name?." Next type the name of the destination file and press ENTER. If the file already exists you are asked if you want to append to it or replace it? Press A to append or R to replace. KeySoft imports the file or document and saves it as the destination file in the selected folder. KeySoft then returns to the Translation Menu. 14.19.2 Importing from the Serial Port. After selecting "Serial" as the device to import from, KeySoft prompts: "Serial. Is this a Braille or text file?." If you are importing a text file KeySoft queries: "Translate into Braille?." If you press Y to translate a text file into Braille, the file is converted into Braille when it is received. If you press N the file is left as a text document. Specify the destination folder name and file name in the usual way. When you have done that, KeySoft queries: "Host ready to transmit?." Check that the host is ready to transmit, and press ENTER or Y on the VoiceNote mPower QT keyboard. On the host's keyboard, type any commands required to start transmitting the file. You should hear a periodic beep as the file is transferred. When the beeps stop, wait a few seconds and then press ESCAPE. If the host stops transmitting or does not start KeySoft announces: "Host has not sent any characters for some time. To exit press ESCAPE." If you do exit KeySoft announces: "File import complete." You are returned to the Translation Menu. 14.19.3 Importing a Foreign Braille File. Note that while you can import files that are in either North American Braille Computer Code format or in United Kingdom Braille Computer Code format, the importation process does not convert the Braille language of the file. If your VoiceNote mPower QT is set to USA Braille and you import a file in UK Braille format, for example, the contents of the file appear strange when you read it with KeyWord. To read an imported file that is in another Braille language, you can temporarily change the language that your VoiceNote mPower QT uses, then change it back again when you have finished. The Braille language your VoiceNote mPower QT uses can be changed using the Braille Options in the Options Menu as described in 5.3 Braille Options. 14.19.4 Exporting a Document. To export a document press E, in the Translation Menu. You can export the document as one of the following document formats: Plain Braille file; Microsoft Word file; Rich text format file; Word Perfect file; KeySoft version two Braille document; KeySoft version two text document; ASCII text file; The original document remains unchanged. 1. Select the drive in the usual way when prompted. KeySoft then prompts: "Export document from which folder? (Suggested folder)." 2. When you have selected the folder KeySoft prompts: "Document name? (Suggested file name)." 3. Select the document to export. KeySoft prompts: "Export to which device? Press ENTER for file." The options are: To export from a File press F. To export from the Serial port press S. 14.19.5 Exporting to a File. After selecting "File" as the device to export to, KeySoft prompts: "Export as an ASCII text file?." 1. To export as an ASCII text file press ENTER. To select another file type, press CONTROL with SPACE repeatedly to step through the list of file types that you can export. The available file types were listed in 14.5 Document and File Types. 2. When you have selected the file type, select the destination drive. KeySoft then prompts: "Directory name? (suggested directory). Computer Braille is required." 3. Select the suggested directory, find the one you want in the usual way, or type the path name of the desired directory. Remember that the slash character, dots 34, is used to separate the different parts of the directory. 4. After the file is exported you are returned to the Translation Menu. To find out how to access files in another directory, see 14.15.2 Accessing Files in Another Directory. 14.19.6 Exporting to the Serial Port. If you select "Serial" as the device to export to, KeySoft will announce: "Serial cable on COM1." "COM1" is the 9 pin male connector at the left of the rear panel. A serial cable is provided with your VoiceNote mPower QT. Of course you must connect one end of the cable to COM1 and the other end to a mating connector of a host; most likely a PC. Both ends of the cable are the same. The connectors are discussed in 2.3.4 Using the Serial Port. The Serial Port settings are listed in the ASCII translation options list, which is discussed in 14.19.8 Reviewing and Setting ASCII Translation Options. Remember that the VoiceNote mPower QT and host serial port must be set exactly the same to transfer a document. When you have selected a device KeySoft prompts: "Export as a Braille or text file?." Press B for Braille or T for a text file. When you have selected the file type KeySoft queries: "Host ready to receive?." Prepare the host to receive the file and when it is ready press ENTER or press Y. You hear a periodic beep as the document is transferred. When the transfer is finished, you are returned to the Translation Menu. 14.19.7 Translating between Braille and Text. To translate a document from KeyWord Braille to KeyWord text or vice versa, select Translate between Braille and Text from the Translation Menu. This is useful if, for example, you have written a Braille document which you now intend to print, but before printing, you want to check out the inkprint formatting. You can translate it into a text document and review it. KeySoft guides you through the translation procedure. Select the source folder name when prompted by KeySoft. Either type a folder name and press ENTER, or press SPACE to review the List of Folders. Alternatively, to select a subdirectory path name, press CONTROL with T. To change the current drive, press BACKSPACE. For the Flash Disk, press F. For the KeySoft System Disk, press K. If you have a storage card installed you can press P for PC Card, C for CompactFlash card, or S for SD card. To review the list of drives, press SPACE. After you have selected the drive and folder, select the source file. Either type a file name or select it in the usual way. Follow the same procedure to select the destination folder name and enter the destination file name. If you type a document name that does not exist, KeySoft asks if you want to create a new document. Conversely, if the document already exists, you are asked if you want to append the translated document to the end of the existing one, or replace it entirely. When you have entered the destination file name, the source document is translated to its complementary format. That is, a Braille document is translated to text, or vice versa. The source document remains in its original format, and you are returned to the Translation Menu. 14.19.8 Reviewing and Setting ASCII Translation Options. The ASCII translation options are used by KeySoft when translating between KeyWord and ASCII formats including when exporting documents to the Serial Port. To review and set ASCII translation options, select ASCII Translation Options from the Translation Menu. Press SPACE to announce the ASCII Translation Options list. Each item in the list is discussed below. When you have reviewed the list, you can use BACKSPACE to move back through the list to check the settings. The current setting is announced for each item. Remember that you must press ENTER after you have changed the setting. Press ESCAPE to exit when you are satisfied with your settings. 14.19.8.1 Use line or paragraph format. Press P for Paragraph, or L for Line. Press ENTER to complete the entry. This option determines the way that lines are terminated during document exporting or file importing. During document exporting, if the Line option has been selected, a carriage return is added at the end of each line. If the Paragraph option is selected, a carriage return is added only at the end of each paragraph, giving a line that is as long as the paragraph. The Line option is usually best when exporting to a communications program. The Paragraph option is most suitable when exporting a document to a word processor because it allows the text to be reformatted after it is received. The Line or Paragraph format option also determines how KeySoft treats each incoming line of text during file importing. If the Line format option is selected, KeySoft leaves the text unaltered. In the Paragraph option, KeySoft removes single carriage returns. Where there are two or more carriage returns, or a carriage return followed by an indent to indicate a new paragraph, no change is made. If you go into KeyWord and insert any hard carriage returns to format the file contents, these will be retained next time the file is opened in the VoiceNote mPower QT. When importing an ASCII file, for example a Braille book, that has a single space in front of each line, the left margin is automatically stripped out so that KeySoft doesn't interpret it as if every line is the start of a new paragraph. 14.19.8.2 Extended ASCII character. The options are: To convert extended ASCII characters to standard ASCII characters, press C. This option removes the high order bit. It is useful in situations where this bit may be inadvertently set. To ignore ASCII characters, press I. This option removes characters with the high order bit set. It is useful where graphical symbols have been used extensively. For example, when boxes have been drawn around text. To retain ASCII characters as extended ASCII characters, press R. Extended ASCII characters are 8 bit characters such as characters in foreign languages or graphical symbols. In most cases KeySoft can name or use the character. In other cases the character will be referred to as "character n" where n is the ASCII value of the character. 14.19.8.3 Extended Character Set. The options are MSDOS; International MSDOS; or ANSI. 14.19.8.4 Use of end of file character. The options are N to turn on the use of an end of file character, or F to turn off and ignore the use of an end of file character. This option determines whether an ASCII end of file character (1AH or ^Z) is appended to a document being exported after the end of the text. In most cases this will cause a communications program to stop receiving text and save it on disk. 14.19.8.5 Use of line feed character. Press N to turn on the appending of a line feed character after a carriage return character is exported. Press F to turn off appending a line feed character. Appending a line feed character may be required when exporting to a communication program depending on the program. 14.19.8.6 Baud Rate. The baud rate is the speed at which data is transferred between serial devices. Type a new baud rate value if you know the standard values or press CONTROL with SPACE to cycle through the list of available values. 14.19.8.7 Parity. Press N, E or O, for None, Even or Odd parity respectively. If you are unsure which setting is correct select none; this is usually preferred for short cables. 14.19.8.8 Number of data bits. Press 7 or 8 for the number of data bits and press ENTER. Standard ASCII characters use only 7 data bits while extended ASCII characters have 8 bits. 14.19.8.9 Handshaking. The options are S for Software or H for Hardware. Handshaking determines how the VoiceNote mPower QT and a host computer control the flow of data from each other. Handshaking is needed if the VoiceNote mPower QT or host computer cannot keep up with the flow of data when a high baud rate is selected. VoiceNote mPower QT supports both types of handshaking. You know when it is needed because large blocks of data are lost when exporting documents or importing files. Try the software option first if information about the host computer is limited. 14.19.8.10 Transmit delay. This is the delay between each character when exporting a document. It should be zero when using a communications program on the host. Where a document is being exported directly into a word processor or other program, a value from 1 to 5 may be used to allow the word processor to keep up. Use the smallest value which does not cause characters to be lost. This is the end of the ASCII Translation Options list. 14.19.9 Reviewing and Setting Back Translation Options. These are the general settings which are used during the translation of a KeySoft Braille document to a KeySoft text document. These settings are used throughout KeySoft whenever a document is back translated. For example, when exporting a Braille document. The first 6 items and the last item may be overridden in a document by changing the Inkprint Translation Options, as described in 7.17.11 Inkprint Settings linked with a Braille Document. To review and change Back Translation Options from Braille to Text, select Back Translation Options from the Translation Menu. Press SPACE to announce the Braille to Text Translation Set Up List. Each item in the list is discussed below. When you have reviewed the list, you can use BACKSPACE to move back through the list to check the settings. The current setting is announced for each item. Note that you must press ENTER after you selected a new setting. Press ESCAPE to exit when you are satisfied with your settings. 14.19.9.1 Type of paragraph boundary used in the source document. The way paragraphs are formatted in Braille is usually different from the way they are formatted in inkprint. For example, paragraphs in Braille are commonly indented two spaces whereas paragraphs in inkprint are commonly separated by one or more blank lines. This option tells KeySoft how to recognize a paragraph in a Braille document so that it can be formatted correctly in the text document. KeySoft needs to know what type of paragraph boundary is used in the source document. It needs to know this in order to correctly interpret where one paragraph ends and the next starts in the Braille document. There are 3 options, as follows: 1. For an Indented line, or one or more blank lines, press I. This is the suggested setting. For a new paragraph to be started in the destination document, the source document must have either a New Line followed by an indented line, or a blank line. Single New Line markers which are not followed by an indented line are not taken as the start of a new paragraph and therefore are not passed over into the text document. 2. For one or more New line markers, press N. This setting causes every New Line marker to indicate the end of a paragraph. 3. For one or more Blank lines, press B. Use this option if every line in the source document ends with a New Line marker and paragraphs are indicated by blank lines. The way paragraphs are formatted in the resulting text document is not affected by this setting but is determined by the "Paragraph format?" setting below. This setting is also used by KeyWord to determine the paragraph boundary when the paragraph reading commands are used. 14.19.9.2 New line translation option. This applies to Heading, Subheading and Lines styles of presentation and determines how New Line markers in a Braille document are translated. To leave the line formatting Unchanged, press U. To remove New Line markers and thereby Join lines together, press J. To expand single New Lines into Blank lines, press B. This is the suggested setting. 14.19.9.3 Convert Braille Italics to Italics Font. To have Braille italics converted to italics font press Y. To have italics ignored press N. 14.19.9.4 Include two spaces between sentences. In Braille, sentences are usually ended by a period followed by a single space whereas in inkprint sentences are usually ended with a period followed by two spaces. To have a space after a period in a Braille document converted to two spaces after the period, press Y. To leave as a single space press N. 14.19.9.5 Suppress new page markers. The places where you have forced a new page in a Braille document by pressing CONTROL with N are often not the correct places to force a new page in inkprint. This option excludes New Page markers in the Braille document from the text document. You can force new pages in the text document by using the Inkprint Inclusion option in the Braille document as described in 7.17.11.3 Inkprint Exclusion. 14.19.9.6 Include a blank line between items in outline style. To save space in Braille, items in an outline may start on the next line, rather than after a blank line. If this is the case and you want a blank line left in the text document, press Y to turn this option on. Press N to turn it off. 14.19.9.7 Blank lines before and after a heading. This sets the number of blank lines which are left in the text document before and after a section of text which has the Heading presentation style. The factory setting is 2 and 1. To change the setting, type the new number of blank lines before a heading, a comma and then the new number of blank lines after a heading. Number signs are not needed. For example "1,2." 14.19.9.8 Heading format. This sets the format indicators to be inserted at the beginning of each line in a heading in a text document. These format indicators are: center the line, right justify the line, insert tab, fonts, underline, space, or force new line or new page. Entering format indicators here is the same as when searching for them. Refer to 3.11.2 Searching for Format Indicators for details. The factory setting for the heading format is: "Center line," "Bold on." 14.19.9.9 Blank lines before and after a subheading. This sets the number of blank lines which will be left in the document before and after a section of text which has the Subheading presentation style. The factory setting is 1 and 1. The same procedure as discussed in Item 7 above is used to change the setting. 14.19.9.10 Subheading format. You can enter the commands to be inserted in the text document at the beginning of each line in the Subheading presentation style. You can use the same format indicators as listed in the Heading Format item above. There is no factory setting for this item. 14.19.9.11 Paragraph Format. This item determines the format indicators that are inserted between paragraphs in the text document. You can enter a combination of New Lines, spaces and tabs. To enter a New Line press CONTROL with ENTER. The default is 2 New Line format indicators. 14.19.9.12 Revert to paragraph style after how many blank lines. When either the heading, subheading, outline or line styles of presentation are used, the style will continue in effect until another style is selected or the number of blank lines set here are encountered. This is the end of the Braille to text translation setup list. 14.19.10 Reviewing and Setting Forward Translation Options. These are the general settings which are used during translation from a KeySoft text document to a KeySoft Braille document. These options are used throughout KeySoft wherever a document must be translated into Braille. The items are generally similar to those for back translation, but there are differences to cater for the direction of translation. The first 8 items may be overridden from within a text document by using the Braille Translation Options, as described in 7.4.2.6 Translation Options. To review or change the settings in the Forward Translation Options list, select Forward translation options, from the Translation Menu. The 15 items in the list are as follows: 14.19.10.1 Types of paragraph boundary used in the source document. KeySoft needs to know this in order to correctly interpret where one paragraph ends and the next starts in the text document. The options here are the same as for Item 1 in the Back Translation Options. Refer to 14.19.9 Reviewing and Setting Back Translation Options above for details. 14.19.10.2 New line translation. This applies to Heading, Subheading and Lines styles of presentation and determines how New Line markers in a text document are translated into Braille. There are four options: To leave the line formatting unchanged, press U. To remove New Line markers and thereby Join lines together, press J. To replace New Line markers with two Spaces, press S. To have new lines in the text document start new lines in the Braille document but remove any blank lines, press B. This is the factory setting. 14.19.10.3 Convert italics font to Braille italics. To have italics font converted to Braille italics press Y. To have italics ignored press N. 14.19.10.4 Suppress multiple spaces. Multiple spaces may be used in a text document between sentences or for visual formatting. This option can be used to remove these from the Braille document during translation, leaving only one space. 14.19.10.5 Suppress new page markers. The places where a new page has been forced in text are often not the correct places to force a new page in the Braille document. This option excludes New Page markers in the Braille document from the text document. 14.19.10.6 Ignore tabs. If the text document uses tabs extensively for visual formatting, you can have these replaced by a space in the Braille document using this option. 14.19.10.7 Include capital signs. Usually you would want capital signs included in Braille document, but if you are translating a text document where every word is in capitals, for example, then this option will become very useful. 14.19.10.8 Suppress blank lines in outline style. This option enables you to save space in Braille by eliminating blank lines left between items in an outline. 14.19.10.9 Blank lines before and after a heading. This sets the number of blank lines which are left in the Braille document before and after a section of text which has the Heading presentation style. The factory setting is one before and one line after. 14.19.10.10 Heading format. You can enter the format indicators to be inserted in the Braille document at the beginning of each line in the Heading presentation style. You can include format indicators to center the line, right justify the line, insert tabs, and spaces, or force new lines or new pages. For details, refer to 3.11.2 Searching for Format Indicators. The factory setting is: "Center line." This sets the number of blank lines which are left in the Braille document before and after a section which has the Subheading presentation style. The factory setting is one and zero. 14.19.10.11 Subheading format. You can enter the format indicators to be inserted in the Braille document at the beginning of each line in the Subheading presentation style. You can use the same indicators as listed in the Heading Format item above. The factory setting is 4 spaces. To enter a space as the first character in the Subheading, press CONTROL with SPACE. 14.19.10.12 Paragraph format new line (two spaces). This item determines the format indicators which are inserted between paragraphs in the Braille document. You can enter a combination of New Lines, spaces and tabs. To enter a New Line press CONTROL with ENTER. The factory setting is a New Line followed by 2 spaces. 14.19.10.13 Revert to paragraph style after how many blank lines. When either the heading, subheading, outline or line styles of presentation are used, the style continues in effect until another style is selected or the number of blank lines set here are encountered. The factory setting is two. 14.19.10.14 Size of indent for wrapped lines in the lines and outline styles. Often a line of text in inkprint takes up more than one line in Braille. Sometimes this makes it difficult to find an item in a list or an outline when reading an embossed copy. This option does not affect the first line of each item in Braille, but if more than one line has to be used for an item, the second and subsequent lines will be indented by this number of cells. The factory setting is two. This is the end of the Text to Braille options list. End of File Manager Chapter. 15 Utilities Menu. The Utilities Menu provides a number of generalpurpose functions. This chapter covers most of the functions available from the Utilities menu. To enter it, select the "Utilities" option in the Main Menu. The available operations are as follows: Connect to ActiveSync. ActiveSync is discussed fully in 13.14 Connecting your BrailleNote to a PC. Synchronization. This is discussed fully in 13.15 KeySync. Backup or Restore Files, which allows all working files to be backed up or restored to a backup drive. Pronunciation Dictionary, which corrects the pronunciation of unusual words. Date and Time Set, used to reset the internal clock. Application Program, which runs optional KeySoft software. Miscellaneous Options, which allows you to select a connection type for ActiveSync. Key Management – for keeping track of separately purchased KeySoft products. You can select an item by reviewing the list and pressing ENTER, or by pressing the initial letter of the required item. 15.1 Backup or Restore Files. You can use the Backup Options in the Utilities Menu to save and restore all KeySoft working files, including word processor and email documents, planner files and address lists. By default, KeySoft stores these files on the Flash Disk. It is good housekeeping to backup your files to an external drive. This could be a storage card, an external memory drive, or a PC or network. This safeguards your information against loss caused by accidental overwriting or deletion of files and other mishaps. Incremental Backup can be used to reduce the time taken to copy the files to the backup drive. Only those files changed since the last backup are copied. You should back up your files into the same folder used for the previous backup. You may use the Restore option to restore your working documents or files in the event of a problem, or to return to an older version. 15.1.1 Backing Up. From the Utilities menu, select the "Backup or Restore files" option. KeySoft prompts: "Do you wish to Backup or Restore files?." If you want to backup your working files, press B, for Backup. KeySoft prompts: "Backup which drive? Press ENTER for Flash Disk." Press ENTER to backup the Flash Disk. KeySoft prompts: "Backup which folder? All." KeySoft assumes you want to backup "All" folders. You would normally do a complete backup of all folders on the Flash Disk together with their contents. Alternatively you can backup a folder at a time if you wish. To backup all folders, press ENTER, or to backup one folder at a time, press SPACE to review the list of folders and press ENTER to select the desired folder. KeySoft prompts: "Make backup on which drive? Press ENTER for (suggested drive)." Backups are normally done to a storage card, an external memory drive, or to a Network. Select the appropriate drive from the drive list, then press ENTER. KeySoft prompts: "Make Backup in which Folder? Press ENTER for (suggested folder)." The suggested folder name is based on the current date, and is in the form "June 10, 2006 backup." Press ENTER to accept the suggested folder, or press SPACE to review the list of folders on the backup drive. Alternatively you can type in the name of a folder. If the folder does not already exist you will be asked to confirm creation of the new folder; press Y to do this. The time taken for the backup process depends on the number of files being backed up, and VoiceNote mPower QT continues to beep about once per second during the process. At the completion of the backup KeySoft confirms the number of files copied to the backup disk, and you are returned to the Utilities menu. To speed up the backup process you can perform an incremental backup, which only copies files modified since the last backup. This procedure is described in the next section. 15.1.2 Incremental Backup. Incremental Backup can be used to reduce the time taken to copy the files to the backup drive. Only those files changed since the last backup are copied. You should back up your files into the same folder used for the previous backup. From the Utilities menu, select the "Backup or Restore files" option. KeySoft prompts: "Do you wish to Backup or Restore files?." Press I for Incremental Backup. KeySoft prompts: "Backup which drive? Press ENTER for Flash Disk." Press ENTER to backup the Flash Disk. From this point on, the procedure is as outlined in 15.1.1 Backing Up. Given that you are performing an incremental back up to an existing folder, KeySoft requests confirmation before backing up files modified since the previous backup. Even if you have only created one new file, you will be asked to confirm the replacement of the KeySoft.ksd file that resides in the Dictionaries folder. Press Y to confirm that you want this system file to be updated. 15.1.3 Restoring Files. From the Utilities menu, press B to select Backup Options. KeySoft prompts: "Do you wish to Backup or Restore files?." To restore files that have been backed up, press R. KeySoft prompts: "Restore from which drive? Press ENTER for (drive)." Press ENTER to select the offered backup drive, or select the drive which has the backup you wish to restore. KeySoft prompts: "Folder name? (suggested folder)." Select the folder that you want to restore. KeySoft prompts: "Restore to which drive? Press ENTER for Flash Disk." Your backup files are copied from the backup disk, and you are returned to the Utilities menu. VoiceNote mPower QT continues to beep once per second during the process, and on completion announces the number of files copied. If a file already exists, you are asked to confirm that you wish to replace the existing file with one on the backup drive. To replace the existing file press Y, to skip this file press N, to accept all files press A. You can press HELP to get detailed information on the date and time of creation of a file, and the file size of both the source and destination files, before the back up process starts Backup and Restore work on the entire contents of a folder. If you want to restore an individual file, you should use the Copy File option in the File Manager described in 14.9 Copying a File. 15.2 Pronunciation Dictionary. The Pronunciation Dictionary allows KeySoft to correctly pronounce unusual words, and to expand abbreviations. KeySoft's accuracy is superior to most speech products, but proper names or technical words can be corrected by adding a suitably misspelled version to the pronunciation dictionary. This is done by entering the correct spelling of the word, together with a suitable misspelling. Before speaking a word, KeySoft searches the pronunciation dictionary and if it finds the word, the misspelled version is spoken instead. Commands are provided to add, delete and change words in the pronunciation dictionary. To access the Pronunciation Dictionary, start from the Utilities Menu and press P. The Pronunciation Dictionary Menu includes the following 3 options: Add a word; Change a word; Delete a word. 15.2.1 Adding Words to the Pronunciation Dictionary. If KeySoft mispronounces a word, you may add it to the Pronunciation Dictionary. 1. From the Pronunciation Dictionary menu, press A. 2. KeySoft prompts, "Type word to add." Type the normal spelling of the word, without spaces or numbers, and press ENTER. 3. KeySoft then prompts, "Type misspelling." Type in a misspelling of the word, using only letters and spaces, which gives a correct pronunciation for the word. Spaces are useful for changing the stress. Do not press ENTER yet. 4. To check the new pronunciation, press READ with I. If it does not sound correct, change it with the prompt editing commands, or delete it by pressing REPEAT, and try again. If it sounds OK, press ENTER. You are then returned to the Pronunciation Dictionary Menu. 15.2.2 Changing Words in the Pronunciation Dictionary. If you are concerned about the pronunciation of a word, you can review the Pronunciation Dictionary to check whether it is included. If it is, you can change the misspelling to improve the rendition. From the Pronunciation Dictionary menu, press C. KeySoft prompts, "Type word to change." Either type the normal spelling of the word and press ENTER, or review the pronunciation dictionary by pressing SPACE repeatedly and select the word from there. KeySoft then prompts: "Type misspelling, press ENTER for (default)" You can now amend the offered default by using the prompt editing commands, or you can type in a new misspelling. Before pressing ENTER, listen to the new pronunciation by pressing READ with I. If you are not happy with the sound, continue to edit the misspelling until you are satisfied with the pronunciation, and then press ENTER. The latest misspelling is saved, and you are returned to the Pronunciation Dictionary menu. 15.2.2.1 Foreign words. It is unusual to find a word which is seriously mispronounced, but people's names and foreign words may be exceptions. Typical problems are a shift in vowel sound, and misplaced stress. To correct the way a word is spoken, misspell it phonetically, and use a space to shift the stress. For example: Change "Mikhail Gorbachov" to "Mikhile Gorba choff". Change "Socrates" to "Socra tees". Change "Taj Mahal" to "Taaj Mah harl". 15.2.2.2 Substituting a Text String. There are various reasons why you may wish to put a substitute text string in the Pronunciation Dictionary. For example, KeySoft correctly speaks many acronyms that contain vowels, such as "IBM". However, a less common acronym may be spoken as a word, so you may wish to use the Pronunciation dictionary to change the rendering. For example: Change "ATM" to "A T M", or "automatic teller machine". Change "NaCl" to "N A Cl", or "sodium chloride". You can change the way symbols are spoken. For example, KeySoft says "star" when it encounters the symbol often called "asterisk". If you prefer to hear "asterisk", you may do this with the Pronunciation Dictionary. To do this Braille an asterisk symbol at the "Type word to add" prompt and then Braille the word "asterisk" at the "Type misspelling" prompt. The pronunciation of the plural of the punctuation name also needs entering. To do this Braille an asterisk symbol followed by an "s" at the "Type misspelling" prompt and then Braille the word "asterisks" at the "Type misspelling" prompt. 15.2.2.3 Military Renditions. Finally, you can change the word which KeySoft says when you press READ with COMMA, twice to identify an indistinct letter. For instance, if you prefer to hear "toffee" instead of "tango" when you check the letter T, go to the "Add word" option and press T, followed by an exclamation mark. For the misspelling, type "toffee". This now does as you wish, but it does not alter the pronunciation of the word "tango" in normal text. You can have fun changing the way things are spoken, but take care! It can be a source of mystery later on, when you have forgotten that you made the change. 15.2.3 Deleting Words from the Pronunciation Dictionary. From the Pronunciation Dictionary menu, press D. KeySoft prompts, "Type word to delete." Either type the normal spelling of the word and press ENTER, or review the pronunciation dictionary by pressing SPACE repeatedly and select the word from there. The word is deleted and you are returned to the Pronunciation Dictionary Menu. 15.3 Date and Time Set. Follow these steps to set, or change the settings of, KeySoft's internal clock and calendar. Remember that at each point in the process you can obtain relevant help by pressing HELP. 1. From the Utilities menu, press D for Date and time set. 2. KeySoft prompts: "Date format? (default). Press ENTER for USA." Press S for USA format, which is: month/day/year, or K for UK format which is: day/month/year. Press ENTER to confirm your selection. To leave the date format unchanged, just press ENTER. 3. KeySoft prompts: "Time format? Press ENTER for 12 hour." Press 1 for 12 hour or 2 for 24 hour clock format, followed by ENTER. To leave the time format unchanged, just press ENTER. 4. KeySoft prompts: "Time zone? Press ENTER for (current time zone)." Either press ENTER to choose the current selection, type the first letter of your timezone repeatedly until you hear it then press ENTER, or cycle through the list of time zones by pressing CONTROL with SPACE. 5. KeySoft prompts: "In Daylight saving time? Currently (yes/no)." Type Y for Yes or N for No then press ENTER. Or if the current selection is correct, just press ENTER. 6. KeySoft prompts: "Time? Press ENTER for (current time)." Enter the time, in the form: hh:mm, where "hh" is hours and "mm" is minutes, separated by a colon. You may abbreviate an entry with fewer digits and no separator if it is unambiguous. In 12 hour format, follow the minutes by a space and then A or P to denote before noon and after noon. Press ENTER. 7. KeySoft prompts: "Date? Press ENTER for (current date)." If the date is correct, press ENTER to retain it, or enter a new date. If USA date format has been selected, enter the date in the form: month/day/ year, such as 4/22/05 for April 22, 2005. If UK date format has been selected, enter the date in the form: day/month/year, such as 25/08/ 05 for 25 August 2005. When you have typed the date, press ENTER. As an alternative to entering the date, you may move around the calendar until the date you want is announced. To move back or forward a day at a time press LEFT or RIGHT ARROW. To move a week at a time press UP or DOWN ARROW. To move a month at a time press PAGE UP or PAGE DOWN. To move a year at a time press TAB or SHIFT with TAB. After the date entry is made, you are returned to the Utilities menu. 15.4 Application Programs. This option allows you to run optional software applications written specially for the VoiceNote mPower QT, including manual and software upgrades. To run an application program, start from the Utilities Menu and press A to select Applications Program. KeySoft prompts: "Run program from which drive? Press ENTER for (default drive)." Press ENTER, or use SPACE to select another drive from the drive list. KeySoft prompts: "Directory name? Press ENTER for (default directory)." Type in the directory name, or use SPACE to select the required directory. KeySoft prompts: "Program Name?." Either type the program name, or review the list of programs by pressing SPACE, and press ENTER to complete your entry. The program is now loaded and you will be prompted for a "Command Line." Refer to the instructions associated with the Application Program you are running to determine if a Command Line parameter is required. If you don't have information on this, try pressing ENTER which will run the program without a command line parameter. The Application Program immediately starts running. The Miscellaneous Options setup list allows you to nominate the type of ActiveSync connection you require. To access the Miscellaneous Options, start from the Utilities Menu and press M. 15.4.1 ActiveSync Connection. From the Miscellaneous Options setup list, press SPACE until KeySoft announces: “ActiveSync Connection? (default).” where the word "default" shown in brackets is the current setting. The options are: To connect to ActiveSync using the serial port, press S followed by ENTER. To connect to ActiveSync using a "low speed" 19,200 baud serial connection, press L followed by ENTER. This mode is provided to support older PC's that can not run the serial port at the 115K baud expected when the S option is chosen. To connect using the infrared port, press I followed by ENTER. Depending on the infrared port on your PC, it may be necessary to limit the maximum data rate at the PC to 1 Megabit/second. To connect using Ethernet, press E followed by ENTER. 15.5 Key Management. The purpose of this menu item is to give you access to information about what kind of addon software products you have installed on your VoiceNote mPower QT. There are two options on the Key Management Menu as follows: Enter a new product key – If you purchase an add on software product, sometimes part of the installation process may require typing in a security code. This is the place where one would do that. If it is necessary, instructions for correct usage will be included in the add on software's documentation. System Options – If you press ENTER at this option, the VoiceNote mPower QT will announce a list of addon software products. This includes extra languages, software maintenance agreements etc. End of Utilities Chapter. 16 Media Center. This Chapter covers the Media features offered in KeySoft. These include the Media Player and audio recording functions. 16.1 Media Player. The KeySoft Media Player allows you to play music, readings and any other audio in a range of media formats, on your VoiceNote mPower QT. The Media Player is accessed from the Media Center menu found on the Main Menu. Alternatively, you can go directly to it from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with M. You can play just about any size of media file from either the VoiceNote mPower QT itself or a storage card or memory drive. When the track is playing, you can skip back and forward through it, stop, pause or resume the track as you wish. As well as playing single tracks, you can play M3U playlists, allowing you to listen to continuous audio. And streaming audio off the internet is also possible. Other features include volume control that operates independently of speech, changing tasks with one keystroke, track information and the ability to listen to the audio track in the background while performing other tasks in KeySoft. This section describes the features and their uses in detail. 16.1.1 Supported File Types. The Media Player can play media files with the following extensions: wma, wav, mp3, mpa, snd, aif, aiff, aifc, wmv, au, wax, wmx, wvx and asx. It can also play M3U playlist files. This is discussed more fully in 16.1.8 Playlist files. 16.1.2 Storing media files on the VoiceNote mPower QT. You can store media files anywhere you would store any other file. However as they can be large files, you may find it most convenient to save them on a storage card. You can transfer media files from a PC onto a storage card plugged into your VoiceNote mPower QT via ActiveSync or network client, load them directly onto a storage card using a card reader/writer, or download them directly off the Internet using the web browser on your VoiceNote mPower QT. While it is possible to play a media file on the VoiceNote mPower QT while it is still located on a network, please be aware that the sound quality will be impacted by any variations in the network, just as it is when using a PC based media player. A much better quality sound can be achieved by copying the file to a storage card in one of the ways listed above. 16.1.3 How to play Media files. Opening a media file to play is the same as opening a file anywhere else in KeySoft. The steps are laid out below. In this procedure, it is assumed that you know how to select a drive, folder or file from a list. 1. To open the Media Player, press FUNCTION with M anywhere. 2. The VoiceNote mPower QT will announce one of the following two prompts: a) KeySoft prompts “Play media file in which folder? Press ENTER for (folder name)" where the folder name is "General" the first time you use the media player, and after that, it's the last folder accessed. Go to step 3. b) KeySoft prompts “Continue playing (file)?” where file is the last file you paused while it was playing. To start the track playing from the same point it was paused, press Y. To select a different file, press N and refer to a) above. c) If the Media Player was already playing in the background, it will continue to play. Stop the track by pressing ESCAPE and go to option a) above. 3. There are three possible actions at this point: a) If the folder you want was offered at the prompt, simply press ENTER and go to step 4. b) If you want a different folder on the same drive as the folder offered, press SPACE and select another folder, then go to step 4. c) If the folder you want is on a different drive or on a card, press BACKSPACE and select the drive or card from the drive list. Select a folder from the list of folders, and go to step 4. 4. KeySoft will prompt for a file name. Go to a file in the list. If you want to play only this file, press Enter and the track will start playing. If you want to play several files, one after another, press SPACE with M to mark the first file you selected and want to play. Continue to select files from the list and mark them with SPACE with M until you have selected and marked all the files that you want to play. Press ENTER to start playing all the marked files. For more information on marking and unmarking files, refer to. 14.8 Selecting Multiple Files 5. When the track or tracks finish, KeySoft will prompt, "Media file to play? Press ENTER for (file name)" where file name is the name of the last file played. At this point you can select another file, or exit the media player by pressing ESCAPE. 16.1.4 How to stop or pause a track. There are two sets of commands that you can use to stop or pause a media track. While in the Media Player application itself, you can use the pause command READ with SPACE and restart using either READ with SPACE again, or READ with G. You can also stop it all together by pressing ESCAPE. However, while a track is playing in the background and you are working in another part of KeySoft, these commands will only affect the application you are working in. It is however, possible to stop and restart the track using CONTROL with BACKSLASH. This command also works while you are in the Media Player application. Sometimes you may want to skip through a track rather than listen to it straight through. These skip commands skip forwards or backwards by either 1, 5 or ten percent of the total file. They are: Skip forward 1% RIGHT ARROW, Skip back 1% LEFT ARROW, Skip forward 5% CONTROL with RIGHT ARROW, Skip back 5% CONTROL with LEFT ARROW, Skip forward 10% READ with RIGHT ARROW, Skip back 10% READ with LEFT ARROW, You can use these singly or repeatedly to skip through a track. 16.1.5 Restarting a Track. If you are part way into a track and want it to start from the beginning, press READ with T. This is the same command as used elsewhere in KeySoft for returning to the beginning. 16.1.6 Streaming Audio. As well as playing files, the media player can also stream audio from compatible links on the internet. Compatible links include ACB Radio's winamp link, along with other winamp links that use a pls file format, and MS Media player links, except in the case of ACB Radio. If it is not clear from the link whether it is going to be compatible, try it to see. If you select a compatible streaming audio link while in KeyWeb, it will automatically open either the Media Player, or open an online media player, depending on how the link is designed. After selecting the link there will be a period of time when the file buffers and the web page reloads itself. The length of time this takes will depend on the internet connection speed. KeyWeb lets you know what is going on by a series of prompts and progress beeps something like this: "Please wait ...beep ...beep... beep... loading media... beep... beep...Name of webpage." There may be a short period of silence before or at the end of this sequence depending on how long it takes for the Media Player to buffer the file. When the file is loaded, the stream will start to play. Hitting ENTER again during this process could cause it to hang, so make sure you give it time before retrying. If the link opens a player on the site itself, you will have to use KeyWeb to activate the controls on the site itself. If the link opens in the Media Player, you can use the stop, pause and play functions but not the others. This is standard behavior for media players playing links that stream audio. 16.1.6.1 Pausing and stopping audio streaming. There is a command that pauses and restarts audio streaming. It is CONTROL with BACKSLASH. If audio is playing, it will cause it to pause. If it is paused, it will cause it to restart. This command also works to stop and start any media file while it is playing. 16.1.6.2 Saving a streaming link as a Favorite. By saving a streaming link as a favorite, you can go directly to it from the favorites menu instead of having to go to the page then select the link. Instructions on how to save a link are covered in 12.8.2 Create favorite from current link. 16.1.7 Volume Control. The media player volume controls are: Louder: CONTROL with EQUALS. Softer: CONTROL with HYPHEN. They operate independently from the speech volume, in that you can change the volume without changing the volume of the speech. The speech volume is still the "master volume", so if you adjust the speech volume, the media player volume will change relative to it. This relativity is a useful feature as it means that if you wish to turn down the volume of both speech and track at the same time, you can do so with one action. For example, if you are listening to a piece of music while writing an essay and someone addresses you, you can turn down the speech volume, keep working, and still conduct a conversation. The Media Player volume commands are also mentioned in the last two items of the Options Menu. If you wish to increase the relative volume of the voice to the Media Player, that is, you want to make the speech louder or softer without making the Media Player louder or softer at the same time, you can adjust it independently by pressing FUNCTION with R, then select "Speech Volume Level?." Select a number between 1 and 5, 5 being the loudest. The default setting is 3. 16.1.7.1 Stereo and Mono Outputs. When listening to the media player over stereo headphones or through a set of stereo speakers, the audio track will play in stereo. The builtin speaker is mono. Recordings made will also be in mono. 16.1.8 Playlist files. The Media Player supports the use of M3U playlist files. These files define a playlist of MP3 files that must also be either on your VoiceNote mPower QT or an inserted storage card for the playlist to work. To use an M3U file, open it in the same way as you would any other media file. Any file paths defined in the M3U file will need to point to the location of the MP3 files. If an existing M3U file has file paths relative to a PC, you would need to open the M3U file either on your VoiceNote mPower QT or on your PC in Notepad and edit the file paths to reflect the location on the VoiceNote mPower QT. If the M3U file is in the same folder as the MP3 files to which it refers, you don't need to include any file path at all, just the file names. Alternatively, it is easy to create an M3U file in Keyword. If this interests you, follow the steps below: Before you start, you need to know the location of the media files you wish to include in the playlist. 1. Create a new ASCII text document in KeyWord. When prompted for a file name, add the .m3u suffix to the name you give it. As stated above, it is easiest if you save the M3U file into the same folder as the MP3 files listed in it. 2. In the document, you have two options: a) Type or paste in the file name of the MP3 including the file extension e.g. Purple Rain.mp3. Or, b) If required, type or paste in the file path to the first file, ending with its file name including the file extension, for example: \Flash Disk\My Music 3. Go to the next line by pressing ENTER and repeat, so that each track is listed on its own line. 4. When you've added all the tracks you want to include in the playlist, press CONTROL with S. Your playlist is now ready to use. 16.1.8.1 Playlist Commands. While running an m3u playlist, you might want to skip a track or go back to a previous track. The commands are: Return to previous track: SHIFT with LEFT ARROW Go to next track: SHIFT with RIGHT ARROW All of the other media player commands also work when playing m3u files. 16.1.9 Information on your media file. There are two types of information available about your media file as it is playing – track information and elapsed time. 16.1.9.1 Track Information. You can check out file information while playing a media file. The list of information will vary depending on what type of file you are playing; for example, when streaming audio, there is no track length to report, and likewise with an M3U file, which may not have the track lengths specified in it. The available items of information in order is Title, Track Length, Sample rate and bit rate. Time is given as hh:mm:ss. For example: Title: Sample.mp3 Track length: 0:1:1 Sample rate: 44100 Hertz Bit rate: 128 kbps. To access this information, press READ with I. To pass from one item to the next, press SPACE. To go back to the previous item, press BACKSPACE. To exit from the information at any point, press ESCAPE. 16.1.9.2 Elapsed time. You can also find out the elapsed time, that is, how long the track has been playing and the total length of the track. To access this information, press READ with Q. Time is given as hh:mm:ss. For example: “Elapsed time: 0:0:27 of 0:1:1” 16.1.10 Changing Tasks. Having set a track to play, if you then wish to work on a different task while playing it in the background, either press the hotkey combination for the new task, for example FUNCTION with 6 for Planner, or return to the main menu by pressing MENU and take it from there. The hotkey combination for returning to the Media player is FUNCTION with M. 16.2 Audio Recorder. The audio recorder allows you to make short audio recordings using your VoiceNote mPower QT. It is ideal for short recordings such as reminders and "todo" items, recording a phone number, shopping lists etc. There is a choice of input via an inbuilt microphone or external microphone (not provided) and you can set the quality of the recording in the set up list. Play back recordings via the Playback function, or the Media player. In this user guide, and in the prompts on your VoiceNote mPower QT, recordings are referred to as memos. Recorded memos are wave format files (they have a *.wav file extension) and can be played either via the playback function, or through the Media Player. Memos are saved by default to the My Memos folder on the Flash Disk unless otherwise specified. 16.2.1 Microphones. You can use the audio recorder with either the internal microphone, or an external microphone plugged into the port on the left side of the unit. The internal microphone is positioned inside the top left hand corner of the VoiceNote mPower QT. It has an effective range of about 30cm (1 foot). To let the Recorder know which microphone you are going to be using, you can specify it in the Recording options set up list, as discussed in 16.2.2 Setting up the Audio Recorder. Bear in mind that the internal microphone is the factory default and therefore if you have never used nor do not intend to use, an external microphone, there is no need to do this. It may be necessary before recording to adjust the recording levels, depending on factors such as the usual volume of your voice, the default settings may be too high or low. These are discussed in 16.2.3 Adjusting Recording levels. 16.2.1.1 External Microphone. The VoiceNote mPower QT can record using an external microphone. The kind of external microphone that will work with it is a lowvoltage "electret" type. Electret microphones are distinct from "dynamic" microphones, and are readily available. It would pay however, before purchasing any new microphone, to test it with your VoiceNote mPower QT, or to ensure that you can return it if it is not compatible. Just a quick note on external microphones  any damage to the microphone's lead, no matter how slight, can result in a noticeable loss of sound quality. Likewise the use of extension leads between the microphone and the socket. 16.2.2 Setting up the Audio Recorder. Before recording, there are some settings to configure. From Media Center in the Main Menu, select SetUp options. This takes you to the Media SetUp Menu. The options are; "Select folder for Memos" and "Recording Options". The first option in the menu is "Select folder for Memos," where you can nominate in which drive and folder you wish memos to be saved. The factory default folder is the My Memos folder on your Flash Disk. If you wish however, you can save the file to a storage card or device. To change the default offered, change the drive then folder in the usual way. You can either configure the settings directly in the Recording Options setup List, or as part of setting up to make your first recording. 5. To access the recording options set up list, from the "Media SetUp menu" menu either: a) Select "Recording options set up list," or b) Select "Record a Memo" and at the prompt, "Start recording from the internal/external microphone?" press O for Options. 6. The first setting is "Default input source?" This is where you specify either an external or the internal microphone. For internal press I, for external, press E. Press ENTER 7. The next option is Sampling frequency. For low quality (11.025 kHz), press L. For middle quality (22.05 kHz), press M. For high quality (44.1 kHz), press H. Press ENTER. 8. The next option is Bit Depth. For low quality (8 bits), press L. For high quality (16 bits), press H. (Read more about bit depth in 16.2.7 Bit depth.) Press ENTER. 9. The next item is, "Record button input source? currently Internal microphone" In this item, you are nominating what, if any, type of microphone is selected. Options are: Internal microphone: Whenever you use the record button to instigate recording, it will use the internal microphone External microphone: Whenever you use the record button to instigate recording, it will use an external microphone. Note: if you select this and try to record without the external microphone plugged in, nothing will happen to tell you this and all you will end up with is some white noise, so it pays to check! Off (hotkey is F): If you are not using the record button, you can turn it off altogether so as to minimize the risk of bumping it and making an unwanted recording. Default input source setting: The record button will use whatever input source you set as the default in the first setting of the "Recording options set up list". 10. The next option is "Respond to the Record Button when the power switch is off? Currently no." This allows you to nominate whether you can use the record button while the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. The options are Y for Yes and N for No. If you disabled the Record button in the previous option, this option will not be announced. 11. The last options are Internal and External microphone recording levels. These are covered in the next section. You are now ready to make a recording. Go to. 16.2.3 Adjusting Recording levels. The recording levels for both microphones are set to an average level but you may well wish to adjust them to suit the volume or pitch of your voice. There are two places where you can adjust the level (also known as "gain")  using the menu items and entering a different value, or at the prompts. In the menu, you can set a specific value whereas at the prompts, you can adjust the level on a sliding scale and test it. The next two sections cover each of these in turn. 16.2.3.1 Setting levels at the menu. From the Recording Options Set up List, select either Internal or External microphone recording level. When the item is announced, the current setting will also be announced. To change the value, type a new value and press ENTER. The recording level values available represent the viable decibel range for each kind of microphone. For the internal microphone, the available values are 115 (covering a range of 31.5 to 52.5 decibels), default setting is 12. For the external microphone the available values are 135 (covering 1.5 to 52.5 decibels), the default being 25. 16.2.3.2 Setting levels at a prompt. Setting the recording levels this way impacts the chosen default microphone, which if you have not changed it at all, is the internal microphone. To adjust the levels on a sliding scale at a prompt and test the results, follow these steps: 1. From the Media Menu, select Record a memo. KeySoft prompts "Start recording using...". Do NOT press ENTER yet! 2. At this point you can adjust the recording levels  increase by pressing LEFT ARROW repeatedly, or decrease by pressing RIGHT ARROW repeatedly. Still do NOT press ENTER yet. 3. You can now test the new level. Start a test recording by pressing T and speaking normally as you would if recording a memo, then to stop the recording, press T again. Still do NOT press ENTER yet. 4. To play back the test recording, press P. 5. If the level is not right, repeat steps 1 to 4 until you are happy. At that point, continue on with making your recording by pressing ENTER! The test recording is called "Test.wav" and each new test overwrites the old file so that you don't end up with lots of test files. 16.2.4 Recording a Memo. There are two methods available for making a recording. The first method is useful if you wish to change microphones or are not sure which microphone is set as the default. The second method is useful if you are confident all the settings are as you wish them to be. Method 1: 1. From the Main Menu, select Media Center. 2. From this menu, select "Record a memo." 3. The Recorder prompts, "Start recording using internal microphone?" unless you have already changed the default microphone to external in the set up options. To start recording with the offered microphone, press ENTER, or Y, or the Record button. If you are using the external microphone you will need to plug it in first. Note: The Record button works with the selected input source in this instance. 4. You will hear a beep, which indicates that it is time to start recording. KeySoft will otherwise remain silent during recording. 5. To stop the recording, press ENTER or Y, or the Record button. Two beeps confirm that recording has ceased, and KeySoft will repeat the prompt: "Start recording using internal microphone?". Note: The Record button works with the selected input source in this instance. Method 2: 1. From anywhere in KeySoft, press the record button. This is located on the left side of the unit, and is the first thing you will find if you feel from the front edge. It is a small button. Press it in and you will hear a beep. Release the button and start recording. 2. To stop recording, press the button again. There are some other commands available while recording: To change tasks and continue working with KeySoft while still recording, either press ESCAPE or the relevant changing task hot key combination. At the "Start Recording from...?" prompt, you can also: Playback the last recorded memo by pressing P; Erase the last recorded memo by pressing E; or Name the last recorded memo by pressing N. 16.2.5 Playing back a Memo. Memos are recorded, unless you have specified otherwise, in the My Memos folder on the Flash Disk. The hotkey for playing back a memo is SHIFT with FUNCTION with M. When you select Playback Memos from the Media menu, KeySoft will prompt: “Playback memos in which folder? Press ENTER for My Memos.” KeySoft will announce "List of memos, most recent first, in My Memos folder" for example: “10:59:32 AM on Thursday June 7, 2006 memo” “4:22:10 PM on Wednesday June 6, 2006 memo” “Class singing happy birthday to me” Just as in any file list in KeySoft, you can review it by pressing SPACE and BACKSPACE. To play a memo, press ENTER. When that memo has finished playing, the memo name is repeated. While playing a memo, all of the usual Media Player commands are available. In the My Memos folder, all the usual file commands are available, e.g.: Information about item: READ with I To erase a file: CONTROL with I To rename it: CONTROL with R Etc. 16.2.6 Sampling Frequency. The sounds we use and hear in the real world, such as our voices, are "analog" signals. This means that they are continuous and constant. To process these signals as a recording, we need to convert the signals to "digital" form. Digital signals are not continuous, and so to create the effect of continuous sound, a process called sampling is used. The value of the signal is measured at certain intervals in time, and each measurement is referred to as a sample. The frequency with which samples are measured is called the sample frequency. The more samples that occur in a second, the better the quality of the sound. As the measurement used to describe this is Kilohertz or kHz, the larger the number of kHz, the better quality the sound. Of course, the higher the sample frequency, the larger the resulting file will be. Because there will be times when the sound quality is not as important to you as the amount of storage space you have available, the Recorder has three sample frequencies to choose from: 11.025 kHz (low quality), 22.05 kHz (medium quality), and 44.1 kHz (high quality). The factory defaults is 22.05kHz. 16.2.7 Bit depth. A bit (short for binary digit) is the smallest unit of data in a computer. The range of a digital signal is measured in bits. So, each time a sample is taken, the size of that sample is measured in bits. This is called a bit depth, because the size of the sample is determined by the vertical range of the sound wave The Recorder has two available bit depths  8 bits and 16 bits. Using 16 bits per sample gives a higher quality recording with a larger dynamic range and less noise. However, it uses twice as much storage space as 8 bits. The factory default is 8 bits. 16.2.8 File size. As discussed before, the higher the sample frequency and bit depth of a recording, the larger the resulting sound file will be. However, the larger the file, the better the sound quality. Therefore you may want to make a value judgment about what to record at a high quality and what to record at lower quality, to manage your storage capacity. Below is a breakdown of the relative sizes for 10 second and 60 second sound recordings according to the sound quality. For a 10 second recording, the file sizes are: 1. Low Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =107KB 2. Medium Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =215 KB 3. High Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =431 KB 4. Low Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =215 KB 5. Medium Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =431 KB 6. High Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =861 KB For a 60 second recording, the file sizes are: 1. Low Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =646KB 2. Medium Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =1.26MB 3. High Frequency sample, Low quality bit depth =2.5MB 4. Low Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =1.26MB 5. Medium Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =2.5MB 6. High Frequency sample, High quality bit depth =5.04MB 16.3 FM Radio. The FM Radio includes several features that are standard for a digitally tuned FM Radio such as a typical car radio. For example, it has automatic tuning and the ability to preset stations. The default frequency range of between 87.5MHz and 108MHz is used for the FM Radio. The FM Radio is accessed from the Media Center menu found on the Main Menu. Alternatively, you can go directly to it from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with F. When you access the FM Radio for the first time you will tuned into the frequency 87.5 FM. Unless this is a station, you will just hear static! Since the headphones act as an aerial they must be plugged in whenever you want to listen to the radio. You can listen to the radio either via headphones or the speaker. To listen to the radio via the speaker instead of through your headphones, press FUNCTION with L. This is a toggle command; in other words it will alternate between the headphones and the speaker each time you press FUNCTION with L. This section describes the features and their uses in detail. 16.3.1 Tuning the FM Radio. You will need to tune your radio into your local FM stations using one of the three options described below. 1. If you already know the frequency of a station, you can tune into it directly by pressing READ with F. KeySoft prompts: "Station frequency?". Type the frequency you want to tune into and press ENTER. The radio will then be tuned into the frequency you have selected and KeySoft will then display the frequency. For example "92.1 FM Stereo". 2. The FM Radio can automatically tune into stations using the following hot keys: To scan forward to find a station press READ with RIGHT ARROW; To scan back to find a station press READ with LEFT ARROW. Once you have tuned into a station you can make further adjustments to the frequency by manually tuning the radio. See option 3 below for an explanation of manual tuning. 3. Manual tuning is handy for fine tuning when the reception of stations is unclear. To improve the reception you can increase or decrease the frequency by 100 KiloHertz at a time. It is also useful for coarse tuning if you want to move the frequency up or down by 1 Megahertz. Fine or coarse tuning can be performed by using the following hot keys: To increase the frequency by 100kHz press RIGHT ARROW; To decrease the frequency by 100kHz press LEFT ARROW; To increase the frequency by 1MHz press CONTROL with RIGHT ARROW; To decrease the frequency by 1MHz press CONTROL with LEFT ARROW. Remember that you can press HELP at any time to read a summary of the options available. 16.3.2 Presetting stations. Presetting stations is possible with the Presets feature. Presets save you from having to remember the frequency of all your favorite stations. You may have as few or as many presets as you wish. Each preset is given a personalized name so that they can be easily identified. For example, Concert FM or Cool Party Tunes. All you need to do is tune to a station of your choice and press CONTROL with R. You can then type in a name and press ENTER. Repeat this process for each station you want to preset. The following hot keys are available for navigating preset stations: To move forward through the list of preset stations press SPACE; To move back through the list of preset stations press BACKSPACE. Once you have preset your favorite stations you can move from one to another by entering the first character of the name, for instance, C for Concert FM. If there are more than one preset starting with the same character, enter the first unique part of the name instead. For example, "Co" for Concert FM or "Cl" for Classic. When KeySoft finds a preset station it will display both the name you have given it and the frequency. For example "Concert FM 89.7 Stereo". Note that once you have scrolled through all the preset stations KeySoft will display "End of list" and remain tuned to the the last preset station. The name and frequency of the last preset station will then be displayed. It is possible to change the name of a preset and if you decide that you no longer want a preset on the list you can delete it. The following hot keys are available for entering, editing or renaming and deleting preset stations: To enter a new preset station press CONTROL with R. Keysoft will prompt: "Name for this station? Currently (blank space)." The blank space represents no preset name entered. Type in a name for the preset station and press ENTER. KeySoft will then display the name of the new preset station. To edit or rename an existing preset station, select the one you wish to change and press CONTROL with R. Keysoft will prompt: "Name for this station? Currently (existing preset station name)." Type in the new name for the preset station and press ENTER. KeySoft will then display the new name of the preset station. To delete a preset station, select the one you wish to delete and press CONTROL with 8. KeySoft will prompt: "Delete (preset station name). Sure?." Type Y for Yes and KeySoft will display the frequency of the station. Note that the FM Radio will tune into the last frequency that it was tuned into when the radio was previously switched on. 16.3.3 Listening to the radio while using KeySoft. The VoiceNote mPower QT allows you to listen to your favorite station at the same time as performing other tasks in KeySoft. For example, while you are writing a document or reading a book. If you want to leave the radio on in the background while you work in another part of KeySoft press ESCAPE. Keysoft prompts: "Leave the radio on?." Type Y for Yes. If you need to change the station or adjust any of the other FM Radio features, return to FM Radio via the Main Menu or by pressing FUNCTION with F. To switch off the FM Radio press ESCAPE. KeySoft prompts: "Leave the radio on?". Press N for No. 16.3.4 Volume Control. The FM Radio volume controls are: Louder: CONTROL with EQUALS. Softer: CONTROL with HYPHEN. They operate independently from the speech volume, in that you can change the volume without changing the volume of the speech. The speech volume is still the "master volume", so if you adjust the speech volume, the FM Radio volume will change relative to it. This relativity is a useful feature as it means that if you wish to turn down the volume of both speech and radio at the same time, you can do so with one action. For example, if you are listening to the radio while writing an essay and someone addresses you, you can turn down the speech volume, keep working, and still conduct a conversation. If you wish to increase the relative volume of the voice to the FM Radio, that is, you want to make the speech louder or softer without making the FM Radio louder or softer at the same time, you can adjust it independently by pressing FUNCTION with R, then select "Speech Volume Level?" Select a number between 1 and 5, 5 being the loudest. The default setting is 3. 16.3.5 Mute. You can quickly silence the FM Radio using the mute function. For example, this is useful when phone rings or you need to access Help without being distracted by the sound of the radio blaring. To mute or unmute the radio press CONTROL with BACKSLASH. 16.3.6 Recording the radio. You can record the radio using the Audio Recorder function. The Audio Recorder provides you with the option of recording the radio whether or not you are listening to it. Refer to 16.2 Audio Recorder for further details. End of Media Chapter. 17 Database Manager. This chapter introduces the basics of KeyBase, the database part of KeySoft. A database is an organized collection of information (otherwise known as data) that has been arranged so that it is easy and fast to find. Databases are useful for storing a wide range of information. The information within a database is organized into fields and records. Each piece of information, such as a phone number, is called a "field". You can enter multiple fields against a person's surname, for example, to form a "record". Databases are useful for storing a wide range of information, such as a catalog of CDs in your CD collection, your recipes, bank records and so on. For your convenience, KeyBase comes with 9 different databases that are ready for use. If you cannot find exactly what you need from the list of supplied databases, you can develop your own database or modify one to suit your needs. The supplied databases are: CD Catalog: Keep information on the CDs that you own, such as the track titles on each album. Home Inventory: Useful for entering information about household purchases such as appliances that are under warranty and insurance details. My Books: Provides an opportunity to search for data on the genre and format of books you have read. My Recipes: Retrieve lists of ingredients for your favorite dish. Transaction Record: Allows you to keep track of debit and credit movements within your bank accounts. Copy and rename this database as appropriate, for instance, create one copy for each of your bank accounts. Receipt Book: Make a record of goods and services bought or sold. Copy and rename this database as appropriate. Membership List: Club/Organization contact details, for example, membership numbers and subscription information. Copy and rename this database to suit your requirements. For example, if you are the secretary of a Blind Cricket Club, rename it "Blind Cricket Club Membership". Wine Tasting: Create records of your wine tasting experiences, including notes on the taste and bouquet. Ham Radio Log: Used to keep a log of amateur radio contact and call details, such as location, call sign and frequency. To enter the Database Manager from the Main Menu, use the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys to review the items in the menu, until "Database Manager" is displayed, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, you can select the Database Manager from the Main Menu by pressing D. You can switch directly to the Database from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing SHIFT with FUNCTION with D. KeyBase prompts: "Database to use. Press ENTER for (default)?", where the word "default" is really the database you used last. This is a standard KeySoft filename prompt and all the usual commands are available, as described below: To select the announced database, press ENTER. To cycle through the list of available KeyBase files, press SPACE. KeySoft will then display "List of KeyBase files in KeyBase folder". To look through the list of available KeyBase files, press SPACE or ADVANCE repeatedly and when the name of the file you require is announced, select it by pressing NEXT or ENTER. Note: As the remainder of this chapter uses the example of the Membership List database to illustrate the features of the Database Manager, now is a good time to select it from the list of supplied databases. 17.1 KeyBase Menu. Once you have selected the database you want to work with, the KeyBase Menu is announced. If you are familiar with KeyList, the address list manager, you will notice that KeyList and KeyBase have many features in common. The KeyBase menu comprises of 8 options as follows: Add record. Lookup records. Copy records. Emboss records. Print records. Import data. Review database definition. Free database space. The following sections describe these options. Note: If you are using a database for the first time, it will be empty until you have added records. 17.1.1 Adding a Record. The supplied database, Membership List (for instance, one named Blind Cricket Club) is used here to help you add a record. This option allows you to enter any information into the database. Each item of information, such as the first name of a member (in the Blind Cricket Club database), is called a "field". All the fields associated with a particular first name are used to form a "record". At the KeyBase menu, select "Add Record". KeyBase displays: "Entry list for Blind Cricket Club". Move to the first item in the list by pressing SPACE or ADVANCE, and KeyBase prompts you for a first name. Type the first name of a particular member and press ENTER. You are then prompted for the next field. Either enter text and press ENTER or skip the field by pressing SPACE. Continue adding rentries until you come to the end of the list. You can review the list at any time by pressing DOWN ARROW or SPACE to move back, or UP ARROW or BACKSPACE to move forward. When you are satisfied, add the new record by pressing CONTROL with ENTER. KeyBase announces, "Record added", and you are returned to the KeyBase menu. If you wish to add another record, press A and repeat the previous procedure. 17.1.2 Finding Information. This option allows you to quickly find information in the database. It is useful when you have a particular query that you need answered. To explain how to find information in a database, the example of a Membership List for a Blind Cricket Club has again been used. At the KeyBase menu, select "Lookup Record". KeyBase displays: "Selection List for Blind Cricket Club". Move to the first item in the list by pressing SPACE, and KeyBase prompts: "First Name?". The Selection List allows you to specify the search for a particular record or several related records. For example, you may want to review the records of all people called "Smith" who are members of the Blind Cricket Club. In this case, type "smith" at the last name prompt, and press ENTER. The first name and last name of the first person in the Blind Cricket Club database called "Smith" is announced. You can move through the list of "Smiths" by pressing RIGHT ARROW. Each press announces his or her first name, followed by the last name, in this case "Smith". Only records which match the selection list are displayed. A beep indicates when there are no more matching last names. To review the other fields in a particular record, press SPACE repeatedly. Only fields containing an entry are announced. The format of each item comprises the name of the field, such as "Membership Category", followed by the entry, such as "Senior".The movement commands for the KeyBase menu are as follows: To move to the next record: RIGHT ARROW. To move to the previous record: LEFT ARROW. To move to the next field: SPACE. To move to the previous field: BACKSPACE. To read all fields: READ with 8. To delete this record: CONTROL with 8. To change this field or any other field or to enter information into additional fields press CONTROL with K. To copy a record to the clipboard: CONTROL with B then C. When you have finished reviewing to a selection, you can return to the "Selection List" by pressing ESCAPE. You are then asked for another Last name. If you have finished searching, you can return to the KeyBase menu by pressing ESCAPE again. The information which you enter into the Lookup Record option is used to find matching records. You may include as much or as little data as you wish. For example, when looking up a membership number, you might want to find Jane Smith. Move to the first item in the list by pressing SPACE, and KeyBase prompts: "First Name?". Type "jane" and move to the next field by pressing READ with O. KeyBase will prompt: "Last name?". Type "smith" and start the search by pressing ENTER. The first "Jane Smith" will be announced. If necessary, cycle through the other "Jane Smith's" by pressing RIGHT ARROW, until you locate the one you require. To find the correct "Jane Smith", review the fields by pressing the initial letter for the field name. For example, D for "Date Joined". For string fields, you need only type the first few characters in a field rather than the whole field. For example, if you just type S in the "Last Name" field, you are able to access the records of all people whose last names begin with S. You can search for all members who fall into the senior membership category. At the selection list, don't specify a last name, but press SPACE repeatedly until the prompt: "Membership category?" is announced and then type "senior" and press ENTER. You can then use RIGHT ARROW to move through all the members who are senior members of the Blind Cricket Club. You can also search for a name fragment within a field, using the multicharacter wild card for the unknown first part. For example, you may remember a members' postal address as: "Something View Road". If you press *, followed by "View" in the address line 1 field, you should have a very short list of records to review. Any fields used in a Lookup will be offered as a suggestion for the next search, unless you exit to the KeyBase Menu between searches. You may want to clear a previouslyused field so it is not used in the next search. To do this, move to the required field using SPACE or BACKSPACE and press the Clear Field command, CONTROL with BACKSPACE. Note: numbers are matched identically, so that 42 will match with 42, but not with 39.9. Conversely, dates and times will be matched regardless of how they are entered. For example, 11.00p.m. will match with 23.00. 17.1.3 Embossing Records. You may want to emboss a name and membership number, or a selection of records, to create membership cards for your Blind Cricket Club members. From the KeyBase menu select "Emboss Records". KeySoft prompts: "Emboss or Set up embosser?" If you haven't previously set up the embosser, press S. The set up procedure is covered in 6.8 The Embosser Setup List. To proceed with embossing, press E, and KeySoft prompts: "Template name"? A template is a standard KeyWord text or Braille document that specifies the field layout that is to be used when database records are printed, embossed, copied, or merged into documents. Each database can have one or more templates, but each template only works with one database. For this reason, in selecting a template, you can only select templates associated with the current database. To avoid confusion caused by viewing templates that are associated with other databases, follow the suggestions below: 1. Create a separate folder for each database that holds the database and templates associated with that particular database. 2. Name each template clearly to easily identify with its associated database. For instance, for the database named Book Club Membership, the template to be used when composing subscription reminder letters, could be named Book Club Subscriptions. Note you will be provided with an error message if you accidently select a template that is not associated with the current database. The error message is "This template is associated with a different database, (name of database). Use anyway?". To select another template, type N. Refer to 10.9.2 Creating a Template for further details on how to create a template. To select a template for embossing, you need to understand the difference between a database record and an embossed page. A database record is a series of fields, whereas an embossed page must have a specific format. So, to emboss database records, you must specify which fields you want to emboss, and how they should be arranged. This is defined by a template, which is a KeyWord document laid out with the required field names in the required arrangement. A template may also contain text and formatting information. There are two main template categories, namely Braille templates and text templates. To emboss records from your Blind Cricket Club database, you would use a Braille template. Conversely to print records from the same database, you would use a Text template. The convention used for naming templates, places the word "Braille" in front of the Braille templates. After you have selected the template, KeyBase announces, "Selection list for Blind Cricket Club". This is the Selection List that you use in the Lookup Record option. It is used in the same way to select the records that you want embossed. If you want to emboss every record, press ENTER. However, you can select just those records you want to emboss. When you have set up the required search field, or fields, start the lookup by pressing ENTER. KeyBase announces the number of selected records, and prompts, "Emboss all selected records?" To do this, press Y. All the selected records are embossed, and you are returned to the KeyBase menu. Alternatively, you have a further opportunity to choose from the selected records. To do this, press N, and you are presented with the first matching record. If you wish to emboss this record, press ENTER and this record is embossed. If you do not want to emboss this record, scan the list by pressing RIGHT ARROW, and press ENTER for each record that you wish to include. 17.1.4 Printing Records. The procedure for printing a record, or a selection of them, is very similar to embossing. From the KeyBase menu, select "Print records". KeySoft prompts: "Print or Set up printer?" If you haven't already set up the printer, press S. The set up procedure is covered in 6.11 The Printer SetUp List. To proceed with printing, press P, and follow the prompts to select a template and choose which records to print. 17.1.5 Importing Data into a Database. Importing information into a database is a valuable feature of KeyBase that allows you to input records from files rather than entering them by hand. Comma Separated Values (CSV) is the file type used for importing into a database. It is a file type that is widely supported by many database and spreadsheet applications, including but not limited to, Access, Excel, and Lotus Notes. To ensure that .csv files are successfully imported, check that the first line of the .csv file contains the field names and that these are named the same as the field names in KeyBase. This is often given as an option when you export data from another application in order to import the data into KeyBase. To begin the process of importing data, either press I or access the KeyBase menu or cycle through the items using SPACE until you find "Import Data" and then press ENTER to select it. KeySoft will prompt "Source folder name? Press ENTER for (default)", where "default" is the last folder used. Select the drive and folder containing the .csv file you wish to import. The prompt "Import data from which CSV file?" will be announced. Type the name of the .csv file you wish to import and press ENTER. Alternatively, you can select it from the list of files by pressing SPACE repeatedly, followed by ENTER when the file is announced. KeySoft will prompt: "Does line 1 (field 1, field 2, field 3) contain field names?". If you type Y, KeyBase will exclude line 1 of the .csv file when importing, because it contains field names rather than data. If you type N, line 1 will be included. Note: To help you determine whether or not the first line contains field names, KeySoft will announce up to 30 characters of line 1. The field mapping of .csv files to the field names in the KeyBase database now begins. Field names in the .csv file (if field names are present) are compared with those in the database. Once the matching is complete, the results are displayed as one of the possible outcomes that follow: "All fields match. Review field mapping list?" "One field doesn't match. Review field mapping list?" "(A specified number) fields do not match. Review field mapping list?" "No fields match. Review field mapping list?" Your response to the result will be either Yes or No. If you type Y, the Field Mapping List will be displayed. The Field Mapping List contains one item for each field in the .csv file. This will show you what .csv field maps to which database field. For example, in the case of a membership list, "(Last name) maps to (last name)". If the .csv file does not contain field titles, an example of a prompt could be "(Jones) maps to nothing". To change the mapping of a particular field, press ENTER. You will then be presented with a list of the fields in the database. Once you have selected a field, KeySoft will once again prompt "(item) maps to (KeyBase field)" and the new mapping announced. For example, "Jones maps to last name". Once you are happy with the field mapping, press ESCAPE. KeyBase will then announce your changes (for example, "All fields match"), and follow with the prompt: "Review field mapping list?". To start the import process, press N. If your .csv file is large, the import process may take some time. If this is the case, "Please wait" will be announced and you will hear a beep every few seconds. If you want to check on progress, find the status information by pressing ENTER. Once the process is complete, the KeyBase Menu will be announce. Note that KeyBase can be used to view data that is maintained on another system and frequently imported into a database. To manually delete existing data before performing an import, follow these steps: 1. At the "Database to use?" prompt, press SPACE and locate the database from which data is to be deleted. 2. To delete the existing data, press CONTROL with I. KeyBase will prompt: "This KeyBase Definition File has an associated database called xyz. Erase the Definition File only, the database, or both?." 3. Select "database only" by pressing D. You will then be given a further warning. 4. Confirm that you only want to erase the database by pressing Y. 5. You will then be returned to the list of files. To select the database, press ENTER. 6. KeyBase will inform you that the database does not exist and give you the option to create it. 7. Press Y and select the Import Option to import your .csv file. 17.1.6 Copying Records to a Document. KeyBase allows you to use the information in a database as the basis for a document. For example, when embossing or printing records, a template is used to designate how the information is formatted and to add command text, etc. This option is useful for preparing lists or forms for emailing, allowing you to review form letters before printing, and so on. At the KeyBase menu, select "Copy Records". KeyBase announce: "Copy Records to a document, another database or a CSV file". To copy to a document, press D. KeyBase willl prompt: ""Destination folder name? Press ENTER for (default)" where "default" is the last folder used. Select the drive, folder and document you want to copy the records to and KeyBase will prompt you for the template file to use. The type of document you are copying records to will determine whether you choose a Braille or Text template. If you are copying to a Braille document, you can only choose a Braille template. If you are copying to Text document, you can only choose a Text template. Select the template you wish to use and continue as described in 17.1.3 Embossing Records. 17.1.7 Copying Records to another Database. This option allows you to take a selection of records from one database and add them to another database. Because you can select which fields are copied and which are not, the two databases do not need to be exactly the same. The field names also do not have to match, because you can control how the fields are mapped. This is useful when you have records you want to copy from old KeyList based databases, into new KeyBase databases, for example. At the KeyBase menu, select "Copy Records". KeyBase announce: "Copy Records to a document, another database or a CSV file". To copy to another database, press A. KeyBase will prompt: "Destination file name?". Select the database you wish to copy. KeyBase will then attempt to match the field names in the current database with those in the destination database you have selected and will display the results in the same way as in the Import Data option. Use the Field Mapping List to adjust this mapping as required. This is described in 17.1.5 Importing Data into a Database. From the Selection List, select the records you wish to copy in the same way as described in 17.1.3 Embossing Records. 17.2 Exporting data. Exporting information out of a database is a valuable feature of KeyBase that allows you to upload a database to a PC, as well as share data with other people and applications. Also, by using the export option for backup allows the backup to be restored on any machine. Comma Separated Values (CSV) is the file type used for exporting out of a database. It is a file type that is widely supported by many database and spreadsheet applications, including but not limited to, Access, Excel, and Lotus Notes. To begin the process of exporting data, access the KeyBase menu and cycle through the items using SPACE until you find "Copy Records". Press ENTER to select it. KeySoft will prompt "Copy records to a document, another database, or a CSV file". Type C to select a .csv file and KeySoft will prompt "Destination folder name? Press ENTER for (default)". Once you have selected the drive and folder, KeyBase will prompt: "Destination CSV filename?". Type the name of the file and press ENTER or select an existing file to overwrite it. You do not need to type the .csv extension because it is automatically added for you. If the .csv file already exists, the prompt "File exists. Replace?" will be announced. KeySoft will then prompt: "Include field titles?". Whether you answer yes or no, depends on the requirements of the application you will use to open the .csv file. Commonly, you will decide to include the field names by pressing Y. The first line of the .csv file will then contain a list of the field names. To omit field names, press N. Select the records that you want to include in the .csv file from the Selection List. To select all records in the database, press ENTER. Otherwise, use the Selection List to only select the records you require, as described in 17.1.3 Embossing Records. 17.3 Creating a new Database. If you are feeling adventurous, you may want to create your own database. There are many possibilities for the types of databases that can be created. For the purpose of explaining how to create a new database, the example of developing a Medical History is used to illustrate how a new database is created. Note: Creating your own database is a difficult task. To be successful, you will need a solid technical understanding of how databases work and be an advanced user of KeySoft. To create a new database, select Database Manager from the Main Menu. KeyBase prompts: "Database to use?". Instead of selecting an existing database, you will now type the name of the database you wish to create (such as Medical History) and press ENTER. KeyBase will prompt: "File does not exist. Create a new file?". Confirm that you wish to create a new file, by typing Y. You will then be led through the process of creating a new database. This includes the following: The Field Definition List, where you define the fields and field types for your new database. The Sort Order, which defines the order that the records are presented during the lookup records process. The Record Title, that is displayed when you first enter a record during lookup and helps you to identify the record you wish to find. The Associated Database which is in the form of a .cdb file. You will notice that a KeyBase database consists of two different files. First, there is the KeyBase Definition File (this has the extension .kbs) that defines the field names, various field options, the sort order, record title, etc. And second, there is the .cdb file that contains the actual data. The KeyBase Definition File is created when you develop a new database. The first time you add a record, the .cdb file is created and KeySoft will prompt “The database for (.kbs filename) does not exist. Create a database called (.cdb filename)”. Normally these files have the same base name, for example the Medical History database will have Medical History.kbs and Medical History.cdb. However, sometimes you may wish to have more than one KeyBase Definition file using the same data. This will allow you to have different views of the data. 17.3.1 Field Definition List. Once you have created a new database by typing and confirming the new database name, KeyBase will announce "Field definition list for Medical History". You will now need to think of all the information that you want to keep from each visit the Medical Center. Each piece of information becomes a field and you can have up to 150 different fields in your database. Also consider which order you want the fields presented when you add a record. Last, but not least, you will need to decide on the type of data to store in each field. Is the data a date, time, number or text only? The type of data you store in each field is known as a field type and there are 8 choices: String Number Yes or No Document Date Time Field types are explained in detail in 17.3.2 Field Types. For the Medical History database, the following fields and field types will be entered in the order below: Reason for appointment  String Appointment Date  Date Appointment Time  Time Medical Practitioner  String Prescription Issued – Yes or No Notes  Document Medical Center Name  String Medical Center Cost  Number Prescription Cost  Number You don't need to get everything right the first time. You can come back later and add additional fields, remove fields you find you don’t need, or change the name of fields. However, think carefully about the field type, because if you change a field type after you have added data to your database, any data already stored in the previous type will no longer be displayed. When you are ready to start defining the fields, press SPACE at the prompt: "Field Definition List". KeyBase will prompt "Field 1 name?". Type a name for the first field that you want to be presented with when you add records and press ENTER. In the example of a Medical History database, the first field is "Reason for appointment". The prompt "Field type for Reason for Appointment? Currently string" will be announced. To confirm that this is the correct field type for this field, press ENTER. KeySoft will then prompt "Field 2 name?". Type "Appointment Date" and press ENTER. KeySoft will then prompt: Field type for "Appointment Date? Currently string". This field is a date field not a string field and you must therefore change the field type. To cycle through the list of types, press CONTROL with SPACE repeatedly until “Date” is displayed and then press ENTER. KeySoft will then prompt “Field 3 name?”. Continue on adding all the fields in the order you want them presented. You can review the field names and types you have already added by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE. While reviewing the fields you can change the field names, as well as inserting, deleting, or changing the order of the fields: To change the name of a field, either type the new name and press ENTER or edit the existing name using the standard KeySoft editing commands. Note that if you are using a Braille keyboard you can type field names in your preferred keyboard grade. When you review the field names, you will notice that they are announced in your preferred reading grade. However, KeyBase stores field names internally as text, so if you edit a field name you must make sure to edit using computer Braille. To insert a field before the current field, for example to add "Medical Center Address" before "Prescription Cost", press CONTROL with ENTER. The current field and all subsequent fields are moved down one place to open up a gap for the new field to occupy. To delete a field, for example, the Appointment Time field in your Medical History database, press CONTROL with I. KeyWord will prompt: "Delete Appointment Time field. Sure?". If you type Y, the field will be deleted from the Database Definition. The subsequent fields will move up a place. In other words, "Medical Practitioner" will take the place of "Appointment Time" and "Prescription Issued" will take the place of "Medical Practitioner" and so on. To move the current field up one place in the Field Definition List, that is, closer to the beginning of the list, press CONTROL with 7. If the field can be moved up by one place, the field name prompt will be repeated and the new position number is announced. For example, "Field 2 name? Currently Appointment Date", becomes "Field 1 name? Currently Appointment Date". This move will then force the first field in the list, "Reason for Appointment", to become Field 2. To move the current field down one place in the Field Definition List, that is, closer to the end of the list, press CONTROL with 9. If the field can be moved down by one place, the field name prompt will be repeated and the new position number is announced. For example, "Field 4 name? Currently Medical Practitioner", becomes "Field 5 name? Currently Medical Practitioner". This move will then force the next field in the list, "Prescription Issued", to become Field 4. There are numerous options available for each field, depending on the field type. To review these options for the current field, press CONTROL with 2 after the Field Type prompt. The Field Options list will be displayed as described in detail in 17.3.3 Field Options. Once you have added all the fields you require and are fairly satisfied with them, you are then ready to move onto the next stage. You can return to the Field Definition List later to make further changes if needed. To exit the Field Definition List, press ESCAPE. KeyBase will prompt: "Sort Order is Reason for Appointment. Change?". 17.3.2 Field Types. Note: If you decide to change a field type after records have been added, any fields that had been assigned with the original field type will not be announced. This situation does not apply for string and document field types as they are interchangeable. If you have entered a significant number of records and you want to keep the database, make a copy of the KeyBase Definition File in a different folder. Make the required changes in the copy and then use the Copy Records option (from the KeyBase Menu) to copy the data from your old database into your new database. Delete the original database and move the new database to a location where you wish to store it. The 6 Field Type options are described in the following sections: 17.3.2.1 String. A string is a sequence of characters. For example, you can enter a string to retain important phone numbers; months of the year or the symbol representing a currency. A string can be presented in text or any grade of Braille and is sorted alphabetically. The maximum length of a string is 255 characters. For longer entries or multiple line entries, use a document field type. Note: When you include characters and numbers in a sequence, they are treated as words. To store the sequence with the numbers in numerical order, put a 0 in front of numbers 19. For example, the My Books database includes a field to store series numbers, and this procedure would ensure that the titles appeared in order of their series number. 17.3.2.2 Number. This Field Type applies to any sort of number, but can only contain digits, the negative sign and a decimal point. The number field type is therefore unsuitable for storing phone numbers as they may contain spaces, brackets, and so on. Suitable numbers to have in your database, include quantities, ages, and event years. Numbers can also represent measurements, such as temperature, and quantities (dollars and cents, for instance). Numbers are sorted numerically. 17.3.2.3 Yes or No. The Yes or No Field Type provides two options to choose from; yes or no. This is useful when you want to include a question requiring a yes or no answer in your database, for instance, "Was there a prescription issued?". 17.3.2.4 Document. The maximum length of data allowed in a string field type is equivalent to 255 characters. If you think the data you want to add to a field will be beyond this limit, use a document field type. For example, in the case of a Medical History database, you could add a document that outlines details of your treatment schedule or lists the ingredients in your medication. An advantage of using the document field type over a string field type is that a document is two dimensional. That is, you are able to read and edit it as you would with a document in KeyWord. 17.3.2.5 Date. The Date Field Type is useful for keeping a record of events such as your last dental checkup or when you purchased an appliance that is under a fixed warranty. If you want to enter the date for today, type "today". A date is sorted chronologically. In other words, you can sort your checkups or warranty expiry dates from the earliest to the latest. 17.3.2.6 Time. The Time Field Type is useful for keeping a record of events such as what time you spoke to someone on your Ham Radio or the time of a medical appointment. 17.3.3 Field Options. There are numerous options available for each field, depending on the field type. These can be reviewed or changed by pressing CONTROL with 2 when a field type prompt is displayed. The Field Options are displayed as a list. Move forward or back through the list by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE. To change an option, either select or type the new value and press ENTER. When you are happy with the options, return to the Field Definition List by pressing ESCAPE. For String Fields, you have 4 options to choose from that are exclusive to this Field Type: "Braille Option?" This is used to determine how the field will be entered and if Braille code or Unicode is stored in the database for this field. On units that have a Qwerty keyboard, Unicode is used universally. If you have a unit with a Braille keyboard, the options are: Preferred Keyboard Grade, which is used for general strings such as names, descriptions, etc. Your entry will be stored and announced again, exactly as you entered it. Computer Braille, which is used when combinations of letters, punctuation and/or numbers are entered. For example, email addresses, post codes, etc. Backtranslate from preferred grade. You will be able to use grade 2, or whatever your preferred keyboard grade is when adding this field, but the field will be stored in the database as Unicode. When the field is displayed, it will be displayed in your Preferred Reading Grade. Use this for fields you will be sorting on to ensure that they are sorted correctly. If you select a string field type as one of the fields in the Sort Order, KeyBase will automatically change the Braille Option to "Backtranslate from preferred grade". "Braille Prefix?" If you are using literary Braille, you can choose between Capital Sign, Double Capital Sign, Auto Number Sign and None. "Field Context?" This option is used for many different purposes, including controlling how the contents of the field will be announced. Fields usually contain fragments of text that by themselves, do not denote context. For instance, in some cases the pronunciation that is used is dependent on the context. For example, "Dr" in a "Title" field is "Doctor", but in an "Address" field, is most commonly the abbreviation for "Drive". The options for Field Context are as follows: General (the default) Spell Name Address Town or City State Country Organization Password Email address Phone number "Maximum Length?" The default maximum length is 255. Numbers between 1 and 255 can be entered. If you need longer fields, use a Document fieldtype. Usually you would leave this set to 255. However, if you will be using the database in a situation where you are printing on preprinted forms, for example, where there is a specific limit on the length of a field, then set this appropriately to ensure that your entry will fit in the preprinted space. For Number fields, you have 1 option that is exclusive to this Field Type: "Number format?" The options are preferred setting (this is the default and uses the Number Format setting in the Review Options List); digits and words. The settings below, apply to all field types and follow on from the settings above: "Help message?" Any entry in this option will be announced when you request "help" on this field in the "Add Record" option. It is announced in addition to the standard KeySoft help and the default for this setting is blank. "Default value?" The default for this setting is blank. When a new record is initialized, the field is set to the default value. For example, a "City" field with a default of "Auckland", will appear as "City? Currently Auckland", in the "Add Record" option. There is no difference in the amount of work involved in changing the city than there is to assign a field without a default value. However, if the majority of new database entries have "Auckland" as the city, having "Auckland" as the default improves the efficiency. Note: If a default value is specified, this value is actually added to all records and uses storage space that would not be used if the field was left blank. For date and time fields, "auto" can be entered as the default value. This sets the field to the time or date when the record was created. "Display option?" The display options are normal; read only and hidden. An example of when this setting can be used is with auto time and date fields. You want the date and time logged as well as used to print, emboss or merge the data, but you don't need to review or change it. Another example of when the display option is useful, is for filling in forms using KeyBase. There may be some fixed fields on the form, such as a tax number. These are set with a default value and they would otherwise clutter the list when adding or reviewing fields. 17.4 Sort Orders. After you have defined the fields you require for a database, the next priority is to define how you want the records sorted. This determines the order in which the records are presented during the lookup records process. For example, sort the records in chronological order by the "Appointment Date", when looking for all records with "sore throat" in the “Reason for appointment” field. In a membership list, where there are separate fields for a member’s first name and last name, it is most practical to initially sort the records by last name. Where there are several members with the same last name, you would sort by first name. For example, those members with Jones as their last name would be sorted in the following order: Alice Jones, Ben Jones, and Sally Jones. Depending on the type of field you are sorting, records can be sorted into one of the three categories below: 1. Chronological order  listing by date field type, from earliest to latest. 2. Alphabetical order  listing by string field type. 3. Numerical order  listing by number field type in ascending order. You must sort by at least one field and can sort on up to 3 fields in a specified order. The records are initially sorted by the first field you specify. This means that records will be grouped together when the first field is identical. These records are then sorted by the second field you specify. In cases where this field is identical, the third sort field is used. When you first create a database, the first field in the Field Definition List is automatically chosen as the sort order. When you enter the Sort Order List, the initial prompt provides a list of the sort order fields in the order that they are presented. For example, "Sort order is First Name, Last Name, Membership Number. Change?". To leave the sort order unchanged, press N. The Record Title prompt will then be announced. To change the Sort Order, press Y and the Sort Order List will be announced. The Sort Order List presents each field in the sort order one by one, therefore allowing you to add, remove or change the fields. There will always be a 1st sort field, announced as "1. Sort by (fieldname)". If there is a 2nd sort field, KeyBase will announce, "2. Then sort by (another fieldname)". The 3rd sort order will be announced as "3. Then sort by (yet another fieldname)". However, if there is no 2nd sort field, the prompt for the 3rd field will not be presented. In this is the case, the 2nd sort field will announce"2. None". To change a sort order field or add another field, move through the list by pressing SPACE or BACKSPACE until the position you want to change is displayed, and press ENTER. You will be presented with the Field Selection List. Move through this list to find the field you want and press ENTER. A sort order can be removed by pressing CONTROL with I. If you remove any field (except the last field), the subsequent fields move down to replace the field that has been removed. Remember that there must always be at least one field in the Sort Order. If only one field remains, it cannot be deleted so must be changed instead. Note: If you change the sort order of existing records, the database will be sorted again once you return to the KeyBase menu. There may be a short delay during the sorting process. Once you have finished the order sorting process, press ESCAPE. KeyBase will prompt: "Record title (field 1; field 2; field 3). Change?". 17.5 Record Title. The Record Title helps you quickly identify records during lookup and is announced when you first enter a record in the lookup option. The Record Title consists of up to 3 fields in any order. For example, if you may want the Record Title to be the "Appointment Date", followed by the "Reason for Appointment" in your Medical History database. In a Membership List database, you may want the Record Title to be the First Name, followed by the Last Name. Note: The Record Title must contain at least one field. When you first create a database, the Record Title defaults to Field 1. The way that you interact with record titles is similar to how you deal with sort orders. The first prompt is: "Record title (field 1; field 2; field 3). Change?". To leave the record title unchanged, press N and the Associated Database prompt will be announced. To change the Record Title, press Y and the Record Title List will be announced. The Record Title List presents each field in the Record Title one by one, therefore allowing you to add, remove or change the fields in the same way as Sort Orders, which are described in 17.4 Sort Orders. For example, the Record Title for our Medical History database will automatically be set to “1. Reason for Appointment”, “2. None”. We want to change this to “1. Appointment Date”, “2. Reason for Appoinment”. Once you have finished with the record title, press ESCAPE. KeyBase will prompt: "Associated Database? Currently (name)". 17.6 Associated Database Name. As described earlier, a KeyBase database consists of two different files, the KeyBase Definition File that defines the field names, etc. and the .cdb file that contains the actual data. Normally these files both have the same base name, for example Medical History.kbs and Medical History.cdb. However, you may occasionally use the same data for more than one KeyBase Definition File. The Associated Database Name will enable you to have multiple “views” of the same data for different purposes. The Associated Database Name prompt is: "Associated database name? Currently (name)". Select the default name, which is the same name as your KeyBase Definition File. If you are creating another view of an existing database, select the .cdb file of that database. Note: An associated database must be in the same folder as the KeyBase Definition file with which it is associated. The Associated Database prompt is the last prompt required to define a database. Once you have confirmed or selected it, you are prompted: “Confirm Changes?”. Press Y to go to the “KeyBase Menu” where you can start adding records to your new database. However, if you have made a complete mess of your database and want to start again, press N and the “Database to use?” prompt will be announced. Try adding some data to your database once it is defined. You will often find that you need to make some changes to the definition. For example, you may need additional fields, have added fields you realize you don’t need, or find the order the fields are presented is inappropriate, and so on. The "Review Database Definition" option in the KeyBase Menu has been created for the purpose of reviewing and making changes to your Database Definition. 17.6.1 Review Database Definition. It is clear that developing even a basic database is not a simple task and that it will take several attempts to get it right. It is likely that fields will be named incorrectly, important fields will get missed out, or that you accidently duplicate fields and so on. Because of the need to make changes to your databases during the development process, the DataBase menu includes a "Review Database Definition" option. At the KeyBase menu, select "Review Database Definition". The Database Definition Menu will be announced. This contains the following options: Field Definition Sort Order Record Title Associated Database Name The above options correspond to the tasks you perform when you initially create a database as described in 17.3 Creating a new Database. However, when you review a database definition you can access each option individually. Once you have reviewed and made the changes you require, exit from the Database Definition Menu by pressing ESCAPE. If you have made changes, KeyBase will prompt: "Confirm changes?". If you made changes you didn’t intend to and want to abandon them, press N. To bring your changes into effect, press Y. 17.7 Database File Management. A KeyBase database consists of two files. The KeyBase Definition File, which contains the field names and other information that defines the database, and the database itself that contains the data. Normally both these files have the same base name, but different endings or extensions. The KeyBase Definition File has a .kbs extension and the database file a .cdb extension. When you use the File Manager, you will not be able to read the .kbs extension when a KeyBase Definition File name is announced. If you need to find out if a file has a .cdb or .kbs extension, press READ with I. Because the KeyBase Definition File and the .cdb file form a pair, KeySoft’s File Manager takes both files into account when you operate on a KeyBase Definition File. When you copy a KeyBase Definition File, both the definition file and the database are copied. This is very useful for backup purposes. When you erase a KeyBase Definition File, KeySoft prompts: “This KeyBase definition file has an associated database called (associated database name). Erase the definition file only, the database only, or both?”. To erase only the KeyBase Definition File, press F. To erase the database (.cdb) file only, press D. To erase both the KeyBase Definition File and the database (.cdb) file, press B. Before erasing a database (.cdb) file, you will receive another warning. It is possible for a .cdb file to be associated with more than one KeyBase Definition File and you are warned of this before a .cdb file is erased. Similarly, when you rename a KeyBase Definition File, KeySoft also prompts to see if you want to erase only the definition file, only the database, or both files. 17.7.1 Free Database Space. One of the peculiarities of databases is that when you delete items from them, they may not automatically shrink back down again. Because of this, simply deleting your unwanted records does not always free up more disk space. The "Free database space" software shrinks the database back to the smallest size capable of storing the records remaining in the database. To use this utility, simply go to the KeyBase menu, and select the item: "Free database space". After running, the utility will report how much space, if any, has been freed. End of Database Manager chapter. 18 Games. Text adventure games, also known as Interactive Fiction, involve fun games that are played using textbased input and output. There are nine games in The are in zgame file format supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT: A Tutorial Game. The Dreamhold. Adventure Bear's Night Out Curses Dragon Gourmet Hunter In Darkness The Underoos That Ate New York Winter The first game in the list of games supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT is A Tutorial Game. The Dreamhold. Because this is a tutorial game, it allows you to learn as you play. If you have never played adventure or interactive fiction games before, we recommend that you play The Dreamhold first. Before you try playing any game on your VoiceNote mPower QT, it is important that you read and understand the following: 1. There are many differences and similarities between games. As you will notice, most moves you can perform in one game can also be done in another. For example the keyword "look" will work in most games. When you type "look" and then press ENTER you will be given a description of your current location. 2. Humanware did not write the games that have been supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT. We are simply distributing them and if you have a problem with a specific game then Humanware will not be able to provide support. To resolve a problem with a specific game, you will need to contact the author of the game. To find out details about the author, try typing the keyword "about" and press ENTER. You will usually then be given some details about the game and information on how to contact the author. 3. The start of some of the games may be a bit strange. This is because the games have been designed with a visual screen in mind and the author of the game assumes that you are using a screen. The best action to take is to wait for the spoken text to finish and then try pressing the ENTER key once or twice. Alternatively, press READ with S to hear the status line. 4. Although the supplied games suit both a speech and braille environment, you need to realize that they were primarily designed to run on a screen. This means that you may encounter a situation that is confusing because the author has included graphics or a timer. The games supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT should not encounter such situations. However, if you try out games that have not been supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT, you should be aware that this may occasionally happen. 5. Press HELP to learn about the KeySoft commands to use for loading, saving and reviewing the game output. Note: This is not the help for the specific game you are playing. Each game includes its own detailed help. To access this help, type "help" and press ENTER. 6. During the process of playing a game, you will type in commands and press ENTER before receiving feedback from the game. There is an exception that applies to the one key mode that is discussed in 18.7 Single Key Mode. You can also read by using the standard reading keys for reading the previous, current, and next sentence. Specifically, READ with U, READ with I, and READ with O. Words and characters can also be read in the same way as they are in the Word Processor and Book Reader, using READ with J, READ with K, and READ with L for words and the commands READ with COMMA and READ with PERIOD for characters. You can also read from the cursor position to the end of the current game response, by pressing READ with G. To hear the entire text again, press REPEAT to repeat it. Note. The standard reading keys of READ with 7, READ with 8, and READ with 9 do not behave in the same manner as they do for reading in the Word Processor and Book Reader. These commands should not be used until you have read 18.5 Reading Previous Moves. 18.1 Starting a Game. As with other applications within Keysoft, a game can be left running whilst you move across to another application (see 1.14 Switching Between Tasks for details on task switching). Whilst playing a game you can task switch to another application. For example pressing FUNCTION with 5 will switch you to the calculator. To return to the game in progress press FUNCTION with G. To enter Games from the Main Menu, use the SPACE and BACKSPACE keys to navigate the items in the menu, until "Games" is announced, and then press ENTER. Alternatively, you can select Games from the Main Menu by pressing G. You can switch directly to the Database from anywhere in KeySoft by pressing FUNCTION with G. KeySoft prompts: "Play which game?". Press SPACE and KeySoft will then prompt: "List of game files in My Games folder". Press SPACE again, and you will be given a list of the games that have been supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT. If you have loaded a game in the past then the last loaded game name will be announced. The standard Keysoft operations for choosing a file are available. If you have never played a game before, we recommend that you first play the tutorial game, named "Dreamhold". Cycle through the games and when "A tutorial game. The Dreamhold" is announced, press ENTER. An introduction to the game is then spoken that begins with "Time shifts and flattens, days and decades folding aside like pages in a book." The text continues further and ends with "Press space to continue". The reason that you must press SPACE to continue, is that each game only presents a certain amount of information at a time and this prompt is a way to tell you that there is still more to learn about the game, before any commands can be entered. To hear the final part of the introduction to the Dreamhold, press SPACE and you will hear: "Only the floor is smooth...a fine white surface beneath you feet. There is a narrow gap in the east wall". Congratulations, you have now entered the fantasy realm of text adventure games! You now have the option of reviewing the details of the last part of the message, using any of the review commands for reading sentences and paragraphs (except for the commands for reading the current, previous and next paragraph, as these will be explained later). 18.2 Entering Commands. Now that the introduction to The Dreamhold has finished and you know where you are in the game, it is now up to you to perform an action. This is done by typing in a command and pressing ENTER. A simple one is the shorthand command, "look". Type "look" and press ENTER. The game will then respond with exactly the same message about the room you have entered. If you want to repeat your last command, press CONTROL with R. You can also review and edit the command text before pressing ENTER to send the command to the game. Well done, you have made your first move! If you are still using The Dreamhold, then typing help and pressing enter would now be a good thing to do, to learn about more commands. The Dreamhold has extensive help built into it. The following commands can be typed in to learn more standard game commands. Type the following commands and then press ENTER : "Help basics". "Help commands". "Help talking". "Help system". "Help special". "Help strategy". As you can observe, the commands are quite detailed and in some cases rather long. You move around by typing directional words, such as East, West, North, South, as well as pick objects up by typing the word "get" ("get sword", for example), and put objects down by typing the word "drop" (such as, "drop sword"). These commands are not part of KeySoft, but part of the game supplied. Each game may use these commands in different ways and may extend the range of words. The commands explained in the Help section of the "A tutorial game. Dreamhold" are standard and typical of many games. 18.2.1 Block Marker Commands. When playing a game, it is useful to be able to mark a block of text and move it to another location, such as the clipboard. For example, when there is a complicated and longwinded description that you want to reread and think over before making your next move. The following block marker commands can be used when playing games: To insert a block marker, press CONTROL with SHIFT with M. To copy a block to the clipboard, press CONTROL with Z. To paste the contents of the clipboard into the input prompt, press CONTROL with V. 18.2.2 Entering a Command While Reading. If you are part way through reading a response in a game, you do not have to move to the end in order to start typing your response. All you need to do is start typing and press ENTER. 18.2.3 System Words. There are numerous special words, called system words and these are used to perform actions outside the game, but are very important. They include : "Restart"  to restart a game. "Restore"  to load a saved game. "Save"  to save a game. "Undo"  to undo the last move (not available in all games). "Quit"  to leave a game. 18.2.4 Shorthand. Many game commands have the option of entering short hand. This is useful when you have commands that you need to frequently type, often a long and tedious process. The important examples of shorthand include : "l"  for look. "x"  for examine. "n", "s", "e", "w"  for North, South, East and West. "g"  for Again (to repeat the last move). 18.2.5 Grade 2 Braille Input. If you are typing in Braille and using grade 2 as your preferred keyboard entry, then single character commands will need to be preceded by a letter sign. This prevents KeySoft from treating these single characters as a contraction and expanding them (something which can confuse the game). Note: The game will attempt to default to grade 1, even if the default keyboard grade is set to grade 2. To avoid this situation, press FUNCTION with O and KeySoft will prompt: "Options menu". Press G to select Grade of Braille for Keyboard Entry and select your preferred braille grade. This selection is applied until you choose to change it by repeating this procedure. 18.2.6 Invalid Input. All the games supplied, as well as the many others that can be played on your VoiceNote mPower QT handle many types of commands. However, if you misspell or type something that the game does not understand, it will then let you know that you have entered an invalid input. A common response is "That is not a verb I understand". Each game may respond slightly differently but will be consistent in the response that it provides. You will learn that the invalid input response means the game did not understand what you typed, either because of a spelling mistake or because you used words the game does not recognize. Another possibility is when you have used words in a combination that the game does not understand. Try similar words and simpler expressions. For example "put the Piano on top of the stage" may fail, but "put piano on stage" may succeed. 18.3 Leaving a game. If you want to exit a game and return to the Main Menu press ESCAPE, or type "quit" and press ENTER. You will then usually be prompted to confirm that you want to quit. You will then need to type Y or Yes and press ENTER to be returned to the Main Menu. If you are typing in Braille and using grade 2 as your preferred keyboard entry, then single character commands will need to be preceded by a letter sign. 18.3.1 Abandoning a Game. Some games may have bugs in them and do not run properly or suddenly stop working. They may expect timed responses or contain graphics that also make the game unreadable. A mechanism has been provided to exit back to the main menu without going through the standard way of quitting. To abandon a game at any time, press CONTROL with Q. This is a last resort way of leaving a game and it is not recommended for use under normal circumstances. 18.4 Saving Games. A game can be saved by either pressing CONTROL with S or by typing "save" and pressing ENTER. You will then be presented with a standard KeySoft save prompt and will be able to type in a name to save the current game that you have started but not as yet completed. Because this saved game is applicable only to the current game, it is a good idea to include the title of the name of the game or something similar. This will allow you to easily distinguish between the partially completed saved games and the unsaved games. For example naming a saved game "A Bears Night Out" game as "Bear Lounge1" will make it easier to restore the partially completed game. At the save prompt you can use BACKSPACE in the usual way to save the game in a different folder or drive. 18.4.1 Restoring a Saved Game. Note: Restoring and loading a game is the same procedure. In order to restore a game, follow the two step process described below. First you need to start the game and once it is running, restore the saved game. For example, save a "A Bears Night Out" game as "Bear Lounge1". To run "A Bears Night Out", select "Games" and choose this game from the list, before loading "Bear Lounge1". To load a saved game press CONTROL with O, or type the word "restore" and press ENTER. You will then be presented with a standard KeySoft prompt and by repeatedly pressing SPACE, cycle through to the game you wish to restore. Use BACKSPACE to move to a different folder or drive, as you do elsewhere in KeySoft. Once the appropriate game is found, press ENTER to restore the saved game. The previous moves will not be available as these are not kept. However, you will be able to review the game details, where you are, your score, how many moves you have made, what you are carrying and so on. At this stage, it is advised to check the status line by pressing READ with S  see 18.6 Status Line) and to look around by typing "look" and then press ENTER. 18.5 Reading Previous Moves. During the time you play a game, you will type in many moves and the computer will remember these responses. It can sometimes be quite useful to review previous moves, for example, to check the spelling of a word. KeySoft stores the last 20 moves you performed through typed commands, and the response from the game itself. Each one of these historical moves can be read in the same manner as the current move, by using the reading keys below: To read from the start of the previous sentence, press READ with U To read from the start of the current sentence, press READ with I To read from the start of the next sentence, press READ with O To move back a word, press READ with J To read the current word and read it, press READ with K To move forward a word and read it, press READ with L To read continuously, press READ with G 18.5.1 Moving Between Historical Moves. To move between historical moves, use the command for moving by section, as listed below: To move to the previous move, press READ with 7 To move back to the top of the currently selected move, press READ with 8 To move to the next move results, press READ with 9 The game will also store up to 20 moves. When you have made 20 moves, the oldest moves will be removed from the list as new moves are added. The commands for jumping to stored moves are listed below: To jump to the oldest stored move, press READ with T To jump to the most recently stored move, press READ with B If you are entering a move and need to hear the previous move again, press READ with B Note: The moves you type are stored in the move history. If you want to review what you did to cause the game to react in a certain way, go back one or more moves in the history. 18.6 Status Line. As mentioned earlier, Interactive Fiction games are written with a screen in mind. One of the downsides to this approach, is that there are a few situations where the author of a game, considers things from a visual perspective. Part of this issue is the status line, an area on the screen (usually at the top) which holds information about the game, such as the title, the number of moves a player has had and the score. Keysoft a way to access the status line via a keystroke. The contents of the status line will be captured and it will be read to you, when you press READ with S. You can also read the information once it has been captured in the same manner as any other turn, by using the standard reading keys. The status line is another place where the author of a game, can write information. In fact the status line can grow to be several lines in size and can be used to display a lot of text. Some games have what is called a "splash screen" at the start of a game, which is an enlarged status line. If you hear limited words when you first start up a game, then you may wish to try reading the status line, as it could hold some valuable information. It is a good idea to do this before you press any other key if you have not run the game before. By pressing READ with S, you know if there is important information at the start of the game. 18.7 Single Key Mode. Games also use a mode of interacting with you that is slightly different from the standard way in which you type commands and then allow the game to provide feedback. This is usually only used in a small section of the game, or to provide you with a menu based help and information system. However, some games may use this mode continuously. Single key mode can occur at any time and some games use it as their primary input device. In general, this mode is mainly used to provide a menu based help system. In this mode you press a key, and instead of going to the command input area, the key will be acted on immediately, that is, without you needing to press ENTER. This can be quite confusing when it first happens to you. If you type a letter and hear a response straight away, press READ with S. This provides you with status information from one or more lines on the screen. You can use the standard reading keys to read everything the game presents to you. A good example of this situation can be found in the supplied game "Bears Night Out". If you load this game and then HELP, you will hear: "How to play, a few helpful hints". To repeat the help message, either press SPACE or the character "A". If you now press READ with S you will hear a lot more information. For example, for "A Bear's Night Out", you will hear: "A Bear's night out help menu. N = Next subject, P = previous, RETURN = read subject, Q = resume game. Greater than How to Play. The scoring system ... etc" What you are reading is all the information on the status screen. Firstly the title of the game  "A Bear's Night Out". Secondly, a series of relevant single keys and what action they will perform, N = next subject, P = previous, return = read subject and Q = resume game. Finally you will hear a series of menu items, the first of which has a > (greater than) symbol next to it. This indicates that the currently selected menu item is active. If we press N then the second item, "the scoring system", will become the active menu item and will be spoken. Press READ with S again to repeat all the information that was previously presented. The difference is that this time the greater than symbol will be next to the second menu option. To access the information for that menu item, press ENTER. You can then press Q to return to the menu and press Q again to get back to the game. In some games (those not supplied), this mode of operation is used as part of the game itself, not just for help and hints. They can also contain menus within menus and may take some time to explore. The N, P, ENTER and Q keys will work. Alternatively, you can usually rely on capturing and reading the status line to find out specific single keys to press that are relevant to the game. Note: The moves you type are not stored in the move history and you are therefore unable to review what you did to cause the game to react in a certain way. 18.8 Downloading and Playing More Games. If you have enjoyed the games supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT, you may wish to play additional games. There is an extensive range of zgames available, many are free and some are commercial and must therefore be purchased. The best starting place is the Internet, though you may have a friend or relative who still has some of the older commercial games, in particular, from a company called Infocom. 18.9 Selecting Games for Children. Many of the games available on the Internet have been written for an older audience. That is, usually aged15 years and up, and several of the games are for adults only. Those supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT have been carefully scrutinized, and are deemed to be appropriate for a general audience. For younger game players, Dragon, Winter Wonderland and The Underoos that Ate New York are the most appropriate. If a parent, teacher or guardian does supply games to younger VoiceNote mPower QT users, Humanware recommends that these games are first reviewed by an adult. This can be done by playing the game, or visiting www.sparkynet.com/spag/noframe.html (a web site that contains detailed reviews about many zgames). 18.10 Freely Available Games. The place to find freely available games and as a useful resource for finding out about interactive fiction is www.ifarchive.org. This web site contains many freely available games which can be download from http://ifarchive.org/indexes/ifarchiveXgamesXzcode.html Baf's site  http://wurb.com/if/ is an easier web site to find specific games, although we recommend that children are supervised whilst visiting this site. 18.11 Commercial Games. Zgames were invented back in the early 1980's by a company called Infocom and the games that they wrote are still available to be purchased. Many of these games are all able to be played on your VoiceNote mPower QT. A CD of all the games was produced in 1996 and can still be purchased. The CD was called "Infocom Classic Text Adventure Masterpieces" and can be found and purchased online from sites such as amazon.com. Friends or family may also have old copies that they bought years ago. Note: Games that expect timed responses or contain graphics, will not run correctly on your VoiceNote mPower QT. 18.12 Hints and Walkthroughs. Many interactive fiction games contain puzzles and tasks that you must complete before you can move further on in the game. These puzzles can occasionally be too difficult to solve and our advice is to firstly persevere, try different things, talk to others about the problem, and do not give up. When you finally solve the puzzle, you will feel a lot more satisfaction than having to "cheat". However, sometimes you may need a little help. The games supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT have the following resources to help you: If you are unsure of what to do next, try typing the word "hint" and pressing ENTER. Some of the games also have hints in the help menu. To get help, press HELP. If you need help when you are in single key mode, try pressing N. Listen to the menu option and when you hear the word "hint", then press ENTER. If all else fails, use the Book Reader or Word Processor to look at the supplied text files in the My Games folder. 18.13 Internet Resources. Learning about interactive fiction, or text adventures as they are also called, can take a little time and it may appear confusing at the very beginning. There are many resources on the Internet that can help you learn how to play, or even how to create your own games. A good starting point is the web site www.ifarchive.org and this site has been added to your web browser favorites when you upgraded to the current version of Keysoft. Two other good sites to learn about playing are : A Beginners Guide to playing interactive fiction which can be found at www.microheaven.com/IFGuide/ and The Brass Lantern at http://brasslantern.org/beginners/ If you are interested in writing your own text adventures (in fact any sort of game) you need to learn about the INFORM compiler, the language used to create the games. Two good web sites for this are The Inform compiler home page  www.informfiction.org/ and A tutorial in creating a game at www.informfiction.org/examples/alice.html The inform compiler is complex and will take many hours to learn to use. This is probably only of interest to those VoiceNote mPower QT users who have had some experience in programming. 18.14 History of Text Adventure Games. When computers were first evolving, the terminals that were used to display information did not allow graphics to be displayed. People still wanted to play games that created scenes and allowed players to move around in an environment where they could interact with it; wander through caves and tunnels; find hidden treasure and attack monsters. The only way that this could be done was by describing to the player what was happening and then allowing them to type in some actions. The first game that was like this, was called "Adventure". As you played the game, you walked around houses, caves and tunnels. You also picked objects up, looked around, fought monsters and solved puzzles. The text adventure had been born. Note: A copy of "Adventure" is included in the games supplied with your VoiceNote mPower QT. Because it is quite a difficult game to play, it is not recommended as the first game you try. Over the next 10 years many text adventures were made and sold to early users of personal computers. But as graphics improved this type of game became unpopular and nearly disappeared. However in the late 1990's a group of nostalgic programmers and authors got together and reinvented the games, calling them Interactive Fiction (abbreviated to IF), a more appropriate description of what you are doing when you play a game. All the games included with your VoiceNote mPower QT are classified as interactive fiction where you as the player must unravel puzzles, or perform certain tasks, all of which causes the story to slowly unfold. End of Games chapter. 19 Command Summary. 19.1 General Commands. 19.1.1 In a Menu or List. Move forward in a menu or list: SPACE, or DOWN ARROW. Move backward in an menu or list: BACKSPACE, or UP ARROW. Select spoken item: ENTER. Jump to item: Press first letter. 19.1.2 Options Available at Any Point. Return to Main Menu: MENU. Exit current option: ESCAPE. Obtain help for current operation: HELP. Increase volume: FUNCTION with PERIOD. Decrease volume: FUNCTION with COMMA. Speak faster: FUNCTION with EQUALS. Speak slower: FUNCTION with HYPHEN. Raise pitch of speech: SHIFT with FUNCTION with EQUALS. Lower pitch of speech: SHIFT with FUNCTION with DASH. Stop reading, or acknowledge alarm: READ with SPACE. Date announcement: FUNCTION with O, D or FUNCTION with D. Time announcement: FUNCTION with O, T, C or FUNCTION with T. Stopwatch: FUNCTION with O, T, S or FUNCTION with W. Keyboard Settings: FUNCTION with O, K or FUNCTION with K. Review Voice: FUNCTION with O, R or FUNCTION with R. Power and Battery status: FUNCTION with O, P. User Guide: FUNCTION with O, U or READ with HELP. Next appointment: FUNCTION with O, N or FUNCTION with N. Repeat the last message or prompt: REPEAT. Repeat the last prompt with spelling: FUNCTION with O, S or FUNCTION with L. Repeat the last prompt with all punctuation: FUNCTION with O, H or FUNCTION with P. Options Menu: FUNCTION with O. Increase volume of media player, FM radio and streaming audio: CONTROL with EQUALS. Decrease volume of media player, FM radio and streaming audio: CONTROL with HYPHEN. Pause media player, stop audio streaming, mute FM radio : CONTROL with BACKSLASH. Restart media player, start audio streaming, unmute FM radio: CONTROL with BACKSLASH. Playback last memo: SHIFT with FUNCTION with M. Unicode table (available at any point computer braille is in use): FUNCTION with X. UEB symbol table (available at any point that UEB is in use): FUNCTION with X. Select Language and Braille code: FUNCTION with SHIFT with L. Change Braille Grade for keyboard entry: CONTROL with G. 19.1.3 Switch Programs. Task menu: FUNCTION with S, or FUNCTION with O, M, or Go to Wordprocessor: FUNCTION with 4. Go to Planner: FUNCTION with 6. Go to Address List: FUNCTION with 7. Go to Email: FUNCTION with 8. Go to Book Reader: FUNCTION with 9. Go to Calculator: FUNCTION with 5. Go to Internet: FUNCTION with 0 (zero). Go to Terminal for Screen Reader: FUNCTION with B. Go to Media Player: FUNCTION with M. Go to Database Manager: SHIFT with FUNCTION with D. Go to Games: FUNCTION with G. Go to FM Radio: FUNCTION with F 19.1.4 At “Folder Name” prompt. Type folder name and press ENTER, or Access folder list: SPACE. Select a directory path: CONTROL with T. Change Drive: BACKSPACE. 19.1.5 At “List of Folders” prompt. Cycle forward through folder list: SPACE. Cycle back through folder list: BACKSPACE. Jump to folder name starting with: Press first letter. Display disk name and space available: READ with I. Return to “Folder Name?” prompt: ESCAPE. Change order in which folders are listed: READ with V 19.1.6 Within a Folder list. Cycle forward through folder list: SPACE. Cycle back through folder list: BACKSPACE. Jump to folder name starting with: Press first letter. Return to “Folder Name?”prompt: ESCAPE. Select displayed folder or marked folders: ENTER. Display folder information: READ with I. Rename folder: CONTROL with R. Delete folder: CONTROL with I. Copy folder: CONTROL with Y. Mark or Unmark folder: SPACE with M. Mark or Unmark all folders: CONTROL with READ with F Change order in which folders are listed: READ with V 19.1.7 At "Directory Name" prompt. Type subdirectory and press ENTER. Access subdirectory list: SPACE. Select a folder: SPACE with T. Change drive: SPACE with E. Go up a level in the directory structure: SPACE with dots 23. 19.1.8 At "Subdirectories" prompt Cycle forward through subdirectory list: SPACE. Cycle back through subdirectory list: BACKSPACE. Jump to subdirectory name starting with: Press first letter. To go up a level in the directory structure: LEFT ARROW. Display disk name and space available: READ with I. Return to “Directory Name?”prompt: ESCAPE. 19.1.9 Within a Subdirectory List Cycle forward through subdirectory list: SPACE. Cycle back through subdirectory list: BACKSPACE. Select displayed subdirectory: ENTER. Jump to subdirectory name starting with: Press first letter. To display the subdirectories of the displayed directory: RIGHT ARROW To go up a level in the directory structure: LEFT ARROW. Display subdirectory information: READ with I. Rename subdirectory: CONTROL with R. Erase subdirectory: CONTROL with I. Copy subdirectory: CONTROL with Y. Mark or Unmark subdirectory: SPACE with M. Mark or Unmark all subdirectories: CONTROL with READ with F Return to “DirectoryName?”prompt: ESCAPE. Change order in which subdirectories are listed: READ with V 19.1.10 At “File Name” and “Document Name” prompt. Type file name and press ENTER, or Cycle forward through list of files: SPACE. Change folder: BACKSPACE. Toggle document type to create: CONTROL with X. Cycle forward through most recently opened files: READ with 9. Cycle back through most recently opened files: READ with 7. Change order in which files are listed: READ with V 19.1.11 At “List of Files” and “List of Documents” prompt. Cycle forward through list of files: SPACE. Cycle back through list of files: BACKSPACE. Jump to file name starting with: Press first letter. Display directory information: READ with I. Change order in which files are listed: READ with V Return to “File Name?” prompt: ESCAPE. 19.1.12 Within a List of Files or Documents. Cycle forward through list of files: SPACE. Cycle back through list of files: BACKSPACE. Jump to file name starting with: Press first letter. Select displayed file or marked files: ENTER. Rename file: CONTROL with R. Delete file: CONTROL with I. Move file: CONTROL with READ with M. Copy file: CONTROL with Y. Protect or unprotect file: BACKSPACE with P, then P Mark or unmark a file: SPACE with M Mark or unmark all files: CONTROL with READ with F Toggle file type to view: CONTROL with X. Return to “File Name?” prompt: ESCAPE. File information: READ with I. Change order in which files are listed: READ with V 19.1.13 Other Options. Braille Options: FUNCTION with O, B. Visual Display: FUNCTION with O, V. Stopwatch: FUNCTION with O, T, S. 19.2 Wordprocessor. 19.2.1 KeyWord, text review. Read continuously: READ with G. Stop reading: READ with SPACE BAR. Top of file: READ with T. Bottom of file: READ with B. Previous character: READ with M or LEFT ARROW. Current character: READ with COMMA. Next character: READ with PERIOD, or RIGHT ARROW. Previous word: READ with J, or CONTROL with LEFT ARROW. Current word: READ with K. Next word: READ with L, or CONTROL with RIGHT ARROW. Start of line: READ with H. End of line: READ with SEMICOLON. Start of next line: READ with ENTER. Next Tab position: READ with APOSTROPHE. Reviewonly mode toggle: READ with X. Information menu (for filename and word count): READ with CONTROL with I. Check or change reading mode: READ with S. In Sentence and Paragraph reading Mode, the following commands review sentences and paragraphs: Previous sentence: READ with U. Current sentence: READ with I. Next sentence: READ with O. Previous paragraph: READ with 7. Current paragraph: READ with 8. Next paragraph: READ with 9. In Line Mode, the same commands review lines and sections. In Column mode, the same commands review the current word on the line above or below and section above or below. 19.2.2 Other Review Commands. Define Place Marker: READ with D. Jump to Place Marker: READ with P. Hear cursor position: READ with Q. Go to: READ with R. Previous page: FUNCTION with UP ARROW. Next page: FUNCTION with DOWN ARROW. Go to next Tab position: READ with APOSTROPHE. Find: READ with F. Find Next Occurrence: READ with N. 19.2.3 Editing Commands. Backspace: BACKSPACE key. Delete current character: CONTROL with COMMA, or DELETE. Delete current word: CONTROL with K. Delete previous word: CONTROL with J. Delete to end of sentence: CONTROL with I, in Sentence and paragraph reading mode. Delete to end of paragraph: CONTROL with 8, in Sentence and paragraph reading mode. Delete to end of line: CONTROL with I, in Line and Column reading modes. Delete to end of section: CONTROL with 8, in Line and Column reading modes. Delete to end of document: CONTROL with D. Find and replace: CONTROL with F. 19.2.4 Formatting Commands. New line: ENTER key. New Page: CONTROL with N. TAB: TAB. Binding space: CONTROL with SPACE. Document Layout: CONTROL with L. Page settings: CONTROL with P. Style of presentation: CONTROL with Y. Center line: CONTROL with E. Right justify line: CONTROL with R. Underline: CONTROL with U. Font: CONTROL with T. Insert the Time: CONTROL with 4. Insert the Date: CONTROL with 6. Insert calculator result or whole calculation: CONTROL with 5. Insertion menu: FUNCTION with I. Template Menu: CONTROL with A. 19.2.5 Format Text Document for Braille. Braille Settings Menu: READ with CONTROL with B. Braille page settings: Braille Settings Menu, P. Braille layout list: READ with CONTROL with L. Braille only inclusion: READ with CONTROL with N. Start Braille exclusion: READ with CONTROL with X. End Braille exclusion: READ with CONTROL with Y. Braille translation options: CONTROL with O. Braille grade, query or change: CONTROL with G. 19.2.6 Format Braille Document for Text. 19.2.6.1 Inkprint Settings. Ink Print Settings Menu: READ with CONTROL with B. Inkprint page settings: Inkprint Settings Menu, P. Inkprint layout list: READ with CONTROL with L. Inkprint only inclusion: READ with CONTROL with N. Start inkprint exclusion: READ with CONTROL with X. End inkprint exclusion: READ with CONTROL with Y. Inkprint translation options: CONTROL with O. 19.2.6.2 Block Commands. Block menu: CONTROL with B. Append block to clipboard: Block menu, A. Bottom marker insertion: Block menu, B. Copy block to clipboard: Block menu, C. Delete block: Block menu, D. Erase file & exit Keyword: Block menu, E. Insert file: Block menu, I. Move block to clipboard: Block menu, M. Paste clipboard: Block menu, P. Read block: Block menu, R. Store block: Block menu, S. Top marker insertion: Block menu, T. Zap block markers: Block menu, Z. Correct Braille grade of block (English only) Block menu, B Language and Braille grade change (if more than one language is enabled): Block menu, L. Quick Mark commands. Mark word: Block menu, READ with K. Mark sentence or line: Block menu, READ with I. Mark paragraph or section: Block menu, READ with 8. 19.2.6.3 Miscellaneous KeyWord Commands. Exit a document: ESCAPE. Save document: CONTROL with S. Quit document: CONTROL with Q. 19.2.6.4 Spelling Checker Commands. Spelling Checker menu: READ with CONTROL with S. Check to end of document: Spell Check menu, C. Document check: Spell Check menu, D. Lookup Word in dictionary: Spell Check menu, L. Word check: Spell Check menu, W. Paragraph or section check: Spell Check menu, P. Select Language: Spell Check menu, S. At the Spelling Checker "Option?" prompt, the following are valid: Review the word: READ with K. Ignore the word: I. Skip this occurrence of the word: READ with L. Add the word to the dictionary: A. Correct the word: C, new word. Review suggested spellings: S. Look up a word in the dictionary: L. Read sentence containing word: READ with I. Read paragraph containing word: READ with 8. During Suggested Spelling Review: Announce original word: I. Second press spells word. Spell current suggestion: FUNCTION with L. Use suggestion: ENTER. Return to option prompt: ESCAPE. 19.2.6.5 When Looking up Word in Dictionary. Spell current word in dictionary: FUNCTION with L. Announce original word: I. Replace original word: ENTER. 19.2.6.6 Template Commands. Template Menu: CONTROL with A. Insert Field: Template Menu, I. Force inclusion of line: Template Menu, F. Start conditional suppression: Template Menu, S. End conditional suppression: Template Menu, E. Mark comment line: Template Menu, M. 19.3 Calculator. 0: 0 or M. 1: 1 or J. 2: 2 or K. 3: 3 or L. 4: 4 or U. 5: 5 or I. 6: 6 or O. 7: 7. 8: 8. 9: 9. Plus: + or = or SEMICOLON. Minus:  or P. Multiplied by: * or COMMA. Divided by: /. Equals: ENTER. Decimal point: PERIOD. Negative number: N. Percent operator: %. Left parenthesis: (. Right parenthesis: ). Set decimal places: CONTROL with PERIOD, then 0 to 9. Clear calculation: CONTROL with I. Delete last key: BACKSPACE. Announce calculation or result: READ with I. Read last number or operator entered: READ with K. Square root: Q. Squared: SHIFT with Q. Decimal exponent: ^. Log to base e of: E. e to the power of: SHIFT with E. Log to base 10 of: T. 10 to the power of: SHIFT with T. To the power of: X. To the power of 1 divided by: SHIFT with X. Degrees: D. Radians: SHIFT with D. PI: Y. Sine: CONTROL with T, S. Arc sine: READ with T, S. Cosine: CONTROL with T, C. Arc cosine: READ with T, C. Tan: CONTROL with T, T. Arc tan: READ with T, T. Clear memory: C, then 0 through 9. Store memory: S, then 0 through 9. Add to memory: A, then 0 through 9. Recall memory: R, then 0 through 9. Announce memory: SHIFT with R, then 0 through 9. Announce Key Mode: READ with A. Enter a fraction: Type the numerator, CONTROL with / and then the denominator. Enter a mixed number: Type the whole number, SPACE and then the fraction. Convert a decimal to a fraction: READ with /. Convert a fraction to a decimal: READ with / D. Convert a fraction to its lowest terms: Type the fraction and press ENTER. Convert a mixed number to an improper fraction: SPACE with dots 34. Convert an improper fraction to a mixed number: READ with / M. Convert a fraction to a percentage: %. Take the reciprocal of a fraction: READ with / R. Find an equivalent fraction to the displayed fraction: READ with / E. Data Set Menu: CONTROL with S. Check whether the data entry is on or off: SHIFT with I. Find the result of a calculation without entering it into the data set: READ with ENTER. Statistical Functions Menu/Statistical Functions Review List: READ with S. Sample size: N. Mean: M. Median: D. Minimum: I. Maximum: X. Sample standard deviation: S. Population standard deviation: P. Sum of values: V. Sum of the square of values: Q. Copy a value to the clipboard: CONTROL with C. Enter the Review Mode: READ with X. Go to the previous data item: READ with U. Go to the next data item: READ with O. Go to the first data item in the data set: READ with T. Go to the last data item in the data set: READ with B. Find a specific number in a data set: READ with F. Find the next occurrence of the same number in the data set: READ with N. Change the View Option: READ with V. Entry order: E. Frequency order: F. Numerical order: N. Delete the current data item: CONTROL with I. Save a Data Set: CONTROL with S. 19.4 Planner. 19.4.1 Selecting a New Date. At the calendar: Move by day: RIGHT or LEFT ARROW. Move by week: UP or DOWN ARROW. Move by month: PAGE UP or PAGE DOWN. Move by year: TAB or SHIFT TAB. In a planner page: Go to a new date: READ with R, then F for forward, or B for back, then Move by day, week, month: D, W, M. 19.4.2 Reading the Entries. Previous entry: READ with U. Current entry: READ with I. Next entry: READ with O. Note: In Notes, the above commands move by sentence or line as in KeyWord. All entries for previous day: READ with 7. All entries for current day: READ with 8. All entries for next day: READ with 9. Top of current day: READ with T. Bottom of current day: READ with B. Note: In Notes, the top and bottom commands take you to top or bottom of the notes. Read continuously: READ with G. Find text string: READ with F. Schedule appointment: CONTROL with ENTER. Review or Modify appointment: CONTROL with R. Cancel appointment: CONTROL with I. Hear next appointment anywhere in KeySoft: FUNCTION with N. Go to next overlapping appt: CONTROL with READ with O. Go to previous overlapping appt: CONTROL with READ with U. When the cursor is in the date line of a calendar page: Number of appointments and all day events: READ with I. Date and days away from current date: READ with Q. When the cursor is in an appointment: Summary of recurrences and alarm status: READ with I. Date and time and days away from current date: READ with Q. 19.4.2.1 Recurring Appointments. Move to next instance: SHIFT with READ with O. Move to previous instance: SHIFT with READ with U. Patterns: Daily: Type number of days. Weekly, Yearly: Sunday: Su. Monday: Mo. Tuesday: Tu. Wednesday: We. Thursday: Th. Friday: Fr. Saturday: Sa. every day: v. weekdays: d. weekend days: e. Note: you can type less letters for Monday, Wednesday or Friday as their initial letters are unique. You can also type more of the name of a day, for example, Thurs for Thursday. Weeks between occurrences: Type number of weeks. Monthly, Yearly: first week 1. second week: 2. third week: 3. fourth week: 4. last week: l. Months between occurrences: Type number of months. Number of Recurrences: (not all options documented). Days: Right Arrow. Weeks: Down Arrow. Months: Page down. Years: Shift Tab. 19.4.3 Alarms. Acknowledge alarm: READ with SPACE, then: Read alarm details: R. Cancel alarm: C. Postpone alarm: P. Go to planner entry: G. 19.4.4 Miscellaneous Functions. Move from planner page to calendar: ESCAPE. Hear the current time: FUNCTION with T. Hear today's date: FUNCTION with D. Query day and date: READ with Q. Announce Key Names: READ with A. 19.5 Address List. 19.5.1 Manipulating Records. Previous record: LEFT ARROW. Current record: READ with 8. Next record: RIGHT ARROW. Previous field: UP ARROW or BACKSPACE. Current field: READ with I. Next field: DOWN ARROW or SPACE. Previous word: READ with J. Current word: READ with K. Next word: READ with L. Add a completed record: CONTROL with ENTER. Select a record to copy: ENTER. Change current field: CONTROL with K. Clear current field: CONTROL with BACKSPACE. Delete record: CONTROL with 8. Copy record to Clipboard: CONTROL with B. 19.6 Email. 19.6.1 In an Email Folder. Read Email: ENTER. Next field: SPACE, or DOWN ARROW. Previous field: BACKSPACE or UP ARROW. Next Email: RIGHT ARROW. Previous Email: LEFT ARROW. Move Email to Trash: CONTROL with 8. Mark Email: CONTROL with SPACE. Mark All: CONTROL with ENTER, then A. Search: READ with F. Email Action Menu: CONTROL with ENTER. Move forward by day: CONTROL with PERIOD. Move back a day: CONTROL with M. Move forward by week: CONTROL with L. Move back a week: CONTROL with J. Move forward by month: CONTROL with O. Move back a month: CONTROL with U. Move forward by year: CONTROL with 9. Move back a year: CONTROL with 7. Move to first email: READ with T. Move to last email: READ with B. 19.6.2 In a List of Email Folders. Select prompted folder: ENTER. Delete folder: CONTROL with I. Rename folder: CONTROL with R. Display Number of emails: READ with I. 19.6.3 At "Ready to send" prompt. Send email: Y. Return to "send to" prompt: N. Save email as a Draft: D. Print email: P. Emboss email: E. Abandon email without sending: ESCAPE. 19.6.4 Email Trash Folder. At "Empty Trash?" prompt, Leave items in Trash: N. Delete items in Trash: Y. Review items in Trash: R. Options after selecting Review, Move to next email: RIGHT ARROW. Move to previous email: LEFT ARROW. Delete email being reviewed: CONTROL with 8. Trash Folder Menu: CONTROL with ENTER. then, Restore email to original folder: R. Empty Trash folder: E. 19.7 Database Manager. 19.7.1 Adding a Record. Add a record: CONTROL with ENTER. Retrieve last record: CONTROL with B then R. Paste the clipboard into a field: CONTROL with B then P. Remove a field entry from the current record: CONTROL with BACKSPACE then ENTER.. 19.7.2 Finding Information. Go to the next record: RIGHT ARROW. Go to the previous record: LEFT ARROW. Next field: SPACE. Previous field: BACKSPACE. Next word: READ with L. Previous word: READ with J. To hear the current record: READ with 8. Exit from the list of records: ESCAPE. Delete a record: CONTROL with 8. Edit current record: CONTROL with I. Copy a field to the clipboard: CONTROL with C. Copy a record to clipboard: CONTROL with B then C. 19.7.3 Field Definition List Commands. To delete a field: CONTROL with I. To review or change field settings: CONTROL with 2. To insert a field before the current field: CONTROL with ENTER. To cycle through the field data types: CONTROL with SPACE. To move current field one up in the list: CONTROL with 7. To move current field one down in the list: CONTROL with 9. Exit the field definition list: ESCAPE. 19.7.4 Sort Order and Record Title List Commands. To change a sort order or a record title field: ENTER. To remove a sort order or a record title field: CONTROL with I. 19.8 Games. 19.8.1 Basic Commands. Go to game: FUNCTION with G. Save the game: CONTROL with S. Load the game: CONTROL with O. Abandon the game: CONTROL with Q. Enter the next move: Type a single/multiple character. Insert the last move entered: CONTROL with R. Insert block marker: CONTROL with SHIFT with M. Copy block to the clipboard: CONTROL with Z. Paste the contents of the clipboard to the input prompt: CONTROL with V. 19.8.2 Game History Commands. View the current status: READ with S. Move forward from the history item: LEFT ARROW. Move backward from the history item: RIGHT ARROW. In Sentence and Paragraph reading Mode, the following commands review sentences and paragraphs. Move back a sentence : READ with U. Hear the current sentence: READ with I. Move forward a sentence: READ with O. Move back a word: READ with J. Hear the current word: READ with K. Move forward a word: READ with L. Move back a character: READ with M. Hear the current character: READ with COMMA. Move forward a character: READ with PERIOD. 19.9 Unicode Characters. Unicode character entry: FUNCTION with X. Select Unicode Table: SPACE, then ENTER. Select Unicode Character: SPACE or letter. Review or change the way a character is displayed in Braille: Unicode Table, CONTROL with D. Review or change a macro for a character: Unicode Table, CONTROL with K. Unicode Macro: FUNCTION with C. 19.10 Web Browser. Open a new URL: ESCAPE. Go forward one page: READ with Right Arrow. Go back one page: READ with Left Arrow. Save web page: CONTROL with S. Refresh Page: CONTROL with R. Hear URL contents: READ with COMMA then repeat the command. Modem disconnect: FUNCTION with O, then C then Select from the Connectivity Menu. Progress Tone Volume: FUNCTION with O then R. Move through the list to "Progress Tone Volume". Internet Options Menu: CONTROL with 2. Favorites Menu: CONTROL with 1. 19.10.1 Move by Element. "Click" on an item: ENTER. Read Input Control Prompt: REPEAT. Move to next element: TAB. Move to previous element: SHIFT with TAB. Current element: READ with X. Change move type: READ with C. Link: L. Input Control: I. Heading: H. Frame: F. Link or input control: B. Move to next link or input control: NEXT thumbkey. Move to previous link or input control: PREVIOUS thumbkey. Change option for NEXT and PREVIOUS thumkeys: FUNCTION with O, B. Review the list for "Function of previous and next thumkeys". 19.10.2 Move from link to link. Move backwards: BACKSPACE. Move forwards: SPACE. 19.10.3 Tables. Table Mode: READ with S repeatedly until "Table Mode" is displayed. Query Cursor Position: READ with Q. While in Table Mode: Move forward one cell along a row: READ with O. To hear the current cell in a row: READ with 8. Move back one cell along a row: READ with U. Move down one cell in a column: READ with 9. To hear the current cell in a column: READ with I. Move down one cell in a column: READ with 7. 19.10.4 History. History command list: READ with CONTROL with H. Navigate to current record: ENTER. Next Field: SPACE. Previous field: BACKSPACE. Next History record: RIGHT ARROW. Previous History record: LEFT ARROW. Forward one Day: READ with PERIOD. Back one Day: READ with M. Forward one week: CONTROL with L. Back one week: CONTROL with J. Previous Domain name: CONTROL with O. Next Domain name: CONTROL with U. Newest History record: READ with G. Oldest History record: READ with B. Sort by domain/day: CONTROL with S. Note: history is presented alphabetically for day or domain. 19.11 Stopwatch. Go to StopWatch: FUNCTION with W, or  FUNCTION with O then T, then S. Stop or Start Stopwatch: SPACE. Set time back to Zero: CONTROL with I. Stop stopwatch altogether: SPACE then CONTROL with I. Hear elapsed time: REPEAT. Hear elapsed time again: L. 19.12 Media Player. Go to Media Player: FUNCTION with M, or M from Main Menu. Pause track: READ with SPACE. Restart track: READ with SPACE or READ with G. Skip forward 1%: RIGHT ARROW. Skip back 1%: LEFT ARROW. Skip forward 5%: CONTROL with RIGHT ARROW. Skip back 5%: CONTROL with LEFT ARROW. Skip forward 10%: READ with RIGHT ARROW. Skip back 10%: READ with LEFT ARROW. Elapsed time of total time: READ with Q. Track Information: READ with I. Stop track and exit: ESCAPE. 19.12.1 Audio Recorder. Record a memo: Either press Record button or go through the Media Center menu. Stop Recording: Either press Record button or go through the Media Center menu. Playback a memo: SHIFT with FUNCTION with M. 19.12.2 FM Radio. Go to FM Radio: FUNCTION with F. Turn off FM Radio: ESCAPE. Toggle speaker on/off: FUNCTION with L. Go to next preset station: SPACE. Go to previous preset station: BACKSPACE. Go to preset station starting with a particular character: ALPHA or DIGIT. Enter a new preset station: CONTROL with R. Rename preset station: Select the preset then press CONTROL with R. Delete radio preset: Select the preset then press CONTROL with 8. Jump directly to a frequency: READ with F. Scan frequency forward: READ with RIGHT ARROW. Scan frequency backward: READ with LEFT ARROW. Jump frequency forward by 1MHz: CONTROL with RIGHT ARROW. Jump frequency back by 1MHz: CONTROL with LEFT ARROW. Jump frequency forward by 100kHz: RIGHT ARROW. Jump frequency back by 100kHz: LEFT ARROW. Turn the FM Radio volume up relative to speech: CONTROL with EQUALS. Turn the FM Radio volume down relative to speech: CONTROL with HYPHEN. Mute or unmute the FM Radio: CONTROL with BACKSLASH. End of Command Summary. Appendix A User Settings for VoiceNote mPower QT. The following User settings should be setup and/or checked on the VoiceNote mPower QT. A.1 Speech; volume, rate, and pitch. Refer to: 1.13.2 Setting Volume and Pitch A.2 Time and date set, and in preferred format. Refer to 1.18 Time and Date: or. A.3 Keyboard input voice setting; words, characters, or off. Refer to 1.10.1 Help Messages. A.4 Braille language. Refer to: 5.3 Braille Options, then Section 5.3.1.3 Braille Code. A.5 Braille grade for keyboard input. Refer to: 5.4.2 Preferred Keyboard Braille Grade A.6 Calculator Braille code. Refer to 5.3 Braille Options, then 5.3.1.4 Calculator Braille Code. A.7 Computer Braille language. Refer 5.3 Braille Options, then 5.3.1.5 Computer Braille Table. A.8 Spelling checker dictionary language installed. Open the "Demonstration Document" in the "General" folder, and access the spelling checker by pressing READ with CONTROL with S. If the spelling dictionary has not been installed you will advised that there is no language currently installed, followed by a prompt to choose the language. Press SPACE repeatedly until the dictionary name is announced, for example "USA Spelling Dictionary," then press ENTER. A.9 Address list data base installed. From the Main Menu select the Address List, then press A to add an address. You will be advised if the address list data base does not exist, followed by the prompt to create a data base called "Address List." Press Y to create the data base named "Address List." A.10 Email data base installed. From the Main Menu select the Email option, then press S for Setup, and select the "Directory of Email Account" item from the Setup menu. Press A to add a service. You will be advised if the data base for "Directory of Email Accounts" does not exist, followed by the prompt to create a data base called "Directory of Email Accounts." Press Y to create the data base. You will then be placed in the entry list for the "Directory of Email Accounts." Unless you wish to continue on and setup a "Directory of Email Accounts" record, press ESCAPE to exit, and answer N to the prompt "Add this record?" End of Appendix A  User Settings. Appendix B Information on BookShare. At the time of publishing, the Bookshare service is only available to residents of the United States. Up to date information on Bookshare.org and eligibility to join etc is available from their website: http://www.bookshare.org. For information on the special offer for VoiceNote mPower QT users as well as how to join, go to: http://www.bookshare.org/Braillenote For membership information, go to: http://www.bookshare.org/web/AboutMembership.html To join Bookshare.org, go to: https://www.bookshare.org/web/MembersJoinForm.html For Frequently Asked Questions about Bookshare.org, go to: http://www.bookshare.org/web/SupportFAQ.html There is also a book available called "Finding ebooks on the Internet", by BrailleNote user Anna Dresner, available through National Braille Press, which tells you how to find, download, and access electronic books from a variety of sources, including Bookshare.org. Sources for free public domain eBooks, as well as for commercially available accessible eBooks, are also included. For more information, including a link to the table of contents, visit: http://www.nbp.org/ebook.html End of Appendix B  Info on Bookshare Appendix C Troubleshooting the VoiceNote mPower QT. If the VoiceNote mPower QT does not respond as you expect, there are a number of things you should check: Make sure that the VoiceNote mPower QT has power. Connect the AC adapter. The VoiceNote mPower QT should detect the AC adapter when the adapter is powered on even if the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched off. The message "AC adapter on," is normally spoken. Switch off then on again. If the VoiceNote mPower QT does not respond, leave the AC adapter connected. Wait 10 minutes, then try switching the VoiceNote mPower QT off, then on again. Resets – The three types and their uses. C.1 Reset Button. Press just the reset button when:  asked to by an upgrade/new feature installation program to install new drivers and restart KeySoft  the VoiceNote mPower QT stops responding for any reason (assuming the problem is not that the power is off, or the battery is flat!)  the VoiceNote mPower QT generally seems to not be its normal self. Switch the VoiceNote mPower QT on and gently press the reset switch with a pointed instrument until it clicks, then release it. The VoiceNote mPower QT should beep immediately. After about ten seconds silence, a chime should sound and the VoiceNote mPower QT will announce "KeySoft CE, version 8.0x. Build (number)."  After a pause KeySoft announces: "Main Menu." You will lose data if you have to press reset while a file is open in the word processor or the planner is open or an email is being written and changes have been made and not saved before reset is pressed. Same in the address list if changes are made to a record and not saved before reset is pressed. C.2 Reset with SDF keys held down. This reset runs the original factoryinstalled software, and clears any later ROM upgrade of KeySoft you were running. Necessary before an upgrade. Useful if an upgrade or addon has become corrupted and the BN will not start after a reset due to this. The data lost will be the same as above. It won't change your user defined defaults back to the factory settings. Hold down SDF keys. Gently press the reset button until it clicks then release it, while still holding down SDF keys. After about ten seconds silence, a chime should sound and the VoiceNote mPower QT should speak. Release the keys. KeySoft announces. "KeySoft CE, version 3.0x. Build (number)."  After a pause KeySoft announces: "Main Menu." C.3 Reinitialize with JKL keys held down. If KeySoft still does not start, VoiceNote mPower QT's memory may have been corrupted. If this has happened, then it is necessary to reinitialize the memory. (This reset is sometimes called a Hard Reset although technically it isn't) Make sure the VoiceNote mPower QT is switched on. Hold down JKL keys and gently press the reset switch with a pointed instrument until it clicks. The VoiceNote mPower QT should beep immediately. Continue to hold down JKL keys. After about ten seconds silence, a chime should sound and the VoiceNote mPower QT should speak. Release the keys. KeySoft announces. "KeySoft CE, version 3.0x. Build (number)."  After a pause KeySoft announces: "Main Menu." C.4 Service Reset. The service reset should only be performed under the supervision of a service staff member. If performed at the wrong time, it can cause loss of data and possibly a malfunction that could require you to return your unit for servicing. It is akin to, but potentially more harmful than, pulling the plug on your PC while it is working. It is only mentioned at all in this manual so that users will be aware of the consequences of doing it should they hear of it from other users. The service reset involves holding down both the record button and the reset button at the same time and then releasing them both. C.5 Still doesn't start. Telephone your VoiceNote mPower QT Distributor for further advice. End of Appendix C  TroubleShooting. Appendix D Computer Braille Reference List. The VoiceNote mPower QT supports USA and UK Computer Braille in both 6 dot and 8 dot forms. This Appendix contains 6 tables which give you the dot combination used for each ASCII character available in each of the supported configurations. The 6 tables are listed in the following order: United States 6 dot Computer Braille  Lower Case United States 6 dot Computer Braille  Upper Case United States 8 dot Computer Braille United Kingdom 6 dot Computer Braille  Lower Case United Kingdom 6 dot Computer Braille  Upper Case United Kingdom 8 dot Computer Braille Each table has two columns. The first column contains the actual ASCII character enclosed in single quote marks so that it is read at all punctuation levels. The second column lists the dots required to obtain this character. Each table is divided into sections according to the type of character. For example, the lower case letters are in one section, the digits are in another, and so on. The sections are divided by a blank line. Reading of this Appendix may be best accomplished by using KeyWord to select Appendix D from the Manual folder on the "KeySoft System Disk" To find a particular character, first find the start of the relevant table. Next set your Reading Mode to the "Line Reading" option, by pressing READ with S as many times as necessary. Now, using the "Read next line" command, which is READ with O, start reading the first line of the table. As soon as you have heard the character name, if it is not the character you are looking for, press DOWN ARROW again to cut off the speech and instantly start reading the next line. If you determine that the character you are looking for is in another section, press READ with 9 to start reading the next section. Continue skimming through by line or section until you find the character you are looking for. Now let KeySoft read the whole line, and you will hear the dot combination for this character. D.1 United States Computer Braille. D.1.1 United States 6 dot Computer Braille  Lower Case exclamation mark '!' 2,3,4,6 quotation mark '"' 5 hash sign '#' 3,4,5,6 dollar sign '$' 1,2,4,6 percent '%' 1,4,6 ampersand '&' 1,2,3,4,6 apostrophe ''' 3 left bracket '(' 1,2,3,5,6 right bracket ')' 2,3,4,5,6 asterisk '*' 1,6 plus sign '+' 3,4,6 comma ',' 6 hyphen '' 3,6 period '.' 4,6 forward slash '/' 3,4 colon ':' 1,5,6 semi colon ';' 5,6 less than '<' 1,2,6 equals '=' 1,2,3,4,5,6 greater than '>' 3,4,5 question mark '?' 1,4,5,6 underscore '_' 4,5,6 grave accent '`' 4 left curly brace '{' 2,4,6 right curly brace '}' 1,2,4,5,6 upright slash '|' 1,2,5,6 tilde '~' 4,5 zero '0' 3,5,6 one '1' 2 two '2' 2,3 three '3' 2,5 four '4' 2,5,6 five '5' 2,6 six '6' 2,3,5 seven '7' 2,3,5,6 eight '8' 2,3,6 nine '9' 3,5 'a' 1 'b' 1,2 'c' 1,4 'd' 1,4,5 'e' 1,5 'f' 1,2,4 'g' 1,2,4,5 'h' 1,2,5 'i' 2,4 'j' 2,4,5 'k' 1,3 'l' 1,2,3 'm' 1,3,4 'n' 1,3,4,5 'o' 1,3,5 'p' 1,2,3,4 'q' 1,2,3,4,5 'r' 1,2,3,5 's' 2,3,4 't' 2,3,4,5 'u' 1,3,6 'v' 1,2,3,6 'w' 2,4,5,6 'x' 1,3,4,6 'y' 1,3,4,5,6 'z' 1,3,5,6 D.1.2 United States 6 dot Computer Braille Upper Case The following table shows the combinations which change when a keystroke is immediately preceded by SPACE with U or when Caps Lock has been turned on by pressing SPACE with U twice in succession. 'A' 1 'B' 1,2 'C' 1,4 'D' 1,4,5 'E' 1,5 'F' 1,2,4 'G' 1,2,4,5 'H' 1,2,5 'I' 2,4 'J' 2,4,5 'K' 1,3 'L' 1,2,3 'M' 1,3,4 'N' 1,3,4,5 'O' 1,3,5 'P' 1,2,3,4 'Q' 1,2,3,4,5 'R' 1,2,3,5 'S' 2,3,4 'T' 2,3,4,5 'U' 1,3,6 'V' 1,2,3,6 'W' 2,4,5,6 'X' 1,3,4,6 'Y' 1,3,4,5,6 'Z' 1,3,5,6 at symbol '@' 4 left square bracket '[' 2,4,6 right square bracket ']' 1,2,4,5,6 back slash '\' 1,2,5,6 carat symbol '^' 4,5 underscore '_' 4,5,6 D.1.3 United States 8 dot Computer Braille exclamation mark '!' 2,3,4,6 quotation mark '"' 5 hash sign '#' 3,4,5,6 dollar sign '$' 1,2,4,6 percent '%' 1,4,6 ampersand '&' 1,2,3,4,6 apostrophe ''' 3 left bracket '(' 1,2,3,5,6 right bracket ')' 2,3,4,5,6 asterisk '*' 1,6 plus sign '+' 3,4,6 comma ',' 6 hyphen '' 3,6 period '.' 4,6 forward slash '/' 3,4 colon ':' 1,5,6 semi colon ';' 5,6 less than '<' 1,2,6 equals '=' 1,2,3,4,5,6 greater than '>' 3,4,5 question mark '?' 1,4,5,6 at symbol '@' 4,7 left square bracket '[' 2,4,6,7 back slash '\' 1,2,5,6 right square bracket ']' 1,2,4,5,6 carat sign '^' 4,5,7 underscore '_' 4,5,6,7 '_' 4,5,6 grave accent '`' 4 left curly brace '{' 2,4,6 upright slash '|' 1,2,5,6 right curly brace '}' 1,2,4,5,6 tilde '~' 4,5 Delete 8 Delete 1,2,3,4,5,6 '0' 3,5,6 '1' 2 '2' 2,3 '3' 2,5 '4' 2,5,6 '5' 2,6 '6' 2,3,5 '7' 2,3,5,6 '8' 2,3,6 '9' 3,5 'A' 1,7 'B' 1,2,7 'C' 1,4,7 'D' 1,4,5,7 'E' 1,5,7 'F' 1,2,4,7 'G' 1,2,4,5,7 'H' 1,2,5,7 'I' 2,4,7 'J' 2,4,5,7 'K' 1,3,7 'L' 1,2,3,7 'M' 1,3,4,7 'N' 1,3,4,5,7 'O' 1,3,5,7 'P' 1,2,3,4,7 'Q' 1,2,3,4,5,7 'R' 1,2,3,5,7 'S' 2,3,4,7 'T' 2,3,4,5,7 'U' 1,3,6,7 'V' 1,2,3,6,7 'W' 2,4,5,6,7 'X' 1,3,4,6,7 'Y' 1,3,4,5,6,7 'Z' 1,3,5,6,7 'a' 1 'b' 1,2 'c' 1,4 'd' 1,4,5 'e' 1,5 'f' 1,2,4 'g' 1,2,4,5 'h' 1,2,5 'i' 2,4 'j' 2,4,5 'k' 1,3 'l' 1,2,3 'm' 1,3,4 'n' 1,3,4,5 'o' 1,3,5 'p' 1,2,3,4 'q' 1,2,3,4,5 'r' 1,2,3,5 's' 2,3,4 't' 2,3,4,5 'u' 1,3,6 'v' 1,2,3,6 'w' 2,4,5,6 'x' 1,3,4,6 'y' 1,3,4,5,6 'z' 1,3,5,6 D.2 United Kingdom Computer Braille. D.2.1 United Kingdom 6 dot Computer Braille Lower Case. exclamation mark '!' 3,4,5,6 quotation mark '"' 4 hash sign '#' 5,6 dollar sign '$' 4,5,6 percent '%' 4,6 ampersand '&' 1,2,3,4,6 apostrophe ''' 3 left bracket '(' 4,5 right bracket ')' 3,4,5 asterisk '*' 3,5 plus sign '+' 2,3,5 comma ',' 2 hyphen '' 3,6 period '.' 2,5,6 forward slash '/' 3,4 colon ':' 2,5 semi colon ';' 2,3 less than '<' 2,3,6 equals '=' 2,3,5,6 greater than '>' 3,5,6 question mark '?' 2,6 grave accent '`' 2,3,4,6 left curly brace '{' 1,2,3,5,6 upright slash '|' 5 right curly brace '}' 2,3,4,5,6 tilde '~' 6 Delete Delete Delete 3,4,6 '0' 1,2,3,4,5,6 '1' 1,6 '2' 1,2,6 '3' 1,4,6 '4' 1,4,5,6 '5' 1,5,6 '6' 1,2,4,6 '7' 1,2,4,5,6 '8' 1,2,5,6 '9' 2,4,6 'a' 1 'b' 1,2 'c' 1,4 'd' 1,4,5 'e' 1,5 'f' 1,2,4 'g' 1,2,4,5 'h' 1,2,5 'i' 2,4 'j' 2,4,5 'k' 1,3 'l' 1,2,3 'm' 1,3,4 'n' 1,3,4,5 'o' 1,3,5 'p' 1,2,3,4 'q' 1,2,3,4,5 'r' 1,2,3,5 's' 2,3,4 't' 2,3,4,5 'u' 1,3,6 'v' 1,2,3,6 'w' 2,4,5,6 'x' 1,3,4,6 'y' 1,3,4,5,6 'z' 1,3,5,6 D.2.2 United Kingdom 6 dot Computer Braille Upper Case The following table shows the combinations which change when a keystroke is immediately preceded by SPACE with U or when Caps Lock has been turned on by pressing SPACE with U twice in succession. 'A', 1 'B', 1,2 'C', 1,4 'E', 1,5 'D', 1,4,5 'F', 1,2,4 'G', 1,2,4,5 'H', 1,2,5 'I', 2,4 'J', 2,4,5 'K', 1,3 'L', 1,2,3 'M', 1,3,4 'N', 1,3,4,5 'O', 1,3,5 'P', 1,2,3,4 'Q', 1,2,3,4,5 'R', 1,2,3,5 'S', 2,3,4 'T', 2,3,4,5 'U', 1,3,6 'V', 1,2,3,6 'W', 2,4,5,6 'X', 1,3,4,6 'Y', 1,3,4,5,6 'Z', 1,3,5,6 at symbol '@', 2,3,4,6 left square bracket '[', 1,2,3,5,6 back slash '\', 5 right square bracket ']', 2,3,4,5,6 carat sign '^', 6 underscore '_', 3,4,6 D.2.3 United Kingdom 8 dot Computer Braille exclamation mark '!' 3,4,5,6 quotation mark '"' 4 hash sign '#' 5,6 dollar sign '$' 4,5,6 percent '%' 4,6 ampersand '&' 1,2,3,4,6 apostrophe ''' 3 left bracket '(' 4,5 right bracket ')' 3,4,5 asterisk '*' 3,5 plus sign '+' 2,3,5 comma ',' 2 hyphen '' 3,6 period '.' 2,5,6 forward slash '/' 3,4 colon ':' 2,5 semi colon ';' 2,3 less than '<' 2,3,6 equals '=' 2,3,5,6 greater than '>' 3,5,6 question mark '?' 2,6 at symbol '@' 2,3,4,6,7 left square bracket '[' 1,2,3,5,6,7 back slash '\' 5,7 right square bracket ']' 2,3,4,5,6,7 carat sign '^' 6,7 underscore '_' 3,4,6,7 grave accent '`' 2,3,4,6 left curly brace '{' 1,2,3,5,6 upright slash '|' 5 right curly brace '}' 2,3,4,5,6 tilde '~' 6 Delete 3,4,6 '0' 1,2,3,4,5,6 '1' 1,6 '2' 1,2,6 '3' 1,4,6 '4' 1,4,5,6 '5' 1,5,6 '6' 1,2,4,6 '7' 1,2,4,5,6 '8' 1,2,5,6 '9' 2,4,6 'A' 1,7 'B' 1,2,7 'C' 1,4,7 'D' 1,4,5,7 'E' 1,5,7 'F' 1,2,4,7 'G' 1,2,4,5,7 'H' 1,2,5,7 'I' 2,4,7 'J' 2,4,5,7 'K' 1,3,7 'L' 1,2,3,7 'M' 1,3,4,7 'N' 1,3,4,5,7 'O' 1,3,5,7 'P' 1,2,3,4,7 'Q' 1,2,3,4,5,7 'R' 1,2,3,5,7 'S' 2,3,4,7 'T' 2,3,4,5,7 'U' 1,3,6,7 'V' 1,2,3,6,7 'W' 2,4,5,6,7 'X' 1,3,4,6,7 'Y' 1,3,4,5,6,7 'Z' 1,3,5,6,7 'a' 1 'b' 1,2 'c' 1,4 'd' 1,4,5 'e' 1,5 'f' 1,2,4 'g' 1,2,4,5 'h' 1,2,5 'i' 2,4 'j' 2,4,5 'k' 1,3 'l' 1,2,3 'm' 1,3,4 'n' 1,3,4,5 'o' 1,3,5 'p' 1,2,3,4 'q' 1,2,3,4,5 'r' 1,2,3,5 's' 2,3,4 't' 2,3,4,5 'u' 1,3,6 'v' 1,2,3,6 'w' 2,4,5,6 'x' 1,3,4,6 'y' 1,3,4,5,6 'z' 1,3,5,6 a acute 'á' 8 a grave 'à' 4,6,7,8 a circumflex 'â' 5,6,7,8 Cap A diaeresis 'Ä' 2,5,6,7,8 a diaeresis 'ä' 4,5,6,7,8 Cap a ring 'Å' 3,4,7,8 a ring 'å' 1,2,3,4,6,7,8 cap a diphthong 'Æ' 1,2,6,7,8 a diphthong 'æ' 1,6,7,8 feminine ordinal 'ª' 1,2,3,4,6,8 masculine ordinal 'º' 3,8 c cedilla 'ç' 7,8 cap C cedilla 'Ç' 3,7,8 cap E acute 'É' 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8 e acute 'é' 4,7,8 e grave 'è' 3,5,7,8 e circumflex 'ê' 4,5,7,8 e diaeresis 'ë' 3,4,5,7,8 i acute 'í' 3,4,5,6,8 i grave 'ì' 3,6,7,8 i circumflex 'î' 2,7,8 i diaeresis 'ï' 2,3,5,7,8 cap N tilde 'Ñ' 4,6,8 n tilde 'ñ' 4,5,6,8 o acute 'ó' 4,8 o grave 'ò' 1,5,6,7,8 o circumflex 'ô' 1,4,6,7,8 cap O diaeresis 'Ö' 2,4,6,7,8 o diaeresis 'ö' 1,4,5,6,7,8 u acute 'ú' 5,6,8 u grave 'ù' 1,2,4,5,6,7,8 u circumflex 'û' 1,2,4,6,7,8 Cap U diaeresis 'Ü' 2,5,7,8 u diaeresis 'ü' 3,4,5,6,7,8 y diaeresis 'ÿ' 1,2,5,6,7,8 Exclamation inverted '¡' 3,6,8 question mark inverted '¿' 4,5,8 Start of '¬' 3,5,8 Logical NOT '?' 3,4,5,8 Right double angle quotation '»' 3,4,8 Left double angle quotation '«' 2,5,6,8 Pounds sign '£' 2,3,6,7,8 cent sign '¢' 2,3,7,8 Florin sign '?' 2,6,7,8 Yen sign '?' 3,5,6,7,8 Peseta sign '¥' 2,3,5,6,7,8 half '½' 2,3,5,8 quarter '¼' 2,8 Plus or minus '±' 1,2,3,4,5,8 Greater than or equal to '÷' 1,2,3,6,8 Less than or equal to '?' 2,3,4,8 Greater than or equal to '?' 1,2,3,5,8 Nearly equals '?' 2,4,5,6,8 Identity symbol '?' 1,2,3,4,8 Superscript 2 '²' 2,3,4,5,6,8 Superscript n '?' 5,8 Radical symbol '?' 1,2,3,5,6,8 Integral sign '?' 2,3,4,5,8 Integral sign '?' 1,3,6,8 degree sign '°' 1,3,4,6,8 Intersection symbol '?' 1,3,5,8 Greek epsilon '?' 1,3,4,5,8 '·' 1,3,5,6,8 '?' 1,3,4,5,6,8 Solid square '?' 6,8 Greek alpha '?' 2,3,4,6,8 Greek beta, 'ß' 1,8 Greek Gamma '?' 1,2,8 Greek pi '?' 1,4,8 Greek Sigma '?' 1,4,5,8 Greek sigma '?' 1,5,8 Greek mu 'µ' 1,2,4,8 Greek tau '?' 1,2,4,5,8 Greek Fi '?' 1,2,5,8 Greek Theta '?' 2,4,8 Greek Omega '?' 2,4,5,8 Greek delta '?' 1,3,8 Infinity '?' 1,2,3,8 Greek fi '?' 1,3,4,8 Upper left '?' 1,3,5,6,7,8 Center box '?' 1,4,6,8 Lower Left '?' 2,3,4,6,7,8 Upper right '?' 2,6,8 Lower right '?' 1,3,4,5,6,7,8 Middle box '?' 1,2,7,8 Left middle '?' 1,4,7,8 Box intersection '?' 1,5,7,8 Right middle '?' 1,4,5,6,8 Middle box '?' 1,7,8 Center box '?' 1,4,5,7,8 Double upper left '?' 2,4,7,8 Double center box '?' 2,5,8 Double lower left '?' 1,2,5,7,8 Double upper right '?' 2,3,8 Double lower right '?' 2,3,6,8 Double middle box '?' 1,3,7,8 Double left middle '?' 1,2,3,7,8 Double box intersection '?' 1,3,4,5,7,8 Double right middle '?' 2,4,6,8 Double middle box '?' 2,4,5,7,8 Double center box '?' 1,3,4,7,8 Double horizontal upper right '?' 1,2,5,6,8 Double horizontal right middle '?' 1,5,6,8 Double horizontal left middle '?' 1,2,4,8 Double horizontal lower right '?' 3,5,6,8 Double horizontal upper right '?' 1,3,6,8 Double horizontal lower left '?' 2,3,4,5,7,8 Double horizontal top middle '?' 1,2,3,4,5,7,8 Double horizontal intersection '?' 1,3,4,6,7,8 Double horizontal bottom middle '?' 1,3,5,7,8 Double vertical upper right '?' 1,2,4,5,6,8 Double vertical left middle '?' 1,2,4,5,7,8 Double vertical right middle '?' 1,2,4,6,8 Double vertical lower right '?' 2,3,5,6,8 Double vertical upper left '?' 1,2,3,6,7,8 Double vertical intersection '?' 2,4,5,6,7,8 Double vertical lower left '?' 2,3,4,7,8 Double vertical top middle '?' 1,2,3,5,7,8 Double vertical bottom middle '?' 1,2,3,4,7,8 Fill character '?' 1,2,3,4,5,6,8 Fill character '?' 1,6,8 Fill character '?' 1,2,6,8 Solid fill '?' 5,7,8 Solid fill '?' 6,7,8 Solid fill '?' 3,4,6,7,8 Solid fill '?' 1,2,3,5,6,7,8 Solid fill '?' 2,3,4,5,6,7,8 End of Appendix D Computer Braille Reference List. 20 Index. A AC Adapter • 21 ActiveSync about • 18, 258, 303 connecting to • 262 file synchronization • 263, 271 installing • 260, 261 Add e-mail account • 219 Address list adding an address • 184 changing a field • 188 clearing a field • 188 copy to address list file • 194 copy to braille document • 126, 194 copy to text document • 126, 194 copying a record • 189, 221 copying addresses to a file • 193 creating an address list • 195 deleting a record • 188 embossing • 190 entry list • 184 fields • 184 inserting an address into a document • 189 look up address • 186 manipulating databases • 197 printing • 191 record matching • 187 searching • 186 select an address file • 195, 197 selection list • 186 synchronising with Outlook • 268 templates • 133, 191 templates for embossing • 190 Alarm about • 178 acknowledge • 179 repeat period • 179, 180 ring time • 179, 180 Set up • 179, 180 setting • 178 status • 176 volume • 179, 180 Application program KeySoft • 309 Application switching • 8, 15, 68, 224, 349 Appointments canceling • 178 editing • 177 entering • 168 modifying • 175, 177 next • 87 recurring • 169, 170 rescheduling • 175, 177 reviewing • 174 set alarm • 178 synching with Outlook • 271 ASCII text export document as • 292 ASCII Translation about • 122, 123, 293, 294 baud rate • 295 end of file character • 295 extended ASCII • 295 handshaking • 296 line feed character • 295 number data bits • 296 options • 122, 123, 293, 294 paragraph format • 294 parity • 295 transmit delay • 296 Attachments • 209, 211 Audio see also Media Center playback recording • 321 recording • 317 streaming audio • 313 B Back translation about • 112, 132, 296, 299 braille italics • 297 heading blank lines • 298 heading format • 134, 298 new line • 297 new page markers • 298 outline style • 298 paragraph boundary • 134, 297 paragraph format • 298 revert after • 299 spaces between sentences • 297 sub-heading blank lines • 298 sub-heading format • 298 Backup files • 17, 304, 305 incremental • 305 Battery about • 21 care of • 23, 24 charging • 22 critical warning • 21 information • 24 life expectancy • 23, 24 low warning • 21 recalibrating manually • 23 Binding space • 126 Block commands about • 65, 76, 118 append a block • 121 copy a block to clipboard • 120 delete a block • 121 erase file • 123 format considerations • 122 insert a file • 123 mark block • 119 menu • 119, 177 merging documents • 123 move a block • 121 paste to clipboard • 121 quick mark • 119 read a block • 120 store a block • 122 zapp markers • 123 Bluetooth activesync • 253, 258, 259, 261 keyboard • 254 pairing • 253 setting up on PC • 254 Book reader about • 63 block commands • 65 book storage • 68 Bookshare • 68 exiting • 68 reading commands • 63, 225 reading from another drive • 63, 67 review opening options • 65 select another book • 65 Book reading • 63 Bookshare about • 68 downloading from • 69 membership information • 395 unpacking new book • 70 Braille Display calculator language • 83, 393 preferred reading grade • 82 text document reading grade • 83 computer braille • 84, 393 Braille document about • 102, 128 general • 129 layout • 97, 131, 133 open • 130 reference 1 • 37 review and edit • 130 style • 134 Braille entry • 37, 129 Braille Grade reading grade selection • 82 text reading grade • 83 Braille language selection • 83, 393 Braille settings for text document about • 104, 114 braille grade • 102, 116 braille layout • 114 control translation • 117 exclusion from braille • 115 inclusion for braille • 115 page settings • 116 translation options • 116, 299 Browser • 223 dialog boxes • 235 display settings • 231 downloading • 70, 236 favorites • 232 forms • 227, 229 general functions • 224, 230 history • 228, 234 homepage - go to • 231 homepage - set • 230 links • 226 Logging on • 224 moving commands • 228 Streaming audio • 313 tables • 237 C Calculation insertion • 88 Calculator add to memory • 160 addition • 145, 148 announce key • 145, 148 announce memory • 161 arc cosine • 162 arc sine • 162 arc tan • 162 clear • 145 clear memory • 160 correcting input errors • 146 cosine • 162 decimal exponent • 163 decimal places • 146 decimal point • 145, 148 degrees • 162 division • 145, 148 edit entry • 146 entering a calculation • 145, 148 fractions • 148 insert calculation • 164 insert result • 164 inverse trig functions • 162 log functions • 164 memory operations • 160 multiplication • 145, 148 negation • 147 parentheses • 147 percent • 148 PI • 162 powers • 163 precision • 146 radians • 162 recall memory • 161 review calculation • 146 roots • 163 sine • 162 square • 163 square root • 163 starting • 145 statistical operations • 151 store memory • 160 subtraction • 145, 148 tangent • 162 trig functions • 162 Calendar - in planner • 165 Cards CompactFlash Storage • 30 LAN network • 246, 247, 248 Secure Digital • 32 Care - general • 36 Carry case • 4 Center line • 103, 110 Check for e-mail • 201 Checklist of Equipment • 1 Clipboard • 120 Column reading mode • 45, 54, 120, 124 Command summary address list • 381 address list record manipulation • 381 browser • 387 browser history commands • 389 browser moving commands • 387 browser moving link to link • 388 calculator • 374 database manager • 384 e-mail • 382 e-mail at ready to send • 383 e-mail in list of folders • 383 e-mail inside folder • 382 e-mail trash folder • 383 FM radio • 391 games • 385 KeyWord block • 371 KeyWord dictionary look up • 373 KeyWord editing • 369 KeyWord format braille document for text • 370 KeyWord format text document for braille • 370 KeyWord formatting • 369 KeyWord miscellaneous • 371 KeyWord other review • 368 KeyWord spelling checker • 372 KeyWord template • 373 KeyWord text review • 367 options at folder name prompt • 362 options at list of folders prompt • 363 options within a folder list • 364 other options • 367 planner • 377 planner alarms • 380 planner miscellaneous functions • 380 planner reading entries • 378 planner select date • 377 switch programs • 362 unicode characters • 386 word processor • 367 Commands for moving • 45, 54, 120, 124 for reading • 42, 124 Compact Flash cards • 30 about • 30 installing and uninstalling • 31 Computer braille reference list • 401 translate for display • 102 US or UK • 84, 393 use with KeyMail • 202 Computer Braille reference list • 401 Connect to send and receive • 216 Connectivity • 239 ActiveSync • 18, 258, 303 configurations • 240 connectivity menu • 201, 241 dial-up connections • 246, 247, 249 glossary • 251 LAN connections • 246, 247, 248 menu • 201, 241 network client • 255 Connectors • 26 Converting file formats • 263, 272 Copy a file • 280, 305 addresses • 193 block • 120 record • 189, 221 Copying address list • 193 Create a document Braille • 37, 129 Microsoft Word • 128 Create folder • 275 Cursor Moving commands • 45 relocate position • 50, 53, 64 start of next line • 125 D DAISY listening options • 75 navigation options • 72 placemarkers • 75 reading options • 72 searching • 71 storage • 77 text notes • 76 Database Manager about • 327 adding a record • 329 associated Database Name • 344 copying records to a document • 334 copying records to another database • 335 creating a new Database • 336, 345 database File Management • 346 Database Menu • 328 embossing records • 331, 334, 335 exporting Data • 335 Field Types • 337, 339 finding information • 329 free database space • 346 importing data into a database • 333, 335 printing records • 332 record title • 344 sort orders • 343, 344 Date Display • 80 format • 308 insert • 125 Date and time insertion • 87 Date set • 308 Delete current character • 48 current word • 48 last character • 48 previous word • 48 text • 48 to end of document • 48 to end of paragraph • 48 to end of sentence • 48 Delete alert tone volume • 86 Dial tone • 219 Dial-up connections creating new connection • 241, 246, 255 dial using • 246, 247, 249 disconnecting from • 241, 249 Dictionary spelling • 54 Directory about • 284 access file • 285, 290, 293 root • 284 switching • 285 Directory of email accounts about • 218, 219 Disk drive description of • 39 file operations • 274 Document about • 38 braille • 37 creating • 41 creation of • 41 editing • 47 emboss • 94 handling of large • 60 listening to • 42, 124 naming of • 41 opening • 58, 65 print • 94 review options at opening • 58, 65 save • 127 save as another type • 127 selection of • 40, 42, 274 text • 37 types reference 2 • 276, 282 word count • 50 Double spacing • 107 Double-sided embossing • 94, 95, 96, 181, 190, 331 Download and read e-mail • 208 Downloading using browser • 236 Drive change • 126 description of • 39 selection • 39 Duplicating • 251 E Earphones • 7 Editing a document • 47 calculation • 146 delete to end of sentence • 48 quit • 128 replacing text • 52 E-mail about • 199 add service • 219 all folder • 207 attach file • 203, 205 attachments • 209, 211 before you start • 201 capabilities • 199 change email account details • 221 connecting to send and receive • 216 correcting input errors • 202 detaching • 209, 211 dial tone • 219 directory of email accounts • 218, 219 download and read • 208 drafts folder • 207 Eudora • 199 folder management • 211 folders overview • 207 free database space • 201, 218 Inbox folder • 207 Keymail menu • 200 logging on. • 224 mark e-mail • 212 maximum message size • 216 outbox folder • 207 Outlook Express • 199 pasting text into a field • 16, 224 preparation • 201 received folder • 207 reviewing e-mail • 210 sent folder • 207 service name • 216 Trash folder • 216 E-mail action copy • 214 delete • 212 emboss • 214 forward • 214 mark all • 214 move • 214 print • 214 Embossing about • 93 group of documents • 95 options • 95 pausing embosser • 95 setting up embosser • 93 set-up list • 94, 95, 96, 181, 190, 331 via Bluetooth • 94, 97, 254 via Infrared port • 27, 93, 97 via Parallel port • 94 via Serial port • 27, 93, 97 via USB port • 93 Erase file from file manager • 280, 281 using block commands • 123 Erase folder • 276, 282 Error alert tone volume • 86 Exiting bookreader • 68 Export document about • 292 to a file • 292 to serial port • 293 Extended characters about • 88, 139 assigning a macro • 141 assigning braille dots • 143 changing an assigned macro • 142 entry by name • 139 entry by unicode code • 141 interpreting Braille display • 143 methods of entering • 125, 139 F Favorites adding • 69, 233 organizing • 234 selecting • 224, 233 Fields address list • 184 File Manager about • 273 copy file • 280, 305 copy folder • 275 directory • 274 erase file • 280, 281 move file • 282 protect file • 281, 282 rename file • 280, 281 resolving file extensions • 278 selecting multiple files • 279, 312 sorting file lists • 278 File synchronization • 263, 271 File translation about • 128, 137, 273, 289 ASCII translation options • 122, 123, 293, 294 back translation options • 112, 132, 296, 299 export document • 292 exporting to serial port • 293 forward translation options • 112, 113, 116, 299 from other file types • 128, 137, 273, 289 import Braille file • 291 import from file • 290 import from serial port • 291 File types • 277, 280, 289, 292 Files converting • 263, 272 File • 96, 283 synchronizing • 263, 271 Find • 50, 64 Find and replace • 52 First page number • 109 FM Radio • 323 mute • 325 presetting stations • 324 radio and KeySoft • 325 recording the radio • 325 volume control • 325 Folder description of • 39 Folder manager about • 275 create folder • 275 erase folder • 276, 282 rename folder • 275 Font • 104, 111 Format braille document for printing • 132, 135, 296 factory settings • 108, 109, 138 text document for embossing • 111 Format marker, search for • 46, 51, 298, 300 Forward translation about • 112, 113, 116, 299 heading blank lines • 300 heading format • 300 include capital signs • 300 indent size • 301 italics font • 299 multiple spaces • 300 new line • 299 new page markers • 300 outline style • 300 paragraph boundary • 299 paragraph format • 301 revert to paragraph after • 301 sub-heading blank lines • 301 sub-heading format • 301 tabs • 300 Fractions • 148 Frames - on web pages about • 227 G Games abandoning a game • 352 block marker commands • 350 entering a command wile reading • 351 entering commands • 350 Grade 2 braille • 351 history of text adventure games • 358 Internet Resources • 357 invalid input • 352 Leaving a game • 352 moving between historical moves • 354 reading previous moves • 348, 353 restoring a saved game • 353 Saving Games • 352 shorthand • 351 starting a game • 349 system words • 351 Go to another date • 178 cursor position • 50, 53, 64 Grade of braille • 82 H Handshaking • 94, 95, 96, 181, 190, 331 Hardware • 21 Hayes compatible • 249 Heading style braille to print • 134 Headphones • 7 Help messages • 7, 393 Hibernate Mode • 6 Hyperlinks • 226 HyperTerminal • 33, 86 I Identical to Source style braille to print • 135 print to braille • 113 Import file foreign braille file • 291 from file • 290 from serial port • 291 Incremental backup • 305 Indent • 105, 106 Indenting tab • 106 Infrared port • 27, 259 Insert address • 126 calculation • 164 date • 125 field • 133, 191 text • 47 time • 125 Internet connection disconnect or stay online • 224 disconnecting outside KeyWeb • 224 Internet Options Menu • 224, 230 ISP • 201 J JET EYE PC • 27, 259 Justification • 107 K Keyboard layout • 5 shortcuts • 10 Keyboard learn • 16 Keyboard settings about • 84 braille input grade • 85, 393 prompt for computer braille • 85 KeyBook - see Bookreader • 63 KeyPlan - see Planner • 165 KeySoft menus • 10 KeySync address list • 268 all • 263 PC set up • 264 planner • 271 KeyView • 33 KeyWord advanced features • 101 L LAN Networking • 246, 247, 248 Layout list for text document • 103, 104 marker • 103, 104 Layout Indicator • 108 Left margin • 107 Line reading mode • 45, 54, 120, 124 Line spacing • 107 Lines style braille to print • 135 print to braille • 113 Loading a Book from Another Drive • 68 M Main Menu about • 10 reviewing items on • 8, 9 selecting from • 10 Margin left • 107 right • 107 top and bottom • 109 Margins • 109 Mark e-mail • 212 Marking places • 53 Media Center about • 311 changing tasks • 317 how to play a file • 312 playing file • 312 playlists • 311, 315 recording • 317 restarting track • 313 skipping through tracks • 313 stereo and mono • 316 stop track • 313 streaming audio • 313 track information • 316 volume control • 314 Memory, calculator • 160 Menu block commands menu • 119, 177 connectivity menu • 201, 241 file translation menu • 289 KeyMail • 200 KeyWord • 38 planner • 165 shortcuts • 10 Merging documents • 123 Microsoft Word attachments • 209, 211 create document • 128 email attachments • 199 export document as • 292 translation to and from • 128, 137, 273, 289 Modem external modem • 249 Hayes compatible • 249 internal modem • 249 PC Tel • 249 Mono sound • 315 Move file • 282 MS Word email attachments • 199 N Network client • 255 Networking • 246, 259 connecting via • 246, 247, 248 favorites • 255, 257, 258 New document • 41 Numbers spoken format of • 86 O Online forms - Internet how to fill out • 227, 229 On-line Manual • 19, 87 Open book understanding settings • 65 Outline style braille to print • 135 print to braille • 113 P Page break • 50 number of first page • 109 numbering • 107 settings • 103, 108 Paper length and width • 109 Paragraph style braille to print • 134 Password detail • 216 Pasting text • 121 PC Card about • 29, 30 installing & removing • 30 Place marker about • 53 defining • 53 deleting • 53 jumping to • 53 Planner about • 165 alarms • 178 all day events • 167 calendar • 165 canceling • 178 date entry • 166 date format • 166 date selecting another • 178 editing appointments • 177 embossing and printing • 181 finding an appointment • 176 making notes • 167 menu • 165 modifying • 175, 177 page layout • 166 recurring appointments • 169, 170 rescheduling • 175, 177 review commands • 174 scheduling appointments • 168 set alarm • 168 Plugs and Sockets • 26 Power switch • 6 Presentation style • 104, 112, 134 Printer about • 93 printing braille documents • 99 setting up • 93 set-up list • 100, 111, 191, 332 test • 100 via Infrared port • 27, 93, 97 via Parallel port • 94 via Serial port • 27, 93, 97 via USB port • 93 Prompts cutting off • 8 repeating spoken • 8 Pronunciation Dictionary about • 306 add word • 306 change word • 307 delete word • 308 misspelling • 306 Protect file • 281, 282 Punctuation set level • 85 Q Quick mark • 120 Quit edit • 128 spell check • 56 R Read e-mail • 206 Reading e-mail • 200 modes • 45, 54, 120, 124 review commands • 44 Reading books sample • 63 Reading grade setting • 82 text document • 83 Recording • 317 gain control • 317, 319 making recording • 320 microphones • 317 playback recording • 321 recording levels • 317, 319 setting up • 317, 318 sound quality • 321 Recurring appointments about • 169, 170 daily • 170 frequency • 172 monthly • 171 moving between • 173 weekly • 171 yearly • 172 Rename file • 280, 281 Rename folder • 275 Repeat and spell • 14, 88 hear punctuation • 14, 88 Reset button hard rest • 397 in brief • 6 J-K-L keys reset • 397 S-D-F keys reset • 397 service reset • 398 Restore files • 305 Review commands • 44 Review voice number format • 86 punctuation • 85 Review-only mode • 44, 64 Rich text format export document as • 292 Justify • 103, 110 Right justify • 103, 110 Right margin • 107 S Save document • 127 SD Cards • 31 Search about • 50, 64 and replace • 52 search string • 51 searching back • 51 wildcard • 187 Search and replace • 52 Sub-Folders • 275, 287 Sentence and paragraph reading mode • 45, 54, 120, 124 Serial port • 28, 293 Service email Service • 216 provider • 201 Service name • 216 Service, look up • 221 Shortcuts keyboard • 10 Sockets and Plugs • 26 Speech controls-how to set • 13, 14, 80, 393 hear punctuation • 88 military call sign • 43 pitch • 90 repeat and spell • 88 speed • 90 spelling of words • 44 volume • 90 Speech Settings review • 85 Spell checker about • 54 add word to dictionary • 55 browse dictionary • 57 correct word • 55 exiting from • 56 ignore word • 55 look up word • 56 review suggestions • 56 review word • 54 skip word • 55 user dictionary • 55, 57 Spell folder or filename • 274 SSL • 219 Statistical Operations • 151 Stereo sound • 315 Stopwatch • 80 Storage Cards Card reader • 33 Compact Flash card • 30 SD card • 31 Streaming audio • 313 Sub-Directories creating • 275, 287 erasing • 288 renaming • 276, 287 using • 285 Sub-heading style braille to print • 134 print to braille • 113 Switching documents • 60 Switching off • 17 Synchronization address list • 268 files • 263, 271 how to • 265 planner • 271 setting up • 264 T Tab go to next tab • 125 indenting • 106 regular • 106 Tables navigating online • 237 Task switching documents • 60 Templates creation and use • 133, 191 embossing • 190 Text document about • 102, 128 default settings • 108, 109, 138 font • 104, 111 layout list • 103, 104 page settings • 103, 108 reference 2 • 37 style • 104, 112, 134 underlining • 103, 110 Text settings for braille document about • 132, 135, 296 Ink print exclusion • 137, 298 ink print inclusion • 136 layout • 136 page settings • 138 Time daylight saving • 308 display • 80 format • 308 insert • 125 stopwatch • 80 synchronizing with PC • 262 Time set • 17, 262, 393 timezone set • 308 Time and Date set • 17, 262, 393 Top margin • 109 Translate file about • 128, 137, 273, 289 ASCII • 128, 137, 273, 289 between braille and text • 293 between text and braille • 293 export to file • 292 import file • 290 MICROSOFT • 128, 137, 273, 289 WordPerfect 51 • 128, 137, 273, 289 Translation Menu • 289 Translation options • 132 Trash • 216 Trash folder • 216 E-Mail • 207 U Underline • 103, 110 Unicode characters about • 88, 139 character insertion • 88 macros • 141 view unicode tables • 140 USB activesync using usb • 28, 259, 260 printing • 93 storage devices • 33 USB Host Ports • 29 User guide • 87 User Guide On-line • 19, 87 User settings initial setup • 393 Utilities Menu about • 303 V Version 7.5 VoiceNote mPower QT • 19 View all Files • 276, 282 Visual Display about • 33, 86 commands • 86 use with HyperTerminal • 33, 86 Volume browser progress tones • 86 delete tone • 86 error tone • 86 planner alarm • 179, 180 W Web page moving to another page • 228 reading and navigating • 225 Wild cards file operations • 96, 283 when embossing • 95 Wireless creating a wireless connection • 29, 242, 243, 255 list of configurations • 245 reconnecting to wireless network • 242, 244, 245 scanning for wireless • 242, 244 Word Count • 50 Word processor advanced features • 101 description of • 37 menu • 38 Word wrap • 107 WordPerfect translation to and from • 128, 137, 273, 289 Writing a Simple Document • 11 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 2-24 2-23 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 2-60 2-61 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 3-76 3-77 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 4-90 4-91 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 5-100 5-99 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 6-142 6-143 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 7-180 7-181 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 9-196 9-197 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 10-222 10-221 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 11-236 11-237 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 12-272 12-271 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 13-300 13-301 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 14-310 14-309 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 15-324 15-325 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 16-346 16-345 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 17-358 17-357 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 18-390 18-391 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 394 393 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 2 395 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 398 399 VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide VoiceNote QT mPower User Guide 422 423 432 433